215 34 2MB
English Pages 272 [269] Year 2011
Decolonizing native Histories
narrating native histories Series editors
Editorial Advisory Board
K.TsianinaLomawaima
DeniseY.Arnold
FlorenciaE.Mallon
CharlesR.Hale
AlcidaRitaRamos
RobertaHill
JoanneRappaport
NoenoeK.Silva
DavidWilkins
JuandeDiosYapita
Decolonizing native Histories
Collaboration, Knowledge, and Language in the Americas EditedbyFlorenciaE.Mallon SelectedessaystranslatedbyGladysMcCormick Duke university Press
DurHam & lonDon
2012
©2012DukeUniversityPress Allrightsreserved PrintedintheUnitedStatesofAmerica onacid-freepaper♾ DesignedbyAmyRuthBuchanan TypesetinMinionandOfficinaSans byTsengInformationSystems,Inc. LibraryofCongressCataloging-in- PublicationDataappearonthelast printedpageofthisbook.
contents
AbouttheSeries vii Florenciae.Mallon 1 Introduction.DecolonizingKnowledge, Language,andNarrative
Part one
Land, Sovereignty, and Self-Determination....................................................... 21 J.KehaulaniKauanui 27 HawaiianNationhood,Self-Determination, andInternationalLaw rietDelsing 54 IssuesofLandandSovereignty:TheUneasy RelationshipbetweenChileandRapaNui
Part two
Indigenous Writing and Experiences with Collaboration................................ 79 FernanDogarcésV. 85 QuechuaKnowledge,Orality,andWritings: TheNewspaperConosur Ñawpagman JoannerappaportanDabelarDoraMospacho 122 CollaborationandHistoricalWriting: ChallengesfortheIndigenous–AcademicDialogue JanrusanDDianel.rus 144 TheTallerTzotzilofChiapas,Mexico: ANativeLanguagePublishingProject,1985–2002
Part tHree
Generations of Indigenous Activism and Internal Debates............................ 175 brianKlopoteK 179 DangerousDecolonizing:Indians andBlacksandtheLegacyofJimCrow eDgaresquit 196 NationalistContradictions:Pan-Mayanism, RepresentationsofthePast,andthe ReproductionofInequalitiesinGuatemala Conclusion 219 References 221 Contributors 243 Index 247
vi contents
about tHe series
NarratingNativeHistoriesaimstofosterarethinkingoftheethical,methodological,andconceptualframeworkswithinwhichwelocateourworkonNative historiesandcultures.WeseektocreateaspaceforeffectiveandongoingconversationsbetweenNorthandSouth,Nativesandnon-Natives,academicsand activists,throughouttheAmericasandthePacificregion.Wearecommittedto complicatingandtransgressingthedisciplinaryandepistemologicalboundaries ofestablishedacademicdiscoursesonNativepeoples. This series encourages symmetrical, horizontal, collaborative, and auto- ethnographies;workthatrecognizesNativeintellectuals,culturalinterpreters, andalternativeknowledgeproducerswithinbroaderacademicandintellectual worlds;projectsthatdecolonizetherelationshipbetweenoralityandtextuality; narrativesthatproductivelyworkthetensionsbetweenthenormsofNativeculturesandtherequirementsforevidenceinacademiccircles;andanalysesthat contribute to an understanding of Native peoples’ relationships with nation- states,includinghistoriesofexpropriationandexclusionaswellasprojectsfor autonomyandsovereignty. Decolonizing Native HistoriesrepresentsaninnovativeefforttomotivatedialoguebetweenscholarslivingintheNorthandSouth,academicsandnonacademicactivistintellectuals,indigenousandnonindigenousresearchers,andthe differentbutoverlappingformsofknowledgethatariseoutofthesesubjectpositions.BringingtogetherresearchonNativeLatinAmerica,NorthAmerica,and thePacific,thisbookenquiresintoaseriesofpressingissues:Howdodebates overNativesovereigntyvaryoverthethreeregions?Whatdoesitmeantobean indigenousresearcher,andhowmightnonindigenousscholarsmosteffectively collaboratewiththeirNativecounterparts?Howshouldscholars—whetherNativeornon-Native—whoarecommittedtoNativestrugglesaskhardquestions ofactivists?Whatroutesmustwetaketodecolonizescholarshipinthetwenty- firstcentury?Theanswers,whichrangefromexaminationsofNativestatusin Hawai‘iandEasterIsland,toevaluationsofcollaborativeresearchandwriting techniquesinLatinAmerica,andtoapproachestoraceasacriticalcomponent ofnativenessinNorthAmerica,allcontributetothedialoguewewillneedto decolonizeourscholarshipinthenewmillennium.
Florencia e. mallon
Introduction
DecolonizingKnowledge,Language,andNarrative
ThisbookwasbornataconferenceentitledNarratingNativeHistoriesheld attheUniversityofWisconsin,Madison,inApril2005,ameetingwhich itself was the result of exchanges and collaborations among faculty colleaguesfromvariousdisciplinarydepartmentsandwithdifferentregional specialtieswhosharedaninterestinNativestudies.1NarratingNativeHistoriesbroughttogetherintellectualsandscholar-activists,bothNativeand non-Native,fromHawai‘iandtheAmericas.Forthreedaysweexchanged viewsonhowtoestablishcollaborationsacrossdifferencesoflanguage,culture,region, andhistorical experience thatwouldpermitustodisengage ethnographyaswellasotherformsofnarrativeandresearchfromtheircolonialmoorings. Giventhecrucialroleoftheconceptscolonialismanddecolonizationin theprojectofourconference,inthebookseriesbythesamenamethatit helpedgenerate,andinthisbook,whichbringstogetheraselectionofthe papers originally presented in 2005, it is important to begin with at least somerudimentarydefinitionsofthem.Forthepurposesoftheconference aswellasinthisvolumewehaveusedthesenotionsquiteexpansively,to definerelationshipsofdominationandinequalitythatarosehistoricallyin differentpartsoftheworldwiththeexpansionofEurope.Asthesenotions applytoindigenouspeoples,theyinvolvetheconquestandexpropriationof territories;massivelossoflifethroughwar,forcedlabor,anddisease;erasure ormarginalizationofculturesandlanguages;andtheredefinitionofaprocessofviolentconquestas“inevitable”becauseofsupposeddifferencesin levelsof“civilization.”Ashasbeenwelldocumented,theallegeddifferences ofcultureandso-calledprogressbetweencolonizerandcolonizedwerethen
usedtoconstructavisionofaworldorderinwhichcertainpeopleswere alwayslowerontheevolutionarychain,whatthesubalternistscholarDipeshChakrabartyhastermedthe“not-yet”principleofhistoricalevolution (Chakrabarty 2000). Among the notions central to this worldview is the racialconstructionofwhiteprivilege.Decolonization,therefore,involvesthe questioningoftheracialandevolutionarybasesofcolonialpower,andhow thesehavetendedtounderlietheconstructionofknowledge.2 WecametogetherinMadisonanimatedbyacommonagenda.Sincethe 1970s,whenNativeleadersfromtheAmericasjoinedtheirfellowactivists fromotherpartsoftheworldinreformulatingtheun agendaforindigenous peoples’rightsasapartofinternationalhumanrights,indigenousdemands for political and cultural recognition have generated a series of strong, identity-based Native movements that have challenged the integrationist policies of nation-states. As part of this new political and cultural dynamism,Nativepeopleshavegeneratedtheirownintellectuals,whohavetaken centerstageindebatesoverculturalinterpretationandtranslationandover thenarrationofNativehistories.Insuchacontext,theintellectualagency ofNativepeoplesthemselveshasbeenplacedsquarelyontheagendaofall researchandwritingaboutandwithindigenoussocieties.Scholarsworking onandcollaborating withNative societies, whether themselves Nativeor non-Native,havethereforebeenchallengedtorethinktheethical,methodological,andconceptualframeworkswithinwhichwelocateourworkon questionsofNativehistoriesandcultures. Yetdespitethesechallenges,theanthropologistandactivistVíctorMontejosuggestednearlyadecadeagothat,despitedeclarationstothecontrary sincethemid-1980s,changeonthegroundwasslowincoming(Montejo 2002).Whilecritiquesoftraditionalresearchmethodsandposturesstarted ananimatedandprolongeddebateinanthropology(seeespeciallyClifford andMarcus1986),westillhavealongwaytogoinmovingsuchdebates more fully into the area of concrete ethnographic and dialogic methodologiesandpoliticalpositions.Inspiredinpartbythepioneeringeffortsof suchNativescholarsasDevonMihesuah(1998,2004),LindaTuhiwaiSmith (1999),andAngelaCavenderWilson(1998a,1998b,2004),wewishedtolook comparativelyacrossdistinctregional,tribal,andhistoricaldifferencesin ordertoattempttoformulateabroaderethicalandmethodologicalagenda. Thisvision,asimpliedabove,notonlyinspiredtheconference,butalso inauguratedtheseriesNarratingNativeHistories.Severalvolumesthattake seriouslytheprinciplesdiscussedattheconference,aswellasreflectingthe 2 introDuction
synergybetweenintellectualvisionanddebate,ontheonehand,andconcreteprojectsandmethodologiesontheother,havealreadyfoundahome there. In both the conference and the series, moreover, we were and are committedtotroublingrelationsbetweenNorthandSouthandbetweenthe AmericasandthePacificregion.Attheconferenceourmethodwastodiscuss,withthehelpofsimultaneouslanguageinterpretation,commonissues acrossdifferencesofculture,region,andhistory.Webeganbyaskingourselvesquestionsaroundfivethemes. First,buildingfromtheperceptionthattraditionalacademicnarratives aboutindigenouspeoplesarestillembeddedinacolonialframework,both epistemologicallyandpolitically,wewonderedwhatitwouldmeantoshift ethnographyandotherformsofresearchandnarrativeawayfrommoretraditionalandverticalformsofengagementtowardmoresymmetrical,horizontalapproachesorcounternarratives.HowwouldwenurturecollaborativerelationshipsthatrespecttherightsofNativepeopleandtheircultural expertstomakedecisionsabouttheusetowhichtheirknowledgeisputas wellastheirrighttoberecognizedascoauthorsorparticipantsintheproductionofknowledge?Whogetstotalkaboutwhat,andinwhichlanguage? Second, we wished to consider the relationship of language to power andalsotoempowerment.Inadditiontorecognizingtheurgentnatureof projectstorecoverandstrengthenindigenouslanguages—projectsonwhich anumberoftheconferenceparticipantshaveworkedandareworking—we discussedtheinescapableinteractionsbetweenlanguage,thelegitimation ofvoice,andthepowerrelationsembeddedinallresearchcontexts.How dosocial,political,economic,andculturalfactorsshapetheresearchwedo andthestorieswetell?Asresearchersandwriterscommittedtothecultures aboutwhichwewrite,whatcanwedotofurthertheprocessofrecognition ofNativeintellectuals,culturalinterpreters,andalternativeknowledgeproducerswithinthebroaderacademicandintellectualworlds? Third,asamatterrelatedtoissuesoflanguageandpower,wetalkedabout some of the ways in which colonialism had marked orality as inferior to textuality,andthushadconsideredsocietieswithdifferentrecordsystems as“primitive”or“prehistorical.”Iflanguage,thelaw,andthearchivehave historicallyservedasinstrumentsofcolonialism,wewondered,howcould thesesameinstrumentsbeusedintheconstructionofautonomy?Asresearchers,whatisourroleintheprocessofrecovery,preservation,andextensionofNativeliteraryandnarrativetraditions?Whatistherelationship betweenoralityandtextualityinthisprocess?Isitpossibletodecolonize introDuction 3
language,law,andhistorysothattheybecometoolsintheconstructionof horizontalrelationsbetweenpeoples? Fourth,weconsideredtheimportanceofstorytellingtraditions.Among manyindigenouspeoplesstorytellinghasservedasaformofculturalpreservation and protection, memory and empowerment, legitimacy and autonomy.Isitpossibletoproductivelyworkthroughthetensionsbetween thesebroaderintellectualnarrativeswithinNativeculturesandtherequirementsofevidenceintheacademy?Howcanacademicresearchersweave distinct,divergent,andsometimesconflictualstrandsintotheirstorieswithoutbetrayingtheirownprinciplesorthoseoftheirinterlocutors? Finally,werecognizedthemanychallengesassociatedwithmakingautonomyaviableoptionintoday’sworld.Asindigenousmovementsthroughouttheworldhavedemandedrespectforcultural,political,andterritorial autonomy,questionsconcerningcitizenship,politicalcoalitions,policyoptions, and the legal ramifications of autonomy have become increasingly complex.Howcanweestablishausefuldialogueamongtheextremelydiverseexperienceswithandpracticesofautonomyandsovereigntythatexist intheAmericasandthePacificregion?HowcanresearchersprofitablyinvolvethemselvesinthesedebatesinawaythatisusefultoNativesocieties? Beginningwiththesefivethemes,wethreadedthemthroughparticular topics,includingindigenoussovereignty;collaborationandtruthtellingin researchmethodologies;interculturalconversationsontranslation,inscription,andtheboundariesbetweeninsideandoutside;andthenatureofintellectualandculturalauthority.Partofwhatwefoundalongthewaywasexhilarating,inthesensethattherewerepointsofcommonalityandsolidarity acrossotherwiseseeminglyunbridgeabledistances—geographical,cultural, andlinguistic.Peoplewhocouldcommunicateonlythroughsimultaneous interpretationneverthelessfoundthattheycouldrecognizetheircommon strugglestorecoverNativelanguagesand,throughthem,adistinctvoice.Or theysharedperspectivesinwhichthelinesbetweenacademicandactivist, insideandoutside,oralandwrittencouldbeandhadbeenquestioned,leadingtoamutual,deepcross-fertilizationbetweentheoryandpractice,analysisandexperience.Andallofus,whetherNativeornon-Native,recognized acertaincommonalityinourintellectualworkastranslators,aspeoplewho inhabitfrontiersbetweenworlds,orasbisagras(hinges)whoserveasconnectionsbetweendisparateknowledges,cultures,andplaces. Part of what we discovered was sobering, for the challenges before us seemed daunting and at times overwhelming. We noted deep differences 4 introDuction
betweenNorthandSouth,bothinthehistoricalexperienceofindigenous peopleswithcolonialismandintheplaceofindigenousintellectualsinsocieties and academies. We saw distinctions among indigenous experiences within both North and South, within indigenous groups themselves, and betweentheAmericasandthePacificworld.Weperceivedinternalhierarchiesalonglinesofrace,region,language,andgender. Oneofthemostchallengingthemeswediscussedduringtheconference, onewhichemergesinthisbookgenerally,wastherelationshipbetweenacademicandactivistformsofnarrationandcollaboration.Thiswasanespecially vibrant theme in the presentations about Latin America. Six of the ninepaperspresentedonLatinAmericaanalyzedexperiencesofcollaborationinwhichscholar-activistsparticipatedinprojectsintendedtoputnew technologiesandtools—writing,socialscienceorlinguistictheory,video— attheserviceofindigenouspeopleswhowishedtousethemfortheirown purposes.Inthethreeessaysaboutthistopicthatareincludedhere—those ontheTzotzilMayaofChiapas,theNasaofColombia,andtheQuechuaof Bolivia—non-Nativecollaboratorsinvolvedthemselvesinongoingnegotiationwithindigenousleaderswhoenvisionedtheuseofthesetoolsinpoliticalandintellectualprojectsoftheirownmaking.Whilethesecollaborators werealleducatedintheuniversity,notallhadestablishedthemselveswithin theacademy.Andtheprojectsinwhichtheywereparticipatingdemanded thatNativeagendasbegivenpriorityatalltimes. The three papers presented at the conference that dealt with Native peoplesinHawai‘iandthecontinentalUnitedStateswereallbyNativeacademicsand,whilediverseinthemeandscope,sharedtwogoals.First,they aimedtobringindigenouspoliticalandhistoricalquestionsintotheheart ofacademicdiscussionandtohighlighthowthepresenceofNativescholars intheacademychangedthenatureofintellectualconversation.Second,the threepaperswereinterestedinusingthetoolsofacademicanalysistofosterdebatewithinNativesocietiesthatwouldleadtogreaterempowerment. Thetwothatappearhere,byJ.KehaulaniKauanuionNativeHawaiianoptionsforautonomyandBrianKlopotekonnotionsofraceamongLouisiana Choctaws,aretheworkofcommittedindigenousacademicswhowishto usetheanalyticaltoolsattheirdisposaltomovedebatesonsovereigntyand autonomyforward. Whileoverallthepapersreadatourconferencecannotbetakenasrepresentative,theydosuggestdistincthistoriesofarticulationofacademicand intellectual knowledge to indigenous activism between North and South. introDuction 5
IntheUnitedStates,indigenousscholarsandintellectuals,facingimmense obstacles,havebeenmakinginroadsintotheacademyandintopublicdebate.Whilesuchparticipationisnotapanacea,itdoesopenupnewvenues of academic and political debate that were not present before. In Latin America,whileindigenouspoliticalandintellectualrevivalsarealsobeginningtoopenpublicspaceforNativeperspectives—forexample,amongthe AymarainBolivia,theMapucheinChileandArgentina,theMayainGuatemala,theMiskitoalongNicaragua’sAtlanticCoast,andtheMaya,Zapotec, andothergroupsinMexico—ingeneralithasbeenlesspossiblehistorically forNativeintellectualsintheSouthtoclaimrealspaceintheacademy.In providingexamplesoftheexperiencesandstrugglesofindigenouspeoples inconcretehistoricalcontextsandinrelationtoparticularconstellationsof politicalandeconomicpower,wehopetodeepenourcomparativeconversationsinwaysthatwillbeusefultoindigenouspeoplesandtheirmovements. Perhapsthemostimportantunifyingthemeoftheconference,andthus ofthebook,wastheneedtocollaborateintheprocessofdecolonizationor, asRobertaHillputitduringherconferencecomments,to“getcolonialism offourbacks.”Allthechaptersaddresstheissueofdecolonizingmethodologiesinonewayoranother,andthethemeofdecolonizationservesasa kindofbackboneofthebook.3AsKlopotekexplainsinhisessay,thedouble meaningofthephraseisproductive,inthesensethatweaimbothtodecolonizethemethodologiesusedinresearchandwritingandtoelaborate methodologies that decolonize the relationship between researchers and subjects.Atthesametime,however,theauthorsrepresentedinthebookdevelopvaryingtakesonwhatthismeans. Inthefirstpartofthebook,theessaysbyJ.KehaulaniKauanuiandRiet Delsing(whoseessayistheonlyoneinthebookthatdidnotoriginatein aconferencepresentation)solidifythedialoguebetweentheAmericasand thePacificthatisanimportantpartofourproject.Althoughthehistorical differencesbetweenthetwocasesarequitelarge,wefindsurprisingsimilaritiesandparallels.Oneoftheseisthetimingoftheforcedincorporation oftheterritoriesintodistantnation-states,separatedbyonlyadecade(1888 forRapaNuiorEasterIsland’sannexationtoChile,1898forHawai‘i’sannexationtotheUnitedStates).Thisisnotsurprising,sincethelastdecades ofthenineteenthcenturywere,acrosstheworld,atimeofintensificationof colonialismandofglobalrelationsoftrade,tworeasonsthePacificislands wereattractivetoeconomicallyandmilitarilyexpansivenation-states.Inthis regarditisequallytellingthat,attherespectivemomentsofforcibleannexa6 introDuction
tion,bothChileandtheUnitedStateshadjustemergedvictoriousfromexpansionistwarsandterritorialconquest,ChilefromtheWarofthePacific (1879–84)andtheconquestofMapucheautonomousterritoryin1883,the UnitedStatesfromtheSpanish-AmericanWar(1898). DespitethevastgeographicaldistanceseparatingRapaNuifromHawai‘i, takentogethertheyremindusthattheprocessofcolonialismisatthevery heartofthehistoryofindigenouspeoples.Oneexampleofthatcentrality ishowterritory,includingbothlandandotherresources,isexpropriated throughillegalmeans.InbothRapaNuiandHawai‘i,asDelsingandKauanuimakeclear,concessionsthatwereunderstoodbyNativepeoplestoinvolveuserightswerefraudulentlyandforciblytransformedintoproperty rights.Eventhoughthepoliticalstatusofthetworegionsdifferedgreatly— RapaNuiwasarural,kinship-basedsocietyatthetimeofannexation,while Hawai‘iwasanindependentkingdomandhadbeenrecognizedassuchby EuropeanpowersandtheUnitedStatesfornearlyacentury—colonialviolencecanprovetobeastronglevelingforce.Atthesametime,thedistinct historical experiences of Rapa Nui and Hawai‘i dramatically differentiate theirpresent-dayoptionsfromthoseofotherindigenouspeopleswhoinhabitthecontinentalUnitedStatesandmainlandChile. ThroughadetailedanalysisofHawai‘i’ssovereignhistoryinconversationwithpresent-dayinternationaldebatesaboutthestatusofindigenous peoples,Kauanuichangesthetermsofthediscussionaboutindigenousautonomy. Given the earlier history of the Kingdom of Hawai‘i, there is, in internationallaw,ahistoricalbasisformakingaclaimtoindependentstatus. ApartofthemovementforautonomyinHawai‘ithussupportsthenotion oftotalindependencebasedoninternationallaw.Thereis,however,asizable sectorinHawai‘iwhosevisionforself-determinationwouldpassthrough U.S.law;thisgrouppreferstomakeclaimswithintheU.S.systemoffederalrecognitionthathasevolvedinrelationtotheindigenousnationson continentalsoil.Kauanuimakesclearthatachievingfederalrecognitionfor NativeHawaiianswouldindeedforecloseboththedecolonizationandthe deoccupationmodelsforachievingautonomy,sinceitwoulddefineKanaka Maoli,orindigenousHawaiians,asa“domesticdependent”nationwithno recoursetoindependentstatus. Delsing demonstrates in her discussion of struggles over sovereignty inRapaNuithattheperspectivesoftheRapanuiandthehistoryoftheir strugglecannotbefoldedneatlyeitherintoChileanhistoryorintotheindigenoushistoriesconnectedtotheChileanmainland.OriginallyaPolyintroDuction 7
nesianpeople,theRapanuicontinuetobelinkedtothePacificregion.And whiletodaytheRapanuiareinternallydividedoverthemostappropriate strategiestofollowintheirongoingconfrontationwithChileanassimilationistpolicies,asignificantminoritymovementhasformedaroundtheidea ofpursuingpoliticalindependenceindialoguewithotherPacificpeoples. Part2ofthebookdiscussestheinterrelatedthemesofcross-culturalcollaboration,translation,andwriting.JoanneRappaportandAbelardoRamos Pacho,whohaveformedpartofacollaborativeresearchteamledbyNasa intellectualsinColombiaformanyyears,addressthequestionofcollaborationmostsystematically.Ramosconceptualizesintellectualandtheoretical collaboration as a minga, a project of collective work for collective benefit,whichprovidesuswiththeopportunitytothinkthroughtheconnectionsbetweenphysicalandintellectuallaborandthetensionsbetweenacademicanalysisandpoliticalusefulness.Inevitably,hewrites,collaboration producestensions;butthesebecomeproductivethroughwork.ForRappaport,thisworkinvolvesadialogueamongwaysofknowing—adiálogo de saberes—in which indigenous epistemology is primary but not exclusive. Interculturalism,shesuggests,mustbeagrass-rootspracticethatgoesfar beyondmulticulturalismasanencounterwithinacontextalreadyhegemonized from one side. Building such horizontal relationships is a work in progress,anditssuccesswillbefoundinthepoliticalarticulationofindigenousandnonindigenousculturalregisters. RappaportandRamosalsoexploretheconceptoftranslationanditsrelationshiptowritingorinscription.Translation,inthiscontext,isinseparable from indigenous theorizing, for it is a project of appropriation, rethinking, and reconfiguration of language and concepts from indigenous perspectives.Thismeanstheimprovementandtransformationofreality,not onlyitsanalysisorrepresentationinadifferentlanguage.Culturalaswellas linguistictranslation,therefore,opensupnewpotentialsandpossibilities andgivesaccesstoaninterculturalspacewherenewstrategiesofnegotiation andnewwaysoflivingcanpotentiallybesuggested.Ramosconcludes,along theselines,bysuggestingthatonegoalmaybeanindigenouslygrounded objectivityinwhichthelinebetweenacademicrigorandpoliticalnecessities anddesirescanbemoreeffectivelytroubled. JanRusandDianeL.Rusdiscusshowtheybuiltontheirlong-termpresenceinthehighlandsofChiapasamongtheChamulastocontributetothe TallerTzotzil,analreadyexistingTzotzil-languagepublishingproject,beginninginthe1980s.TheRuses’legitimacywithintheTzotzilcommunity— 8 introDuction
theyhadbeengivenTzotzilnames,whichappearatthebackofthevolumes producedbytheTaller—servedasacrucialentrypointintotheprojectof translationandinscriptioninwhichtheycollaborated.Theirlongpresence intheregionalsohelpedthemunderstandmorefullyissuesofalphabetand orthography,whichcalledtomindthepresenceofBibletranslatorsaswell asProtestantmissionariesandquestionsofdialectandthediversityofvoices presentwithinthenarratives.Indeed,theRuses’projectrevealedhowdeep thenegotiationsandknowledgesinvolvedinasuccessfulprojectoftranslationandinscriptionare,amatterdiscussedbyotherauthorsandsummarizedbyoneofourpanelcommentators,FrankSalomon,whenhesuggested thatindigenouslanguageaccountsbecometextthroughacollaborationthat involvesdecontextualizationandthenrecontextualizationandhencemultipletranslations. But even more important, the Ruses’ work on the Tzotzil publishing projectisanespeciallydramaticexampleofanoptiontakenbymanyprincipled intellectuals and professionals in Latin America in the 1960s and 1970s—that of the committed, engagé collaborator. Rappaport, who has nearlythreedecadesofexperiencewiththeNasaandCumbalpeoplesof Colombia,isanotherexampleofsomeonewhotookthisoption,thoughin hercaseshehasclaimedaplacewithintheacademyintheUnitedStates, something the Ruses have eschewed. In part activist anthropology in the moldofAlcidaRitaRamosandTerrenceTurner,whoalsopresentedpapers atourconference,thispracticeofengagécollaborationhaditsoriginsinthe radicalmobilizationsofthe1960sand,bytheearly1970s,wasinspiredas wellbyliberationtheologyandtheradicalpedagogyofPauloFreire,mentionedbytheRuses. Theseformsofactivistcollaboration,whichexistedinmanypartsofthe so-calledThirdWorldinthe1970sand1980s,tookonaparticularlyintense qualityinLatinAmerica.Partofthereasonforthishadtodowiththespecific history of revolutionary movements in the region, movements that oftenplacedattheirverycenterthecollaborationbetweenurbanintellectualsontheLeftandtheruralpoor,asignificantproportionofwhomwereof indigenousdescent.Atthesametime,theverynatureofLatinAmerica’spoliticalandeconomiccrisesateawayatearliercoalitionsbetweenindigenous peopleandtheLeft,sothatinanumberofareasrelationshipsofcollaborationthathadrestedontheseearliercoalitionseitherfellapartentirelyorhad toberenegotiated.ThishasbeenthecasewiththeChileanMapuche,whose intellectualshaveincreasinglytakencenterstageindefiningresearchand introDuction 9
activistagendas,andithasalsohappenedinotherareasofLatinAmerica, suchasGuatemalaandNicaragua’sAtlanticcoast. AsRamosandRappaportandtheRusesdemonstrate,collaborativerelationshipstendtoendurewhentheyinvolveongoingnegotiations.Inreflectingontheirlong-standingcollaborationthroughtheConsejoRegional Indígena del Cauca (cric), Ramos and Rappaport demonstrate that it is preciselythemomentoffriction,ofdiscomfort,incollaborationthatisthe mostproductive.Ramossuggeststhatitbecomessothroughwork:inother words,throughconcretetasksanddiscussionsthathelpdeepenacommon commitmenttoajointproject.TheRuses,fortheirpart,builtontheirlong- lasting relationship with Tzotzil Maya communities in the Chiapas highlands, especially in Chamula, to configure a unique indigenous language publishingprojectthathasspannedtwodecades,adaptingitsgoalsaccordingtothechangingnatureofconditionsintheregionaswellasinresponse tofeedbackfromtheparticipantsthemselves.Iftheirprojectbeganwiththe purposeofrecoveringpiecesofcommunityindigenoushistoryandmaking themmorebroadlyavailableacrosstheChiapasregion,itwastransformed inthe1990sandbeyond,notonlybytheZapatistauprisingof1994,butalso bythedeepeningeconomiccrisisthatreconstructedthespatiallocationsof TzotzilMayapeople,forcingmanytomigratetothelocalcapitalcityofSan CristóbaldelasCasasandthenincreasinglyacrosstheU.S.-Mexicanborder intosouthernCalifornia. Similar multifaceted moves are at the center of the project described byFernandoGarcésV.inhisessay.Asanonindigenouslinguistoriginally fromEcuadorwhohasbeenworkingonaQuechua-languagenewspaperin Bolivia,Garcésconsidershispositioningtobeacrucialpartofhisproject. Apoliticalprocessatitsverycore,theproductionofthenewspaper,Conosur Ñawpagman,combinesitsdistributionatpoliticaleventsandpeasant gatheringsinCochabambawiththerecordingofnewinterviewsandtestimonials for the next round of articles. At the heart of the newspaper’s project,Garcésargues,iswhathecallstheintertextualplaybetweenorality andwriting.Inscribingoralityintextisnotonlythereproductionofspeech inwriting,butanewactofcommunicationthatinvolvespoliticalmediation. Intertextuality,insuchacontext,includesoralityinaprocessinwhichboth thereceptionandconstructionoftextsarecrucial.Movingbeyondapurist oracademicallygroundednotionofthepreservationofclassicalQuechua intext,GarcésarguesfortheinteractionbetweenQuechuaandtheSpanish writtenwordinordertocreatenewusagesandtostrengthentheQuechua 10 introDuction
language.Ashesuggestedinhisoralremarksattheconference,thepointis nottopreserveQuechuaeitherbylimitingittoacademicuseorputtingitin amuseum(museoficar),buttorevitalizethesocialstrengthofthelanguage bysupportingitslife-givingandlivelyusagesindailypractice. Garcés’s participation in the publication of a Quechua newspaper has been framed, as in the case of Rappaport and Ramos and of the Ruses, withinabroaderhistoryofcollaborationwithindigenouspeasantorganizations.Forhim,therefore,intellectualgoalsmustofnecessitybeinterlaced withissuesofempowermentandsocialjustice.Whilehisknowledgeasalinguisthelpshimconceptualizethevalueofagrass-rootsnewspaperinterms ofthelargerprojectofQuechualanguagerevitalization,hisexperienceasan activistprovideshimwiththetoolsthroughwhichhecanvalueareal-life processoflanguagerecuperationinwhicheverydayusage,wheninscribed intext,allowsfornewpracticesthatcreativelyextendtherelevanceofthe language. Theemphasisontherevitalizationofindigenouslanguagesthroughdynamic and creative forms of translation and inscription and through the honoringofindigenouspracticesandepistemologiesthatincludesalllevels ofsocietyisapowerfulthemeinthechaptersbyGarcés,RamosandRappaport,andtheRuses.Thesenotionsreverberatestronglywiththecallmade byEdgarEsquittoextendanddeepenourunderstandingofthemultiplicity ofMayahistoriesandknowledges.Amongsomeeducatedpan-MayaintellectualsinGuatemala,hesuggests,theuncoveringofaunifiedMayahistorycanpresentapastheretoforehiddenbyofficialGuatemalanversions ofhistory.Whilethisisanimportanttask,whenthemembersofaparticularprofessionalsectoramongtheMayaelaborateit,indialoguewithother knowledgesoutsideofandunknowntoMayaoraltraditions,theycancreate theirownofficialhistorythatpositionsthemas“civilized”inrelationtotheir Mayabrothersandsisters. Itispreciselythesekindsofinternaltensionsanddivisions,andhowthey mightunexpectedlyhelptoreproduceexistingrelationshipsofdiscriminationandinequality,thatformthecoreofKlopotek’sandEsquit’sexplorationsinpart3.InhisworkwiththeLouisianaChoctaws,KlopotekexaminesthewaysinwhichracialclassificationsystemsspecifictotheU.S.South, themselvestheresultofcolonialrelationshipsofracialpower,arereflectedin thedefinitionsofindigeneityusedbysouthernIndiancommunities.Hesuggeststhatafullercritiqueoftheracialhierarchiesembeddedinthegeneral systemofwhiteprivilege,ofhowthe“one-droprule”asappliedtopeopleof introDuction 11
Africandescenthasledtoanti-BlacksensibilitiesamongNativeAmericans asamechanismofself-defense,mightinthelongrunbeapositivemovefor indigenouspeople. Esquit,forhispart,questionscurrentusesofthenotionofinternalcolonialism by pan-Maya intellectuals.4 When the concept is used to explain politicalrelationsbetweenMayaandladinosasseparateyethomogeneous groups,hesuggests,itmayhideasmuchasitreveals.5Towhatextent,he asks,mightsuchausageresultinanunderstandingofapeople’srightsand culture as separate from economics? Would it not be more productive to thinkofpoliticalrelationsasorganized,inamorecomplexway,alongmany linesofdifferenceandhierarchythatexistbetweenandinsidebothMayaand ladinogroups?InthiscontextEsquitsuggeststhatweconsiderinsteadthe colonialshapeofpowerrelations,whichallowsustoconnectclasstonotions ofraceandethnicity,thusopeningthewayforadeeperrecognitionofthe multiplicityofexperiences,perspectives,andhistoryamongtheMaya.6 BothKlopotekandEsquit,asyoungindigenousintellectuals,areraising questionsaboutthepoliticalandintellectualpracticesofapreviousgenerationofleaders.Theirlocationswithinverydifferentsocieties—Klopotekis aChoctawacademicintheUnitedStates,EsquitaMayaanthropologistin Guatemala—configuretheiroptionsastheynegotiatebetweenactivismand intellectualwork.Yetatthesametime,theyshareadesiretoexpanddefinitionsofindigenousidentityandbelongingsothatbroadercoalitionsof peoplewhoidentifyasindigenous,includingthosetraditionallyexcluded fromleadership,canworkmoreeffectivelytodefinecommongoals. The desire to open up indigenous politics to wider coalitions involves aswellthequestionofgender,asEsquitexplainsinhispaperandasalso emergesintheTzotzilpublishingproject.AstheRusesexplain,DianeRus’s collaborationwithMaruchKomesonKomes’slifehistoryinitiatedabroader discussionofaMayawomen’sweavingandembroideringcooperativeasan economicresponsetocrisis.Yetevenasthisgeneratednewresourcesforthe cooperativeitcreateddeepdebatesaboutwomen’seconomicautonomy.Internaltensionsovergenderedpowerrelationshavealsoemergedinother contextsofindigenousmobilization,asisdivulgedintherecentautobiographybythefeministMapucheleaderIsoldeReuque,whowaspresentatthe conference.7 Takentogether,then,thepresentationsattheconferenceandtheessays inthisbookexploreamyriadofthemesrelatingtothechallengesofdecolonization—intellectual, academic, and political. Noenoe Silva and Stéfano 12 introDuction
Varese,giventheperhapsimpossibletaskofsummingupthepapersand ourdiscussionsasapreludetoalastgeneralplenarysession,representedin theircommentssomeofthiscomplexityofsolidarityanddifference.Silva, aNativeHawaiianpoliticalscientistwhoseworkhasdemonstratedhowthe recoveryofHawaiianlanguagesourceschangesthehistoryofU.S.annexationandourunderstandingofHawaiianintellectuallife(Silva2004,2007), emphasizedtheimportanceofstoriesandlanguagetotheempowermentof peoples,illustratingherpointsthroughoutwithnarrativesfromherownexperiencesandthoseofherpeople.Shealsospokeoftheimportanceandthe difficultyoffosteringNativescholars.Sheunderlinedboththepossibilities andthedangersconnectedtothistask,butintheendshesuggestedthatonly byhavingNativevoicesandpresenceintheacademycanweaspiretoatruly interculturaleducationinwhichindigenousepistemologiesandlanguages haveapowerfulvoiceandstandingforall. StéfanoVarese,ontheotherhand,anactivistanthropologisteducatedin PerubutwhohasworkedonindigenousactivismandsovereigntythroughouttheAmericas,focusedonthepowerofpoliticalmobilization.Hestressed thedangerinherentintheacademy’sabsorptionofprojectsaimedatsovereignty, the recuperation of language and territory, and the rewriting of history,suggestingthatindigenousintellectualsneedtobeorganicinthe Gramsciansense.Heemphasizedthepoliticaldimensionsoftheprojectsof recoveryandreclaiming,whethertheseinvolvedlanguageorlandscape,history,memory,orsovereignty.Ultimately,hewarnedagainstoverlyacademic projectsthat,eveninthehandsofindigenousintellectuals,mightrecolonizeindigenousknowledge.Thedifferencesofemphasisandvisioninthe generalcommentsofSilvaandVaresecanhelpframealastsetofreflections thatemergedfromandwerepromptedbyourdiscussionsattheconference. Asthesubsequentconversations,bothformallyattheplenaryandalongthe edgesinmoreinformalone-on-oneexchanges,madeclear,thesedifferences arosepreciselyfromthediversityofexperienceandhistoricalcontextthat existstodayamongindigenouspeoplesintheAmericasandthePacific.But theycanalsobeseeninthecontextofourcommonprojectofdecolonization,whichmustinvolveanunderstandingofhowarespectforandunderstandingofvariationcanleadtonewformsofcreativity. Inherdiscussionofthepoweroflanguageandstories,Silvawasdrawingonadeeptraditionofstruggletohonorthetruthsandepistemological perspectivescontainedinNativeoraltraditions.Asseveraloftheessaysin thisbookargue,thedevelopmentofmorehorizontalandrespectfulformsof introDuction 13
researchandanalysismustnecessarilypassthrougharethinkingofandreencounterwiththeformsofknowledgecontainedinandpassedonthrough oraltradition.Attheconfluenceofseveralintellectualdebates,discussions aboutoralhistoryandalternativeformsofknowledgeandnarrativehavebecomeincreasinglywideranginginrecentyears.Whetherintheformoftestimonio,oralhistory,orsubalternstudies,theseconversationsandconfrontationshavespannedtheglobe.Whilenotallthediscussionshaveconcerned indigenousissues,manyofthemhave,andNativeandnon-Nativescholars ofindigenouscultureshaveplayedprominentrolesinthem.Whileevena representativesampleoftheseconversationsistoolargetocitehere,often themainissuesatstakeconcerntheassessmentofclaimstotruthaccording toestablishedrulesofevidence.8Giventhedistinctnatureoforaltradition andoralhistoryasaperformativemediumbasedonimpartingknowledge andwisdomgainedthroughdirectpersonalexperienceorconnection,the rulesofevidenceassociatedwiththescientificmethodarelessrelevantor applicable.Forsome,thismakesoraltraditionalesserformofevidence,preciselybecauseitisnotverifiable.9 Two complementary answers to this challenge have taken shape. One takesontheacademicprojectofverifiableresearchresultsanddemonstrates howalternativeformsofknowledgeproductionandtransmission,especially oraltradition,contributenew,important,anddistinctperspectivestoour questforknowledge.Theydosopreciselybecausetheyarenotdatabutsystems of thought that provide, as Julie Cruikshank writes in her work on Yukoncommunities,“awindowonthewaysthepastisculturallyconstituted anddiscussed.Inotherwords,”shecontinues,“storieswerenotmerelyabout thepast,theyalsoprovidedguidelinesforunderstandingchange”(Cruikshank2002,13).Similarclaimsaremadeinaverydifferentcontextbythe oralhistorianAlessandroPortelli,whoarguesthattheperformativeandapparentlysubjectiveformoforalhistoryisitsgreateststrength,preciselybecauseitallowsustodigbeyondfacttomeaning(Portelli1991,1997).And itispreciselyinthisaccesstomeaningandinterpretationthatwecanfind apracticalanswertothechallengesetforthbyChakrabarty(2000)when hecallsonustoresistthepositivistclosureofnarrativethatkeepsusfrom understandingalternativeversionsofhistorythatdonotstartfromandend inEurope.10Asecondwaytoconfronttheobjectivistcritiquehasbeento questiontheassumptionofsuperiorityonwhichitisbased.Somescholars,includingLindaTuhiwaiSmith(1999),haveusedpostcolonialandother formsofcriticaltheoryindialoguewithindigenousknowledge toevalu14 introDuction
atetheintellectualbasisuponwhichdominanttheoriesandmethodologies havebeenbuilt.Others,suchasDevonMihesuahandAngelaCavenderWilson(1998,2004),haveaddressedspecifichistoriographiesandtheirminimizationorerasureofNativesources. It was precisely this rich tradition that Silva referred to when she discussedthepowerofstories.Shealsowasmakingreferencetoherownwork onHawaiianlanguagesources,andhowthehighlightingofnewversions, whether oral or written, can and should turn our interpretations of both thepastandthepresentontheirheads.AndforSilva,doingsowithinthe academy,throughtheincreasingpresenceofNativescholarswithinitsgates, isanabsolutelycrucialpriority.ThisisalsothemostimportantpointputforwardintherecentanthologyIndigenizing the Academy(MihesuahandWilson,2004),notinthesensemerelyofinclusionbutalsooftransformation. AsSilvanotedinhercomments,severaloftheauthorsrepresentedinthat book,includingMihesuahandTaiaiakeAlfred,demonstratethatbringing indigenousperspectivesintotheacademymakessenseifandwhenacritical massofindigenousscholarscanbegintochangethewayinwhichacademic knowledgeitselfisorganized,produced,andtaught.11Thismeansnotonly claimingaspacewithinacademiccirclesforindigenouspointsofview,but envisioningatimewhenindigenouslanguages,histories,andepistemologies arepartoftheknowledgethateveryoneseeksout. Onthispoint,SilvaandVaresebroughtthemostdistinctperspectives tothetable.HistoricaldifferencesbetweenNorthandSouth—howNative– staterelationshavebeennegotiated,theroleofacademiclearninginsociety, thenatureofindigenoussocialandpoliticalmovementsandtheirrelationshiptootherformsofresistance—helpexplaininpartthediversevisions ofindigenousparticipationintheacademy.Iftodayasecondgenerationof indigenousscholars,onthebasisofmuchstruggleandsacrifice,isestablishingabeachheadinuniversitysystemsintheUnitedStates,Canada,andNew Zealand,suchisnotyetthecase,withfewexceptions,inLatinAmerica.12The always-present danger of the academy colonizing the indigenous scholar, ratherthantheotherwayaround,isaseriousthreatintheSouth.Butperhapsevenmorestarkisthevariationinthedepthanddegreeofparticipation byindigenousactivistsinclass-basedmovementsforsocialchange. Indeed,asArmandoMuyolemaarguedinhispresentationattheconference,oneofthecentraldistinguishingcharacteristicsofindigenousmovements in Latin America historically has been their close interaction and interrelationwithpopularclass-basedmovements.InLatinAmericathelack introDuction 15
oftreatyornation-to-nationnegotiationsledtoanearlyfragmentationof Nativeterritoriesintosmallcommunitiesandtodirectnegotiationbetween nationalstatesandthesesmall,land-basedpoliticalunits.Asaresult,theindigenousquestionwasdeeplyembeddedinthebroaderlandquestion,and inthemajorityofcasesthemostpromisinglineofstrugglelayinaclassalliancewithotherlandlessorruralpoor.Thisalliancewasbuttressedbythe generallydependentstatusofLatinAmericancountries,whichincreasedthe pressureforacommoncoalitioninfavorofnationaldevelopment,especially intheheadyyearsofreformbetweentheSecondWorldWarandtheendof theVietnamWar. Duringthesethreedecadesnational-popularstatesbasedoncoalitionsof leftistintellectualsandpoliticalparties,trade-unionorganizations,andsome peasantgroupsheldoutpromisesofegalitarianreformastheyconfronted entrenchedoligarchiesandlandowningelites,whileatthesametimepromotingrelationsofso-calledinternalcolonialisminwhichsomeofthepoor endedupbeingmoredeservingthanothers.Still,atamomentinhistory whenchangeseemedpossible,manyfounditmoreimportanttomaintain theunityofallpopularforcesthantotakeexceptiontotheongoingformsof inequalitywithinthereformistalliance.Thegreaterstrengthofclass-based socialandpoliticalmovementsinLatinAmerica,moreover,increasedthe attraction,amonglaboringindigenouspeoplesincityandcountryside,of aclass-basedcoalition.Onemajorexceptiontothesetendenciescouldbe foundamonglowlandindigenouspeoples,particularlyintheAmazonian regionsofVenezuela,Colombia,Peru,Bolivia,andespeciallyBrazil,where Nativepeopleshadlittlepermanentinteractionwithemergingnation-states exceptthroughviolentextractiveindustriesandthespreadofepidemicdiseases(Ramos1995,1998;Turner1995,2002;Varese1970). Itwasonlywiththegeneralizedfailureofnational-democraticandsocialistattemptsatreformandnationalliberation,therefore—mostnotablyin the1970sandearly1980s—thattheclass-alliancestrategywasfinallybrought tocrisisformanyindigenouspeoplesinLatinAmerica.Yet,asCharlesR. HaleandRosamelMillamánhaverecentlyargued(2006),theevolutionof culture-baseddemandsforindigenouspeopleshasledtoanewkindoftrap foractivistsinterestedinautonomy,sinceneoliberalstatesinprocessoftransitiontowarddemocraticrulehavearticulatedarights-baseddiscoursethat provideslimitednewprivilegesforindigenouspeopleswithinthecontextof thenewpoliticalorder.Thishasgivenrise,intheirestimation,totheemer-
16 introDuction
genceof(borrowingatermfromtheAymarahistorianandactivistSilvia RiveraCusicanqui)theindio permitido,or“permissibleIndian,”anewfigure who,inreturnforlimitednewculturalandpoliticalrights,iscolonizedinto theexistingsystem.Sointheend,itseemsthatforahostofhistoricalreasons many Native intellectuals in the South have perhaps a deeper, more enduringsuspicionofandhostilitytowardinstitutions,bothpoliticaland academic.Thiswas,inpart,theperspectivereflectedinVarese’sconcluding comments. AndyetwemustnotoverdrawthecontrastsbetweenNorthandSouth butusethem—asweuseotherdifferencesandtensions—asentrypoints fordeeperreflection.Inourfinalplenarysession,LeilaniBasham,aNative Hawaiian scholar, addressed the nonindigenous people in our midst, remindingusthatrespectfordifferenceandfortheintegrityofculturesmust lieattheheartofallformsofcollaboration.Theminutewestarttofeelproprietary,sheimplied,it’stimetoletgo,toestablisharespectfuldistance. JenniferDenetdaleaddedtothisobservationthat,asWilsonhasnoted,not onlycolonialismbutdecolonizationaswellengendersviolence.“Whenwe speakandwespeakhonestlyandwespeakacrosscultures,”Denetdalesaid, “oneofthethingsthatwillhappenisthattherewillbetension,itwillbe uncomfortable.Don’tbeafraid,staythere,seewhatitfeelslike,seewhatit tasteslike.”13Denetdale’scommentsechoedRamos’searliersuggestionthat collaborationinevitablyleadstotension,butthattensionandcontradiction canbeproductivethroughwork.Theyalsoraised,onceagain,thepainful oruncomfortablequalityofthefrontier,thatplacewhere,asGloriaAnzaldúawrote,“theThirdWorldgratesagainstthefirstandbleeds”(Anzaldúa 1987,3). Asintellectuals,scholars,researchers,andwriterswhoinhabitavarietyof frontiers,wefacethesecontradictionsdaily.Attemptingtobuildnonviolent knowledgemust,perhaps,inevitablybedonealongthefrontier—between worlds,betweenculturesandlanguages,betweenhistoriesandterritories. Whattoolsdowehave?Many,includingthelaw,history,thearchive,the academy, and writing itself, have also been the tools of colonialism. And giventhehistoryofourworld,coulditbeanyotherway?Tobuildnonviolentknowledgewithtoolssteepedinviolencemaybethecoreofourproject. Andweneedtobuildsuchknowledgeglobally,sincetheforcesthatoppose itareglobal,too.AsRamossuggestedduringthediscussions,itisindeeda challengetousethesametoolsthecolonizershaveused.But,heinsisted,it
introDuction 17
isachallengewecantakeoncreativelyandambitiously,withthepurposeof transformingboththeiruseandtheirmeaning.Weofferthisbookinthat spirit.
Notes 1. Colleagues at Wisconsin who participated in the early intellectual planning stagesfortheconferenceareNedBlackhawk,AdaDeer,RobertaHill,PatriciaLoew, LarryNesper,FrankSalomon,andTheresaSchenck.NedBlackhawkinparticular wasmosthelpfulinidentifyingpotentialparticipantsworkingonHawai‘i,theUnited States,andCanada.Ourconferencewasheldinconjunctionwiththegraduatestudentconferenceofthe cic AmericanIndianStudiesConsortium,organizedthat yearinMadisonbyNedBlackhawk.Someoftheparticipantsmadeimportantcontributions to our plenary discussions. For logistical and organizational support, I owethankstotheInstituteforResearchintheHumanitiesandespeciallytoLoretta Freiling;andtotheAmericanIndianStudiesProgram,especiallytoDeniseWyaka. FinancialsupportfortheconferencewasprovidedbytheBurdickVaryFundofthe InstituteforResearchintheHumanities;theAnonymousFundandtheUniversity LecturesCommitteeoftheUniversityofWisconsin;andthenaVe FundoftheLatin American,Caribbean,andIberianStudiesProgram.Thefollowingprograms,offices, anddivisionsoftheUniversityofWisconsincontributedtothepurchase,housing, andmaintenanceofthesimultaneousinterpretationequipmentusedattheconference,whichisnowavailableoncampusforusebyotherinterpreters:theLanguage Institute;theGlobalStudiesProgram;theOfficeofHumanResourceDevelopment; theDivisionofInternationalStudies;theDepartmentofHistory;theOfficeofFacilities,PlanningandManagement;theDivisionofUniversityHousing;theMedical School;theWisconsinUnion;andLearningandSupportServices.SimultaneousinterpretationwasprovidedbyGladysMcCormick,AdanPalau,YeseniaPumarada Cruz,andDonnaVukelich.I’mgratefultoRobertoGaloArroyoforpermissionto usehisartonthecoverofthepaperbackbook.AtDukeUniversityPressI’mgrateful, asalways,toValerieMillholland,MarkMastromarino,andMiriamAngress.Carol Robertsdidherusualexcellentworkontheindex. 2.Theliteratureontheseissuesistooextensivetocitehere.Amongthepioneers intheapplicationofcolonialandpostcolonialtheorytoastudyofindigenousissues isLindaTuhiwaiSmith(1999).Otherstartingpointsforpostcolonialtheorymight includeSaid1978;Chatterjee1986;GuhaandSpivak1988;Prakash1995;Dirlik,Bahl, andGran2000;Loomba,Kaul,Bunzl,Burton,andEsty2005. 3.Thephrase“decolonizingmethodologies”comesfromthetitleofSmith1999. 4.Originallyformulatedasaconcept byPabloGonzález Casanova(1965)and RodolfoStavenhagen(1965),“internalcolonialism”hasbeentakenup,anditsmean-
18 introDuction
ing transformed, by indigenous intellectuals in Guatemala and Bolivia. See Cojtí Cuxil1996;RiveraCusicanquiandBarragán1997;Qayum2002. 5.InmodernGuatemala,thewordladinoisusedtodesignateaHispanicizedperson,usuallyofmixedEuropeanandindigenousdescent;inmanyotherpartsofLatin Americathatpersonwouldbetermedmestizo. 6.Thiscallformoreconsciouslyinclusiveformsofindigenouspoliticsisechoed aswellbyVíctorMontejo(2005). 7.Indigenouswomen,Reuquesuggestedattheconference,canbedoublymarginalizedordoublyinvisible;andyet,asherexperiencewithherbookhasdemonstrated,indigenouswomenarealsoasourceofgreatculturalandpoliticaldynamism. SeeReuquePaillalef2002a,b. 8.SomeexamplesareCruikshank2002;Howe2002;James2000;Mallon2001, 2002,2005;Montejo1987,1999;Portelli1991,1997;Wilson1998. 9.AnexampleofthesedebatescanbefoundinHispanic American Historical Review(1999). 10.IengageinadialoguewithChakrabartyontheseissuesinMallon2005. 11.SeeespeciallyMihesuah’sessay“AmericanIndianHistoryasaFieldofStudy” andAlfred’sessay“WarriorScholarship,”bothinMihesuahandWilson2004. 12. One might argue that within Latin America indigenous intellectuals have madelimitedprogressinenteringacademiccirclesinBolivia,Guatemala,Colombia,Chile,andonNicaragua’sAtlanticcoast,butallgainsarepartialandveryhard tomaintain,giventhefinancialdifficultiesofuniversitiesingeneral.Thetendencyis forindigenousintellectualstodeveloptheirowninstitutions,whicharefinancially fragileaswell.Anespeciallytrenchantexampleoftheseproblemsisrepresentedin ChilebythepublicationofMarimán,Caniuqueo,Millalén,andLevil2006,abook ofessaysbyfouryoungMapuchehistorians,ofwhomonlyone,Marimán,hassofar hadaccesstoaPh.D.program. 13.JenniferDenetdale,GeneralComment,PlenarySession,ConferenceonNarratingNativeHistories,UniversityofWisconsin,Madison,10April2005,transcriptionfromrecordingofthesession.
introDuction 19
since tHe 1970 stheinternationalizationofindigenousmobilizationandthe
formationofglobalizedcoalitionsofNativepeopleshavechangedtheface ofindigenousculturalpoliticsandofindigenousclaimstoautonomy.One ofthevenuesthroughwhichNativeactivismhasbeenmostdramaticallyfelt hasbeentheUnitedNations,whereindigenouspeopleshavesuccessfully pressuredforthepassageofbroad-rangingresolutionssupportingNative rightstoself-determination,autonomy,andterritorialandculturalintegrity. BoththeInternationalLaborOrganization’s(ilo)Convention169,adopted inJune1989andputinforceinSeptember1991,andtheUnitedNations DeclarationontheRightsofIndigenousPeoples,ratifiedinSeptember2007, havebrokennewgroundintheareaofinternationalrecognitionofindigenousrights. Duringthe1990s,asNativepeoplespressuredexistingnation-statesto ratifyandobservetheprinciplesof ilo Convention169intheirdealings withindigenouspeopleswithintheirborders,itbecameclearthatun resolutionscanserveaspowerfulweaponsformobilization.Additionally,the intensificationanddeepeningofinternationaldebateonindigenousissues, buttressedbyback-to-backDecadesofIndigenousPeoplesdeclaredbythe UnitedNations(1990–2000,2000–2010),haveincreasedconsciousnesson the question of Native peoples and their rights, not only among political elites but also in intellectual and academic communities worldwide. And thisnewawarenesshasdoubledbackintoNativesocieties,encouragingnew formsofactivism. Thetwoessaysinpart1situatethestrugglesoftwoindigenouspeoples, the Kanaka Maoli of Hawai‘i and the Rapanui of Rapa Nui, or so-called Easter Island, squarely within this evolving story of international indigenousmobilization.Informedbyliteraturesininternationalpolitics,internationalhumanrights,anddebatesoverindigenousself-determination,these essaystakeabroadviewoftheinteractionsbetweenindigenouspeoplesand thestatesthatcolonizedthem.Thefocusisnotonlocalformsofcultural practiceorhistoricalmemory,butonthehistoricallychangingalternatives availabletoindigenouspeoplesasawholeintheirstruggletoretainland, culture,andresourcesandtoachievesovereigntyandself-determination. KehaulaniKauanuiplacesthehistoricalstruggleofKanakaMaoliboth inthecontextofU.S.federalgovernmentdebatesandwithindiscussionsin
internationallaw.Asshemakesclear,thecaseofHawai‘iisinsomeways uniquebecause,duringthenineteenthcentury,theKingdomofHawai‘ireceived international treaty recognition as a sovereign state. Subsequently, however,theU.S.-backedoverthrowofthekingdomin1893,theillegalannexationofHawai‘iasaU.S.territoryin1898,andtheirregularvotethatled tostatehoodin1959havealladdedlayersofcomplexityandcolonialism, making questions of national sovereignty, deoccupation, and indigenous rightsdeeplyconflictualamongtheislands’inhabitants.Indeed,asKauanui exploresinheressay,noneofthealternativesexistingtoday—whetherindigenousself-determinationunderU.S.federallaworunderinternational law,decolonizationunderinternationallaw,ordeoccupationbasedonthe kingdom’s previous existence as an independent state—attend simultaneouslyandeffectivelytotheneedsofallthoseinvolved. Consciouslydevelopingadifferentkindofanthropologicalperspective, Riet Delsing traces the revitalization and recovery of identity and memoryinRapaNuibothasastoryembeddedinthenarrativeoftheChilean nation-stateandasaninternationalpracticeframedbythelastgeneration of globalized indigenous mobilization. Delsing shows how the history of ChileanexpropriationandcolonizationoftheRapanuiisbothembedded intheevolutionoftheChileannation-stateandisachapterinthebroader storyofChileanPacificimperialismandterritorialexpansion.Atthesame time,shetracesthelinksbetweentheevolutionofanewRapanuiconsciousnessandthedevelopmentofaPacific-basedindigenousconsciousness.In theend,shesuggeststhattherecentturntomilitancybyasectorofRapanui activistsisarticulatedtotheexpansionofinternationalindigenousactivism andtotheRapanui’srecognitionofthemselvesasaPolynesian,ratherthan anAmerican,people. Takentogether,thetwoessaysassumethreeimportanttasksofthecollectionasawhole.First,theyshowhow,intwospecifichistoricalcases,the internationalindigenousmovementand un debatesonindigenousrights havechangedthestrugglesforautonomyandself-determinationoverthe lasttwogenerations.Therichnessofhistoricalcontextprovidedisextremely important,becausesomeanalystshavetendedtoassumethat,ratherthan comingtofruitioninthecontextofthe un debates,indigenousstruggles actuallyoriginatedinthem.Theseessaysdemonstrate,tothecontrary,that thechanginginternationalcontexthasaffordednewvenuesandlanguages withinwhichtoplacealreadyexistingandongoingstrugglesovercultural recognition,resources,andself-determination. Sovereignty and Self-Determination 23
Louisiana
Chiapas
Hawaii
Chimaltenango Cauca Valley
PAC I F I C O C E A N Cochabamba Valley
Rapa Nui
Mapofregionsdiscussedinthebook. Credit:CartographicLaboratory,UniversityofWisconsin,Madison. Mallon 5 x 4 in
08.09.10 ThesecondtasktheessaystakeonistodecenterthefocusofthevolumefromtheAmericas.ByconcentratingonthePacificregion,andspecificallyontwoPolynesianpeoples,theauthorsremindustolookoutside ournational,orevencontinental,boundariesinconsideringtherelationship betweenindigenouspeoplesandcolonialism.DespitethedramaticdifferencesinthehistoryofHawai‘iandRapaNui,certainsimilaritiesinhistoricalperiodizationandeveninlinguisticterminology(forexample,theuseof thewordcanacainRapaNuiandkanakainHawai‘itodenoteindigenous people)standout.Thisprocessofdecenteringcanperhapsbebestappreciatedvisuallybylookingattheaccompanyingmap.Asthereaderwillsee,in ordertoshowHawai‘iitwasnecessarytocutoffaportionofeasternSouth America,givingtheimageacertaincounterintuitivefeel. ThethirdtasktheseessaysperformistoraisethequestionofmethodologyinthewritingofindigenoushistoryandNativenarrative.Wetendto assumethatNativehistory,becauseitisaboutindigenouscommunities,is bestwrittenfromanethnographicperspectivethatseekstogetinsidethe culturesaboutwhichwewrite.Certainlyacloseunderstandingofcultural 24 partone
categoriesandpractices,ofpeople’snarrativesandmemories,muststand atthecenterofhowNativehistoryisrendered.Yetatthesametime,aswe reflectinthisbookonnotionsofdecolonization,wemustalsotaketoheart the fact that broad national and international narratives and analysis are equallyimportantasNativepeoplescontinuetoengagenation-states,intellectuals,politicalorganizations,andacademicpractitioners.Perhaps,inthis sense,decolonizationcanalsobeginathome,aswethinkthroughthemultiplewaysandregistersinwhichtorenderindigenousnarratives,history, andexperienceintheevermoreglobalizedworld.
Sovereignty and Self-Determination 25
J. keHaulani kauanui
HawaiianNationhood,Self-Determination, andInternationalLaw
ThismeasuredoesnotprecludeNativeHawaiiansfromseekingalternativesintheinternationalarena.Thismeasurefocusessolelyonself-determinationwithintheframeworkof federallawandseekstoestablishequalityinthefederalpoliciesextendedtowardsAmericanIndians,AlaskaNativesandNativeHawaiians. —U.S.SenatorDanielKahikinaAkaka(2001a) Letmebeclear—Itisnotmyintention,northeintentionofthedelegation,topreclude effortsofNativeHawaiiansattheinternationallevel.Thescopeofthisbillislimitedto federallaw. —U.S.SenatorDanielKahikinaAkaka(2001b)
U.S.SenatorDanielKahikinaAkaka’sassurances,madein2001,wereinregardtoalegislativeinitiativetorecognizeaNativeHawaiiannationwithin theconfinesofU.S.federalpolicyonTribalNationsthatstillremainsbefore theU.S.Congress.Beginninginthe106thU.S.Congressin2000andcontinuingatleastthroughthe111thCongressin2011,Akaka,aNativeHawaiianDemocratfromtheStateofHawai‘i,introducedthisfederallegislationin ordertosecuretherecognitionofNativeHawaiiansasanindigenouspeople whohavea“specialrelationship”withtheUnitedStatesandthusarightto internalself-determination.Passageofthebillwouldlaythefoundationfora nation-within-a-nationmodelofself-governancedefinedbyU.S.federallaw as“domesticdependentnations”toexercisetherighttoself-government. TheU.S.governmenthasincludedKanakaMaoli(indigenousHawaiians)in over160legislativeactsrelatingtoNativeAmericans.1However,ithasnotincludedKanakaMaoliinitspolicyonNativeself-determination.Akaka’sassertionsthatpassageofthebillwouldnotprecludeKanakaMaolifromseek-
ing“alternativesintheinternationalarena”havebeenhisstandardresponse to challenges posed to him by individuals and organizations opposed to thelegislationbecausetheyfavorHawaiianindependencefromtheUnited States—thatis,therestorationofaHawaiianstateunderinternationallaw. ThesegroupsincludeHuiPuaswellasthosewhoarepartoftheHawaiian IndependenceActionAlliance:thePro-KanakaMaoliIndependenceWorkingGroup,KaPakaukau,KomikeTribunal, honi (HuioNaIke),KaLei MaileAli‘iHawaiianCivicClub,KoaniFoundation,‘OhanaKoa, nFip — Hawai‘i,SpiritualNationofKū—HuiEaCouncilofSovereigns,LivingNation,SettlersforHawaiianIndependence,Mana (MovementforAlohaNo Ka‘Aina),aswellastheHawai‘iInstituteforHumanRights. Akaka’sresponse,however,echoedrepeatedlybyHawai‘i’sstateandfederalofficialsoverthepastdecade,speaksonlytotherightsofindigenous peoplesunderinternationallaw(Namuo2004).Butbecausehismention of“alternativesintheinternationalarena”hereandelsewhereisill-defined, hehasledmanytoinferthatKanakaMaolicouldpursuefullindependence inapostfederalrecognitionpoliticalscenario,iftheysodesire.WhatproponentsoftheAkakabillrefusetoacknowledgeisthatthisstrategydiffers fromtheprevalentHawaiianindependencepositionfromtheoutset.While manyproponentsofU.S.federalrecognitionpresumethatactivistsinthe KanakaMaoliindependencemovementmerelywantcontinuedaccesstothe UnitedNationsasindigenouspeoples,thevastmajorityofproindependence KanakaMaolisupporttwoentirelydifferentlegalstrategiesunderinternationallaw,decolonizationanddeoccupation,neitherofwhichisbasedon indigeneity. Decolonization is specific to colonized peoples in non-self- governingterritories,whiledeoccupationpertainstooccupiedstates. ThehistoryoftheKingdomofHawai‘i,whichwasrecognizedasastate by all major global powers throughout the nineteenth century, provides KanakaMaoliandotherswithararelegalclaimthatshowsthecurrentstate- drivenpushforfederalrecognitiontobeproblematicforoutstandingsovereigntyclaims.2ThisessaycriticallyanalyzesthelimitsofbothAkaka’sfederalproposalforinternalself-determinationandtherightsofindigenous peoplesunderinternationallawtoarguethatpassageoftheNativeHawaiianGovernmentReorganizationActwouldindeedthreatentheindependenceclaimsoftheHawaiiannation,whicharenotnecessarilyprotected bytheDeclarationontheRightsofIndigenousPeoples.Inotherwords,I showhowtheindependenceclaimforthesovereigntyoftheHawaiiankingdomexceedsthecurrentrightsaccordedtoindigenouspeoplesattheUnited 28 J.KehaulaniKauanui
NationsbecausethemonarchywasrecognizedasastatepriortotheU.S.- backedoverthrowin1893. ThecaseofHawai‘iilluminatesthelimitationsofinternationallawasa remedy for the politically fraught history of the kingdom and of Kanaka Maoliasanindigenouspeople.First,Ioffersomehistoricalbackgroundin ordertodelineatethediplomaticrelationsoftheHawaiiankingdomandthe UnitedStates,theU.S.-backedoverthrowofthekingdom,andunilaterally imposedU.S.annexationandcontestedstatehoodforHawai‘iasthefiftieth stateoftheAmericanUnion.Next,Icriticallyexaminetheprospectforinternalself-determinationunderU.S.domesticpolicyasproposedintheNativeHawaiianGovernmentReorganizationActof2009,alsoknownasthe Akakabill,inordertoassessthelimitsofthatmodelofgovernanceasitis detailedinthelegislation.Ialsoexplorethewaysinwhichthebill,ifpassed, couldworktopreemptandprecludetheHawaiiansovereigntyclaimunder internationallaw. The next section delineates the terrain of indigenous peoples’ rights underinternationallawasdistinctfromtherightsofstates.Isuggestthat althoughindigenouspeoples’rightsareexpanding,theystillposelimitsfor theHawaiiansovereigntyclaim—giventhelegalgenealogyoftheHawaiian kingdom,anindependentstate—asitcurrentlyexistsbecauseofthewaythat internationallawcontinuestoprivilegetherightsofstatesovertherightsof peoples.Independenceproponentswhoadvocaterestorationofthekingdomrejectbothindigenousself-determinationunderU.S.policyaswellas indigenousself-determinationunderinternationallawaslegalstrategiesfor recuperatingHawaiiansovereignty.Mostalsorejectdecolonizationunder theUnitedNationsCharter,forreasonsdiscussedbelow,andinsteadadvocatefordeoccupation.However,thatlegalstrategyalsohasshortcomings vis-à-vistheplightofKanakaMaoli,whichIaddress. Thehistoryofoccupationandcolonialismhasgeneratedavarietyofoptions,butnoneofthemseemsufficientintheircurrentscopesinceeachhas seriouslimitationsanddemandsanalternativeapproachtobegintoaddress thiscomplicatedhistoricallegacyinawaythatpromotesrestorativejustice.
From Kingdom to U.S.-Occupied Colony OfficialdiplomaticrelationsbetweentheKingdomofHawai‘iandtheUnited Statestranspiredoverfivedecades.Thetreatiesnegotiatedbetweenthetwo weremadeaftertheU.S.governmentandothernationshadalreadyrecogHawaiian Nationhood 29
nizedthekingdomasanindependentstate.In1842KingKamehamehaIII dispatchedadelegationtotheUnitedStatesandlatertoEuropethatwasendowedwiththepowertosecuretherecognitionofHawaiianindependence bythemajorworldpowersofthetime.On19December1842thedelegation securedtheassuranceofPresidentJohnTyleroftheUnitedStatesofAmericanrecognitionoftheindependenceoftheKingdomofHawai‘i,andsubsequentlyitsecuredformalrecognitionbyGreatBritainandFrance. ThetreatiesbetweentheKingdomofHawai‘iandtheUnitedStateswere notconcernedwithlandorgovernance;theyspecifiedonlyrelationsofpeace andfriendship,commerce,andnavigation.Thefirst,signedatWashington on20December1849,delineatedprotocolsforperpetualpeaceandamity betweenthecountries.Itprovidedforreciprocalcommerceandnavigation, includingtheregulationofdutiesandimportsatfavoredforeignnationrates andpermissionforU.S.whalingshipstodockatselectedHawaiianports. Thesecondtreatywasnegotiatedin1870andconcernedanarrangement betweenthepostalservicesofthekingdomandtheUnitedStates.Thethird treaty,knownastheReciprocityTreaty,wassignedin1875.Thisagreement forcommercialreciprocitymeantnoexportdutywasimposedonHawai‘i ortheUnitedStatesandallowedfortax-freegoodsexchangedbetweenthe twonationstoenterandleaveHawaiianandU.S.ports.In1884thetwonationsnegotiatedaconventiontorenewandsupplementthetreatyof1875. ThisallowedtheUnitedStatesprivilegedaccess,overothernations,touse PearlHarbor.TheconventionspecifiedthattheU.S.governmenthadexclusiverighttoentertheharborandtoestablishandmaintainthereacoaling andrepairstationfortheuseofU.S.vessels.Contrarytopopularopinion, thissupplementtothetreatycedednothingtotheUnitedStatesintheway ofterritory.Last,in1882thetwonationsnegotiatedaconventionbetween thePostOfficeDepartmentoftheUnitedStatesandthePostOfficeDepartmentoftheKingdomofHawai‘iconcerningtheexchangeofmoneyorders. Although neither lands nor sovereignty were ceded in any of these treatiesbyeitherparty,thenumberofeliteforeignersresidinginHawai‘i eventually grew to the point where they threatened the autonomy of the kingdom.WhiteAmericanshadmigratedtotheHawaiianIslandsfromthe timeofthefirstChristianmissionin1820sponsoredbytheAmericanBoard ofCommissionforForeignMissions.AsLilikalaKame‘eleihiwa(1992)has documented,whiteAmericansandEuropeanmerchantsconstitutedtheforeignpopulationinHawai‘ibythe1840s,whenthemissionaries’descendants pressuredKingKamehamehaIIItoprivatizecommunallandholdings.The 30 J.KehaulaniKauanui
Mahelelanddivisionof1848increasedthewealthoftheseforeigners,who managedtosecurevastextensionsofland(Kame‘eleihiwa1992).Inturn, whitesettlers’presenceandpowerincreasedontheislandsthroughoutthe nineteenthcentury(Silva2004;Osorio2002;Kame‘eleihiwa1992).Anglo- AmericanlegalimpositionstransformedHawaiiansocietythroughoutthat periodandmadeforadistinctformofcolonialismaccompaniedbyglobal movementsofcapitalismandChristianitythataffectedtheeverydaylivesof Hawaiianswithregardtowork,family,marriage,andevensexuality(Merry 2000). Eventually, the foreign elites formed their own militia, the Honolulu Rifles, associated with the U.S. military (Silva 2004, 122; Osorio 2002, 239–40).In1887theHonoluluRiflesseizedstrategicpointsinthecity,and mountedarmedpatrolsforcedtherulingmonarch,KingKalakaua,tosign whatbecameknownastheBayonetConstitution,adocumentthatstripped himofhismostimportant executivepowersanddiminished theKanaka Maolivoiceingovernment.Thekingwasnolongerabletoappointmembers totheHouseofNobles.TheBayonetConstitutioncreatedanoligarchyofthe haoleplantersandbusinessmenbyprimarilyempoweringwhiteAmericans andEuropeans.ThenewconstitutiongaveU.S.citizenstherighttovotein Hawaiianelections,whilealargesectoroftheKanakaMaolielectoratewas excludedthroughrigorouspropertyqualificationsandAsianswereentirely disenfranchisedasaliens(Osorio2002,243–45,251–54;Kent1993,55).Every decisionwouldhavetohavetheapprovalofthecabinet,nowmadeupof foreigners.Inaddition,theneworderpreventedthekingfromdismissing thecabinethimselfsincethepowerwasgiventothelegislature,whichcould dismissanycabinetwithasimplemajorityvote(Silva2004,122–26;Osorio 2002,194–97). AlthoughtheHouseofNoblesneverproperlyratifiedtheBayonetConstitution,QueenLili‘uokalani’sattempttopromulgateanewconstitutionto replace it (once she succeeded to the throne after her brother Kalakaua’s death)promptedtheunlawfuloverthrowofthekingdom.In1893U.S.MinisterofForeignAffairsJohnL.Stevens,withthesupportofadozenwhite settlers,organizedtooverthrowQueenLili‘uokalani.Thequeenyieldedher authorityunderprotestbecauseshewasconfidentthatPresidentBenjamin Harrisonwouldendeavortoundotheactionsledbyoneofhisministers. However,thiswasnotthecase,andthosewhooverthrewthekingdomestablishedtheprovisionalgovernment.Eventually,aftersendinganinvestigatoronthematter,thenextpresident,GroverCleveland,declaredtheaction Hawaiian Nationhood 31
under Stevens an act of war and acknowledged that the coup, backed by U.S.Marines,wasunlawful(Cleveland1893).Buthenevermovedtorestore formalrecognitiontothequeen. As this struggle for control was taking place, the provisional governmentestablishedtheRepublicofHawai‘ion4July1894,withSanfordBallardDoleaspresident(Trask1993;Silva2004).Besidesassertingjurisdiction overtheentireislandarchipelago,thisgroupseizedroughly1.8millionacres ofland—KingdomGovernmentandCrownLands—anddeclaredthemfree andclearofanytrustorclaim.Thisdefactogovernmentcededthesesame landstotheUnitedStateswhenitillegallyannexedHawai‘iin1898.Thisis thelandbaseatstakeinthepoliticalstruggletoday,onesorelycontested throughcontemporarylegalchallenges. TheUnitedStatesdidnotannextheHawaiianIslandsbytreaty.Rather,it purportedlyannexedthearchipelagothroughitsowninternaldomesticlaw, theNewlandsResolution.Thislegislationpassedin1898despitemassiveindigenousopposition,asdocumentedbyNoenoeSilva(1998,2004).Kanaka Maoliorganizedintotwokeynationalistgroups,HuiAloha‘AinaandHui Kalai‘Aina,eachofwhichsubmittedpetitionsrepresentingthevastmajority oftheindigenouspeople;thecombinedsignaturesamountedtooverthirty- eightthousand.Becauseonlyoneofthetwopetitionshasbeenrecovered,it isunclearhowmanyindividualssignedbothpetitions.However,onlyforty thousandKanakaMaoliresidedinHawai‘iatthetime(Silva1998,2004).In thetwopetitions,KanakaMaoliclearlystatedtheiroppositiontobecoming partoftheUnitedStates“inanyshapeorform.” In1897theU.S.Senateacceptedthesepetitions,andinthefaceofsuch resistancefounditimpossibletosecurethetwo-thirdsmajorityvoteneeded foratreaty.Regardless,underPresidentWilliamMcKinley,proannexationistsproposedajoint-senateresolution,eventhoughadmittingHawai‘iin thisway,thatis,asanewterritoryandnotastate,violatedtheU.S.Constitution.Ajoint-senateresolutioncouldpasswithonlyasimplemajorityin both houses of Congress. The Newlands Resolution passed in 1898 when theU.S.government“annexed”Hawai‘i.Theresolutionalsomandatedthat therepubliccedeabsolutetitletothepubliclandsformerlybelongingtothe HawaiianKingdomandCrown.TheU.S.governmentincorporatedHawai‘i asacolonialterritorythroughtheOrganicActof1900,whichcreatedspecificlawstoadministertheallegedlypubliclands.Theselawsagainstated thatthelandswerepartofaspecialtrustunderthefederalgovernment’s oversight(ResolutionNo.55,2ndSession,55thCongress,July7,1898;30Sta. 32 J.KehaulaniKauanui
atL.750;2Supp.R.S.895).Theselandsremainthecenterpieceinthestruggle torestoreHawaiianindependencebecauseeventhoughtheyamounttoonly slightly less than one-third of the lands throughout the archipelago, they haveneverfallenintoprivatehands.
From Non-Self-Governing Territory to Fiftieth State of the United States of America In 1946 the United Nations compiled a list of non-self-governing territories on which the U.S. government included Hawai‘i (Trask 1994). Although Hawai‘i was on the list and was therefore entitled toa process of self-determinationtodecolonize,theU.S.governmentpredeterminedstatehoodasthestatusforHawai‘ibytreatingitspoliticalstatusasaninternal domesticissue.Theballotusedin1959whenthepeopleofHawai‘ivotedto becomeastateoftheUnionincludedonlytwooptions:integrationandremainingaU.S.colonialterritory(Trask1994,68–87).Amongthoseallowed totakepartinthevote,settlersaswellasmilitarypersonneloutnumbered Hawaiians. Citing the internal territorial vote, the U.S. State Department thenmisinformedtheUnitedNations,whichinturnconsideredthepeople ofHawai‘itohavefreelyexercisedtheirself-determinationandchosentoincorporatethemselvesaspartoftheUnitedStates(Trask1994).3 Byun criteriaestablishedin1960,butalreadyindebatethepreviousyear andthusknowntotheUnitedStatesatthetimeoftheearliervote,theballotshouldhaveincludedindependenceandfreeassociationaschoices.On 14December1960,theUnitedNationsGeneralAssemblyissuedaDeclarationontheGrantingofIndependencetoColonialCountriesandPeoples— Resolution1514(XV).4Alsoin1960,theassemblyapprovedResolution1541 (XV),whichdefinedfreeassociationwithanindependentstate,integration intoanindependentstate,orindependenceasthethreelegitimateoptions offullself-government.5UnitedNationsGeneralAssemblyResolution1541 referstoterritoriesthatare“geographicallyseparateanddistinctethnically and/orculturally”withoutspecifyingwhat“geographicallyseparate”must entail(Barsh1986,373).Nonetheless,thischapteroftheresolutionhasbeen acceptedasapplicablemainlytooverseascolonization,whilerelegatingindigenouspeoplestoaconditionof“internalcolonization”(Barsh1986,373). Atstakeisprohibitingtheindigenousclaimtothesameself-determination grantedto“bluewater”coloniesbyResolution1514,“whichcanlogicallylead to independence” (Griswold 1996, 101n14). Hence the phrase “all peoples Hawaiian Nationhood 33
havetherightofself-determination”hasbeenmainlyappliedtoinhabitants ofterritoriesdestinedfordecolonizationratherthantoindigenouspeoples (Griswold1996,93). Since1960onlypeoplesrecognizedascolonizedhavehadtherightto freelydeterminetheirpoliticalstatus.Forexample,inthecaseofEastTimor in1999,theEastTimoresefinallyhadtheopportunitytovoteontheirpoliticalstatusthroughaun -sponsoredplebiscite,andtheyvotedtofullydecolonizefromIndonesia.AlthoughtheEastTimoreseareanindigenouspeople, itwasthestatusofEastTimorasacolonyofIndonesiasince1975(andbeforethatofPortugalsincethemid-sixteenthcentury)thatqualifiedthemfor therighttofullself-determination,nottheirstatusasanindigenouspeople perse.ItseemsreasonabletoinferthattherightoftheEastTimoreseto fullself-determinationisduetothebluewaterdoctrineunderinternational law,whichdefinescolonialterritoriesplainlyasthosefarfromthecolonial metropolesassertingruleoverthem. Atthesametime,theUnitedNationsrecognizedHawai‘iasanon-self- governingterritoryfrom1946to1959,duringwhichtimeKanakaMaoliand otherswereeligibleforfulldecolonization.Someargue,therefore,thatthe moststraightforwardlegalargumentinsupportofindependenceisthedecolonizationmodel.ThePro–KanakaMaoliIndependenceWorkingGroup, KaPakaukau,andtheKomikeTribunalhaveconsistentlyworkedtoeducate theHawaiiancommunityabouttheabortedoptionunderthedecolonization model and have advocated that contemporary Kanaka Maoli should beentitledtoaplebiscitetoexercisetheirrighttoself-determinationand determine what model of governance they prefer. However, many sovereignty activists who advocate for kingdom restoration reject this strategy ofreinscriptiononthelistofnon-self-governingterritories.Theymakea distinction between a colonial territory (e.g., Guam, a U.S. territory) and anoccupiedstatesuchastheHawaiiankingdom.Asanalternative,those organizedtorestoretheHawaiiankingdomgovernmentadvocatefordeoccupationratherthandecolonizationandrelyontheinternationallawsof occupationbydrawingonregulationscreatedduringTheHagueConventionIVof1907,specificallyArticle43(Sai2001).6Accordingly,thosewho identifyassubjectsofthekingdomaredemandingthattherecoveryprocessaswellasallchargesagainsttheUnitedStates,beguidedbyTheHague Regulations,notbythe un Charterprovidingforself-determination (Sai 2001).Inotherwords,theyavoidananalysisofcolonialismbecausethey assumethattotalkaboutcolonialisminHawai‘iistolegitimateHawai‘iasa 34 J.KehaulaniKauanui
formerU.S.colonyratherthananoccupiedstate.Becausethekingdomhad alreadysecuredrecognitionofitsindependencein1842,deoccupationsupportersdeclaretheirstatusaskingdomnationalsofanationthathasalready achievedself-determination.SincetheU.S.Congressunilaterallyannexed Hawai‘i through its own domestic law, supporters of deoccupation argue thatthekingdomwasneverreallyannexedandthereforeitsterritorycontinuestobemerelyoccupiedbytheUnitedStates.Unfortunately,thispoliticaldiscourseofachievementhasbeenframedinawaythatisdemeaningto indigenouspeopleswhohavenotformedstatesandrevealsareluctanceto emphasizeoppressionspecifictoKanakaMaolilivingunderU.S.domination.Manyproponentsofkingdomrestoration,muchliketheneoconservativesopposedtotheAkakabill,havedismissedindigenousself-government asrace-basedgovernment,andtheyhavedonesobycastingthekingdom asa“colorblind”governmentbecausenon–KanakaMaoliwereincludedas kingdomsubjects.7 Tocomplicatemattersfurther,thereisnoacknowledgmentthatAmericancolonialismarguablybeganlongbeforetheformaltakeoverofHawai‘i bytheUnitedStates,letalonethattheassimilationistpoliciesimposedon KanakaMaolithroughoutthetwentiethcenturyarecolonialinnature.Any discussions of decolonization—including those in the cultural arena not dependenton un protocols,suchasindigenouslanguagerevitalizationin responsetoyearsofindigenouslanguagesuppression,tocitejustoneexample—aretooquicklydismissedinlegalterms.Theproblemthentakes theformofabattleoverinternationallawratherthanfocusingonthewhite supremacistpracticesandpoliciesthatarepartandparcelofthecolonial subordination of Kanaka Maoli, whether one considers Hawai‘i a former U.S.colonyornot.Themyriadofoppressionsfacedbythevastmajorityof KanakaMaoliincludehighinfantmortalityandlowlifeexpectancy;disproportionateratesofdiabetes,hypertension,heartdisease,cancer,depression, andsuicide;intergenerationaltrauma;criminalizationandhighratesofincarceration;aswellasothersocialillslinkedtoindigenouslanddispossessionandpovertyinducedbycolonialstatus. TheformationofHawai‘iasthefiftiethstateoftheUnionhasbeenused tosilencethepossibilityofdecolonizationfromtheUnitedStates.Here,it seemsthatthebluewaterdoctrineholdsnoeffectivemeaning,eventhough Hawai‘iisovertwothousandmilesfromCaliforniaandnearlyfivethousand milesfromWashington,D.C.Thereinliestheparadox.WhileHawai‘iwasa distantU.S.colonyduringthefirsthalfofthetwentiethcentury,itwasan Hawaiian Nationhood 35
independentstatebeforetheU.S.takeover,whichcomplicatesconventional andlegalnotionsofself-determinationindiscussionsofmostindigenous peoples.Andyet,itisclearthatKanakaMaoliarealsoanindigenouspeople.
Internal Self-Determination: The Akaka Bill Proposal OneofthemainrationalesofferedbyAkakaforhislegislativeproposalfor federallyorganizingaNativeHawaiiangoverningentityistheU.S.congressionalApologyResolutionof1993(PublicLaw103–150),inwhichtheU.S. governmentapologizedtotheHawaiianpeoplefortheU.S.military’srolein theoverthrow.Thisjoint-senateresolution,signedbyPresidentWilliamJ. Clinton came about as a result of efforts by Akaka, who worked to have theresolutionpassedduringtheone-hundred-yearanniversaryoftheoverthrow.Althoughtheapologyincludesadisclaimerattheend,statingthat nothingitcontainscanbeusedtosettleacaseagainsttheUnitedStates,it stillisafindingoffact.Theapologymaintainsthat“theindigenousHawaiian peopleneverdirectlyrelinquishedtheirclaimstotheirinherentsovereignty asapeopleorovertheirnationallandstotheUnitedStates,eitherthrough theirmonarchyorthroughaplebisciteorreferendum”(U.S.PublicLaw103– 150, 103d Congress Joint Resolution 19).8 The apology also calls for some formofreconciliationandself-governanceforNativeHawaiians.Itspecifically states that Congress “expresses its commitment to acknowledge the ramificationsoftheoverthrowoftheKingdomofHawaii,inordertoprovideaproperfoundationforreconciliationbetweentheUnitedStatesand theNativeHawaiianpeople;and...urgesthePresidentoftheUnitedStates toalsoacknowledgetheramificationsoftheoverthrowoftheKingdomof HawaiiandtosupportreconciliationeffortsbetweentheUnitedStatesand theNativeHawaiianpeople”(U.S.PublicLaw103–150,103dCongressJoint Resolution19).Akakahasframedhislegislativeproposal,theNativeHawaiianGovernmentReorganizationActof2009,asthesteptowardreconciliationsupportedintheApologyResolution.Butitwasalsopromptedbythe caseofRice v. Cayetano,inwhichtheU.S.SupremeCourtruledHawaiian- onlyvotingconductedbythestateOfficeofHawaiianAffairsfortrusteeelectionsunconstitutional.9Shortlyaftertheruling,AkakasetupaTaskForceon NativeHawaiianIssuesandthenproposedlegislationtofederallyrecognize aNativeHawaiiangoverningentityasadomesticdependentnationwith theaimofcreatinganinternalgovernmentthatwouldbeimmunetolegal challengestothe14thand15thconstitutionalamendments.Asaresult,many 36 J.KehaulaniKauanui
NativeHawaiiansstaffingstateagenciessuchastheOfficeofHawaiianAffairsandtheDepartmentofHawaiianHomeLands,whicharedependenton stateandfederalfundingforspecificallyindigenousprojectslikePapaOla Lokahi(NativeHawaiianHealthcare)andNāPuaNo’eau(CenterforGifted andTalentedNativeHawaiianChildren),andthevastmajorityofHawaiian civicclubssupportthelegislation. TheAkakabillsetsuptheprocessfortheformationofagoverningentity tobeapprovedbytheU.S.government.Theentitywouldbeformedbya commission of nine members appointed by the secretary of the interior, whosedutyfirstandforemostwouldbetoreporttothesecretary.10ThelegislationallowsfortherecognitiononlyofaNativeHawaiiangoverningentity andnotoftherightsofthatentity,whichwouldbesubjecttolaternegotiationbetweentheU.S.federalgovernment,theNativeHawaiianentity,and theHawai‘istategovernment. Thebillwasfirstintroducedin2000inthe106thCongress,whereitdid notsurvivecommittee,andduringeachsubsequentCongressithasbeen defeatedbyRepublicanopposition(Kauanui2005b).Conservatives’refusal tosupportthemeasurebecamemorepronouncedwhentheadministration ofGeorgeW.Bushtookapositionagainstthelegislation,oppositionwhich lastedthroughoutthatadministration.Althoughthroughoutthatperiodthe legislationgainedcommitteeapprovalinboththeHouseandtheSenate,it remainedstalledwhenitcametoafloordebate.Despitemultiplerevisions andreintroductionsofnewdraftsaimedatsatisfyingtheconcernsofthe Department of the Interior and appeasing Republican critics, who called theproposalaplanfor“race-basedgovernment,”thelegislationneverprogressedtoavote.11 UnderthenewleadershipofPresidentBarackObamathereiswidespread supportforthebill.Sincethestartofthe111thCongresson3January2009 threesetsofproposalshavebeenmade,alltitledtheNativeHawaiianGovernmentReorganizationActof2009:S.381andH.R.862,introducedon 4February2009;S.708andH.R.1711,introducedon25March2009;and S.1011andH.R.2314,introducedon7May2009.S.1011wasgivenahearing beforetheU.S.SenateCommitteeonIndianAffairson6August2009and H.R.2314wasgivenahearingbeforetheU.S.HouseCommitteeonNatural Resources.Atthetimeofthiswritingbothawaitafloordebateandvote.12 Thosewhosupportindependenceopposefederalrecognitionbecauseat theverymostitwouldallowfornomorethanadomesticdependententity underthefullandexclusiveplenarypowerofCongress.Mostimmediately, Hawaiian Nationhood 37
federalrecognitionwouldsetupaprocessforextinguishingmostclaimsto landtitle—exceptforwhateverthestateofHawai‘iandthefederalgovernmentmaybewillingtorelinquishinexchangeforthatrecognition—and eventhentheU.S.federalgovernmentwouldholditintrust.Whatisatstake hereisthe1.8millionacresofformerKingdomCrownandGovernment LandsandtheobliterationoftheHawaiiannation’stitletothem.AstheU.S. SupremeCourtcaseof2009regardingtheselandsshows,thereisabsolutely noguaranteethatanyfutureNativeHawaiiangoverningentitywouldhold anyoftheselands.13 CountertoAkaka’sassurances,thereisalsothelikelihoodthatpassage ofthebillcouldforeclosethesovereigntyclaimforHawaiianindependence underinternationallaw.Thelegislationappearstobeapreemptiveattempt to squash outstanding sovereignty claims unsuccessfully extinguished by Hawai‘i’sbeingadmittedasthefiftiethstateoftheAmericanUnion.Ifthe billpasses,thewillofthepeoplewillseemtohavebeenexpressed—asa formofself-determinationinsupportoffederalrecognition—inawaythat would make international intervention much more far-fetched, given the likelihoodthattheworldcommunitywouldseetheHawaiianquestionas evenmoreofaU.S.domesticissuethanitdoestoday.Inanycase,itwould certainlyentrenchtheHawaiiansovereigntyclaimfurtherwithintheU.S. governmentsincetheNativeHawaiiangoverningentity,asproposedinthe Akakabill,wouldbesubordinatetoboththeHawai‘istategovernmentand theU.S.federalgovernment. Alternatively,supportersoffederalrecognitioninsistthatnothinginthe AkakabillwouldcompromiseHawai‘i’snationalclaimsunderinternational law.ButtheydonotattendtothewaysinwhichtheUnitedStatesassertsits plenarypowertokeepindigenoussovereignsbothdomesticanddependent. InthiscontextitisimportantthataprovisionincludedinS.708wasswiftly removedfromthelaterversion,S.1011.Section11ofS.708.wastitled“Disclaimer”andstated,“NothinginthisActisintendedtoserveasasettlement ofanyclaimsagainsttheUnitedStates,ortoaffecttherightsoftheNative Hawaiianpeopleunderinternationallaw.”Despitethischange,neoconservative opponents to the bill have sought to spread misinformation about thelegislation.ThishadledAkakatoprovidefurtherassurancesindirect contradictiontothoseheonceprovidedtosupportersofHawaiianindependence.InahearingbeforetheU.S.SenateCommitteeonIndianAffairs, herepeatedlyassertedthatthebilldoesnotallowHawai‘itosecedefromthe UnitedStates(Akaka2009). 38 J.KehaulaniKauanui
ThislegislationlimitsHawaiianself-determinationbecauseofitsfundamentallegaldistinctionbetweenIndiantribesandforeignnationsunderthe U.S.Constitutionandfederallawwithspecificregardtotheunextinguished sovereigntyoftheHawaiiankingdom.Thenamealonerepresentswhatis problematicforHawaiiansovereigntyandnationhoodunderinternational law.Embeddedinitstitle,the“NativeHawaiianGovernmentReorganizationActof2009,”isafundamentalhistoricallie:therecanbenoattemptto reorganizeaNativeHawaiiangovernmentbecausetheKingdomofHawai‘i wasaninternationallyrecognizedstatethatinthenineteenthcenturyaffordedcitizenshipstatustomorethanjustindigenousHawaiianpeople.This namemisconstruesthenatureofthegovernment-to-governmentrelationshiptheUnitedStateshadwiththekingdom.Thebillshouldbenamedmore accuratelyasthe“NativeHawaiianGovernmentOrganizationAct.” Thebillassertsthat“theConstitutionvestsCongresswiththeauthority to address the conditions of the indigenous, native people of the United States,”drawingonArticleI,Section8,Clause3oftheU.S.Constitution, whichreadsasfollows:“TheCongressshallhavepower...toregulatecommerce with foreign nations, and among the several states, and with the Indiantribes.”TheU.S.SupremeCourthasruledtimeandtimeagainthat thisclause,knownastheCommerceClause,meanstheU.S.federalgovernmenthastotalandcompletepowerovertribalnations(Wilkins1997).Section(3)ofthebillalsostatesthat“theUnitedStateshasaspecialpoliticaland legalrelationshiptopromotethewelfareofthenativepeopleoftheUnited States,includingNativeHawaiians.”Inotherwords,theU.S.government callsit“special”becauseitregardstribalnationsasinternalnationsthatare bothdomesticanddependentbecausetheyareforcedtoexistwithinthe broaderlegalboundaryassertedbytheU.S.government.YettheU.S.governmentneverlegallyregardedtheHawaiiankingdomasdomesticordependent.UndertheU.S.Constitution,theKingdomofHawai‘iwasregardedas aforeignnation,anindependentsovereignstate. TheU.S.Congresshasrepeatedlydelegateditsauthoritytotheexecutive branchoftheU.S.government.WithregardtoIndiantribes,itdelegatesits authorityspecificallytotheU.S.DepartmentoftheInterior.Thismattersfor thepurposesofthebillsincethelegislationproposestocreateandempower theU.S.OfficeforNativeHawaiianRelations,withintheU.S.Department oftheInterior,tocoordinatethe“specialpoliticalandlegalrelationshipbetweentheUnitedStatesandthatNativeHawaiiangoverningentity.”Foreign nationsdonothaveanyrelationshiptotheU.S.DepartmentoftheInterior Hawaiian Nationhood 39
preciselybecausethatdepartmentisconcernedwithareasconsideredbythe U.S.governmenttobeinternaltotheUnitedStates,areassuchasIndians tribes,U.S.IslandTerritories,andNationalParks.Foreignnationsrelateto theU.S.DepartmentofState. Section4,whichdetailsthepurposeofthebill,claimsthatitwill“provideaprocessforthereorganizationofthesingleNativeHawaiiangoverningentityandthereaffirmationofthespecialpoliticalandlegalrelationshipbetweentheUnitedStatesandthatNativeHawaiiangoverningentity forpurposesofcontinuingagovernment-to-governmentrelationship.”At thesametime,itmakesitclearhowthelegislationlimitsthescopeofself- determination:“NativeHawaiianshave—(A)aninherentrighttoautonomy intheirinternalaffairs;(B)aninherentrightofself-determinationandself- governance;(C)therighttoreorganizeaNativeHawaiiangoverningentity; and(D)therighttobecomeeconomicallyself-sufficient”(Section4,part5). Sections5and6ofthebillgivetheU.S.DepartmentofDefensefreerein. WhereasSection5requirestheproposedU.S.OfficeofNativeHawaiianRelationstoconsultwiththeNativeHawaiianGoverningEntity“beforetaking anyactionsthatmayhavethepotentialtosignificantlyaffectNativeHawaiianresources,rights,orlands,”itmakesanexceptionforanythinghaving todowiththeneeds,wants,anddesiresoftheU.S.DepartmentofDefense: “ThissectionshallhavenoapplicabilitytotheDepartmentofDefenseor to any agency or component of the Department of Defense.” This means thatU.S.militarisminandfromHawaiianwatersandlandscancontinue withoutendandthatneithertheOfficenortheNativeHawaiianGoverning EntitycoulddoanythingtostopitaccordingtoU.S.law.Similarly,Section6, afteroutliningthecompositionanddutiesoftheInteragencyCoordinating Groupsetuptocoordinatefederalprogramsthataddresstheconditionsof NativeHawaiiansandareadministeredbyfederalagenciesotherthanthe DepartmentoftheInterior,reiteratesthat“thissectionshallhavenoapplicabilitytotheDepartmentofDefenseortoanyagencyorcomponentofthe DepartmentofDefense.” Section8reaffirmsthedelegationofU.S.governmentauthoritytothe StateofHawai‘iinordertoaddresstheconditionofNativeHawaiiansunder theHawai‘istateadmissionsact.Withregardtonegotiations,thissection specifiesthataftertheNativeHawaiiangoverningentityiscreated,boththe UnitedStatesandtheStateofHawai‘imayenterintonegotiationswiththe NativeHawaiiangoverningentity.Thissetsthebillapartfromotherforms offederalrecognitionofNativenations,whichdonottypicallygivestate 40 J.KehaulaniKauanui
governmentsanypartinthenegotiations,withtheexceptionofmattersrelatedtoIndiangaming.ThisbillallowstheStateofHawai‘itositatthetable tonegotiatemattersincludingthetransferoflands,naturalresources,and otherassetsandtheprotectionofexistingrightsrelatedtosuchlandsorresources;theexerciseofgovernmentalauthorityoveranytransferredlands, naturalresources,andotherassets,includinglanduse;theexerciseofcivil andcriminaljurisdiction;thedelegationofgovernmentalpowersandauthoritiestotheNativeHawaiiangoverningentitybytheUnitedStatesand theStateofHawai‘i;anyresidualresponsibilitiesoftheUnitedStatesandthe StateofHawai‘i;andgrievancesregardingassertionsofhistoricalwrongs committedagainstNativeHawaiiansbytheUnitedStatesorbytheStateof Hawai‘i.Noneofthesethingsareguaranteedinthebill—notland,notjurisdiction,notassets,notgovernmentalpower.Theyareallopentonegotiation oncerepresentativesofaNativeHawaiiangoverningentitysitdownwith federalandstateagents.Thereisnoequalfootinghere;allnegotiationsmust takeplacewithintheframeworkofU.S.federallawandpolicywithregard toIndiantribesandunderU.S.plenarypower,wheretheU.S.government assertstotalandcompletepower,andinthiscasetheStateofHawai‘iwill haveanequalrole.14 Notably,Section(e)ofthebillstates,“NothinginthisActaltersthecivil orcriminaljurisdictionoftheUnitedStatesortheStateofHawai‘ioverlands andpersonswithintheStateofHawai‘i.”Itfurtherstates,“Thestatusquoof FederalandStatejurisdictioncanchangeonlyasaresultoffurtherlegislation,ifany,enactedaftertheconclusion,inrelevantpart,ofthenegotiation processestablishedinsection8(b).”Inotherwords,whentherepresentativesoftheNativeHawaiiangoverningentitysitatthetabletonegotiatewith federalandstateagents,theycannotnegotiateforcivilorcriminaljurisdictionoveranyland.Inorderforthemtodoso,morelegislationwouldneed tobepassed. Thissectionofthebillalsoincludesadisclaimer:nothingintheactcan createacauseofactionagainsttheUnitedStatesoranyotherentityorperson,oralter“existinglaw,includingexistingcaselaw,regardingobligations onthepartoftheUnitedStatesortheStateofHawai‘iwithregardtoNative HawaiiansoranyNativeHawaiianentity.”Itfurtherstatesthatnothingin thebillcancreateanynewobligationtoNativeHawaiiansunderfederallaw, anditspecificallyoutlinesandprotectsthefederalgovernmentthroughsovereignimmunityagainstlawsuitsforbreachoftrust,landclaims,resource- protection or resource-management claims, or similar types of claims Hawaiian Nationhood 41
broughtbyoronbehalfofNativeHawaiiansortheNativeHawaiiangoverningentity.AnditassertsthattheStateofHawai‘i“retainsitssovereign immunity,unlesswaivedinaccordwithStatelaw,toanyclaim,established underanysourceoflaw,regardingNativeHawaiians,thatexistedpriorto theenactmentofthisAct.” Thislastsection,amongothers,especiallyraisedconcernswithintheNativeHawaiianBarAssociation(nhba).On11June2009,thenhba submittedtestimonytotheHouseCommitteeonNaturalResourcesregardingthe HouseversionoftheAkakabill(H.R.2314).Althoughthenhba expressed itssupportforthebill,itstestimonyoutlinedsomemajorconcerns.Thefirst istheroleoftheU.S.DepartmentofDefenseasitrelatestotheOfficeofNativeHawaiianRelationsandtheNativeHawaiianInteragency.Thesecondis theroleoftheU.S.DepartmentofJustice(DoJ)because,unlikeearlierversionsofthebill,thecurrentlegislationdoesnotincludeaprovisionauthorizingthedesignationofa DoJ representativetoassistintheimplementation and protection of the rights of Native Hawaiians and their political, legal,andtrustrelationshipwiththeUnitedStates.Thethirdconcernwasthe sectionofthebillrelatingto“claimsandsovereigntyimmunity.”Thenhba notes, We believe it is unnecessary and premature to include provisions on claimsandsovereignimmunitypriortofederalrecognitionofaNative HawaiianGovernmentandrecommendthattheseprovisionsundersection8(c)betakenoutofthebill.Suchprovisionscouldbecontemplated duringimplementationlegislationafterfederalrecognitionisconferred andnegotiationsbetweentheNativeHawaiianGoverningEntityandthe StateofHawai‘iandFederalGovernmentarecompleted.Thebill’sprovisionsonclaimsandfederalsovereignimmunityappeartobeoverlybroad andmayprohibitlawsuitsbyindividualNativeHawaiiansforclaimsthat couldbepursuedbyanyothermemberofthegeneralpopulation. Inresponse,Rep.NeilAbercrombieofHawai‘isuggestedthelegislationbe revisitedtoassesswhetheranotherrevisionwasneeded.15 AlthoughtheU.S.SenateCommitteeonIndianAffairsproceededtohold ahearingforthecompanionbilltoH.R.2314,S.1011,theinterventionbythe nhba mayservetoslowdowntheprocesstoallowmorecriticalanalysisof theproposaloverall,atleastamongthoseintheKanakaMaolicommunities bothwithintheislandsandthroughouttheU.S.continent.However,should theAkakabillpass,KanakaMaoliwouldbeshutoutofthedecolonization 42 J.KehaulaniKauanui
model, which would technically leave open the venue for redress offered by the United Nations Declaration on the Rights of Indigenous Peoples. But,asweshallseebelow,foravarietyofreasonsthisisanunsatisfactory alternative.
Self-Determination and the Rights of Indigenous Peoples On13September2007,theUnitedNationsGeneralAssemblyadoptedthe DeclarationontheRightsofIndigenousPeoples.Theresultofnearlythree decadesofactivism,itisthemostcomprehensiveinternationalhumanrights documentaddressingtherightsofindigenouspeoplesallovertheworld.Indigenouspeoplesworldwidehaveworkedfordecadestoensurethattheir preexistinghumanrightsarerecognizedandupheldbyglobalnation-states, especiallysincethedomesticlawsinmostsettlerstateshavenotprotected theirabilitytoasserttheirself-determination.Keyissuesofstruggleinclude the right of ownership and control of territory and resources, protection ofsacredsitesandlands,self-governance,anddecision-makingauthority vis-à-vis the dominant population. Central to all of these is the question ofindigenouspeoples’righttoself-determinationunderinternationallaw. Becausethebasiccriteriadefiningcoloniesunderinternationallawinclude foreigndominationandgeographicalseparationfromthecolonizer,indigenouspeoplesupuntilnowhavebeenatadisadvantageintermsoftheapplicationofdecolonizationprotocols,anissueheatedlydebatedthroughout theworldcommunitybecauseindigenouspeoplesareoftenconsideredtobe subjecttointernalcolonization. This limitation reflects the long-term battle over whether indigenous peoplesshouldbeconsideredpeoplesinthecontextofChapterXIofthe UnitedNationsCharterof1945,whichincludestheDeclarationRegarding Non-Self-GoverningPeoplesinArticle73andwithinUnitedNationsGeneralAssemblyResolution1514,whichreads,“Allpeopleshavetherightto self-determination;byvirtueofthatright,theyfreelydeterminetheirpolitical status and freely pursue their economic, social, and cultural development.”16 Regarding the question of self-determination for indigenous peoples,thestill-citedreportbyJoséMartinezCobo,commissionedbythe UnitedNations,states,“Self-determinationconstitutestheexerciseoffree choicebyindigenouspeoples,whomust,toalargeextent,createthespecificcontentofthisprinciple,inbothitsinternalandexternalexpressions, whichdonotnecessarilyincludetherighttosecedefromtheStateinwhich Hawaiian Nationhood 43
theymayliveandtosetthemselvesupassovereignentities.This right may in fact be expressed in various forms of autonomy within the State”(emphasis added). Thereisnoconsensusonwhetherindigenouspeopleshavetherightto full self-determination—an option that would allow for the development of nation-states that are independent of their former colonizers, like the postcolonialThirdWorld—orwhetherthatrightislimitedtointernalself- determinationwithintheexistingnation-statesinwhichtheyareincluded. Theuseofthetermpeoples,whichsignifieslegalrightsunderinternational lawoverandabovethetermpeople,hasbeenthemostcontentiouspartof thisdebate.ThisformofdiscriminationcanbetracedtotheLawofNations, whichinstitutionalizedtheinternationallegaldiscriminationagainstindigenouspeoples(Newcomb2008). Theestablishmentin1982oftheWorkingGrouponIndigenousPopulations(Wgip),undertheUnitedNationsEconomicandSocialCouncil,led theefforttodraftaspecificinstrumentunderinternationallawthatwould protect indigenous peoples worldwide. The Wgip was informed by early organizations,suchastheInternationalIndianTreatyCouncil,formedin 1977,whichwasthefirstorganizationofindigenouspeoplestobereorganizedasaNon-GovernmentalOrganization(ngo)withConsultativeStatus totheUnitedNationsEconomicandSocialCouncil.Anotherexampleisthe AmericanIndianLawAlliance,foundedin1989,whichalsohasspecialconsultativestatuswiththeEconomicandSocialCounciloftheUnitedNations. Initially,the Wgip submittedafirstdraftofadeclarationontherights ofindigenouspeoplestotheSub-Commission onthePreventionofDiscriminationandProtectionofMinorities,whichwaseventuallyapproved in1994.17ThedraftwassenttotheUnitedNationsCommissiononHuman Rights for further discussion. The declaration was stalled for many years because ofconcerns by states with regard to some ofits core statements, namely,therighttoself-determinationofindigenouspeoplesandthecontrolovernaturalresourcesexistingonindigenouspeoples’traditionallands. By1995anopen-endedintersessionalworkinggroupwasformedwiththe understandingthatsomeversionofthedeclarationwouldbeadoptedby theGeneralAssemblywithintheInternationalDecadeoftheWorld’sIndigenousPeoples(1995–2004).TheUnitedNationsCommissiononHuman Rights extended the mandate of the Wgip into the Second International DecadeoftheWorld’sIndigenousPeoples(2005–2015)andalsourgeditto
44 J.KehaulaniKauanui
presentforun adoptionafinaldraftdeclarationontherightsofindigenous people. TheHumanRightsCounciloftheUnitedNationswasthefirsttoadopt the Declaration on the Rights of Indigenous Peoples, in June 2006, and offeredarecommendationthatitbeadoptedbytheGeneralAssembly.18In thevoteoftheGeneralAssembly,thedeclarationwaspassedwithavoteof 143infavor,4against,and11abstentions.Notably,the4votesagainstthe adoptioncamefromwhitesettlerstates,allwithastrongindigenouspresenceintermsofpoliticalresistancetoFirstWorlddomination:Australia, Canada,NewZealand,andtheUnitedStates.Manyattributetheopposition ofthesestatestogovernmentalfearsthatindigenouspeopleswouldsecede andseekindependence,actswhichpotentiallythreatentodisruptthecontiguouslandmassofthesettlernation-statesthatencompassthem. Regardingtheissueofself-determination,however,thenewlyadopted Declaration on the Rights of Indigenous Peoples is ambiguous. On the one hand, Article 3 states, “Indigenous peoples have the right of self- determination.Byvirtueofthatrighttheyfreelydeterminetheirpolitical statusandfreelypursuetheireconomic,social,andculturaldevelopment.” Butontheotherhand,thelastarticle,Article46,states,“Nothinginthis Declarationmaybe...construedasauthorizingorencouraginganyaction whichwoulddismemberorimpair,totallyorinpart,theterritorialintegrityorpoliticalunityofsovereignandindependentStates.”Forexample,the U.S.governmentwouldsurelybethreatenediftheNavajoNationwereto seekindependence,giventhattheassertedboundariesofthestatesofNew Mexico,Colorado,Utah,andArizonafallwithintheDiné’straditionalterritory.Giventhesetwoseeminglycontradictoryarticles,howarewetounderstandwhattherighttoself-determinationmeansandtowhatextentthat rightcanberealizedbyindigenouspeoples? Article26statesthefollowingwithregardtotraditionallands: 1. Indigenous peoples have the right to the lands, territories and resourceswhichtheyhavetraditionallyowned,occupiedorotherwise usedoracquired. 2. Indigenouspeopleshavetherighttoown,use,developandcontrol thelands,territoriesandresourcesthattheypossessbyreasonoftraditionalownershiporothertraditionaloccupationoruse,aswellas thosewhichtheyhaveotherwiseacquired. 3. Statesshallgivelegalrecognitionandprotectiontotheselands,terHawaiian Nationhood 45
ritoriesandresources.Suchrecognitionshallbeconductedwithdue respecttothecustoms,traditionsandlandtenuresystemsoftheindigenouspeoplesconcerned. Parts1and2hereareexplicitintermsoftherighttoland.Theycouldcertainly be cited in support of the Hawaiian sovereignty proponents in the reclamationoftheHawaiianKingdomCrownandGovernmentLandscontrolledbythestategovernmentofHawai‘iundertheUnitedStates,aswell asotherlandsinthearchipelagoheretoforeunalienatedunderthekingdom duringtheMahelelanddivisionof1848,whichprivatizedtraditionalcommunallands.Thequestionremainshowtheclaimtotraditionallandsbyindigenouspeoplescanbeassertedinlightofthearticlemeanttoprotectthe territorialintegrityofstates. SinceKanakaMaoli(amongthevastmajorityofkingdomheirs)livein a historically occupied state, the question of territorial integrity could be evokedbythosesupportinganindependentHawaiianstate,notsimplythe settler state of the United States.19 The principle of territorial integrity is usuallyoperativevis-à-visotherstates:thatis,onestateisprohibitedfrom invadingandaccessinganotherstate’sterritory,althoughthishappensnonetheless.Article46canbeusedaspoliticalleveragetoadvocatefortheterritorialintegrityoftheKingdomofHawai‘iasastate.TheU.S.government violatedtheHawaiianstate’sterritorialintegritywhenitsupportedanillegal overthrowandunilaterallyannexedHawai‘iincontraventiontoU.S.federal law,itstreatieswiththekingdom,andinternationallawoperativeatthetime. Hence, deoccupation supporters demand that the U.S. government withdrawfromHawai‘i.Still,theU.S.governmentcastsindependenceclaimsas attemptsatsecession,acompletemisnomer. Priortothepassageofthedeclarationmanygovernmentalofficialsassumedthattherightofindigenousgroupstoself-determinationwouldlead tosecession,andthisassumptionwasusedtodenyindigenouspeoplesthis right(Lâm1992).EvenmembersoftheWgip andtheun specialrapporteurs havesharedthisassumptionofstates(Lâm1992).MaivânClechLâmsuggeststhatitispossibleforindigenouspeoplestoexerciseself-determination withoutthreateningtheterritorialintegrityandsovereigntyofthesurroundingstate,especiallysincemosthavevisionsofbecomingautonomouswithoutbecomingnation-states.Infact,mostseekmutuallynegotiatedfreeassociation(Lâm1992;Griswold1996,98).Situationsdifferdependingonthe stateinquestionanditslocation.Forexample,mostindigenousmovements 46 J.KehaulaniKauanui
throughoutNorthandSouthAmericacontinuetofightforanexpansionof cultural,political,andterritorialautonomywithintherespectivesettlerstates thatencompassthem.Withinthesedebatesisthecontinuouscontestation overtheconceptsofsovereignty,self-determination,self-government,and autonomy,whichdifferinmeaningandintentionwithindifferentcontexts. InthecontextoftheUnitedStates,evenifindigenouspeopleshaveno visionofbecomingnation-states,themostbasiccomponentsoffullerautonomywouldlikelydisrupttheterritorialintegrityofthesurroundingstate. Forexample,iftheU.S.governmentweretohonorandabidebyallofthe treatiesitsignedwithindigenousnations;returnmostoftheNationalParks totheindigenouspeoplesfromwhomtheyweretaken;federallyrecognize alltribalnationsandentitieswhoseekthisU.S.domesticmodelofacknowledgment (which includes over two hundred tribal entities that have submittedtheirpetitionsandremainontheBureauofIndianAffairs’waiting list);andrestoreallpreviouslyterminatedtribeswithfederalacknowledgment,onecancertainlyimagineamajorreorderingofsocietyinawaythat wouldaffecttheexistingstateandtheterritorytheU.S.governmentcurrentlyclaimsasitsown.Noneofthesefouractionsneedbetiedtothegoal ofindigenousnationsbecomingnation-states;however,thelikelihoodthat thefederalgovernmentwouldactonanyofthesemattersatthismomentin timeseemsquitefar-fetched.Indeed,indigenouspossessionisacontradictioninherentintheU.S.nation-stateanditsveryfoundations. Today,internationallawyerswhofavornation-statesarguethatindigenouspeoplesdonothaveanunqualifiedrighttoself-determinationunder internationallaw,whilethosewhofavorindigenouspeoplesarguethatthey do(Lâm1992).Thereisnoconsensusregardingthismodel,whichiswhyso manyindigenousactivistshavedevotedmuchtimeandefforttoadvocatingthattheUnitedNationsandtheOrganizationofAmericanStates(oas) adopttheDeclarationontheRightsofIndigenousPeoplesaffirmingthatindigenouspeopleshaveanunqualifiedrighttoself-determination. The Indigenous Caucus at both the United Nations and the oas had consistentlytakenthepositionthatindigenouspeoplesarecolonizedand thereforefallunderthedecolonizationmodel.un documentsandinternationalpracticedemonstratethatself-determinationisarightavailabletoall peoples.Buttherewaswidespreadcontroversyoverwhenagroupofpersons constitute a people who are entitled to self-determination under internationallaw.WhentheU.S.NationalSecurityCounciltookapositiononindigenouspeoplesbeforetheUnitedNationsCommissiononHumanRights Hawaiian Nationhood 47
anditsWorkingGroupontheDraftDeclarationonIndigenousRights,along withasimilaroas draftdeclaration,thecouncilstatedthattheUnitedStates urgedtheuseoftheterminternal self-determinationforindigenouspeoples. Inotherwords,theU.S.positionwasthatusingthetermself-determination wasadvisableonlyifitwasdefinedinawaythatmeantthattherighttoself- determinationsignifiedindigenouspeoples’righttonegotiatetheirrespectivepoliticalstatuseswithintheframeworkoftheexistingnation-state.The debateoverindigenouspeoples’demandfortheuseofthetermpeopleswas crucialtoactivistdemandsunderinternationallaw.TheU.S.governmenthas continuouslyopposedtheuseofthetermpeoples,whichmarksdistinction topeoplehoodandattendantcollectiverightstosovereignty.However,with theadoptionbytheUnitedNationsoftheDeclarationontheRightsofIndigenousPeoples,suchoppositionmaypotentiallychange—especiallyifthe declarationbecomesaconventionwiththefullforceofinternationallaw.
Conclusions ThecomplexhistoryofHawai‘ianditsmultipletransitionsfromsovereign kingdomtooccupiedcolonialterritorytofiftiethU.S.statepresentsaunique challengeaswethinkthroughtheoptionsfordecolonizationthatareavailabletoKanakaMaoliandotherheirsofthekingdom.Giventhelayersof historyandforeignintervention,thereisnoclearoreasywaytoresolvethis problem,especiallysolongastheU.S.governmentcontinuestodominate nationsacrosstheglobewithitspoliticalandmilitarypower.Thehistoryof bothAmericancolonialismandU.S.occupationhasgeneratedavarietyof options—butnoneofthemseemsufficientintheircurrentscopesinceeach hasseriouslimitations. AswesawinthediscussionoftheAkakabill,thestatusofdomesticdependentnationthatwouldbegrantedNativeHawaiiansthroughaprocess offederalrecognitionneitherrecognizesthekingdom’shistoryofsovereign existence nor takes into account the unjust occupation and overthrow of themonarchbytheU.S.government.Atthesametime,relyingonpresently existinginternationallawregardingindigenouspeoplesalsohasthelimitationthat,initspresentstate,itstillgivesprioritytoexistingnation-states andputsthepreexistingrightsofindigenouspeoplesasnationsontheback burner. While this may change, for the moment neither of these options givesKanakaMaoliorotherheirsofthekingdomthesatisfactionofrecognizingtheirpreviouslyindependentstatus. 48 J.KehaulaniKauanui
Yet,aswealsosawbriefly,thedeoccupationmodel,whiletakingaccount ofsuchindependentstatus,alsodeniestheinternalcolonialismintermsof culture,language,andterritorytowhichtheKanakaMaolihavebeenspecificallysubjected.Itseemsasthoughrecognitionoftheprevioussovereigntyof thekingdomcurrentlyrestsonthedenialofinternalformsofdomination. Intheend,therefore,theredoesnotseemtobeonealternativethatboth recognizesthekingdom’shistoryofsovereigntyandprovidesKanakaMaoli withtheculturalandterritorial restitution towhichtheyaspire.Furthermore,althoughKanakaMaoliconstitutedthemajorityofthekingdom’ssubjectspriortotheoverthrowin1893,KanakaMaoliandotherheirsofthe kingdomtogetherareademographicminorityinHawai‘i’scurrentpopulation.Thisbegsthequestionastohowthekingdomgovernmentwouldbe restoredifindependencebecameafeasiblepoliticalgoal,sincewithinthe contemporaryworldcommunityminority-ledgovernmentsareviewedas unacceptable.Inresponsetothisproblematic,thenormativesolutionunder internationallawthatwouldhaveallcitizensequallyenfranchisedwithout anydifferentialstatusforKanakaMaoliandotherheirsraisesthepossibility thatKanakaMaoliwouldonceagainbeavulnerableindigenousminority underanindependentHawaiiangovernmentandthushavetorelyonthe indigenousrightsprovidedundercurrentinternationallaw,asitisnowin anycase. Inan“UrgentOpenLettertoU.S.PresidentBarackObama”dated13April 2009,aself-selectedgroupofKanakaMaoli,kupuna(elders),kumu(educators),andrepresentativeswroteonbehalfoftheKanakaMaolipeopleas wellasofotherheirsoftheKingdomofHawai‘i.Signatoriesalsoincluded anumberofourkako‘o(supporters)whowereinvitedtoaddtheirnames.20 Theletter’sprimarypurposewastoinformthepresidentofthesignatories’ categoricaloppositiontotheproposedlegislation.Italsoproposedanalternativebilateralapproachtobegintoaddressthecomplexlegacydetailedin thisessayinawaythatpromotesrestorativejustice.Theletterreadinpartas follows: The Bill arrogantly attempts to unilaterally characterize the historical transgressions of the United States against our people and kingdom, andtounilaterallyspecifytheirremedy.Weinsistotherwise.U.S.crimes againstourKanakaMaolipeopleandotherKingdomheirsfrom1893on require,fortheirredress,thatamechanismcomposedofU.S.agentsand whollyindependentrepresentativesofKanakaMaoliandKingdomheirs Hawaiian Nationhood 49
bebilaterallysetupbyyourAdministrationandustomakefindingsof factandconclusionsofinternationallawthatcouldserveasaroad-map fortheresolutionofthepoliticalandlegalissuesnowoutstandingbetweenourtwoparties. Asthisessayhasmadeclear,thecomplexhistoriesofcolonialism,occupation,anddiscriminationtowhichNativepeopleshavebeensubjectacross theglobehavenosinglesolution,preciselybecauseeachcasehasitsown particularcharacteristics.GiventheespeciallyfraughthistoryoftheHawaiiancase,thecombinationofinternationallawandhonestbilateraldialogue might be the only venue open for redress. But it is also my hope that, if broughttofruition,suchdialoguemightprovideanexampleofwhatcould bepossibleforindigenousnationsinotherpartsoftheworld.
Notes ThisessaybeganasapresentationdeliveredattheNativeAmericanStudiesSymposium“NarratingNativeAmericanHistoryintheAmericas,”UniversityofWisconsin,Madison,7–10April2005.IwouldliketothankFlorenciaMallonandNed Blackhawkforinvitingmetopresentmyworkthere,aswellasthefollowingindividualsandinstitutionsthatcreatedopportunitiesformetopresentvariousworking versions of this piece: Jessica Cattelino and Miranda Johnson for inviting me topresentattheComparativeColonialismsworkshophostedbytheAnthropology DepartmentoftheUniversityofChicago;AileenMoreton-Robinsonforinvitingme topresentanearlierversionfortheinaugurallecturefortheIndigenousStudiesResearchNetwork,QueenslandUniversityofTechnologyinBrisbane,Australia;and AlyssaMt.PleasantforinvitingmetopresentattheAmericanStudiescolloquium atYaleUniversity. 1. Congress has enacted numerous special provisions of law for the benefit of NativeHawaiiansintheareasofhealth,education,labor,andhousing.Alongwith AmericanIndiansandAlaskaNatives,NativeHawaiianshavebeenincludedinover 160federalactsforNativeAmericanssince1903.Tosomedegree,then,theU.S.CongresshasrecognizedthataspecialrelationshipexistsbetweentheUnitedStatesand theNativeHawaiianpeoplewhenitextendedsomeofthesamerightsandprivileges accordedtoAmericanIndian,AlaskaNative,Inuit,andAleutcommunities.Relevant legislationincludestheNativeAmericanProgramsActof1974(42usc 2991etseq.), theAmericanIndianReligiousFreedomAct(42 usc 1996),theNationalMuseum oftheAmericanIndianAct(20usc 80qetseq.),theNativeAmericanGravesProtectionandRepatriationAct(25 usc 3001etseq.),theNationalHistoricPreservationAct(16usc 470etseq.),andtheNativeAmericanLanguagesAct(25usc 2901 50 J.KehaulaniKauanui
etseq.).Also,underTitleVIIIoftheNativeAmericanProgramsActof1975,Native PacificIslandersaredefinedasNativeAmericans.TherearealsoseveralHawaiian- specificfederalacts,comparabletothoseprovidingforAmericanIndiansandAlaskanNatives,suchastheNativeHawaiianHealthCareActandtheNativeHawaiian EducationAct.InalloftheseactsHawaiiansaredefinedbythemostinclusivedefinition:“Anyindividualwhoisadescendentoftheaboriginalpeoplewho,priorto 1778,occupiedandexercisedsovereigntyintheareathatnowconstitutestheStateof Hawaii.” 2.TheUnitedStatesandmembersoftheinternationalcommunityalsorecognized the Kingdom of Hawai‘i’s independence through treaty relations with the majorpowersoftheworld,includingnotonlytheUnitedStates(1849,1870,1875, 1883,and1884),butalsoAustria-Hungary(1875),Belgium(1862),Denmark(1846), France(1846and1857),Germany(1879),GreatBritain(1836,1846,and1851),Italy (1863),Japan(1871and1886),theNetherlands(1862),Portugal(1882),Russia(1869), Samoa(1887),Spain(1863),theSwissConfederation(1864),andSwedenandNorway (1852). 3.ThefiftiethanniversaryofU.S.statehoodforHawai‘i,in2009,markedanopportunity for scholars to investigate the details of the vote issued by the colonial administrationintheHawaiianIslandsatthetime.SomeoftheissuesthatneedresearchattentionincludetheexecutivedecisionsthatallowedbothU.S.militaryand othernon-Hawaiianresidentstovote(regardlessofwhetherornottheyweredescendantsoftheKanakaMaoliandnon-HawaiiansresidingintheIslandspriorto theunlawfulU.S.annexation),andacarefulstudyofthereportsissuedbytheU.S. representativetotheUnitedNations,whoreportedthatHawaiianshadalreadyexercisedself-determinationinthevoteof1959andthereforeshouldberemovedfrom theun listofnon-self-governingterritories. 4.Seewww.un.org/Depts./dpi/decolonization/declaration.htm. 5. In 1962 the General Assembly established a special committee, now known astheSpecialCommitteeof24onDecolonization,toexaminetheapplicationof thedeclarationandtomakerecommendationsonitsimplementation.http://www .un.org/Depts/dpi/decolonization/declaration.htm. 6.Seealsohttp://www.hawaiiankingdom.org/. 7.Here,too,theproponentsofkingdomrestorationengaginginthisproblematic critiquedonotacknowledgethatindigenousgoverningsystemsbyandlargehave alwaysmanagedtoincorporateoutsiderstoo,eveniftheydonotdosounderthe auspicesofastategovernment.Moreover,thereseemstobelittleunderstandingthat contemporarytribesthathavebeengrantedU.S.federalrecognition,forexample, maylimittheircitizenrytothoseofwhoaretheirspecificindigeneity,butthismay alsobebecausetheU.S.governmentmaintainsthatitstrustobligationislimitedto thosewhohaveancestryfromanygivenNativeNationandnotnon-Natives. 8.Unfortunately,asdiscussedbelow,intheU.S.SupremeCourtrulinginState Hawaiian Nationhood 51
of Hawaii v. Office of Hawaiian Affairs, et al.,thecourtruledthattheapologywas merelysymbolicandhadnolegaleffectwhenitcomestothequestionoflandtitle. 9.Foracriticalaccountofthislegalcase,seeKauanui(2002). 10.ThisprocessofappointmentsalreadysettheproposalapartfromtheIndian ReorganizationActof1934. 11.ForacriticalanalysisoftheneoconservativeforcesontheIslandsthatorganizedagainstthelegislationbecausetheyregardeditasaproposalforrace-based government,seeKauanui(2008). 12.ForinformationonS.1011andH.R.2314andtheirpredecessors,seehttp:// thomas.loc.gov/cgi-bin(accessed11August2009). 13.On31March2009theU.S.SupremeCourtissueditsrulinginState of Hawaii v. Office of Hawaiian Affairs, et al.TheStateofHawai‘iaskedthehighcourtwhetheror notthestatehastheauthoritytosell,exchange,ortransfer1.2millionacresofland formerlyheldbytheHawaiianmonarchyasCrownandGovernmentLands.Prior tothestate’sappealtotheU.S.SupremeCourt,theHawai‘iSupremeCourtunanimouslyruledthatthestateshouldkeepthelandtrustintactuntilKanakaMaoli’s claimstotheselandsaresettledandprohibitedthestatefromsellingorotherwise disposingofthepropertiestoprivateparties;itdidsobasedonanApologyResolutionof1993issuedbyCongresstotheHawaiianpeople.TheU.S.SupremeCourt reversedthejudgmentoftheHawai‘iSupremeCourtandremandedthecaseforfurtherproceedingswiththestipulationthattheoutcomenotbeinconsistentwiththe U.S.SupremeCourt’sopinion.Thecontestedlandbaseconstitutes29percentofthe totallandareaofwhatisnowknownastheStateofHawai‘iandalmostalltheland claimedbythestateaspubliclands.TheselandswereunilaterallyclaimedbytheU.S. federal government when it unilaterally annexed the Hawaiian Islands through a jointresolutionbytheU.S.Congressin1898,aftertheyhadbeen“ceded”bytheRepublicofHawai‘i,whichhadestablisheditselfayearafterthearmedandunlawful overthrowoftheHawaiianmonarchyunderQueenLili‘uokalaniin1893.TheCourt insiststhattheapologydoesnotchangethelegallandscapeorrestructuretherights andobligationsofthestate.Therulingstatesthattheapologywould“raisegraveconstitutionalconcernsifitpurportedto‘cloud’Hawai‘i’stitletoitssovereignlandsmore thanthreedecadesaftertheState’sadmissiontotheunion.”TheCourtfurtheropined that“Congresscannot,afterstatehood,reserveorconveysubmergedlandsthathave alreadybeenbestoweduponaState.”ButiftheApologyResolutionhasnoteethin thecourtoftheconqueror,howisitthattheNewlandsResolutionthatunilaterally annexedHawai‘idoes? 14.ThispartofthelegislationshouldworryNativeNationsacrossIndianCountry sinceitgivesstategovernmentsacentralrolealongsidetheNativegoverningentity andthefederalgovernment.AlthoughAkaka,eversincehisproposalwasfirstintroducedin2000,hascontinuouslyassertedthathismeasureseekstoestablishequality inthefederalpoliciesextendedtowardAmericanIndians,AlaskaNatives,andNative 52 J.KehaulaniKauanui
Hawaiians,themostrecentversionofthelegislationmakesitclearthatthatisnotat allthecase.Section9,titled“ApplicabilityofCertainFederalLaws,”actuallyspells outtheinapplicabilityofcertainfederallaws—thosepertainingtofederallyrecognizedIndiantribesthatwouldnotapplytotheNativeHawaiiangoverningentity.All oftheselawsthatexcludetheNativeHawaiiangoverningentityhappentobelaws thatgreatlybenefittribalnations.TheNativeHawaiiangoverningentitywouldnotbe allowedtoclaimrightsundertheIndianGamingRegulatoryAct.TheNativeHawaiiangoverningentitywouldnotbeallowedtohavethesecretaryoftheinteriortake landintotrustonbehalfoftheNativeHawaiiangoverningentity.Thisisimportant becauseonlylandheldintrustbythefederalgovernmentonbehalfofNativeNations isallowedtobeusedbyIndiantribesaspartoftheirsovereignlandbasewherethey canassertjurisdiction.TheNativeHawaiiangoverningentitywouldnotbeallowed torelyontheIndianTradeandIntercourseActtochallengehowtheStateofHawai‘i acquiredtheKingdomofHawai‘iCrownandGovernmentLands.NootherNative HawaiiangroupwouldbeeligibleforrecognitionundertheFederalAcknowledgmentProcess.TheNativeHawaiiangoverningentitywouldnotbeeligibleforIndian ProgramsandServices. 15.SomewithintheNativeHawaiiancommunityinHawai‘ihavespeculatedthat Abercrombie’sresponsivenesstothe nhba ’sconcernsmaybeappropriatelylinked tohiscampaignforelectionasHawai‘i’sstategovernorin2010. 16.www.un.org/aboutun/charter. 17.www.un.org/esa. 18.www.ohchr.org. 19. Thanks to Andrea Carmen, executive director of the International Indian TreatyCouncil(thefirstorganizationofindigenouspeoplestobereorganizedasa nongovernmentalorganization),who,inaninterviewformyradioshow,“Indigenous Politics: From Native New England and Beyond,” explained that Article 46 canbeinterpretedforthebenefitofHawaiianindependencefromtheUnitedStates. Carmenalsonotedthatthearticlebecameacatchallforstatesandthatitwasinsertedafter2004whencountriesthatsupportedthedeclaration,includingMexico, Guatemala,Peru,andothers,promptedsuchamove.ItwasadoptedbytheHuman RightsCouncilin2006.Formoreinformation,listentotheinterview,whichaired on13January2009andisarchivedonline:http://indigenouspolitics.mypodcast.com. AlsofeaturedonadifferentprogramofmyshowwasTonyaGonnellaFrichner, founderandpresidentoftheAmericanIndianLawAlliance.Thisprogramincludes acomprehensiveaccountoftheactivisthistorythatledtothepassageofthedeclarationaswellasacriticalanalysisofthepoliticsofcarefulnegotiationsthatledtothe compromisesovertheseseeminglycontradictoryarticlesofthedeclaration. Seehttp://indigenouspolitics.mypodcast.com. 20. For a list of the signatories, see the letter as it appeared in Counterpunch: http://www.counterpunch.org/blaisde1104152009.html. Hawaiian Nationhood 53
riet Delsing
IssuesofLandandSovereignty The Uneasy Relationship between Chile and Rapa Nui
On New Year’s Eve 1999 a large crowd gathered at the ceremonial site of TahaionRapaNuitocelebratetheadventofthenewmillennium.1Rapa Nui,thesmallislandintheSouthPacificalsoknownasEasterIsland,was annexed by Chile in 1888. That same morning some Rapanui youths had damagedtheChileanNationalTelevision(tVn)equipmentsetuponthe sitetocoverthecelebrations.Theywereprotestingagainsttheviolationofa sacred,ceremonialplaceandalsodemandingaccesstotheconsiderablesum paidbytVn tothemunicipalityofRapaNuifortherightstofilmtheevent, whichwastobebroadcastlive,worldwide,viathe bbc network.Minutes beforemidnightthebest-knownChileantelevisionhosts,flowninfromthe mainlandfortheoccasion,distributedflowergarlandsamongtheislanders andthetouristsparticipatingintheevent,sothattheworldcouldenjoythe exoticcharacterofthismostuniquemillenniumcelebration. Whenfireworkslitupthespectacularsite,withitsfamousstonestatues (moai),andthecrowdwascheering,someofusnoticedthatthiswasnotthe onlymanifestationof“Rapanuiness.”Afewstepsaway,inthedarknight,a smallgroupofRapanuiwearingtraditionalmahute(barkcloth)capesand carryingtorchesstoodsilentlyagainstthestarredsky,nexttoalonelymoai andaChileanflagwhichwasblowinginthestiffbreeze.TheflagwaspurposelyputbeneathaRapanuiflagasachallengetoChileansovereigntyover theisland.ThisincidentillustratessomeofthepoliticalandculturaltensionsinRapaNui.Theeventssurroundingthemillenniumcelebrationshow notonlytheRapanui’sinsistenceonassertingtheircollectiveculturalidentity,butalsotheirentanglementwiththeChileannation-stateandtourism. Sincethe1990stherehadbeenagrowingawarenessamongRapanuioftheir
specificculturalidentity,expressedinpracticesanddiscoursesaroundthe issuesofland,language,andculturalperformances,alongwithastrikingincreaseinculturalexchangeswithotherPolynesians. Morethanacenturyhaspassedsincetheannexation,andtheChilean nation-state has created not an environment leading to cooperation with theRapanuipeoplebutoneofresistance.InthisessayIexploresomeofthe issuesatstakeinthisenduringconflict.Afterareviewoftheearlyyearsof ChileancolonizationIshowhowsuccessiveChileanlawshaveattemptedto integrateRapaNuiintothenation-state,andhowtheyareanobstacletotraditionalRapanuirelationswiththeirlandandterritory.Iconcludewithan examinationofthechangingformsofpoliticalrelationshipbetweenChile andRapaNui. Myworkisbasedonseveralyearsofanthropologicalresearchandlife experienceinRapaNui.Startingin1996Ihaveconductedfieldworkonthe islandonvariousoccasionsrangingfromacoupleofweekstotenmonths. Sincethen,mylifehasbecomeintertwinedwiththepeopleofRapaNui,with theirjoysandtheirstruggles.OverthepastdecadeIhaveexploredRapanuigenderrelations,issuesofglobalization,and,inthecontextofmydissertationresearch,culturalpolitics,RapanuirelationshipswiththeChilean nation-state,andtheirthrusttowardself-determination.IntheseinquiriesI haveadoptedamultisitedapproach(Marcus1995;MarcusandFischer1986) sincemymainpremiseisthatthemovementofpeople,ideas,institutions, communicationsystems,andcapitalacrossthePacificOceaniscentralto thearticulationofamodernRapanuiculturalidentity.Myvoiceisthatofan anthropologist,inquisitiveandcuriousaboutculturalprocesses—thesubjectofourtrade—butalsothatofsomebodywithapersonalinvestmentin socialandpoliticalchangeinRapaNuiandelsewhere.
A Brief History TheannexationofRapaNuididnottakeplaceinahistoricalvacuum.Itwas theresultoftheChileanRepublic’simperialistaspirationsinthelatenineteenthcentury.AftergainingindependencefromSpainin1818,Chilewas stillconsolidatingitsterritoryinthe1880swhenitmadetwomajorconqueststhatincreaseditsterritorybyathird.Tothesouth,itmilitarilydefeatedtheMapuchepeople,whohadstruggledforthreehundredyears,first, againstSpanishand,later,Chileancolonizers.Tothenorth,Chiledefeated Bolivia and Peru in the War of the Pacific (1879–83), and Chile annexed Chile and Rapa Nui 55
substantialpartsoftheirterritoriesthatwereinhabitedbytheindigenous Aymara,Quechua,andCollapeoples.Themajorobjectiveofthiswarwas togaincontrolofthemineralriches,nitrateinparticular,oftheAtacama desert,partofwhichwaslocatedinBolivianandPeruvianterritories(Silva Galdames1995). ButChile’sexpansionistdrivedidnotlimititselftotheAmericancontinent.Agrowingnumberofforeignmerchants,mainlyBritish,usedthe ChileanportofValparaísoasawaystationfortradewiththePacificcoast beforetheopeningofthePanamaCanalin1914.Valparaísobecamethemost importantportonthatcoast,whichallowedChileanmerchantstocreate theirowntraderoutesacrossthePacific,inIndiaandEastAsia,insearchof newmarketsforChile’scopperandnitrates(BushnellandMacaulay1988, 109). Before the end of the century Chilean consulates had been opened inShanghai,Canton,Manila,Calcutta,Sydney,andBrunei.Chileansailors andmerchantsbecamefamiliarwithPolynesiangeography,andthisledto dreams of western expansion into the Pacific (Porteous 1981). In the late 1800sseveralEuropeanandAmericannationsannexedislandsandarchipelagosinthePacific.InthiscontextofimperialistfervorChileannexed RapaNui. AcaptainoftheChileannavybythenameofPolicarpoToroHurtado visitedRapaNuiin1875andagainin1886.Afterhissecondvisithesubmittedaproposalforannexationtohissuperiorsinthenavy.PresidentJosé ManuelBalmacedaofChileapprovedoftheidea,andTorowenttoTahiti in1887withtheintentionofbuyingtheRapanui’slandsandanimals,which hadbeenseizedbyEuropean–TahitianbusinessmenandtheTahitianCatholicChurch(Revista de Marina1983,316,317).Torothenannexedtheislandin September1888bysigningthe“AgreementofWills”(Acuerdo de Voluntades) withtheRapanuichiefs. TheofficialSpanishtextoftheagreementconsistsoftwoparts:the“Cession,”inwhichthechiefsgrantsovereigntytoChile,andthe“Proclamation,” inwhichToroacceptsthecessionofsovereigntyinthenameoftheRepublicofChile(Vergara1939,appendicesXIIandXIII).In2001theRapanui- languageversionofthesedocumentsstartedtocirculateontheisland.A translationofthisversionbackintoSpanishrevealsthattheRapanuididnot handoversovereigntytotheChileansinthesenseinwhichtheconceptis understoodincurrentinternationallaw.2Thisdisparitycoincideswithoral tradition,accordingtowhicharikiAtamuTekenagaveabunchofgrassto Torobutputahandfulofsoilinhisownpocket,agesturemeanttoexpress 56 rietDelsing
thathewasallowingtheChileanstomakeuseoflandandcropsbutthat hewasnothandingoverRapanuiterritory.3Thisenactmentisperformed formeoverandoveragainwheneverIaskRapanuiabouttheirpoliticalrelationshipwithChile.
The Early Years of Chilean Colonization Misunderstandingsabouttheseparatenessoflandandterritorywerepresent fromtheverybeginningofChileancolonization.Aftertheannexationin 1888,Toro’sbrother,PedroPablo,stayedinRapaNuiforfouryearsasan “agentofcolonization”(Toro1892)andwroteaninterestingreportabouthis experiences.BesideshisobservationsaboutChileanversusRapanuipoliticalauthority,Chilean“civilization”versusRapanuiPolynesianculture,and theChileanlegalsystemversusRapanuicustomarylaw,hemadethefirstassessmentofRapanuilandownershipseenthroughtheeyesofaChileanwho hadfirsthandknowledgeofthesituation.“Privateandpermanentownership doesnotreallyexistinthecountryside,”hesaid.“Eachindividualcultivates andsowsaplotofland,whichheabandonsaftertheharvesttotakeanother onelateron”(Toro1892,205).TorohadnounderstandingofthePolynesian systemoflandtenure,whichallowedforcollectiveuseofclanlands,andhe maynothavebeenawareoftheexistingclansystem. MostinterestingarehisrecommendationstotheChileangovernment, whichgiveastrikingvisionofhowtheislandanditspeopleshouldbecome integratedintotheChileannation-state.Hissuggestionsareastunningexampleofcapitalistdiscourseontheadvantagesofprivateproperty.First,he suggestedthattheislandbesubmittedtoChileanjurisdictionbycreatinga subdelegationannexedtotheDepartmentofValparaíso.Second,heproposedtoconstituteindigenousprivatepropertyrightsbyequallydividing thelandinplots,“sufficienttosatisfythenecessitiesofeachfamily”tomaintainitselfindependently.Thecanacas(natives)shouldbeobligedtofenceoff theirrespectiveproperties.Thecreationofprivatepropertywouldstimulate work,production,andexchange.Itwouldcreatehealthycompetitionsince eachindígena(indigenousperson)wouldseehimselfasexclusiveownerof hispropertyand“moreorlessrich,”accordingtohisownefforts,economic ability, and dedication. Toro supposed that in the beginning the canacas wouldresisttheseinnovationsconcerningtheprivatepropertyofland,but thatsuchresistancewouldneverbeserious,andthecanacaswouldslowly but surely become convinced of the advantages of the new system (Toro Chile and Rapa Nui 57
1892,212).Toroalsothoughtitwouldnotbedifficulttosubstitutethelegal authorityofthewhitesforthetraditionalauthorityoftheindigenouschiefs, amongwhomthesubdelegatecouldassignhissubordinates.Itisremarkable howprescientToro’svisionwouldprovetobe,astodaytheWesternconcept ofindividualprivatepropertyhasinvaded,slowlybutsurely,Rapanuicustomaryformsofcommunallandtenureandthenotionofkainga,4orancestrallands,islosinggroundamongmanyRapanui. AftertheinitialyearsofcolonizationChilelostinterestintheisland,possiblybecauseofthecountry’sbloodycivilwarin1891andtherealization thatitwasnotthetropicalparadiseTorohadimaginedittobe.5TheChilean government first rented out the island to a French–Chilean businessman basedinValparaísowhoin1903passedontheleasetoWilliamsonBalfour andCompany,aScottishtradingcompanywithheadquartersforSouthand NorthAmericainValparaíso.TheCompañía(asitisstillreferredtotoday) convertedmostoftheislandintoasheepfarmfortheexportofwool,and itsrepresentativesbecamethevirtualrulersoftheislandforthenextfifty years,until1953.TheChileangovernmentwaspresentintheformofitsnavy, whichsentashiponceyearlyandstayedincontactwiththerepresentative oftheCompañía.However,duringthislongperiodtheRapanuiwerenot treatedasChileancitizens.Chile’slegalsystemwasputintopracticebythe navyonlyinthemostrudimentaryway,whileitsadministrativeandinstitutionalstructureswerevirtuallyabsent. AttheendofthenineteenthcenturysomeRapanuiwerebeginningto losetheirintimatecontactwithanddeepconnectiontothekainga,where theyhadbeenlivingaccordingtotribalaffiliationsandcustomarypractices inwhichthelandwasintrinsicallyinalienable.Legendsaysthattheisland waspartitionedintotwoterritorialconfederacies,theKo Tu’u Aro Kote Mata Nui,themajorclanswhichoccupiedthenorthernandwesternpartofthe island,andtheKo Tu’u Hotu Iti Mata Iti,theminorclanswhichlivedinthe southeasternpart(Routledge1919;Métraux1940;McCall1976).Eachconfederationwasdividedintopatrilinealclans,ormata.Thesixwesternmata wieldedreligiousandpoliticalpowerandemphasizedfishing,whilethefour easternmataweremainlyagriculturalists.Thesespecificeconomicactivities madethemdependentononeanother. Atleasttwofactorswereinvolvedintheprocessofalienationthattook placeinthelatenineteenthcentury.Owingtoslaveraidsandtheintroductionofpreviouslyunknowndiseasesonlyslightlymorethanonehundred RapanuihadsurvivedbythetimeoftheChileantakeover,outofapopu58 rietDelsing
lation of two thousand in the early 1860s. This suggests that some of the originalclanlandsmustalreadyhavebeendepopulatedtowardtheendof thecentury.AsecondfactoristhattheChurchandtheearlyChileancolonizersgatheredtheRapanuiinasinglesettlement,HangaRoa,forpurposes ofevangelizationandcolonialcontrol.Theearlycolonizersalsoprohibited theislandersfromusingtheiroriginalclanlandsforplantingandraising animals. EarlydocumentspresentedbyRapanuitotheChileangovernmentshow thatseveralislanderscomplainedaboutthefactthattheirlandsandanimalsweretakenaway.Theselistsofprotestsstartedtheprocessofalienationfromtriballands.Theveryactoflistinginitselfbroughtaboutadistancingfromearlierwaysofrelatingtothelandasname,age,andproperty wererecorded.6Certainlandswereclaimedbyseveralindividuals,sometimespeoplewithdifferentsurnames,suggestingthatthelandhadbelonged tospecificclans.Inthoseyearsthisnewwayofassertingarelationshipwith thelandmayhavegoneunnoticed,butinhindsighttheindividualizationon paperseemstobeafirststeptowardprivatization.Althoughthelistingof landandanimalsshowsRapanuiresistanceagainstabusesoftheCompañía, italsointroducedtheideaofindividualproperty. The Chilean Republic Consolidates Its Hold on the Island Afewyearsaftertheannexationitbecamestandardpracticethatisland disputeswerearbitratedbynavalofficersduringtheiryearlyvisits(Porteous 1981,50).WhiletheCompañíawasmainlyinterestedintheprofitsofthe woolbusiness,thenavy’sobjectivewastocarryouttheprojectoftheChilean nation-state.Territorialrightsandlandownershipremainedthemajorissues. Beginningin1917thenavystartedtodistributeplotstobeusedforagriculturalpurposes(Vergara1939,81).TheRapanuihadtoconvincenavypersonnelthattheyneededlandforspecificpurposes.Inapublicationof1926 entitledMemorias, Balances, Inventarios y Registro de Propiedades,thenavy listsalltheplotsassignedtoRapanuiuptothatyear.Afterwarditbecame standardpracticetogivefivehectarestoyoungmarriedcouples.Thesecessionswouldbeconfirmedbythecommandersofthenavyshipsduringtheir visitstotheisland.Eachlandtitlewasaccompaniedbyadrawingindicating thesizeandlocationoftheplot.Thenavycompiledanotherdocumentin 1962,theLibro de registros de propiedades llevado por la Armada de Chile, Isla de Pascua.Likeallnavyrecords,thesepublicationsarenolongeravailable ontheislandbutcopiesweremade,andrecentlytheMinisteriodeBienes Chile and Rapa Nui 59
Nacionalesgotholdofone.7Ifithadnotbeenforcopiesmadebyindividuals,thishistoricalinformationwouldbelost,aswasthecasewiththetreaty documents.Thetoneandcontentofthelandtitlesindicatethatthenavy actedasacolonialagent,applyingstrictmilitaryrulesthathadtobeobservedbytheislanders.Thereiterationofthenavy’sdeedsinsuccessiveregistersshowsthatitwasquitekeenonkeepingthingsinorder.Bythe1960s, 525provisionallandtitleshadbeenextended(AnduezaGuzmán2005),and theareaofHangaRoa,wheretheRapanuiliveinfamilygroupsaccording totraditionalclandistributions,grewovertheyearsfromonethousandto threethousandhectares. TheChileangovernment’spositionwasthattheseprovisionaltitlesallowedthebeneficiariestousetheplotsoflandforagriculturalpurposes,but theChileanstatereservedownershiptotheland.Thisisironic,tosaythe least,ifoneconsidersthatthisinterpretationisareversalofwhattheRapanuiofferedtoChileatthemomentofannexation.AtthattimearikiAtamu TekenaassignedtheusufructofRapanuilandstotheChileanstatebutby puttingahandfulofsoilinhispocketexplicitlyexpressedthewishtoremain inchargeofthekainga.Interestingly,theRapanuiconsideredtheprovisional titlesaspropertytitles,aninterpretationthestatedidnotobjecttoinfuture legaldeterminationsaboutlanduseinRapaNui.8ThisisanexcellentexampleofhowtheRapanuihavebeenabletocircumventChileanlegaldecisionsandinterpretthemaccordingtotheirculturalneeds. The Inscription of 1933 Inthe1930sRapaNuiwasstillaBritishsheepfarm,runasifitwereaship byitsadministratorsandtheChileannavyauthorities.Bythentheforeign authoritieshadreplacedRapanuitraditionalleaders,strippedthemoftheir lands,andturnedthemintofarmhands.9However,animportantchangewas madein1933.Tiredofthecat-and-mousegamebeingplayedoverRapanui landsbytheCompañíaandtheChileanstate,thegovernmenttookaction. A high-level government commission headed by a Chilean bishop determinedthatprivatelandownershipdidnotexistontheislandaccordingto Chilean law, and in November 1933 the government registered the entire islandasChileanpublicland(tierra fiscal).Itdeclareditself“ownerofEaster Island,alsocalledRapaNui,”withanareaof15,796hectares.Thedocument saysthatChileacquiredtheislandthroughoccupationbyvirtueofarticle 590oftheCivilCode(Vergara1939,appendixXLI).Thisarticlestatesthat “allthelandsituatedwithintheterritoriallimitsthatlacksanotherowneris 60 rietDelsing
stateproperty”(Vergara1939,appendixXLIV).Thecommission’sarguments werecorrectinthattheearlytransactionsandsalestotheCompañíahadnot beenregisteredinthepropergovernmentoffice(Rochna-Ramírez1996,40), andwhenthegovernmentrenewedtheleasewiththeCompañíaforanother twentyyearsin1936,itreferredtothewholeislandexceptforthelandoccupiedby“thenatives,thelepersandthenavalauthority.”10 Intheinscriptionof1933theChileanstateignoredonceagainthevery existenceoftheRapanuiasapeoplewithancestralrightstotheirlandand territory.ThistimeChilestatedthatithadacquiredtheislandthroughoccupation,not,asithadassertedin1888,throughcession.Thisclaimwasnot mentionedagaininlaterdiscussionsabouttheChileanstate’spoliticalrelationshipwiththeisland,possiblybecauseitwouldhaveputChileinabad lightontheinternationallegalstage.11TheRapanuiwerenotinformedabout theinscriptionoftheirentireterritoryaspubliclandandbecameawareof thisactmorethanthirtyyearslater.12 Inhindsight,theinscriptionhasbenefitedtheRapanuibecauseneither foreignersnornon-RapanuiChileansareallowedtoownlandontheisland. Thisunintendedconsequencehasbecomeamajortoolinthehandsofcontemporary Rapanui to make a case for collective private landownership. ContrarytowhathashappenedinotherPolynesianislandstates,suchas Hawai‘i,wherenon–HawaiianAmericansandforeignerscanownland,the blunderbytheChileanstatein1933allowedRapanuitosecuretheirlands, albeitunderthetutelageofthatverystate.
Chilean Integrationist Policies and the Privatization of Rapanui Lands The Easter Law (Ley Pascua) and the Pinochet Law (Ley Pinochet) Several decades passed before two Chilean laws dealing with Rapanui landholding were enacted. In Law number 16.441, the so-called Ley Pascuaof1966,theRapanuiwererecognizedforthefirsttimeasfull-fledged Chileancitizens.ItauthorizedthepresidentoftheRepublictograntindividualpropertytitles(títulos de dominio)toChileannationalsinurbanterritories belonging to the state (territorios fiscales urbanos), and stipulated thatmostrurallandsbelongingtothestate(tierras fiscales rurales)couldbe giveninconcessiontoChileangovernmentinstitutions.TheLeyPascuais significantinthatitrepresentsthefirsttimeprivatelandownershipinRapa Chile and Rapa Nui 61
NuiwasintroducedthroughaChileanlaw.Inthenameofequality,thisright wasextendednotonlytoRapanui,butalsotonon-RapanuiChileancitizens. However,thesedispositionsdidnothaveamajoreffectontheisland.The titlestoindividualownershipreferredonlytotheurbanareaofHangaRoa, wherevirtuallyallRapanuilived.Thevastmajoritydidnotbothertogetland titlesforplaceswheretheyandtheirfamilieshadbeenlivingforseveraldecades.NotitlesweregiventoChileanslivingontheislandonthebasisof theLeyPascua(Barrientos1998,6).Forseveralyearstocome,remarkably, Rapanui islanders continued living their lives in their Hanga Roa homesteadswithoutsignificantchangesasfaraslandtenurewasconcerned. Amuchbiggersteptowardindividualprivatelandownershipwastaken in1979,whentheChileanmilitarydictatorAugustoPinochetissuedadecree withtheforceoflaw(DL-2885)thatbecameknownastheLeyPinochet.13 GeneralPinochetshowedaspecialinterestinRapaNui,inaccordancewith his geopolitical views and nationalist goals for Chile, which included the homogenizationandintegrationoftheChileanpopulationintothenation- state.Consequently,theRapanuiwerenotreferredtoasapeople.Thedecreegavethepresidenttheauthoritytoextendfreetitlesinurbanandrural publicareas(terrenos fiscales)toChileansbornontheislandwhosefatheror motheralsohadbeenbornthere.ThesetitlescouldalsobegiventoChileansnotbornontheislandifoneoftheirparentshadbeenbornthere,had livedthereforatleastfiveyears,andexercisedaprofessionorpermanentactivityontheisland.InpracticethismeantthatPinochetwasgivinglandtitles toRapanui,althoughintheorynon-Rapanuiwhowerebornontheisland couldownRapanuiland.Onceagain,noreferencewasmadetothefactthat thelawwasapplicableonlytotheroughlythreethousandhectares(outofa totalofsixteenthousand)comprisingHangaRoaanditsvicinities,towhich theRapanuihadbeenreducedinthelate1800s.Thislawdecreehadamuch moreinvasiveeffectthantheLeyPascuasinceitsintentionwastoobligethe Rapanuitotakelandtitles.Thelawwasreinforcedbyanofferofsubsidized governmenthousing,whichcouldbeobtainedonlyiflandtitleswereacceptedandinscribed. TheLeyPinochetmetwithmassiveresistancefromtheRapanui,who feltthatindividuallanddistributionwasbeingforceduponthem.Theirreactionwastoform,in1980,aConsejodeAncianos(CouncilofElders).14 Thecouncil’soppositiontotheLeyPinochetwasbasedmainlyontheargumentthattheChileanstatedidnothavetheauthoritytogivetitlestoRapanuiland.AsoneRapanuiclearlyputit,“Whydowehavetoacceptatitleof 62 rietDelsing
somethingthatisalreadymine?Itisasifsomebodywantstogivemethe shirtIamwearing”(Revista Análisis,February1988).Nevertheless,Rapanui startedtoinscribetheirpropertiesandacquireprivatepropertytitlesduring the1980s;by1990thenumberwhohaddonesototaled359(Gómez2004). Thelawdecreestipulatedthatifpeoplecouldprovetheyhadbeenlivingon orusingapieceoflandformorethantenyears,theywouldhavetheright toalandtitle.Thevalidationoflandoccupancy(poseedor regular)became averypopularwayfortheRapanuitoacceptlandtitles.Therecognitionof arelationshipbetweenlandandpeopleappealedtoRapanuiculturalidiosyncrasy(seeAndueza2005).Livingonorusingaplotoflandforagriculturalpurposes(orboth)foraconsiderableamountoftimereinforcedthese connections.ThussomeRapanuirespondedtoChileanlaws,althoughnot altogetherforthereasonsintendedbythelegislator,whosepurposewasto instilltheconceptofindividualprivatepropertyinRapanuiculturalpractice andturnthemintoregularChileansforwhomprivateownershipisabasic culturalparadigm. The Indigenous Law (Ley Indígena) ThesituationchangedagainafterChile’sreturntodemocracyin1990.The indigenouscausewashighontheagendaofPatricioAylwin,thefirstdemocraticallyelectedpresidentafterthedictatorship.In1993aspeciallawwas issued,theso-calledLeyIndígena(No.19,253),whichestablishednormsof protection,promotion,anddevelopmentofChile’sindigenouspopulation. IncontrasttotheLeyPinochet,whichaimedatabsorbingindigenouspeople intotheChileanpopulation,thislawrecognizedtheexistenceofindigenous peopleandtheirdifferences.TheLeyIndígenarecognizedthatlandwasthe lifebloodofindigenouscultures.SomeRapanuisuggestedthatratherthan includeRapaNuiintheLeyIndígena,theLeyPascuaof1966,whichwas specifictotheRapanui,beamendedtoreflectthenewsituation,butthis initiativewentnowhere.TheseRapanuiarguedthatthedifferencesbetween RapaNui’sPolynesianpopulationandAmericanindigenouspeoplesonthe mainlandaretoogreattoincludethembothinasinglelaw.15TheLeyIndígena,likepreviouslaws,maintainedtheconceptofindividualprivateproperty,althoughitstatesexplicitlyforthefirsttimethatonlypeopleofRapanui descentcanownlandinRapaNuiandthatthelandcannotbetransferred to non-Rapanui. The National Corporation for Indigenous Development (conaDi)wasformedtoimplementtheLeyIndígenaineachoftheplaces whereindigenouspeoplelive. Chile and Rapa Nui 63
Inhindsight,itcanbesuggestedthattheLeyIndígena,althoughdesigned tobenefittheRapanuiasapeople,hashadseveralnegativeconsequences inRapaNui.First,itdividedtheRapanuicommunity,adivisionthatstill existstoday.TheCouncilofElderssplitontheissueoflanddistribution. Thecouncil’sleaderandsomeothercouncilmemberswhohadbeenferventlyopposed totheLeyPinochet became strong supporters oftheLey Indígena.Membersofthedissidentgroup,whoopposedprivatelandtitles, maintainedthatitwasnottherightoftheChileangovernmenttoimpose landdistributioninRapaNui. Thissituationwasmainlycausedbyacomplicatedinteractionbetween RapanuileadersandChileanpartypolitics.Ingeneral,Rapanuiidentifywith neitherChileanpartypoliticsnorthepoliticalandideologicalparadigmson whichtheyarebased,sincetheyhavenohistoricalandculturalrelevancein RapaNui.Nevertheless,leadersoftheCouncilofEldershadstronglysupportedAylwin,thecandidateoftheCenter-Leftgovernmentcoalition,and feltcommittedtotheLeyIndígena.Theresultwasthatthedissidentgroup ofthecouncillinedupwiththeoppositiontothenewlyelectedDemocratic government,whichconsistsofanideological,extremeRight—erstwhiledefendersofthedictatorship—andamoremoderateneoliberal,bigbusiness– orientedcentralRight. TheLeyIndígenaalsocreated,solelyforRapaNui,aDevelopmentCommission(coDeipa),whosemembershipwouldbemadeuppartlyofRapanuiandpartlyofmainlanders.ItconsistsoftheRapanuigovernor,theRapanuimayor,theheadoftheCouncilofElders,fivememberselectedbythe Rapanuicommunity,andsixrepresentativesofvariousChileanministries thatoperateontheisland,fiveofwhomarecontinentalChileans.Thiscomposition guarantees a Rapanui majority in the coDeipa . It was to be in chargeof,amongotherthings,landdistributionthroughoneoftheChilean ministries (Bienes Nacionales).ThesplitintheCouncilofElders created aproblembecausetheultimateleaderofthecouncilwouldbeoneofthe commission’s members. With two individuals claiming the leadership of theCouncilofElders,theDevelopmentCommissioncouldnotbeputinto operationuntil1998,whenelectionswereheldintheCouncilandtheoriginalleaderwonbyanarrowmargin.16 AnevenmoreseriouseffectoftheLeyIndígenawasthedistributionof fifteenhundredhectaresofgovernment-ownedlandtotheRapanui.17The ministryinchargeassignedtheselandsinplotsoffivehectaresratherhaphazardly,oftennotrespectingthetribalaffiliationsoftheapplicants,which 64 rietDelsing
created problems between and discontent among Rapanui. Two hundred fifty-nineindividuallandtitleswerehandedoutin2001.Today,sometwelve hundredRapanuiarewaitingforasecondredistribution.Manywhoearlier resistedlandtitleshavenowregistered.AlthoughmostRapanuistilldonot agreewiththesystemintheirdiscourse,theysubmittoitinpractice.However,thegovernmentisintheprocessofadjustingthecriteriafordistribution,asthereisnotenoughlandavailable,sotheplotswillbesmallerthis timearound.Theprocesshasbeendelayed,andin2006the coDeipa was stillrevisingtherecordsofeachapplicant,whichhascreatedalotofdiscontentandmistrustinthecommunity.18Also,anewrelationshipwiththe Chileangovernmentisinthemaking(seebelow),andthismayreversethe landholdingsituationaltogether. AnothernegativeeffectofthelanddeliveryisthatRapanuihavestarted totradetheirplotsoflandformotorcycles,usedcars,andothermaterial goodsoftheirliking,whichhasallowedsomeRapanuitoaccumulateland. Thishasstimulatedthedevelopmentofarealestatemarket,albeitbetween Rapanui,inthepastcoupleofyears,unheardofbefore.Thiscircumstance implies a further erosion of the concept of kainga, since it separates the Rapanuifurtherfromtheirtraditionalclanlandsanddisintegratestheirtraditionalsocialorganization.TheLeyIndígenaallowsforindividualprivate propertybuttothedetrimentofcollectiveprivateproperty. Loopholesinthelawhavealsopermittedoutsiderstoinvestintheisland, aphenomenonthatrequiresclosesupervisiononpartoftheRapanui.An emblematiccase,thefirstofitskind,wastheconstructionandinauguration inearly2008ofafive-starhotelbytheexclusiveChileanhotelchainExplora. TheExplorahotelsbelongtotheChileanPedroIbañez,awealthybusinessmanandentrepreneur.AfterconsultingforseveralyearswithvariousRapanuifamilies,ExploraofficialsconvincedasuccessfulRapanuibusinessman, MikeRapu,toacquirelandfromhisfamilyandobtainasecondplotfrom anotherRapanui—atotalof9.6hectares—toexecutethisproject.Withthe helpofvariouslawyerstheLeyIndígenawasbypassed.WhenIaskedRapu why he went ahead with this project, he repeatedly stressed the trust the owneroftheExplorahotelshadputinhimandthemistrustotherRapanui hadinspired(interviewMikeRapuPate,2006).Itisinterestingthatpersonal relationsseemtohaveplayedamajorfactorinsuchasignificantfinancial operation.Explorahassetaprecedentandopenedthedoortofutureforeign investments. Ontheotherhand,thanks totheLeyIndígena, permission tobuild a Chile and Rapa Nui 65
casinoinRapaNuiwasdeniedonlegalgroundsinSeptember2006,namely, becausethattheChileancasinolawandtheLeyIndígenaaremutuallyincompatible(El Mercurio,9September2006).Thisdecisionputanendtoa heatedyearlongdebateinRapaNuiandonthemainlandabouttheadvantagesanddisadvantagesofhavingacasinoontheisland.Thecasinolawrequiresafifteen-yearpermittooperate,whileaccordingtotheLeyIndígena indigenouslandscanberentedoutforamaximumperiodofonlyfiveyears. Eventhoughthesefive-yearperiodsarerenewableintheLeyIndígena,the casinolawdoesnotallowforthisfigure.BothconaDi andcoDeipa were against the casino, as was a large part of the Rapanui community. Rapanui University students residing on the mainland organized various protestsduring2006inSantiagoandValparaíso,protestsinwhichIparticipated.TheCouncilofEldersandthemayorofRapaNuiwereinfavorofthe casino.Theirargumentwasthattheprojectwouldbringcashtotheisland. Thecasinoproject,whichinvolvedaninvestmentoffourteenmilliondollars,wasajointventureofaChileaninvestorandaRapanuibusinessman. TheLeyIndígenahasthusbeenmanipulatedandhashadunpredictable consequencesfortheRapanuicommunityandChileanlawmakersalike.The Rapanuihavecertainlynotbenefitedfromtherulesandregulationsimposed by a nation-state that insists on sovereignty over a territory which it has abusedhistorically.
From Colonialism to Self-Determination? These discrepancies in the interpretation and use of existing law and the interplaybetweentheChileanstate’sintentionsandRapanuidiscourseand practicecanalsobeseeninthevariousstagesofpoliticalstatustheChilean statehasimposedontheRapanuipeopleandtheirterritory. ThreedistinctmomentscanbedistinguishedinChile’spoliticalrelationshipwithRapaNui.ThefirstistheAnnexationof1888,whenChileasserted sovereigntyovertheisland.Asdiscussedearlier,theRepublicofChilethen quicklylostinterestinitsinsularpossession,andtheislandwasturnedinto asheepfarm.Arguably,duringthosefirstyearsofcolonizationtheRapanui werebarelyawareofthepresenceofanation-stateexercisingsovereignty overtheisland.Chile’sjudicialandadministrativesystemswereimposedin themostrudimentaryway.Thesituationchangedsomewhatin1917,when ChiledeclaredRapaNuitobeasubdelegation(SubdelegaciónMarítima)of
66 rietDelsing
theNavalDepartment(GobernaciónMarítima)oftheportofValparaíso. NavyofficialswerethenofficiallynamedasrepresentativesoftheChilean governmentinRapaNui,andtheconnectionwiththecentralgovernment waschanneledthroughitsMinistryofDefense.Thissituationlastedforfive decades.DuringthoseyearstheRapanuienduredphysicalandpsychologicalabusesbyrepresentativesoftheCompañíaandnavyofficialsandhadno constitutionalrightswhatsoever.Nevertheless,theirculturalpractices,especiallytheirlanguageandsocialorganization,remainedlargelyintact. La Ley Pascua Thisstateofaffairschangeddrasticallyin1966withthepassageoftheLey Pascua.AyoungRapanuischoolteacher,oneofthefirstRapanuieducated onthemainland,stagedarebellionin1964.19Partlyasaresultofthisrevolt theLeyPascuawasapprovedbytheNationalCongressin1966.Thelawput anendtonavyruleandcreatedtheDepartmentofEasterIslandaspartof theprovinceofValparaíso,withitsownmunicipalityandpublicservices (Makihara1999,101).ThemostimportantconsequenceoftheLeyPascuais thattheRapanuiwerefinallyrecognizedasChileancitizensandweregiven therighttovote. After the law was passed, three hundred newcomers, mostly Chilean functionariesandtheirfamilies,arrivedontheislandtosetupthenewadministrativesysteminrepresentationofChileanministriesandotherinstitutions.Chileanworkerswerebroughtinfromthecontinentfortheconstructionoftheairport,aswellassome60Americanarmypersonnelwho cametosetupabaseforsurveillanceofartificialearthsatellitesincompliancewithanagreementbetweentheChileanandU.S.AirForce.By1968 theoutsidersaddeduptoatotalof665people,ascomparedwithaRapanui populationof1,200,withtheresultthatthereweremoreforeignandcontinentaladultsthanRapanuiadultsontheisland(Cristinoetal.,1984).One canonlyimaginetheimpactthisarrivalofnonislandershadonRapanui’s lifestyleandworld.Besidestheinfluxofpeople,therewasaninfluxofgoods andservices.Electricityandpipedwaterlineswereinstalled,androadswere built.Trucksandjeepswereimported.Theimprovementincommunications realizedbythebuildingoftheairportandthesubsequentairtrafficopened theislanduptotheworldinanunprecedentedway.Theconcentrationof servicesandgovernmentbuildingsinHangaRoamadeittheonlyinhabitedcenterontheisland,afactwhichloosenedthetiesbetweentheRapanui
Chile and Rapa Nui 67
andtheirancestrallandsevenmore.Noneofthiswasadequatelyplanned noranticipatedintheLeyPascua.TheChileanlegislatorsfailedtocomprehendandpredicttheimpactChileanlawsandinstitutionswouldhaveonthe dailylifeoftheRapanui.Ontheotherhand,theChileanswhowereassigned totheislanddidnothaveenoughculturalsensitivitytoperceivethesepossiblealterationsofRapanuicultureandsocialorganization.TheLeyPascua fomentedwesternizationinawaytheRapanuiarestillcopingwithtoday, anditdidnotprovidetoolstosafeguardculturaldifferenceandenhanceself- determination. La Comisión de Verdad Histórica y Nuevo Trato para los Pueblos Indígenas (Commission on Historic Truth and New Relationship with Indigenous Peoples) Today,almostfiftyyearsafterpassageoftheLeyPascua,anotherchange inpoliticalstatusforRapaNuiisinthemaking.TheprotestsbyRapanui in the 1980s over land and territory strengthened their awareness of culturaldifference,whileinChileinthosesameyearsthefirstprotestsagainst themilitaryregimeledtotherecoveryofdemocracyin1990,afterseventeenyearsofdictatorship.Indigenousrightsanddemandsappearedonthe national agenda through the creation of the Ley Indígena in 1993, which informedChileancivilsocietyaboutindigenousissuesanddemands.This processculminatedin2001inthecreationofagovernmententityknownas theCommissiononHistoricTruthandNewRelationshipwithIndigenous Peoples(LaComisióndeVerdadHistóricayNuevoTratoparalosPueblos Indígenas).Then-presidentofChileRicardoLagoschargedthecommission withstudyingthehistoricrelationshipbetweenChile’sindigenouspeoples andtheChileanstateandsuggestingrecommendationsfornewstatepolicies(una política de estado). Thetruthcommissionputoutitsfinalreportin2003,anditsrecommendationsforRapaNuiincludedtheratificationofthe“AgreementofWills” of1888bytheNationalCongress,thecreationofastatuteofautonomy,the recognitionoftheexclusiverightoftheRapanuitolandownershiponthe island,andthepromotionandfinancingofdevelopmentprogramsinRapa Nui(Informe de la Comisión).Theserecommendationswereformulatedby theRapanuiauthoritieswhowererecognizedassuchbytheChileangovernment:themayor,theheadoftheCouncilofElders,andthegovernor,inhis capacityasheadoftheRapanuiDevelopmentCommission.
68 rietDelsing
Anothersetofrecommendationshadbeenformulatedinworkshopsthat took place on the island in 2002. The organizers of these workshops had beenelectedandappointedinameetingwithrepresentativesoftheChilean governmentwhovisitedtheislandinFebruary2002tocreatetheRapanui chapterofthetruthcommission.Theseorganizerswerelaterreconfirmedin ameetingwiththeRapanuicommunity.Nevertheless,theirfinalreportwas nottakenintoconsiderationandwasreplacedbyatextpresentedbytheauthoritiesrecognizedbytheChileangovernment. El Parlamento Rapanui Meanwhile, in 2001 a group of Rapanui created the Rapanui Parliament,severalofwhosemembersformerlybelongedtothesecondCouncil ofElders,whichvirtuallydissolvedafteritlosttheelectionsof1998.Their maindemandwasthattheChileanstatereturnRapanuiterritoryandthat landdistributionshouldbebasedonancestralprinciples.Theyalsodeclared autonomyintheiractofconstitutionanddemandedagovernmentoftheir own (Constitución Parlamentaria, 2001). The document does not specify whatexactlyismeantbyautonomy,butthiswasthefirsttimeaRapanui organizationhadmadeclaimstoself-governmentduringtheChileanepoch. Althoughthegroupisnotconsideredtobeaseriousinterlocutorbythe ChileangovernmentandrepresentsonlyaminorityoftheRapanuicommunity,ithasearnedrecognitionabroadbynetworkinginformallyinPolynesia andthePacific.LatelytheyhavealsorepresentedRapaNuiininternational organizations in New York and Geneva, such as the United Nations PermanentForumonIndigenousIssues,theUnitedNationsWorkingGroup for Indigenous Populations, and the Indigenous Peoples Pacific Caucus, whereithasrevealeditscomplaintsanddemandstotheChileanstate.In June2006somemembersoftheRapanuiParliamenttraveledfromRapa NuitojoinotherRapanuilivinginEuropeandtheUnitedStatestoparticipateinameetingofthenongovernmentalInternationalForumofIndigenousPeoples(Fipau),heldinPau,France.FromtheretheywenttoGeneva toparticipatein un meetingsheldparalleltoandinconjunctionwiththe importantmeetingoftherecentlycreatedUnitedNationsHumanRights CouncilinJuly2006.InbothinstancesRapanuiwereparticipatingininternationalarenasasindigenouspeoplewithspecificrightstoland,territory, andselfgovernment,thuscircumventinganation-statetheyconsidertobe inviolationoftheirrightsasapeople.
Chile and Rapa Nui 69
Special Status for Rapa Nui: A Special Territory with a Special Statute ForseveralyearsRapanuiauthorities,themayorinparticular,insisted ontheneedforapolítica de estadooftheChileangovernmenttowardRapa Nui.20Atthesametimetheworkofthetruthcommissionwasproceeding, Rapanuiauthorities,togetherwithChileanpublicpersonalities,including ex-presidentAylwin,startedtoelaborateaproposalforaSpecialStatutefor theAdministrationofEasterIsland.Ittookalmostthreeyearstoformulate andwascompletedinAugust2005.Theproposalincludesareformofthe ChileanConstitutioninordertocreateSpecialTerritoriesinEasterIsland andtheArchipelagoofJuanFernández.Theseterritorieswouldhaveacertaindegreeofadministrativeautonomybutwoulddependdirectlyonthe centralgovernment(Propuesta2005,5–6). Inthemeantime,thegovernmentsolicitedsuggestionsfromtheRapanuicommunityastowhatshouldbeincludedintheproposal,whichledto passionatediscussionsontheisland.InMay2006,ayearbeforethefinalapprovalofthespecialterritorystatus,thelocalofficeofconaDi organizeda seminarthatlastedseveraldaysandgatheredsomesevenhundredRapanui todiscussagovernmentproposalsimilartotheonedevelopedbythepublic personalitiesthatbasicallymaintainstheexistingadministrativestructure. ThedifferencebetweenthetwoproposalswasthatthegovernorofRapaNui wouldnolongerdependontheFifthRegion(Valparaíso)butdirectlyonthe centralgovernmentthroughitsMinistryoftheInterior. FromtheseminarheldinRapaNuiseveraldiscussiongroupsresulted, andtwomainRapanuiproposalsemergedbySeptember2006.Onewasvery similartothegovernment’sproposalandwasintendedtoincreasethepossibilitiesofbeingtakenintoaccountbytheChileangovernment.Nonetheless, thisgroupofRapanuiinsistedthatthereshouldbealocalgovernmentat thetopconsistingofsixelectedRapaNuimembers,alongsidethegovernor (orhighcommissioner),appointedbytheChileanpresident,andarepresentativeoftheCouncilofElders.Theother,moreradicalproposalinsisted onthereinstallationoftheKingdomofRapaNui,headedbyanarikiand administeredbyaCouncilofElderschosenbytheRapanuifamilies,with theparticipationofonerepresentativeoftheChileangovernment.Inthe discussionsofthesetwoproposalstheimportanceofthetraditionalRapanuisocialorganizationbasedonthethirty-sixfamilieswascentral,aswas theissueoflandandterritory(kainga).Eventhemoremoderateproposal recommendedthatnewpropertytitlesnotbeextendeduntilthepreviously 70 rietDelsing
completeddistributionoffifteenhundredhectareshadbeenproperlyanalyzed.Bothproposalsalsoinsistedthatanyfuturelanddistributionshould becarriedoutaccordingtotheterritorialdivisionsofeachclan.21 ToassisttheRapanuiinthesediscussionsandintheirrequest,theChilean governmentappointedaninternationalconsultant,whovisitedtheislandin December2006andmaderecommendationsforthecontentofthespecial statute.HeemphasizedinhisresultingreportthatChile’spoliticalConstitutiondeterminesthattheheadsofregionsandprovincialgovernorshavethe exclusivetrustofthepresidentoftheRepublicandthuscannotbeelectedby popularvote(Gómez2006).22Unlessstructuralchangesoccurinthehighly centralizedmodeloftheChileanstate,itwillbedifficultfortheRapanuito getpoliticalautonomy.Fromtheperspectiveofthestate,theonlythingthey canaspireto,forthetimebeing,isadministrativeautonomy. RapanuihavecomplainedaboutthefactthattheydonothavetheappropriateanalyticaltoolstodiscusstheChileanproposalforthespecialstatute andthattheappointmentofaconsultantcameverylateintheprocess.The discussiongroupsworkedforseveralmonthsin2006onadailybasiswithoutfullygraspingthetruesignificanceofthecentralizedcharacterofthe Chileanstate.Theyalsograppledwiththedifficultlegallanguageinwhich theproposaliscouchedandwouldsometimesswitchfromSpanishtoRapanuiinordertobetterunderstandthemeaningofspecificpartsoftheproposal. Towardtheendof2006,theChileangovernmentorganizedsomeworkshopsonthespecialstatute.Theydidsowithpublicfunctionariesonthe islandaswellaswithRapanuistudentsonthemainland.Onbothoccasions nocopiesofthegovernment’sdocumentweremadeavailabletotheparticipantsbeforehand.WhenastudentinSantiagoaskedwhythegrouphadnot receivedthisrelevantdocumentationsotheycouldhavestudieditbefore themeeting,theRapanuigovernor,CarolinaHotus,whowaspresentatthe workshop,answeredthatshedidnotwanttoconfusethem(personalinformation).Thislackofproperorientationseemsindicativeoftherelationsthe ChileangovernmentmaintainswiththeRapanui. DuringavisitbyPresidentMichelleBacheletofChiletotheislandin November 2006, on her way back home from the yearly meeting of the Asia-PacificEconomicCooperationheldinVietnam,shepromisedmore autonomyforRapaNui,butshedidnotdifferentiatebetweenadministrativeandpoliticalautonomyandthusconcealedtheimportantdifferencebetweenthetwo.ThesearejustafewexamplesofhowtheChileangovernment Chile and Rapa Nui 71
isstillnotsendingclearsignalstotheRapanuipeopleconcerningissuesof suchvitalimportancefortheirpoliticalfuture.Theremaybemorethanone reasonforthis,butIsuggestthatmistrustoftheRapanuipeople’scapacity tounderstandWesternwaysofthinkingisoneofthem.Bythesametoken, however,ChileansstillhavetoacquirearealunderstandingofRapanuiculturalways. In January 2007 a second seminar between the Rapanui discussion groupsandChileangovernmentofficialsfromtheMinistryoftheInterior tookplace.ItresultedinaproposalthatmostRapanuipresentatthemeetingagreedupon(Propuesta unificada de Estatuto Especial de Administración de Rapa Nui).Themainpointsofthisproposalarethefollowing:thegovernorofRapaNui,appointedbytheChileanpresident,wouldformpartof aCouncil(Koro Nui)consistingofsixelectedmembers;asfaraslandholding goes, individual private landownership would be recognized only for thoseindividualswhoalreadyhavesecuredpropertytitlestodate.Inthe restoftheislandcollectivelandownershipwouldbeappliedaccordingto “thetraditionaluseandcustomsthatexistedontheislandbefore9Septemberof1888”;allpubliclandbeingusedforgovernmentpurposeswouldbe handedovertoaRapanuicorporation.23TheproposalaboutcollectivelandownershipisanimplicitcritiqueofallChileanlegislationtodateandamajor manifestationofRapanuiculturalresilienceagainstallodds. Afterayearlongprocessofdiscussions,onemightthinkthatthiswould havebeenthefinalconsensusproposalonthepartoftheRapanui.Butitwas not.MayorPeteroEdmundsblockedtheproposalbysendingalettertothe MinistryoftheInteriorinFebruary2007inwhichhearguedthatthesigners ofthedraftproposalwerenotrepresentativeoftheRapanuipeopleandasa matteroffactwereopposingthegovernmentofLa Concertación—theruling governmentcoalition—andthatheandtheheadoftheCouncilofElders, theRapanui’slegitimaterepresentatives,hadnotbeeninvitedtoparticipate inthediscussions.24HealsostatedthattheproposalcontradictstheChilean Constitution and the principle of a unitarian state. Further, he expressed oppositiontotheproposedexpropriationofthelandfortheHotelHanga Roa,defendedtherightsofChileaninhabitantsontheisland,andstated thatthemajorityofRapanuidonotwishtobeseparatedfromChile.Healso emphasizedthatallthepreparatoryworkforthespecialstatutehadalready beendonebytheGrupodePersonalidades,ofwhichhehimselfformedpart. InJuly2007,Lawno.20.193reformedthepoliticalConstitutionofChile,
72 rietDelsing
allowingthecategoryofSpecialTerritorytoRapaNuiandtheArchipelago Juan Fernández, whose government and administration has to be determinedbyaspecialstatuteestablishedbyaLey orgánica constitucional(constitutional organic law). Not until May of 2008 was a new proposal for a specialstatutefinallypresentedtoCongress,withoutanyfurtherinputor approvalfromtheRapanuicommunityinopenmeetings.Thenewlyelected representative of conaDi , Rafael (Rinko) Tuki, who participated in the workshopsonthetopicin2006andwhosesignatureappearsonthedraft proposalofJanuary2007,doesnotagreewiththecontent(personalinformation). Onecandistinguishatleastthreepointsofviewinpresent-dayRapanui politics in the context of the discussions around Special Territory Status. OnegroupofRapanuiproposestotrytoconvincetheChileanstatetoincorporateRapanuiwishesforself-government,especiallyinrelationtocollectivelandownership,butiswillingtocompromiseastotheultimatepolitical authorityovertheisland.Implicitly,theseRapanuiacceptdefactoChilean sovereigntyoverRapanuiterritory.Asmallgroup,mainlybelongingtothe RapanuiParliament,insiststhattheAgreementofWillsof1888wasillegal andwantstoproceedfromthatpoint,inthefullknowledgethattheChilean statewillnotrespondtothisrequest.Itisnotquiteclearwhatthepolitical agendaofthecurrentofficialleadersofRapaNuiis.Althoughtheyhave wagedahistoricalstruggleforRapanuirights,theynowinsistontherights oftheChileannation-stateoverRapaNui.
Conclusion I have shown here that the relationship between Chile and Rapa Nui is markedbyChile’sinsistentclaimofsovereigntyoverRapanuiterritory.Successivelawsanddecreeshaveputastrongemphasisontheprivatizationof land,inordertoreplaceideasofcollectiveprivatelandownership.TheseparationoftheRapanuifromtheirancestrallands(kainga)andtherelentless insistenceonthebenefitsofsmall-scaleprivatelandownershiphaveeroded Rapanuicustomarylaw,aswaspredictedbyPedroPabloToromorethana centuryago. Chile’sactionsontheislandaredeterminedbytheshiftingconcernsof successivegovernmentsandbythepersistingconceptofaunitarianstate. Sincethelate1960s—coincidingwiththeintegrationofRapaNuiintothe
Chile and Rapa Nui 73
national administrative system—Chile has gone through various political stages, including the first freely elected Socialist government in Latin Americaandabrutaldictatorship.SuchlawsastheEasterLawof1966,the PinochetLawDecreeof1979,andtheIndigenousLawof1993clearlyreflect the political philosophy of these respective governments. Nevertheless, Chileanlegislatorsofallpoliticalcolorshaveinsistedontheimportanceof individualprivatelandownership,thetrademarkofWesterncivilization. Theselegalinterventions,basedonapoliticalsystemalientotheRapanuiworldview,havecausedculturalmisunderstandingsthatarelittleunderstoodandneedtobeclarifiedbybothRapanuiandChileans.Iarguethat duringthetwentiethcenturyChileanlawmakersfailedtoconceptualizethe importantdifferencesbetweenindividualandcollectiveprivatelandownership,whileonlythelattermakesculturalsenseformanyRapanui.IalsocontendthatoverthepastseveralyearsChileanpoliticianshavebeencovering uptheimportantdifferencebetweenadministrativeandpoliticalautonomy, underthecircumstancethatself-determinationissoimportantiftheRapanuiaretoachievetheirculturalgoals. ItcanalsobesuggestedthattheChileanstate’sinterventionsinRapaNui havecreateddivisionsbetweenRapanuiduringtheperiodunderconsideration in this essay. Because of Rapa Nui’s colonial dependence on Chile, RapanuileadersarevirtuallyobligedtoworkwithinbothsystemsandparticipateintheintricateinstitutionalandpoliticalstructurethatChilehas imposedonRapaNui.AlthoughtheyareconsideredbyChileanpoliticians as their main liaison with Rapa Nui, these leaders are often out of touch withtheirpeople.Theconsequencehasbeenalackofstrongleadershipover thepastseveralyears,causingdisinterestincommonculturalgoalsamong aconsiderablepartoftheRapanuicommunity.Ithasalsocausedinternal powerstrugglesbetweenRapanuithataredifficulttoassessandovercome. Cooptationofindigenousleadersisawell-knowncolonialstrategy,andone canseeitatworkinRapaNui. Chilean legislation has met with Rapanui resistance over the past decades,aswesawinthegeneralrejectionofthedifferentlaws,allaimedatthe privatizationofRapanuiland.SeveralRapanuinowinsistonrevivingthis connectionwiththelandandtheirtraditionalsocialorganization,which aresointimatelyconnected.Atthesametime,someRapanuihavestarted to articulate their cultural difference as a Polynesian people and to organizeaccordingly.TheseRapanuiarepointingouttheculturalblunderscommittedineverysinglepieceofChileanlegislationandareaskingforpolitical 74 rietDelsing
self-determination,evenifwithintheChileannation-state.Onlyaprofound changeoftheChileanConstitutionwouldallowthistohappen. WhateverthedecisionsmadebyChileangovernments,theRapanuiwill continueonthepathtowardself-determination,supportedbyotherPacific peoplesandtheinternationalcommunity.Atthesametime,Chileancivil societywill,onehopes,guideitspoliticalleadersinthedirectionofaparticipatorydemocracy,inwhichculturaldifferencebecomesanassetinstead ofathreattosovereignty.Thesetwoprocessesofsocialandpoliticalchange, inRapaNuiaswellasinChile,haveacertaindegreeofurgency.
Notes 1.InaccordancewithcommonpracticeintheliteratureIusethetermsRapa Nui whenreferringtotheislandandRapanuiwhenreferringtothepeople,thelanguage, etc. 2.Thistranslationproblemcanbecomparedwithasimilaronesurroundingthe TreatyofWaitangi,accordedbetweentheMaoriofAotearoa/NewZealandandthe BritishCrown(seeFentonandMoon2002). 3.Intheearlydaystheariki-mauwastheheadoftheMiruclan,theparamount chiefandundisputedleaderoftheisland.Inthelaterperiodtheislandwasnolonger united,andtheleadersoftheclanschallengedeachotherinayearlycontest.Afterthe disseminationoftheRapanuipopulationattheendofthenineteenthcenturyand thebreakdownoftheclansystem,therewasonlyoneariki,whomtheRapanuicalled kin,aftertheEnglishtermking.IhaveheardcontemporaryRapanuiarguethatitis notclearifthetermarikimeans“chief ”or“king.” 4.Theconceptofkaingahasmorethanonemeaning.Iuseithereasaterritorial unit,constitutingtheestateofaclanordescentgroup(seeMétraux1971;Kirch2000, 272) 5.PresidentJoséManuelBalmaceda(1886–91)committedsuicidein1891,atthe endofthecivilwar,whichlastedforsevenmonthsandcausedbetweenfiveandten thousandChileandeaths(Loveman2001,159;Subercaseaux,1997,16).TheChilean culturalhistorianBernardoSubercaseauxarguesthatthewartookplaceatthecrossroadsofChile’spassagetoa“social,economicandpoliticalmodernity”andthatthe year1891“hasbeenconceivedasakindofmetaphorofthemoderncountry”(1997, 34–36).Chile,saysSubercaseaux,forgeditselfasamodernnation-stateinthereconstructionperiodafterthewar,inwhichanewpoliticalandideologicallandscape formedandnewsocial,cultural,andpoliticalactorsappeared.Thisdifficultprocess ofstrivingforinternalnationalcohesionmayhavedistractedattentionfromChile’s adventureinthePacific. 6.E.g.,DanielMaríaTeave,thirty-sixyearsofage,ownerofthelandsbetween Chile and Rapa Nui 75
Hotu’ItiandHangaTe’e;TimoteoPate,thirty-sixyearsofage,ownerofpartofPoike; SimeonRiroroko,twenty-oneyearsofage,ownerofAnakena,etc.(El Consejo1988, 297). 7. This information comes from an interview I conducted in 2002 with Naval GovernorPatricioCarrasco,whotoldmethatnonavyrecordsontheislandexist before1990. 8.OnseveraloccasionsChileangovernmentshavepreferrednottoofficiallyinterveneinRapanuiconceptsoflandtenure,presumablybecausethesedidnotinterfere inChileanmainlandpolitics.Ontheotherhand,mostRapanuidonotreadilymake theconnectionbetweensovereigntyandterritory.OnlyveryrecentlyhavesomeRapanuistartedtoopenlyquestiontheChileanclaimthattheislandisChileanterritory. 9.SincetheannexationtheRapanuihadelectedarikiinplacewhowereinconstantdisagreementwiththeChileansheepfarmers.Thesituationhadbecomeunsustainableby1902,whenthecommanderoftheyearlynavyshipGeneral Baquedano namedJuanTepano,aRapanui,as“chieforcaciquewiththetaskofvigilanceandrepresentativeoftheislandersforthesubdelegado marítimo[portcaptain]”(Document oftheMinistryofNationalDefense).Thiswasastrategiccolonialdecision,since thenavyneededabufferbetweenthecompanyandtheRapanui.AsayouthTepano hadservedintheChileanarmyduringtheWarofthePacificandhadbeenacculturated,sotospeak.ItwasthefirsttimetheChileansintervenedinRapanuileadership decisions.ThecommanderalsoordainedthatTepanowastobesubordinatetothe companyrepresentativeandsubdelegado,andhetookfiveoftheresistanceleadersto Chile(Ministerio de Marina. Oficios de la Dirección General de la Armada,1902). 10.Thisinformationisextractedfromadocumentof1936oftheChileanMinistry ofDefense.Itrefersto“13.747hectares”outof15.796. 11. Contemporary international law distinguishes four ways of exercising sovereigntyoverterritories,namely,byoccupation,prescription,conquest,orcession (Wallace1997,92–100).Occupationreferstothesituationinwhichastateestablishes titletoaterritorywhichisterra nullius,thisis,ownedbynooneorinhabitedbysavages.TheargumentforoccupationisdifficulttosustaininRapaNuibecauseitwasa stratifiedandorganizedPolynesiansocietyatthetimeoftheChileantakeover.After all,itwasthearikiwhosignedthetreatywiththeChileans.Prescriptionrefersto thesituationinwhichsovereigntycanbeinvokedbyclaimantswhodiscoveredand occupiedaterritoryandwhowanttoconsolidatetheirclaim.Astatecanvalidatean initiallydoubtfultitle,providedthatthedisplayofauthorityispublic,peaceful,and continuous.Prescriptionthusinvolvesadefactoexerciseofsovereignty(Wallace 1997, 97). This situation is also referred to as occupation cum animo domini. The Chileanstatearguesthatitexercisedpublic,peaceful,andcontinuousauthorityover theisland.However,contemporaryinternationallawestablishesthat“anotherclaimantoradispossessedsovereigncanbartheestablishmentoftitlebyprescription” (Wallace 1997, 97). This is a possibility to be explored by contemporary Rapanui. 76 rietDelsing
Sovereigntythroughconquestreferstotheacquisitionofenemyterritorybymilitary forceinwartime.ThisisclearlynotthecaseforRapaNui.Cessionisthetransferof sovereigntybyonesovereigntoanother.ThisistheargumentforChileansovereignty overRapaNuimostfrequentlyusedtoday,byChileansandRapanuialike.However,therecenttranslationoftheRapanuiversionofthecessionandproclamation documentsunsettlesthisargument,asitshowsthat,accordingtothistranslationof theRapanuiversionofthetreaty,theRapanuichiefsdidnotcedetheirterritoryto theChileanstate.IarguethattheonlywayforChiletoclaimsovereigntytodayis throughprescription,butthattheRapanuicanobjecttothisbymeansofdiplomatic protestsintheappropriateinternationalforums(Wallace1997,97). 12.Anotheract,carriedoutwithouttheconsultationoftheRapanui,wasthecreationoftheRapanuiNationalParkanditsnominationasaNationalHistoricMonumentin1935(Makihara1999,86). 13.Thisdecreecorrespondedtoamoregeneralpolicyofprivatizationofagriculturallands,mostlybelongingtoindigenouspeopleonthemainland,mainlythe Mapuche.In1979Pinochetissuedadecree(DL2.536)thatdidawaywithMapuche communal landownership. This was followed by another one in 1980 (DL 3.516) allowingforthedivisionoflandintosmallplotsofhalfahectare,therebyviolating Mapucheculturalprinciples.Thesedecreesformedpartofaprofoundlegaltransformationcarriedoutbetween1978and1981thatreformulatedallformerdispositions aboutpropertyrightsovernaturalresources.Thepurposeofthesereformswasthe implementationofaneconomicmodelfocusedonexportation(Toledo2005,5). 14.Thiscouncilwasstillheadedbyitsfirstleader,AlbertoHotus,in2007andstill existstoday.Itiscomposedofrepresentativesofthethirty-sixRapanuifamiliesthat tracetheirancestrytotheoriginaltribes.ItspurposeistodefendboththeRapanui’s righttotheirland,territory,andcultureandotherRapanuiinterests(seeEl Consejo de Jefes de Rapa Nui . . . ,1988). 15.Personalcommunication,AlfonsoRapu. 16. The head of the council has created a system of patronage over the years. Alongsidehiscentralroleinthecouncil,hehasheldseveralimportantgovernment postsandhasbuiltapowerbaseontheislandandonthemainlandthatishardto matchanddifficulttocontest.HisconsistentsupportonthemainlandcanbeexplainedbythefactthathehasbeenloyaltotheCenter-Leftgovernmentcoalitionin powersincethereturntodemocracyin1990.Especiallythroughhisroleasnational advisorof conaDi ,hehasbeenabletoinfluencetheintricateRapanuifamilynetworkbyhandingoutfavorsinexchangeforvotes. 17.ThisgesturecorrespondedagainpartlytoaChileanelectioncampaign. 18. This information comes from interviews I conducted in 2001 with Alvaro Durán (lawyer for conaDi ) and Alvaro Lafuente and Rodrigo Sepúlveda (functionariesoftheMinisteriodeBienesNacionales),and,in2006,withLuisGuillermo Alvarez(alsoafunctionaryinBienesNacionales). Chile and Rapa Nui 77
19.AChileanassociationbythenameofFriendsofEasterIslandhadarranged throughtheMinistryofEducationforelevenscholarshipstobeawardedtostudents tostudyonthemainland,sincenosecondaryeducationexistedontheisland.One ofthestudents,AlfonsoRapuHaoa,wasonlythirteen,theyoungestofthegroup.He returnedtotheislandeightyearslaterwithateachingdegreeinhand.Hesaysthat inSantiagohewas“alwaysveryconcernedaboutthegreatpovertyandabandonment thatmypeoplesuffered,myfamily,mybrothersandsisters,andIstartedtothink abouthowtotakethemoutofthatworld,getthemoutofthedarknessandputthem inthelight,sotheywouldbeabletowalk”(interview,17May2002). 20.Theconceptofpolítica de estadobecamepartoftheChileanpoliticalvocabularyatthebeginningofthe2000s.ThemayorprobablyadoptedthetermfromChile. 21.ThisinformationwasgatheredduringmyvisittotheislandinAugust–December2006,duringwhichIparticipatedregularlyinthemeetingsofoneofthediscussiongroups. 22.InmeetingsbetweenGómezandRapanuithatparticipatedinthediscussion groups,hesaidthatnation-stateshavemadeindigenouspeoplesinvisible,thatthere isnomutualunderstandingbetweentheChileanstateandRapanuiasyet,andthat itisimportanttopayattentiontothekindoflanguageemployedinconversations betweenthetwoparties.Healsoemphasizedthepoweroforganizing. 23.Theproposalalsocontainsrecommendationsforaspecialbudget,thecreation ofaspecialbodyforthedefenseandprotectionofRapanuicultureandculturalpatrimony,and,crucially,fortheregulationofimmigrationtotheisland.Uncontrolled immigrationisoneofthemaincomplaintstheRapanuihave.AlthoughIfirmlyagree withtheimportanceofthisissue,Idonotaddressitinthisessay. 24.Bynotparticipatinginanyoftheworkshopsorother,moregeneralmeetingsorganizedwiththeRapanuicommunityin2006,themayorandtheheadofthe CouncilofElders,AlbertoHotus,marginalizedthemselves.
78 rietDelsing
inpart2,boundedonbothsidesbysectionsthatestablishadialoguebetweenNorthandSouth,areaboutLatinAmerica.Taken together,theytellaparticularlyLatinAmericanstoryofmorethanagenerationofactivismandcross-culturalcollaborationbetweenNativecommunitiesandtheirintellectualsononesideandnon-Nativeradicalintellectualsontheother.Whilethethreeessaysarequitedifferent,afactIexplore below,thesimilaritiesamongthemhelpusunderstandanespeciallysalient momentinthehistoryofcontinentalindigenouspeoplesacrosstheLatin Americanregion. In contrast to Native peoples based in the continental United States, whosestruggleshaveoftenrevolvedaroundtherecognitionoftreaty-based rightsandtheachievementoffederalrecognition—somethingthatKauanui’sessayonHawai‘iinpart1helpsusputinamorecomplexcontext— indigenouspeoplesinLatinAmericahavehistoricallystruggledmainlyat the individual community level. This is because the process of colonizationinmostcasesreorganizedindigenoussocietyfromthestart,breaking downregionalorimperialcoalitionsandrearticulatinglocalsocietiesand theirleaderstoanemergingcolonialstate.Bythebeginningofthetwentiethcentury,thishistoryhadgeneratedtwointerrelated,thoughsometimes contradictory, trends in the relationship between Native peoples and nationalstates.WhileNativestrugglesforculturalpreservationandeconomic viabilitywereusuallyorganizedaroundtheprotectionofcommunalpoliticalautonomy,oftentheonlywaytoprotectlocallandswasbydemanding thatthenationalstateinterveneagainstrapaciousregionallandowners.As aresult,indigenouspeoplesintwentieth-centuryLatinAmericawereoften caughtbetweenethnoculturalimperativesononesideandtheneedtoform partofbroaderpopular,class-basedcoalitionsontheother. These competing alliances and loyalties were made even more complicated by the emergence ofnational-popular states. Beginning with the MexicanRevolutionof1910andspreadingthroughtheregioninthewake oftheGreatDepressionofthe1930s,coalitionsofmiddle-classpoliticians andpopularsectorsinstitutedwelfare-orientedstates.Whileinsomecases, suchasMexicoandBolivia,themeasuresinstitutedbythesestatesincluded agrarianreform,everywheretheyalsoaimedtointegrateindigenouspeoples intothenationthrougheducation.AsNativepeoplesconfrontedthepromtHe tHree essays
ise of resources in conjunction with the requirement of integration, the emergenceofindigenouspoliticalidentitiesoccurredbothfromwithinand againstthelegacyofthenational-popularstate.Andgiventhetwo-pronged natureofindigenouspoliticalmobilization,non-Nativecollaboratorshave beenanimportantpresencethroughoutthetwentiethcentury. Thethreeregionstreatedinpart2exhibitsomeimportantcontrastsin thisgeneralhistory.InthestateofChiapas,insoutheasternMexico,political andeconomicreformhasbeenpostponedthroughmuchofMexico’smodernhistory.TheMexicanRevolutioncamelatetoChiapasandmainlyfrom outside, and when the indigenous communities were integrated into the emergingpostrevolutionarystateinthe1930sitwasatthecostofaccepting theemergenceofanewlocaleliteunderthehegemonyoftheofficialrevolutionaryparty.IntheCaucaValleyinColombia,wheretheindigenousgroups thatformpartofthe cric arelocated,theNasaandGuambianopeoples haveexperiencedaparallelhistoryofmarginalizationandpostponement. Atthesametime,giventheColombianstate’songoingdifficultieswitheffectivenationalintegration,theyweresometimesabletotransformtheirmarginalizationintoaformofculturalpreservation.Still,inboththeMexican andColombiancases,theindigenouspeoplesfeaturedherehavelivedon themarginsofemergingnationalstates.TheQuechuacommunitiesofthe CochabambaValleyinBolivia,ontheotherhand,haveoftenbeenconsideredtheshowcaseoftheagrarianreformrealizedbytheBolivianRevolution of1952andhavehistoricallyhadareputationascombativeandcentraltothe populistpoliticsoftheBolivianstate.Theimportanceofthevalley’speasant unionsandthecloserelationshiptheyhavewithQuechuacommunalorganizationsemergeinlargepartfromthishistory. Thethreeessayspresentedherediscussthepasttwentytothirtyyears, whentheroleofthenonindigenouscollaboratorhasbeentransformedas theviabilityofthenational-popularstatehasunraveled.Thethreeessaysexploretheimplicationsofthistransformation,indistinctcontextsandwith differentresults.Notonlyaretherulesandparametersofthecollaborations different,butsoisthenatureoftheindigenoussocietyandofthepolitical activitytowhichthecollaboratorsareconnected.Equallyimportant,thecollaboratorsthemselvesoccupydiversepositionswithintheirownsocieties. As a nonindigenous Ecuadorian linguist specializing in Quichua, Fernando Garcés V. has chosen to collaborate with Conosur Ñawpagman, a Quechua-languagenewspaperproducedandcirculatedinthesoutherncorneroftheCochabambaValley.Inthispoliticallymilitantregion,whichgave Indigenous Writing and Collaboration 81
birthtonow-presidentEvoMorales’sMovimientoAlSocialismo,thenewspaperhasevolvedintoaninstrumentattheserviceofthepeasantunionthat connectsdifferentQuechuacommunitiesintheirongoingstruggletopreservetheirland,culture,language,andlocalknowledge.Undertheseconditions, Garcés considers that the editorial team of the newspaper serves asabridgebetweentherichmetaphoricallexiconoforalQuechuaandthe conventionsofthewrittenwordandcanbeapowerfulexampleofmore effectivewaystostandardizewrittenQuechuaonthebasisofcontemporary practice.Atthesametime,thelanguageitselfmustbedefendedthrough writingandthroughthecreativeinscriptionoforalityinwrittenform,but withthespecificpurposeofdefendingthecultureandcommunalresources fromcolonialappropriation.Asaresult,then,thenewspapercollaborates withQuechuapeasantorganizationsinasortof“globalizationfrombelow.” ThedialogueandcollaborationfeaturedintheessaybyJoanneRappaport andAbelardoRamosPacho,astheypointout,hasbeenongoingforthree decades,althoughthespecificprojectdiscussedhereisahistoryofanintercultural and bilingual education project formulated by Consejo Regional IndígenadelCauca(cric).Articulatedwithandbythe cric ,thishistoricalresearchprojectwassuccessful,theauthorsexplain,preciselybecauseit articulateddifferentculturalregistersand,throughtheirmutualinterrogation,reimaginedthemall.Theintermediatebridgepositionalsodiscussed byGarcésishereinhabitedbybothNativeandnon-Nativeintellectualsand researchers,whotogetherstruggletoharnesstheirresearchagendatothe prioritiesofthecric ,whicharethemselvesthecollectiveproductofaconversation among traditional communal authorities, shamanic specialists, localteachers,andnon-Nativecollaborators.AsRamosexplains,onecan seeresearchasaminga—collectiveworkbyandforthebenefitofthecommunity.Thisisanexampleofindigenoustheorizing,whichtakesshapeina multiethnicandinterculturalenvironmentinwhichtranslationentailsthe improvementaswellasthereinterpretationofideasandconcepts. TheessaybyJanRusandDianeRustakes,intheirownwords,theformof adiarythattracestheemergenceoftheTallerTzotzil,anindigenouspublishingproject,inthecontextofadramaticallychangingworldamongTzotzil MayacommunitiesinChiapasbetweenthe1970sandthepresent.Incontrasttotheotheressays,whichstrivetotheorizeaboutindigenousknowledgeandliteracyandtodecolonizeexistingintellectualcategoriesandpracticesfromtheperspectiveofindigenousepistemologies,theRuses’narrative traces the economic, political, and cultural changes on the ground, so to 82 parttWo
speak,asTzotzilMayacommunitiesstrugglewiththeconsequencesbrought onbytheinsertionoftheirregionintotheinternationalglobalizedeconomy.InadetailedyetultimatelyunderstatedwaytheRusestakethereader throughtheirtransformationfromlocallycommittedethnographerswho weredeeplyconnectedinChamulainthe1970stoscribe-collaboratorswho helpedbringintopublicviewhistoriesandnarrativesthathadpreviously beenconsideredsecret.Theprocessthroughwhichthisoccurred,andthe internalaswellasbroadertensionsandconflictsthataccompaniedit,unfold organicallythroughanaccountofhowtheTzotzilpublishinghouseoriginated,evolved,andchangedoverseveraldecades.Amongthelargerevents wovenintothisaccountaretheincreasingmigrationofcommunitymemberstotheUnitedStatesandtheZapatistauprisingof1994. Asisclearinallthreeessaysinpart2,Nativeknowledge,education,and literacyaredeeplyembeddedinindigenoushistories,politicalstruggle,and localcommunitylife.Non-Nativecollaboratorsworkwithinthesespecific contextsandestablishdialoguesand,asRamoswouldputit,mingasthat areappropriatetoeachcase.Atthesametime,thepersonalandintellectual trajectoriesofthecollaboratorsthemselvesplayaroleintherelationships established.AsapracticingmemberoftheU.S.academy,JoanneRappaport usesherexperienceasacollaboratortorethinkandretheorizethenatureof researchandthewaysinwhichinterculturalworkcanchangetheperspectiveswebringandthequestionsweask.Garcésusestheexperienceofthe newspapertoquestiontheseparationbetweenoralityandwritingandthe natureofintertextuality,whileatthesametimecounterposingtheforms oflocalknowledgecontainedinQuechuapeasantyachaytothesupposed universalityofWesterncategories.AndJanRusandDianeRus,bychoice activistanthropologistswhohaveeschewedfullparticipationintheU.S.academicmainstream,strengthentheirpositionasnarratorswhoaccompany TzotzilMayacommunitiesastheymakesenseofarapidlychangingworld. Inthefinalanalysis,theseessayshelpustracethemultiplewaysinwhich indigenousnarratives,histories,andpoliticalactioninLatinAmericahave notonlyparticipatedinandbenefitedfrominterculturalcollaboration,but alsocontributedinpowerfulwaystothedevelopmentofgrass-rootsmobilizationmorebroadly.InColombia,theConstitutionof1991,writtenin dialoguewithindigenous organizations andpolitical activists, hashelped frameinnewwaysthepossibilitiesofmultiethnicnationhood.InBolivia, theindigenouspeasantmovementthatgeneratedMorales’sMovimientoAl SocialismohasmadeclearthateffectiveglobalizationmustrespectandcolIndigenous Writing and Collaboration 83
laboratewithlocalneedsandformsofknowledge,andithashelpedelect Morales,Bolivia’sfirstindigenouspresident.AndinChiapas,theMayacommunitiesthathelpedgeneratetheEjércitoZapatistadeLiberaciónNacional continuetochallengepoliticaltransitionsthatserveonlytheinterestsofthe politicalandeconomiccenterofthecountry.Theselargetransformations, too,arepartofindigenoushistoryandmustbeinterpretedassuch.
84 parttWo
FernanDo garcés v.
QuechuaKnowledge,Orality,andWritings The Newspaper ConosurÑawpagman
InthisessayIreflectonsomeaspectsofQuechuaknowledge,orality,and writingfoundwithinaconcretecaseinscribedinwriting:theConosur Ñawpagmannewspaper.1Tothisend,Iofferreflectionsonthismeansofcommunication,focusingonitsobjectivesaswellasitslinguisticandepistemic usagepractices.Iconcentrateespeciallyontheinscriptionoforaldiscourse and therebyoffer a pragmatic and epistemic defense of Quechua peasant yachay.2Ibeginbyofferingthreeclarificationsbywayofintroduction:how andwhyIusethetermpeasant;what,moreconcretely,ImeanbyQuechua yachay;andashortreflectiononmyauthority,asanoutsider,torepresent Quechuavoices. Incontemporarysocialsciencediscourse,scholarsareworkingtomove beyondaclassist-Marxistvisionsoastorightlyrecognizeotherformsofexclusion.Amongthoseformsofexclusion,ethnicidentityoccupiesaprivileged place. Events ofthe past decades have contributed to the centrality of interest in culture and identity within social and political analyses of different national and multinational spaces (Garcés 2006). Several scholarshavelinkedthisnewfoundattentiontootherformsofexclusiontothe changes contemporary global capitalism has suffered over the past thirty years(Castro-Gómez2003;Jameson1984;Žižek1993).InthecaseofAbya Yala,scholarshaveincreasinglyemphasizedthatthecolonialrestructuring oflocalsocietiesinvolvedsystemsofinequality,basedonsocialclass,andof exclusion,basedoncategorieslikeraceandgender(Quijano2000;Santos 2003).3Undersuchconditions,myuseofthetermpeasantnecessarilycalls forarethinkingoftheimaginaryofclass,enrichingitwithaconcernforthe processesbywhichcontemporaryidentitiesarepoliticized(Regalsky,2003).
Asecondreasonformyusingthetermpeasantinvolvestheterm’shistoricalbaggageintheBoliviancontext.Whatcanbecalledtheindigenousvein inBoliviahascombinedtheexperiencesoforganizationswithso-calledtraditionalindigenousstructuresandthoseofotherswhosehistoricalexperienceshavepromptedthemtoorganizetheirinterestsasAndeancommunitiesthroughthestructureoftheruralunion.Animportantexampleofthis istheTiawuanakumanifesto,whichSarelaPazdescribesasakeymilestone inthematurationofthenotionofindigenouspeoplesintheAndeanworld. Viathatmanifesto,urbanandruralAymarasectorsconvergedwithdiverse peasantsectorsaroundKatarismo,expressing“theculture’shistoricalhorizonsandideologicalthemes.”Forthisauthor,“TheManifestogatherspeasant Quechua/Aymara voices that revindicate their autochthonous culture andtheoriginofdoubleoppression:economicintermsofpeasantsandculturalintermsofexcludedpeoples”(Paz2005,2). Hereweseethatthetermpeasantretainsapresenceasacategoryofself- denominationamongruralBoliviansandwithinBoliviansocialmovements, even as in the new context of struggle they have also reformulated their identitiesasaboriginalorindigenous.4IntheDepartmentofCochabamba, wherethebilingualnewspapertreatedinthisessayprimarilycirculates,itis theformmostfrequentlyfound.NoneoftheabovedeniesthevalidityofdiscoursesandpracticesthatrevindicatetheaboriginalandindigenouscharacterofmanycommunitiesandcollectivitiesinBolivia.Ithinkthatinthis casewecangainmorefromacomprehensive,capaciousvisionthanfroma restrictive,exclusiveone.
Aspartofthismorecapaciousvision,itisimportanttoreflectsystematically onthetermQuechua yachay,bywhichImeanthecollectiveknowledgeproducedandreproducedorallybyQuechua-speakingcommunities.WhileIdo notbelievethereisadirectandexclusiveassociationbetweenalanguage,a typeofknowledge,andasingle,distinctnationorpeople,InonethelesspreferthetermQuechua yachaytoother,moregeneralandlesspreciseones. Andean knowledge,forexample,atleastintheBoliviancase,includesaswell Aymaracommunities,whileindigenous knowledgerefersaswelltothelowlandindigenouspeoples.Thus,Quechua yachayhasacertainpracticaluse. TothinkofQuechuaknowledgeasoralalsoforcesustorecognizethe geopolitics of knowledge that has colonially subalter[n]ized certain languages, among them Quechua (Garcés 2005a). My understanding of 86 FernanDogarcésV.
Quechua yachay as being fundamentally oral might seem to rearticulate thecolonialimaginarywithinwhichindigenouslanguageswereclassified as“lower”becausetheydidnotexpressmodern,abstract,orspiritualideas (Mannheim1991,61–79;Mignolo1999).Onthecontrary,Iwanttoemphasizethatcolonialdifferentiationhasalsoprovidedsubalter[n]izedlanguages withacertainepistemologicalpowerreproducedatthemarginsorinthe intersticesofcolonialpower(Rivera1987;Mignolo2002).Whiletherehas beenahistoryofpermanentcontactsbetweenoralityandtheworldofwrittencommunication,fromcolonialtimesandinamuchmoreintensewayin thecontemporaryperiod,thevastmajorityoftheAndeanworldcontinues toprivilegeoralknowledgeineverydaycommunicationalspaces.AsIwill show,thisisbecauseQuechuayachayanditsoralproductionandreproductionarecounterhegemonicresponsestoaglobalcolonialepistemology.
MyfinalclarificationhastodowiththepachafromwhereIthinkandarticulatemyownintellectualandpoliticalpracticewithregardtoQuechua.5 MyconnectionwiththeQuichuaandQuechualanguagesisrootedinmyinvolvementwithdiversebilingualeducationprograms,mysupportforlocal researchprojects,andmyrelationshipswiththenewspaper’seditorialteam. ThroughtheseexperiencesIhavefoundmyselfinagrowingstrugglewith myownpersonalhistoryofcolonization,awarethatmyabilitytopartakeof thisprocessofreflectionandinterventionplacesmeinapositionofpower. IthusdevelopmyideasaboutQuechuaandQuechuayachayinahighly chargedcontextofstrugglesoverrepresentationinwhichImyselfamaparticipant(Castro-Gómez2000). Inthistext,asIattempttomappoliticallytheenvironmentsinwhich thepowerofknowledgeandlanguagesmoves,Inecessarilyinvolvemyself instrugglesoverpowerandoverdifferentpositionsconcerningQuechua anditsyachay.Ispeak,then,fromalocationmarkedbymyownsubjectivity andhistory:asawhiteintellectual,male,nativeSpanishspeaker,andasfull ofcontradictions.Atthesametime,Iconstantlylabortoinsertmyselfinto alearningprocessmarkedbycrisisandrupture,aprocessthatistheproductofinteractionwithotherwomenandmenalsodisplacedintheactof speakingandknowing.Thisessayemergesfromakindoffrontier,apositionwhereIknowmyselftobepartofthesystemofpoweryetamalsoin constantconversationwithotherformsofknowing,thinking,speaking,and silencing. Quechua Knowledge and Writings 87
Background on the Conosur Ñawpagman TheConosur Ñawpagmannewspaperwascreatedin1983inassociationwith thePortalesCenteroftheSimónPatiñoFoundation.6FinancedwithSwiss aid,thenewspaperservedtopromotereadinginMizque,aprovinceofthe DepartmentofCochabamba.Thenewspaperwascreatedthroughanagreement with the San José de Mizque Cooperative, under the name El Mizqueño.Initially,thepaperwasgearedtothepeopleoftheMizquecommunityandsupportedtheworkofthepopularlibrariesthatthePortalesCenter hadcreatedindifferentprovincesofthedepartment. The year the Conosur was born was one of significant drought in the valleysofCochabambaandmarkedthearrivalofmanynongovernmental organizations(ngo s)thatbroughtwiththemlargequantitiesofmoneyfor peasantcommunities.TheConosurbeganpublicationinanattempttoanalyzetheimpactofdevelopmentprojectsinthecommunities.Thefirstissues ofthenewspaperaddressedthesupposedbenefitsthatdevelopmentinstitutionsbroughttothecountrysideandtheopinionsofpeasantswhoopposed theinstitutions’overwhelmingpresence.Thefollowingyear,inanagreement withtheMoyopampaAgriculturalUnion(Totora,Carrascoprovince),El TotoreñoemergedandessentiallyreproducedEl Mizqueño’scontentbutwith differentheadlines.El Totoreñosoughttobeamoredirectnexuswiththe communitiesandseparateitselffromthesmall-townsectortowhichitwas initiallylinked. TheConosurnewspaperexploredtheissueofappropriatetechnologies andbegantoconductresearchindifferentcommunitiestotestthehypothesis that the introduction of modern technology, instead of benefiting the communities,actuallyacceleratedtheerosionofpeasantknowledge,justas iterodedthesoil(GonzaloVargas,interview,09/10/01).InRaqaypampa,for example,researchdemonstratedthatpeasantsdevelopedtheirownstrategies, in which families and local grass-roots organizations acted together to counter the effects of introduced technologies and the constant, overwhelmingassaultofthemarket.Itwaspossibletoobservethecultivationof cropslinkedtoeachother,theuseofdiverseecologicalniches,highlyprecise weatherforecasting,seedvarieties,andsoforth. Atameetingin1986ofthetradeunioncentralsofthethreesouthernmostprovincesoftheDepartment ofCochabamba (Totora,Mizque,and Carrasco),theparticipantsaskedthateachprovincehaveitsownnewspaper.
88 FernanDogarcésV.
Takingstockoflimitedinstitutionalcapacity,theparticipantsdecidedtocreateonenewspaperlinkedtopeasantorganizations,especiallytheMizque Provincial Trade Union, the Moyapampa Union, and the Departmental PeasantFederationitself.7Atthesamemeeting,thenewspaperwasgiven thenameConosur Ñawpagmanbecauseitdealtwiththeprovincesinthe department’ssoutherncone. In1988theAndeanCommunicationandDevelopmentCenter(cenDa) consideredthepossibilityoffocusingonradiocommunications.Asaresult, theConosur’spublicationwassuspendedforalmostayear,andthenewspaperunderwentanevaluation.Pressurefromorganizationsandthepolitical climate created by the upcoming general elections drove the editorial teamtoresumepublicationofConosurandtodefinethenewspaper’spolitical stance. The paper’s initial regional focus thus became connected with nationalconcerns.Thenewspaperresumedpublicationin1989,thesame yeartheUnifiedConfederationofBolivianWorkersandPeasants(csutcb) was born at the Tarija Congress. At the congress, the delegates also discussedthepossibilityofcreatingapoliticalmechanismtosupportpeasant organizations. The PCÑ hasgonethroughagradualprocessofself-definitionthataffecteditsstatedobjectives.By1992therewasincreasingdiscussionabout theissueofapoliticalmechanism,andaproposalwasmadetorenderthe unionorganizationindependentoftraditionalpoliticalparties.TheConosuralsomadeexplicititsobjectiveanddefineditselfasatoolofthepeasant movement’scriticalintellectuals,notofthemovement’sleadership.Starting withthepromotionofQuechuareadingandwritinganditstranscription ofspeakers’testimonies,thenewspaperbegantodefineitselfaspartofa greaterpoliticalobjective.Thisobjective,asstatedearlier,wastobeatoolfor discussionamongcriticalthinkersinthedepartment’speasantmovement. The editorial team’s question was: Where is that sector of critical thinkers?Fromwhatitunderstood,thesectornevertookshape,notevenafter theMovementtowardSocialism(Mas)wasformedasthedesiredpolitical mechanism.8 TherolethenewspaperplayedwithintheQuechuapeasantmovement wasthereforenotasanimmediatemeansofcommunication,butasaspace forreflectionthatlinkedthe PCÑ totheparticularconjunctureofpeasant mobilization.Thesaleanddistributionofthepaperbecamemassiveattimes ofsocialmobilizationingeneralandofpeasantmobilizationinparticular.It
Quechua Knowledge and Writings 89
wasatthesetimesthattheConosurrespondedmostcloselytoitsobjectives, servingastherepositoryofmemoryandasaninstrumentofreflectionfor thepeasantpoliticalmovement. Initially,thepaperwasaimedattheleadershipsector.Startingin1989, aspartofitsinstitutionalevaluationandrenovation,itsoughtclosertiesto thegrass-rootsamongthedepartment’speasants,insearchoftheaforementionedcriticalsector.Thatsector,ingeneral,wascomposedofpeoplewith lowlevelsofeducationinreadingandwriting.This,however,didnotdeny thepresenceoftheleaders’voices,andruralteachers,merchants,truckers, and even semiurban neighborhood organizations requested copies ofthe newspaper. The PCÑ is distributed in what can be called a personal manner, with representativesvisitingthedepartment’simportantfairsandattendingthe variouseventsheldbythedepartment’speasantorganizations.Themoment ofthenewspaper’sdistributionisatthesametimethemomentofresearch throughspecificinterviewsandtherecordingofspeechesattheevents.The resultingarticlesarelargelytestimonials,recordings,andinterviews.Rather thanmoreusualformsofwriting,theyareconstructedtexts.9 Thenewspaperispublishedbimonthly(itmightevenbecalledamagazine), and it deals with such subjects as the Andean productive system; weatherprediction;communityhistory;education;eventsandresolutions sponsoredbypeasantandindigenousorganizationsatthelocal,regional, andnationallevels;communityevents;nationalandinternationalnews;and theever-presentpersonalstory.Currently,itsprintingvariesfromthirty-five hundredtofourthousandcopies.Abouttwenty-fivehundredtothreethousandcopiesofeacheditionarecommonlysold,althoughattimesofmobilizationtheissuesellsout.Animportantfactisthatapproximately40percentoftheissuesaresoldinChapare,azoneofpermanenttensionbecause ofgovernmentandU.S.effortstoforciblyeradicatecoca.Whilethenewspaperhasatokenprice(3bolivianosinthecityand1or1.50inruralareas), itisnevergivenaway.Significantly,somereaders,especiallychildren,barter communityproducts(grains,potatoes,andsoon)fortheConosur.
The Politics of Written Orality in the pcÑ Oneofthe PCÑ ’scharacteristicsistoworkwithQuechuawritingbasedon theoralityofthespeakers.Thisinvolvesthepoliticsofinscribingoraldiscourse(Marcone1997)thatisnotlimitedtothesimplereproductionofan 90 FernanDogarcésV.
actofspeechbutinsteadcreatesanewformofcommunication.Toinscribe oralitybecomesapoliticalactthatinvolvesatextualselectionbasedonthe editor’sorinscriber’sneedsandinterests.OneexampleofthisintheConosurinvolvesanexpandednotionofintertextuality. Literaryandtextuallinguisticstudiesfrequentlyusetheconceptofintertextualitytomeantheconstructionofatextfromamosaicofreferencesas wellastheabsorptionandtransformationofanothertext(Kristeva1982). Inthissense,intertextualitycreatesnewtextsthroughthere-elaborationof existingones.Forme,intertextualityhasadifferentmeaningwithregardto theConosur’spracticeofinscription.Iunderstandintertextualitynotonly asatextualinterrelationfashionedonpaper,butalsoastheconstructionof aseriesofplotsthataretextual(inthebroadestsenseoftheword),where diversevisual,textual(inthesenseofwritten),andoralcodesareinfigurativebattle.Intertextualityisaconflictualprocesswherebydiverseactors constructtextsastheymoveindifferentculturalimaginaries.Intertextuality alsoconsidersthediversecontextsoftextualproductionandconflictiveand diversereception. Intertextualitycanbeexemplifiedinthenewspaper’sinscribedwritten (and visual)practice.The PCÑ publishes newsandproduces information inQuechuaandinSpanish.Ontheonehand,theeditors’explicitprincipal criterionisthateventsoccurringinonelanguagebedescribedinthatsame language,beitQuechuaorSpanish.Ontheotherhand,anythingthathas todowiththeworldoutsidethecommunitiesandtheorganizations(forexample,nationalandinternationalnewsoragriculturaltechnicalsubjects)is writteninSpanish,whilemattersinvolvinginternalinterests(community history,weatherforecasting,evaluationoftheagriculturalcycle,stories,and soforth)arewritteninQuechua.Thisisthegeneraltendencythatemerges fromtheBoliviandiglotticframeworkinwhichthenewspaperexists.10 Onecouldalsodescribethe PCÑ ’stextual-linguisticeconomyfromthe perspectiveoftheconfrontationbetweenofficialandunofficialdiscourses. From this perspective, official and legal discourse and the expressions or relationsofthediscursiveandhegemonicstateenvironmentarepublished inSpanish.Forexample,eveniftheagendafordiscussionatanorganization’slocalmeetingiswritteninQuechua,itsresolutionsgenerallyappearin Spanish.Thisoccursbecausesaidresolutionspoliticallypositiontheorganizationsandcommunitiesinrelationtothemechanismsofstatedomination.Inthisway,theconstructionofnewsnotmediatedbyoralityalsoappearsinSpanish.Thatwhichformspartoftheorganizationalandcommunal Quechua Knowledge and Writings 91
(notnecessarilylocal)discursiveenvironmentistreatedinQuechua.Here, storiesandweatherforecastingareasmuchapartofthediscussionaslocal peasanteventsandnationalandinternationalnews(ConstitutiveAssemblies,theFreeTradeAgreementoftheAmericas(Ftaa),theNorthAtlantic FreeTradeAgreement(naFta),WorldBankpoliciesaboutagriculture,and soon). Nevertheless,thisspatial-textualdistributionisnotthatsimple,forthere arealsofrequentintertextualgames.Forexample,inagivennewspiecethe titlemaybeinSpanishandmostoftheinformationinQuechua(orvice versa).Withinagivenarticle,theremaybechangesorjumpsbackandforth betweenQuechuaandSpanish. Accordingtotherulesofinscription,therearethreecriteriatofollowin thefaceoftheSpanishwrittenword:totheextentpossible,recoverendangeredQuechuavocabulary;createneologismsforthosetermsthatarenot historicallyfoundinthelanguageandthatcurrentcommunicationdemands; and,whennecessary,incorporateaSpanishtermbyeitherkeepingtheoriginalspellinginSpanishorprovidingaphoneticrenditioninQuechua(Plaza 1995,58).Underthesecriteria,resortingtoSpanishisalastresort,reflecting anexplicitpolicyofrecoveringandstrengtheningQuechua.Thepresence ofSpanishtermsisconsideredalesserevil.Iwilllatertouchonthetopicof thePCÑ ’speriodicefforttorecovertheancientQuechuavocabulary,butfor nowIwillfocusonsomeexamplesofthenewspaper’snormfordealingwith Spanishterms. The PCÑ doesnothaveanexplicitpolicyforthecreationofneologisms inthesensethatitistheeditorialteamthatproposesnewQuechuaterms. Nevertheless,andasaresultofthecollectionoforalinformation,Icanoffer afewexamplesthatprovespeakers’creativity.Insomecases,thatcreativity involvesthedescriptionofcharacteristics,whileinothersitinvolvestheappropriationandconceptualreformulationoftheoriginalSpanishterm.We thushaveaphysicalplacewherearadiofunctions,wayra wasi(54:12)(lit. ‘windhouse’);11forairplane,lata p’isqu(63:4)(lit.‘ironbird’);forhandkerchief,qhuña pichana(61:11)(lit.‘snotcleaner’);formembersoftheMobile UnitforRuralPatrolling,arepressiveforcechargedwiththeaggressiveeradicationofthecocaleaf,p’alta uma(46:3)(lit.‘flathead’);torefertogringosor foreignersingeneral,jawa puka kunka(50:4)(lit.‘redneckfromabroad’). Beyond the effort of lexical recreation through neologisms, it is commonpracticeinthePCÑ touseSpanishterms,writtenaccordingtoSpanish grammar.Thisisobservedatdifferentlevels,suchasthefollowing: 92 FernanDogarcésV.
a.Inentirephrases: [...]lluksinankupaqrepresentantes
Forthemtobecomegenuine
genuinos de las provincias
representatives of the provinces,
compañeros (39:3).
comrades.
b.Inthelexical-morphologicalcombinationofSpanishandQuechua: MunaykuEscuela Fiscalkananta,
Wewantthattheschool be public,
mana privatizakunantacampesinos
thatitbenotprivatized;wethe
manachay escuelas privadasman
peasantswouldnotbeabletopay
pagayta atiykumanchurayku(44:19).
fortheseprivate schools.
c.Intheconsignationofdifferenttypesofacronymsandtheinstitution’s
fullname: CSUTCB uchhika q’ayma kachkan, imata nisun?Central Obrera Boliviana q’aymallataq, uraman yaykuyta munachkan(79:6).
TheCSUTCB isalittlebitunenthusiastic(lit.‘insipid’),whatwouldwe say?TheCentral Obrera Boliviana (Bolivian Workers’ Union)isalso unenthusiasticanditisbecoming down.12
Quechua in the pcÑ Fewstudiesdealwiththepresenceofindigenouslanguagesinthemedia (Albó1998),eventhoughthereisarelativelystrongpresenceofAymaraand QuechuaonurbanradiostationsinLaPazandCochabamba,respectively.13 Inthewrittenpress,thedailyPresenciapublishedonepageinQuechuaand anotherinAymaraeverydayforayear.Unfortunately,thisexperimentin themediaendedbecausethenewspaperclosed.AlbóandAnaya(2003)describetheexperienceofthenewspaperJaima.Itinitiallypublishedtextsin Aymara,andnowitalsodoessoinQuechuaandGuaraníasaweeklyunder thenewnameofKimsa Pacha Ara Mboapi,whichisdistributedtogether withthedailyLa Prensa.TheConosuristhusoneofveryfewmeansofdiffusionoutsideoftheacademythatgeneratesinformationinanindigenous languageinBolivia.14 ThefirstissuesofnewspaperslikeEl MizqueñoandEl TotoreñodistinguishedthemselvesbytheirlimiteduseofQuechua.Nevertheless,withthe New EraoftheConosur(startingin1989)therevaluationofQuechuabeQuechua Knowledge and Writings 93
cameapriority.Aneweraofdebateoverstandardizationbegins,whichcan besummarizedas“dowecompletelynormalizeQuechuaorrespectthetestimony?”(JuliaRomán,interview,05/10/01).Askedinamoreconciliatory way:howtoachieveequilibriumbetweenthenormandaninscribedwrittenvarietythatreaderscouldunderstandevenwithoutahighlevelofstandardization? In the PCÑ , the basic criterion was to use a comprehensible Quechuaeventhoughitdidnotentirelyconformtothecurrentexigencies ofstandardization.Thispracticebeganfromthinkingthroughthewriting fromtheactualwordsofthespeakers.However,therewasamoment(PCÑ numbers44to55)whenthenewspaperexplicitlyintervenedidiomaticallyto purgethenewspaper’sQuechuaspeechofexcessiveuseofSpanishvocabulary.15 The PCÑ ’sthematicsectionsmove,disappear,orreappearfromissueto issue.Thereis,however,aninalterablesectionthatisnotsubjecttothepoliticalarticulationofthemoment:thestory.Ineachissuethestoryappearing onthelastpageisunchangednotonlyinitsappearance,butalsointhelinguisticcodeitrepresents.Inthestory,wefindQuechuainitspurestform, asifitmanagedtocondenseformsimpervioustomoderncommunication requirements. I have carefully studied the PCÑ ’s greater or lesser observation of the normsofwrittenQuechua(Garcés2005b).16Overall,andinspiteoftheeditorialteam’seffortduringaspecificperiodoftime,Icouldgenerallynotfind orthographicconsistency.Thenewspaper’seditorshaveabasicknowledgeof grammaticalnormsandrules,sincetheyoccasionallyattendtrainingseminarsorcoursesonthenormalizationofQuechua,buttheydonotnecessarily applythemdirectly.Thisisbecausethepaper’suniquestrengthisdealing withQuechuawritingbasedonitsinformants’orality—thevoiceofthose whooffertheirtestimoniesandspeak.17
Traces of Orality in the pcÑ Conosurisaspaceoftextualproduction,startingfromtheinscriptionof oral discourse. In the hands of the newspaper’s editors, this is a political practicethatimpliesaprocessoftextualselectionandreconstruction.In myview,thispracticerespondstothreemainissuesintheextensiveliteratureabouttherelationsbetweenoralityandwriting.First,itcontradictsthe ideathatoralityislessvaluablethanwriting,largelybecauseitcontributes littleornothingtotheconfigurationofabstractthoughtandthedevelop94 FernanDogarcésV.
mentofintellect(Goody1968;Olson1994;andOng1982,1992).Second,it problematizesthenotionthatthereisruptureratherthancontinuityinthe relationshipoforalitytowriting,whatStreet(1984)andothershavecalled the“greatdivide.”Andthird,itprovidesanalternativetothequandarywe face when elaborating written forms of subordinated languages from the modelofthedominantlanguages,thusproducingafunctionalandpolitical copythatalsoreproducesthelinguisticcolonialismpresentinoursocieties (Garcés2005a,2005b).Indeed,throughtheseinterventionsConosurserves asanexampleofthepoliticalusesofsubalternsectors’writing,whichsome authorshavenotedcanimpartasenseofhistorytolocalstruggles(Portelli 1989)orcounter-hegemonizeornegotiatewiththewritteninscribedofficiality(Rappaport1990).18Withtheaimofcontributingtothedebatesabout linguisticpoliticsandthepracticeofwritteninterventionsinQuechuaand Aymara,Iofferexamplesofthemostfrequentandimportantcasesofthe oralpresencethatIfoundinConosur’swriting. OneexampleoftheoralpresenceinConosuristheappearanceofconversationalties,includingí,whichinBolivianQuechuaallowsthespeaker toexpressuncertaintyanddoubt,whilealsoaskingtheinterlocutortovoice theirownopiniononthetopicinquestion(HerreroandSánchezdeLozada 1979).InPCÑ 68:14,wefindthefollowing:Nuqaykup lugarniykumanta papa mujuí, Laqmu tarpuyku(“Itisapotatoseedfromourplace,you see;wesow laqmu...”).Thepresenceofíwouldbenormalinanoralinteraction,where oneofthespeakersdemandstheparticipationoftheotherspeaker. AnotherwayinwhichthePCÑ reproducesthecontextoforalconversationinthewrittentextisbytryingtoreproducetheperformativeaspects ofthelinguisticevent.Issue84:11,forexample,detailstheexperienceofa WorkshopfortheHandlingofPotatoandCornVarietiesorganizedbythe Women’sOrganizationofKuyupaya.Theexpertindistinctvarietiesofpotatoes and corn seeds carried out a demonstration for the attendees at the workshop.Thenewspapercoveredthispresentationinthesamewaythelinguisticeventunfolded: Ñuqa apamurkani saritasta, papitasta
Ihadbroughtsomecorn(maize)and
riqsichinaykupaq. Riqsichisaykichiq:
potatoesfordisplay.Iwillshowthem
Yuraq sara waltaku, ranqhanapaq,
toyou:theWaltakuwhitecorn,isfor
sara lluch’usqapipis walliqllataq;
selling;itisalsogoodforbeing
Guinda sara nisqa jank’apaq;kaytaq
peeled;thepurplecorn(isgoodfor)
Q’illu sara Lurivayu, lawapaq,
beingtoasted;andthisonetheyellow Quechua Knowledge and Writings 95
jank’apaqpis, jak’upis sumaq,
corn(called)Lurivayu,forsoup,for
bajiyupi puqun, patapipis kallantaq.
beingtoasted,itisalsogoodfor
KaytaqUchpa sarita jank’apaq,
flour;itgrowsinthelowlandsand
ranqhanapaq;kayYuraq sara rosada
alsointhehighlands.Andthisoneis
jina, tukuy imapaq; Phasanqalla sara,
theAshescorn,goodforbeingtoasted
muchhaspa jank’anchiq.Kaytaq
andforselling;thiswhite,pinkish
Yuraq sara, puka q’uruntañataq
one,isgoodforeverything;thisis
lluch’usqapaq, ranqhanapaq, tukuy
popcorncorn,itistoastedgettingthe
imapaq...(84:11).
grainsoutfromthecob.Andthisone
istheWhitecorn,ithasaredcorn-
cob,itisgoodforbeingpeeled,for
selling,foreverything...
Thetextisaccompaniedbyaphotoofaladypresentingdifferentcornvarieties.Inthisway,thenewspaperattemptstoinsertthereaderintotheinteractionalcontextandmomentofspeaking.Byreproducingtheenvironment inwhichtextisproduced,thistypeoftextualconstructiondistancesitself fromtherulesofobjectivitythatshouldmarkaformalwrittentextandthat givewritingitscharacterasatechnologyofabstractintellectualdevelopment.19 Anotherimportantpresenceoforalityinthenewspaperoccursinitsquotationsystem.InthefollowingexampleweseereproducedthemostcommonQuechuaquotationpractice: gobiernopunicha kachamun “runasta
Itismostpossiblethatitwasthe
maqamuychis”nispafruta sach’asta
governmentitselfthatsentthem,
aqnata machitiyamuychisnispa
“goahead,gotobeatthepeasants,”
(72:15).
saying,“goandcutthemdownwith
machetesasiftheywerefruitbearing
trees,”saying.
InadditiontotheclassicsystemofquotationuniquetoQuechua’sdiscursivestructure,initstestimoniesthe PCÑ oftenreliesonageneralizing anonymitythroughconstructionslike“itwassaid,”“aleadersaid,”and“the peasantdelegatessaid.”Onotheroccasionsthetestimonydirectlyattributes thewordstotheirspeaker: Compañera cocata puquchik
ThecocaproducercomradeEugenia
Eugenia Blancojaqay Central
BlancofromtheCopacabanaUnion
96 FernanDogarcésV.
Copacabanamanta kay jinata
has told us this:“That’sthewaythey
willariwayku: “Kay jinata cocaykuta
rippedoffourcocaplants,theyleftus
t’irapuwayku, mana cocayuqta
withoutanycoca,nowhowarewe
saqirpawayku, kunan imawantaq
goingtofeed(raise)ourchildren.If
wawasniykuta uywasqayku. Coca
thereisnococahowarewegoing
mana kaptin imawan kawsasqayku,
tolive,Ionlygetmoneyfrom(selling)
cocallamanta qullqi jap’ikuq kani,
coca,nothingelsegrowshere.”
mana ni ima puqunchu kaypi”(85:11).
Butinathirdexample,inPCÑ 41:B6–B8,afterapageandhalfofdiscussion onCh’iñi laqatu(Andeanweevil)inaclearlyjournalisticstyle,thearticle suddenly poses the following question: Imata ruwaq kanku ñawpa runas chay khuruta pisiyachinankupaq mana anchá jatarinanpaq? (“What did peopleusedtodotocontrolthebugs,sothattheydonotproliferate?”).An unidentifiedintervieweedirectlyresponds:Bueno, yachasqayman jina... (“Well,accordingtowhatIknow...”).Asofthismoment,sincethetextcontainsnoquotesoranyothersignthatdivulgesitsproductionorauthorship, wedonotknowwithcertaintywhatbelongstothenewspaper’seditorsand whatbelongstotheinterviewee. Adramaticinstanceoforality’spresenceinthenewspaperistheuseof oralformulas.Asmentionedearlier,oneoftheenduringfeaturesinthePCÑ istheconcludingstory.Withanexceptionhereandthere,allofthenewspaper’sstoriesconcludewiththeexplicitformulaoforalnarration.Forexample, PCÑ 46:19–20states,Kunan kuti chayllapi tukukun kay kwintituqa. Waq kutikama(“Onthisoccasionthislittletaleendsjustthere.Seeyou.”); oralsoKaypi tukukun kay willanita(“Thislittletaleendshere.”)(49:16).In addition,attemptstoreproduceoralonomatopoeicorinterjectiveformsappearasofteninthestoriesasinothertestimonialtexts:yuthuqa,churrrrrr nichkaqta pawarikapusqa(77–78:16)(“Thepartridgeflewaway‘churrrrr’ saying”);Chaymantaqa compadren nisqa: —Ayyykumpa, mana ajinatachu luz k’anchaytaqa wañuchina, kay botonllata ñit’ina, chaywan wañun(91:12) (“Thenhiscompadresaid:—heybuddy,thatisnotthewaytoturnoffthe light,youjusthavetopressthisbutton,thatturnsitoff ”);ortheimportant caseofthecoverof PCÑ 45:Kunan uqharikuna . . . a.a.a . . . !(“Nowletus riseeee...!).”20
Quechua Knowledge and Writings 97
Everyday Metaphors and Similes in the pcÑ “Ourordinaryconceptualsystem,intermsofwhatwethinkandact,isfundamentallyofametaphoricnature,”writeLakoffandJohnson(1980,39). Theyshowhowthemetaphorimpregnateslanguage,thought,andaction. Metaphorsareconstructedandcirculatedinaneverydaylinguisticmarket. Theyarenotthefruitofspecialists,astheWesternliteraryintellectualclass wouldprefer.Indeed,wefindinmetaphorsthekeytounderstandingrelationsbetweenlanguage,culture,andthecomprehensionofreality. Insuchacontext,thefactthatthe PCÑ ’smetaphoricworldisespecially evidentinsociopoliticaldiscoursedemandsattention.Inreferencetothe LawofPopularParticipation,forexample,whosenegativeimplicationsfor peasantmovementscouldnotbeclearlyunderstood,thenewspaperstated, Imaynatacha katarita ch’uskirinchik, kikinta kay kamachiyta ch’uskikurqa (“Justaswepeeloffasnake,likewisewepeeledoffthislaw”)(62:3).Onother occasions,weseeamuchmorevisualcomparisonthantraditionalpolitical partiesareabletoconjure: Eleccionespiqaimaynatachusch’uspi
Intheelectionsjustasthefliesfall
leche mankaman urmaykun ajinata
intothemilkpot,theyfallintothe
wakin partidos tradicionalespaq
rearofsometraditionalpolitical
qhipanman urmaykunku, paykunapaq
parties,thevotesforthemappear.
votos rikhurin (84:5).
And throughout different Quechua texts of the PCÑ , we see the popular comparisonofdifferentorganizationalsituationsofthepeasantmovement withthemovementofants(see,forexample,50:3and50:4): Sik’imirajina, ch’inllamanta tukuy
Asants,quietlyallthewomen,
warmikuna, wawa uqharisqa, uk runa
holdingourbabies,justasonesingle
jinalla, auto yankuna wisq’asunchis
person,willclosedowntheroads
(69:5).
(willblocktheroads).
PerhapsoneoftherichestsetsofmetaphoricusesfromQuechuainvolves elementsofhumancorporeity:uma(head),sunqu(heart),maki(hand),and llawar(blood).Umameans,amongotherthings,thecenterofdesiresand intentionsaswellasofwaysinwhichideasarereceived: Kunitangobiernop umanpiqa
Rightnowinthemindofthegovern-
campesinosta wich’uy munachkan jaqay
menttheyarethinkingofdrivingthe
98 FernanDogarcésV.
Parque Isiboro Sécuremanta, chayman
peasantsfromtheIsiboroSécurePark,
gringosta sat’inankupaq(64:5).
toplacethegringosthere.
Participación Popular, mana
TheGrassRootsparticipation(idea)
umaykuman yaykunchu(57:13).
doesnotenterinourminds.
Starting with these first examples, we can better understand the fact that umaisinpermanentrelationwithintentions,deceit,orconfusion: [. . .] uk yana uwija warmikunaq
Ablacksheephadappearedinsidethe
qutuchakuynin ukhupi rikhurisqa,
women’sorganization,swirlingtheir
umaninkuta muyuchiytamunaspa,
minds,therebyfeedingthewomento
jinamanta atuqman qarananpaq
thefox.
warmi masisninta(46:17).
Umaalsometaphoricallydesignatestheleadersandimportantpostsofpeasantorganizations: Kunanqa musuqumallichikkayku,
Nowadayswearethenewleaders,this
chaytaq jatun thaskiriy, Federacionqa
isagreatstep(forus),(for)theUnion
manamin pukllakuyku(51:3).
isnotagame.
Thisispreciselywhyumaalsoreferstothelackofleadershipofadetermined socialentity.Weseethis,forexample,incritiquesofthegovernmentforincompetentsocialleadership:Kay gobiernoqtamana tiyanchu uman, qhasimanakaq(88:3)(“Thisgovernmenthasnohead,itisthereinvain”). Theotherorganofthebodythatisakeystartingpointfortheformulation of Quechua metaphors is the heart. Sunqu is a very versatile word becauseofitsmanymetaphoricconnectionstomultiplerealities,statesof being,andsituations.Throughsunqu,itispossibletospeaktruthfullyand notjustwithwords: Dirigentesta qullqiwan umata muyu-
Theleadersareswirlingtheminds
chichkanku, chayrayku dirigentes
withmoney,thatiswhytheleaders
kanku cuchillo de ambos filos, qull-
aredoubleedgedknives,forthe
qirayku mayladomanpis kutirillanku,
moneytheywillgoinanydirection,
simillawan k’achituta parlanku,mana
theyspeakbeautifullywiththeir
sunqunkuwanchu(94:8).
mouths,notwiththeirhearts.
Butsunqualsoreferstothecenterofagivenreality,initsconceptionofthe “middle,”“importance,”and“clandestine”character.Forexample,withrespecttothenight,wefindthesetypesofsentences: Quechua Knowledge and Writings 99
Chawpitutaq sunqunpisublevacionta
Wehadmadearebellioninthe
ruwarqayku(suplem.77–78:1).
middleofthenight.
Intermsoftheearth: Chayniqta Reservas Fiscales, Parques
Thatiswhytheyaredeliveringthe
nispa jallp’akunata Instituciones-
statereservations,theparks,the
Empresaspaq makinman jaywarapu-
landstothehandsofthe(private)
sanku. Imapaq? Astawan Pachamama
enterprises.Whatfor?Forthemto
jallp’aq sunquntawaqcha runakunaq
squeezetheheartofMotherEarth
pulmonisninta ch’irwanankupaq
andthelungsofthepoorpeople.
(70–71:2).
Agroupofimportantassociationswiththetermsunqurelatetothefact thisisanorganthoughttobetheseatofsatisfaction,conformity,rest,and rejoicing.Incontrast,tosaythatyouarenotwithjunt’a sunquindicatesyou aredisquieted,dissatisfied,andanguished: Mana sunquy junt’achuInstrumento
Myheartisnothappyduetothefact
Politicota vendesqankumanta
thattheyhavesoldoutthePolitical
(73–74:3).
Instrument(ofthepeople).
Intermsofcalmness,tranquility,serenity,theeffectisachievedthroughthe formulasunqu tiyaykuy: Sindicatos p’utusqanmantapacha
Sincethebirthoftheunionsour
sunquyku tiyaykun(suplem.77–78:1).
heartsareinpeace.
Thepainoftheheartvivifiessituationsofsuffering,atthesametimeitsabsenceindicatesinsensitivity: Gobiernuqtamana sunqun nananchu
Theheartofthegovernmentdoesnot
waqcha runakunamanta, payta nanan
acheforthepoorpeople,itachesfor
chay qhapaq runamasinmanta(92:7).
therichpeople.
Thetopicofsocialandpoliticalcontrolisexpressedbyresortingtothe metaphoricconstructionof“beinginthehandsof....”Inthissense,the formulamaki+(nominalsuffixofaperson)+–pi ~–manisusedtoexpress theideaofhavingsomeonesubjectedtothepower,control,andauthorityof anotherperson: Tawa diputados indígenasbasespaq
Thefourindigenousdeputiesarein
makinpi(75:1).
thehandsofthegrassroots.
100 FernanDogarcésV.
Estados Unidospaqmakinpi
Theymakeusdanceinthehandsof
tusuchiwachkanchik(67:3).
theUSA.
Additionally,addingtheroottusuinthislastexampledemonstratesthatthis controlismanipulative,managingothersasiftheywerepuppetsthatcould bemadetodanceondemand. Anotherelementofhumancorporalityfrequentlyusedasametaphoric baseisllawar.“Idonothaveblood”indicatesinsensitivity,notfeelinginthe presenceoftheother: Gobiernoqa k’ullu, uk rumi churakun
Thegovernmentdoesnotlistento
mana llawarniyuqgobierno(67:4).
(thepeople),makingthemselveshard
asarock,itdoesnothaveblood.
Incontrast,todosomething“withblood”indicateseffort,suffering: Federacionqa manamin pukllakuyku,
TheUnionisnotagame,butwe
manataq uk institucion jina qhawa-
cannotconsideritjustasanyother
sunmanchu, ni Prefecturawan, ni
institution,neitherasthePrefecture,
Alcaldiawan, ni Policiatawan, chay-
northemunicipality,northepolice,
kunaqa qullquiwan ruwasqa kanku,
thosearemadewithmoney,butour
Federacionninchiktaqllawarwan
Unionismadeoutofblood.
ruwasqa kachkan(51:3).
Aspecialtypeofmetaphorfoundinthenewspaperreferstothepersonificationofnature.Quechuatestimonialsinthe PCÑ refertonatureorits elementsasentitiesthatgettired,walk,know,predict,getangry.21Hereare someexamples: Pitaq juchayuq kaypacha sayk’usqa
Whosefaultitisthatnatureistired?
kananpaq?(46:1). Sach’akunawaliq wata waqyamuch-
Thetreesarepredictingagoodyear
kawanchik(53:8).
forus[lit.‘callingfor’].
wakinyakusqa phiñas chullchuya-
Somewatersaremean,theymight
chiwasunman(35:7).
makeussick.
In the same way, peasant knowledge is anthropomorphized because it exists,itgrows,anditstayswiththeQuechuaspeaker: Yachayniykuqanuqaykuwan kashan.
Ourknowledgeiswithus.This
Wawita kasqaykumanta pacha kay
knowledgeofourshastogrow(multi-
yachayniykuqamiranan tiyan
ply)eversincewewerechildrenand Quechua Knowledge and Writings 101
wiñaypaq wiñayninpaq, kay yachayqa
foreverandever,thisknowledge
ni jaykaq tukukunanchu tiyan
cannoteverend.
(SeminariosobreEscuelaCampesina deRaqaypampa,in44:6). Kawsayniyku,yachayniykuqa,
Ourlife,ourknowledgelivewithus
unaymantapachapuni nuqaykuwan
fromtimeimmemorial.
kawsan (PedroOlivera,in79:13).
Overall,thenewspaper’smetaphoricworldoffersmanypossibilitiesfor idiomaticdevelopment.TheroleofbridgethatthePCÑ ’seditorialteamplays issignificantgiventhatitsmembersarealsoQuechuaspeakerswhomove betweentheworldoforalinformantsandthatofthewritingskillsrequired forthenewspaper’sjournalisticfunction.Ontheonehand,theyintuitively usetheQuechuametaphorsmobilizedbyvillagersandleadersand,onthe otherhand,theypermanentlystruggletorenderwritingthatiscomprehensibletoreadersbecauseitfollowscertainnorms.
Yachayniyku, or the Politics of Quechua Knowledge Inthepast,theknowledgeproducedbysubalterngroupswasusedtothink about them and formulate policies for them. Today we seek the revaluation of local knowledge and the active participation of the actors themselvesinpolicymaking.Threefactorshaveinfluencedthesechanges.First, the transformation of global capitalism requires the further expansion of transnational markets and access to new, often scarce, resources (Lander 2002a,2002b).Second,postmoderndiscourseshavehighlightedtheessentialistandbinarycharacterofmodernknowledge,makingitspositivisms andabsolutismsmoreflexible(Coronil2004).Third,andincontrast,many counterhegemonicgroupshavemadethedefenseofplaceatheoretical,political,andecologicalproject(Escobar1999,2000). Atthesametime,wecontinuetoexistwithinaframeworkthatMignolo callsthegeopoliticsofknowledge(2000,2001).Eurocentrism(initshistoricalform)andNorth-centrism(initscurrentform),bothcharacteristicof contemporaryglobalcoloniality,havecanonizedandvalidatedoneknowledgeaslegitimateandconsideredituniversal.Localknowledge,thatofthe colonialandglobalperipheries,isdismissedaslocal,aboriginal,indigenous, or“ethnic”knowledge.Itisusefulbutnotlegitimate—aknowledgethatcan bestudiedandlearnedbutthatisnotworthyofincorporationintothepara102 FernanDogarcésV.
digmaticknowledgeofthinkingandliving(Garcés2005a).Whatisforgotten inthiscontextisthatso-calleduniversalknowledgeisalsoalocalknowledge, but one that managed to impose itself onto the emerging capitalist world-system.Asaresult,thisknowledgedefineditselfasuniversalandled otherstorecognizeitassuch(Santos2003). IntheConosurnewspaper,weseeaspaceforthecommunicationofa widegamutoftopicsrelatedwiththeyachay—localknowledge,inthedeepestsense—inQuechuacommunities.Somearetechnicaloragriculturalin nature:typesofsoils;elementsofAndeantechnology,includingtheconstructionofditchesandfurrows;controlofplaguessuchasthesaq’uandthe ch’iñi laqatu;weatherforecasting;nativeseeds;watersourcemanagement; forestmanagement.Othersinvolvethecommunalmanagementofhealth, including traditional medicine, medicinal plants, and animal sanitation. Andstillothersdealwithsociopoliticalorsymbolicaspects:reciprocityinstitutionsliketheayni;communityhistory;themappingofAndeanterritory;ritualsassociatedwithproductiveandspatialcontrolliketheq’uwa, thech’alla,andthepijchu;localeducationalinstitutions;andnarrativetraditionslikeriddlesandstories.ThroughouttheConosur,fourmajorthemes emerge in relation to Quechua yachay: its value; its location in different physical spaces; its relationship to language; and its roots in community productionandculturalpractices.Iwillprovidesomeconcreteexamples ofeach. AbasicaffirmationintheConosuristhatQuechuapeasantknowledgeis betterthanWesternorurbanknowledge,thatitisprofessionalandshould notbelost.Thesebeliefscanbeseen,forexample,inreferencestoknowledge aboutweatherforecastingandtendingtheland: Chay campesinoq yachaynin aswan
Theknowledgeofthepeasantis
sumaq kasan. Nuqaykutaq taripayku
better.Werealizedthat,longbefore,
ñawpaqpi kanan chay campesinoqta
peasantshadknowledge.Theyknow
yachaynin. Pay yachan tiempota qha-
howtoobservetheweatherforthe
wayta uj wata tarpuypaq. Imaynachus
yearlyplanting.Theyrecognizethe
jamuq wata kananpaq señasta riq-
signsforthecomingyear.Orelse,
sillantaq. Mana chayqa, imaynatachus
(theyknow)howtheirancestors
jallp’ata waqaychaq kanku achachis-
knewhowtotakecareoftheland.
ninku(37:7). Profesionales kanchiq yachayninchiq-
Weareprofessionalsinourknowl-
manta (ClementeSalazar,in46:4).
edge. Quechua Knowledge and Writings 103
Nuqanchis unaymanta pachapuni
Weknewfromtimespasthowtotake
montesninchikta jallch’ayta yachaq
careofourforests.
kanchiq”(ZacaríasOrtiz76:4). Nuqaykuqa mana munaykuchu ya-
Wedonotdesirethatourknowledge
chayniyku wiqch’usqa kananta (54:14).
beputaside.
Nevertheless,eventhoughthisexpertknowledgehasrespondedtotheenvironmentbetterthanWesterncapitalistknowledge,itismetwithdisrespect andscorn: “Tecnología científicamanta” técnicos,
Thetechnicians,institutions,govern-
instituciones, gobiernos, Estado ima
ments,eventheStatecontinue
ch’ipakullankupuni, comunidadpata
swarmingaround“scientifictech-
yachayninta manaraqpuni wali-
nology,”(and)theydonotvaluethe
chinkuchu. Ch’irwarkullaytapuni
knowledgeofthecommunity.They
munawayku(63:14).
stillwanttosqueezeus.
Thereisacontemptforpeasantgoodsandlaborwhichrestsonatypeof racismthatvaluesproductionandknowledgefromacolonialpointofview: Campesinospata productonchis mana
Ourcropsarenotappreciated,our
valenchu, trabajonchis mana valenchu;
workisnotappreciated;nothappy
todavía chaywan mana contentaku-
withthat(work),thetownpeople,
wanchiqchu kay pueblopi kaqkuna kay
therich,aregettingdisgustedbyus,—
khapaq runas, paykuna noqanchista
whatdoesanignorantIndianknow—
millachikusawanchis, imatá yachan
saying,comrades.
kay indio bruturi nispa compañeros (ValerianoRomero,34:6).
Asaresult,peasantproductionandknowledgearedegradedasaresultof changesintroducedbymoderntechnologyanditsideology.Peasantyachay issubordinatedtourbanandscientificknowledgeattheserviceofdominantsectors: [. . .] ñawpataqa allinta puquykunata
Inthepastweknewhowtohandle
apayqachasarqayku, jallp’apis sumaq
thecropswell,thesoilwasalsovery
kallpayuq kachkarqa mana kunan
fertile,notasitistoday.Thechemicals
jinachu, chayman chayanapaqqa karqa
thatappearedledustothissituation,
rikhurimusqan chay kimiku, maychus
theso-calledmoderntechnology,the
jamun tecnología moderna nisqawan,
townpeopleresorttothisdiscourse.
104 FernanDogarcésV.
llaqtarunakuna kay parlayta apayqa-
Nowadaysthesoilhasbecomehard.
chanku. Kunanqa jallp’akunaqa chuqru-
Ourfellowcountrymenhaveseen
man tukun, compañeros rikunku kay
thatthesechemicalsareapoisonfor
kimiku jallp’apaq uk veneno kasqanta.
thesoil.
Chaywanpis, llaqtarunaqa Universidad
Inspiteofthat,theoneswhohave
yachay wasipi yachaqkunaqa mana
studiedattheuniversitiesdonot
campesinota valechinkuchu, ninku:
valuethepeasant’sknowledge.They
–imata campo runa yachanri nuqayku
said–whatdoesthepeasantknow?We
Universidadpi yachayku, yachaykutaq
studiedattheuniversity,andweknow
kimiku venenochus manachus–,
whetherthechemical(fertilizer)is
ajinata paykunapis parlanku, jinapis
poisonousornot.Thatisthewaythey
compañeros, yachanchik imaptinchus
speak,comrades.Thuscomrades,we
parlanku chayta, mana kimikusta
knowwhytheyspeaklikethat.Ifwe
rantisunman chayqa, mana qulqi
didnotbuythosechemicals,there
yaykunmanchu qhapaqkunapaq,
wouldbenoincomefortherich.
chayta yachaspa paykunaqa, chay
Becausetheyknowthat,thetechni-
tecnicosqa, comunidadespi yachachispa
ciansareteachinginthecommunities
kanku qhapaq runaq kawsayninman
thewaysoftherich,theydefendthe
jina, paykunaqa qhapaq runaq
wayoflifeoftherich.
kawsayninta jark’akunku(Florencio Alarcón,in60:4).
ThesecondmajorthemeintheConosuristhatQuechuayachayisexpressedandsocializedinmanyplaces,buthereIwilllimitmyselftoshowing thetensionoftwolocations:theschoolandthecommunity.Atitsmostfundamentallevel,educationtakesplacewithinthecommunityandtheorganization: Sapa comuna ukhupi nuqayku pura
Insideeverycommunity,weteach
yachachinakuyku(FructuosoVallejos,
eachother.
in64:10). Jatuchik tantakuykunaqa
Thelargemeetings[congressesand
chaqrarunakunapaqqa uk yachay
unionleadersmeetings]arelike
wasipis kanman jina(67:6).
schoolsforusthepeasants.
Likewise,thereisaclearawarenessthatthefamilyprovidesabettereducationthanschoolsandthatschoolsmustrespondtothecommunity’swayof lifeandproductivesystem:
Quechua Knowledge and Writings 105
Yachayqa mana yachay wasi
Knowledgeisnotfoundonlyinthe
ukhullapichu (64:10).
schools.
Aswan allin wasipi mama tataq
Theteachingsofourparentsathome
yachachisqan, mana ni qhillqayta,
werebetter,(even)withoutknowing
nitaq ñawiyta yachan(64:11).
howtoreadorwrite.
Educación nuqanchikpaq kawsaynin-
Leteducationforusbeaccordingto
chikman jina, nuqanchikpaq
ourculture,accordingtoourwork.
llank’ayninchikman jina kachun(57:14).
Aspecifichistoricalcasethatillustratesthetensionbetweenfamilyand communityononesideandtheschoolontheotheroccurredin1986inRaqaypampa,intheMizquehighlands.Thecommunitycriticizedtheteachers forbeingarrogantwithparentsandcommunityleaders;forimpedingthe children’s learning by teaching in Spanish instead of Quechua; and, perhaps most important, for not respecting the community’s work calendar. Inresponse,theparentstooktheirchildrenoutoftheschool.Thefollowing yearthecommunitynamed“peasantteachers”tomanagetheschoolinthe neighboringcommunityofRumiMuqu.Inanexperimentunderthename AyniSchool(GarcésandGuzmán2006),thecommunitypaidtheseteacherswithproductsandlaborintheirfields,and,inturn,theteacherstaught inQuechuaandworkedfromJune24toSeptember24. The conflict, which persisted until 1992, revolved around two centralpoints:theschoolcalendarandwhohadjurisdictionalauthority.On thefirstpoint,communitymembersarguedthatiftheirchildrenwerein schoolwhentheywereneededforagriculturalwork,theymissedtheopportunitytobeeducatedbytheirparents(Arratia2001;GarcésandGuzmán2006).Onthesecondpoint,thecommunityfeltthattheschool,being practicallytheonlystaterepresentativeinthecommunity,hadtosubmit tocommunalauthority(GarcésandGuzmán2006;Regalsky2003).The Conosurarticlesfromthoseyears,therefore,emphasizedthattheschools respondedtotheinterestsoftherich,nottothedesiresandneedsofthe peasant: yachanchik jina kunankamaqa educa-
Asweknow,uptothisdate(formal)
ción qhapaqkuna yachakunankupaq
educationhasbeenfortherich;ithas
jina, mana nuqanchikpaq munaynin-
notbeen(designed)accordingtoour
chikman jinachu (FlorencioAlarcón,
needs.
in56:6). 106 FernanDogarcésV.
Buildingfromthisexperience,peopleemphasizethatEducacionqa kawsayninchikmanta kawsayninchikpaq kanan tiyan(“Educationhastobe[designed,implemented]fromourlifeandforourlife”)(GarcésandGuzmán 2003).Onthebasisofthisprinciple,theEducaciónInterculturalBilingüe project(InterculturalBilingualEducation,oreib )iscriticizedasbeingimposed from outside and as being unsuitable to peasant life because, even though the project is bilingual, it does not respect the community’s time andrhythms.Inthatcontext,theexperienceofRumiMuquservesasavalid counterproposal. Nuqa uchhikitanta niyta munani chay
Iwouldliketosayalittleaboutthat
iskay qallupi yachanakuymanta (Edu-
educationintwotongues(Intercul-
cación Intercultural Bilingüe), nuqan-
turalBilingualEducation),weare
chik chaqra llank’aypi tarikunchik
peasantsbutthoseteachings(of
manataq kay yachakuykunamanta
formaleducation)arenotforus,are
mana nuqanchikpaq mana kawsaynin-
notdesignedaccordingtoourwayof
chikman jinachu. Chaytataq nuqa kay-
life.Iwouldliketorequesttoour
patamanta autoridadesninchikmanta
authoritiesuphere,thattheschool
mañakuni, nuqanchikpaq kawsaynin-
calendarbedesignedaccordingtoour
chikman jina, calendario escolar ruwa
life.Forafewyears,wehaveplaceda
kunanta. Ñawpaq watamanta pachaña
peasantteacherinayni(reciprocity
nuqanchik aynipi uk campesino yacha-
system),andheisteachingaccording
chik churakuspa llank’aynin chikman
toourwork.Iwishtheyworkinjust
jina risan, kikillantapuni llank’ananta
thatmanner,asintheRumiMuqu
yachay wasin Rumi Muqupi munani,
school;weareusedtothat.
chaywan nuqanchik yachasqa kachkanchik(NicolasPardoin52:4).
Thecentralcriterionisthattheindigenousorganizationmustcontrolany educationalproposal.Schoolcalendars,teachers,andcurriculummustall respectcommunityvalues.Onthequestionofcalendars,iftheschoolfunctionsduringtheseasonalpeakofagriculturallabor,itbreaksthecommunity’seducationaltime: Nuqaykupaq chay tiempo escuela kanan
Forus,forallthepeasantstheschool
mana waliq kasqanta k’ala entero
timeisnotgood.Ihadthoughtthat
agricultorespaq. Nuqa qhawarqani
thetimewerelaxinourfarming,
mayk’aqchus ima tiempochus nuqayku
that’swhentheschoolsforthechil-
llank’ayniykumanta llawqiyaykuman
drenshouldstart.Thefactisthatour Quechua Knowledge and Writings 107
chaymanta qallarinman escuelas
lifeisofonekind,andthelifeofthe
wawaspaq . . . Nuqaykuqta kawsayniy-
citiesisofanothertype.
kuqawaqjinataq, llaqtaq kawsaynin waqjinataq (LuisAlbarracín,in38:13).
Onthequestionofteachersandcurriculum,fortheschooltrulytobelongto thecommunity,itmusthaveitsownpeasantteachersothatQuechuachildrencanstudyaccordingtotheirownknowledgeandlanguageandatthe sametimebenefitfromtheknowledgeoftheirelders: Waturirqayku, imaraykutaq mana
Weaskedwhyaretherenotteachers
kanchu maestros campesinos wawa-
toteachthepeasants’children?It
kunata yachachinapaq? Waliq kanman
wouldbegoodthatthechildrenat
wawakuna escuelapi yachakunanku
schoollearnaboutwhatwehaveon
imataq jallp’a patapi kapuwasqan-
thesoil,aboutourknowledge,our
chikmanta, yachayninchikmanta,
organizationasunions,andallof
organización sindicalmanta, kay
thisinourQuechuatongue.We
tukuytaqa qhichwa qallunchikpi.
couldalsomakeanexchangeofthe
Atillasunmantaq intercambio de
so-calledknowledges,resortingtothe
conocimientos nisqata ruwayta, kuraq
knowledgeofourelders,sowecould
tatakunaq yachayninta uqharispa,
walkaccordingtothat(knowledge).
chayman jina purinapaq (Un comunariodeTacachi,in83:7).
ThethirdmajorthemeintheConosuronthesubjectofQuechuapeasant yachayisitscloselinkagetothelanguageinwhichitisexpressed(Garcés 2005a).Fromtheperspectiveofthegeopoliticsofknowledge,indigenous languageshavebeensubalter(n)ized,orconstructedasinferior,intheprocessofcolonialdifferentiation.Theknowledgeexpressedinindigenouslanguageshasbeendismissedasaknowledgethat,inthebestofcases,expresses theemotiveenvironmentofthesecommunitiesofspeakers(Ong1982).eib programs,ontheotherhand,haveattemptedtonormalizeandstandardize indigenouslanguages,togivethemaninscribedwrittenform,andtorevalorizeindigenousknowledge.Amongthepsycholinguisticjustificationsfor eib programshas beenthepromise ofbettercognitive development and scholarlyresultsthroughlearninginthemothertongue(LópezandKüper 2000). WhatwefindinConosur,however,isthattheQuechualanguagecannot bestudiedinisolationfromthepowerrelationsinwhichitisembedded.The 108 FernanDogarcésV.
discriminationexperiencedbytheQuechuapeasantisseenassimilartothe discriminationQuechuasuffersasalanguage: Qhishwa parlayninchista k’alata
TheyareallowingourQuechua
kunankamaqa saruchisanku kastillanu
languagetobecompletelystepped
rimaywan(33:12).
uponbytheSpanishlanguage.
Becauseofthis,Quechuapositionsitselfconflictivelyandinoppositionto Spanish;tocompetewithSpanishmeanstodefend,value,anddevelopone’s ownculture: Qhishwata pataman tanqananchik
WehavetopushQuechuaupward
tiyan maqanachinapaq waq qalluwan.
sothatitcancompetewithanother
Chantapis kulturanchikta astawan
tongue.Alsotoraiseourculture
pataman uqharinapaq(PabloVargas,
higher.
in59:10).
ThestudyofQuechuaisneveranendinitself.Inordertoserveasatoolof liberation,itmustoperateintandemwithotherstrategies,suchasitswritteninscriptionaccordingtoitsoraluseandnotaccordingtowhatagroup ofplannerssays: Tukuy campesinos qhishwa parlay-
Allthepeasantswhoarespeakingin
ninchispi rimaspa qhilqasunchis.
ourlanguagewillalsowrite.From
Kunan manta ñawpaqmanjinamanta
nowon,inthiswayweshallraiseour
par layninchista uqharisunchis, kay KULLASUYU llaqtanchispi imaray- kuchus kay phisqapachaq wataña qhishwa parlaq runaqa engañasqa rikukuyku tukuy imapi. Chaymanta qhishwa rimayninchispi qhilqasunchis chayqa librostapis ruwasunchis parlay- ninchisman jina (SantosAlbarracín, in39:16).
language.BecauseintheQullaSuyu, wetheQuechua-speakingpeoplehave foundourselvesdeceivedinevery thingforfivehundredyears.That’s why,ifwewriteinourQuechua language,wewillmakethebooks accordingtoourownspeech.
Inthissense,Quechuacanbeaninstrumentofliberationoroppression, ashappenedinthecolonialperiod.Itwouldseemthatthekeymatterisnot onlytodevelop,inscribeinwriting,orintellectualizethelanguage,butto determinewhatpracticalpurposesandsociopoliticalpracticesthelanguage canserve.Inthissense,thelanguage—likecommunalinstitutionsthemselves—canbeputintheserviceofsystemsofstatecontrol: Quechua Knowledge and Writings 109
Gobierno qallunchikpi apay munach-
Thegovernmentistryingtoleadusto
kawanchik paykunaq yuyayninllanku-
theirthinkinginourowntongue.
manta(FélixSantos,in57:14).
ThisbringsmetothefourthandfinalthemeintheConosurdealingwith Quechuayachay,whichisthatQuechuapeasantknowledgehastwoclosely relatedrootsthatfeedit:thepeasantsystemofproductionandreproductionandtheindigenouspeasantcommunity.Inrelationtothefirstroot,the ConosurcollectsQuechuaknowledgeonsuchtopicsashowgranariesare built,whichvarietiesofcornseedareknown,andwhatmedicinalplants arepresentinaparticularareaandhowshouldtheybeused.Italsousesresearch cenDa hasconductedinRaqaypampaovermanyyearstodemonstratethebenefitsoftheQuechuaproductivesystem. Perhapsoneofthemostimportanttopicsisweatherprediction,andthe Conosurhasdedicatedabundantspacetoit.Asafront-pageheadlineinPCÑ 32proclaimed,“Predictingtheweatherispeasantwisdom.”Lateroninthe sameissue(8–9),severalcommunitymembers’testimoniesonthetopicare presentedinasectionentitled,“Theprincipalpeasantartisweatherforecasting.”ThesectionthenconcludesinSpanish:“Theprincipalartofpeasantscontinuestobepredictingtheexactbehavioroftherainsand,accordingly,toorganizetheplantingofdifferentcropsinthebestplacesandonthe bestsoilstoensuretherains’maximumadvantage”(32:20).Thiscontinuous concernisperhapsbestrepresentedintheannualWeatherPredictionContest.In64:8,wefindanannualannouncement: Kay wata 1995–1996 qallarikullanña-
Thisyear1995–1996hasalready
taq, imaynataq kay wata kanqa,
begun,howisthisyeargoingtobe?
watuna kachkan, amañana siñakuna
Wehavetoask,weneedtopredict
qhawayta: sach’akuna, wayra, chiri,
howitwillbe,accustomedasweare
uywakuna, phuyukuna, waqkuna ima
toreadingthesigns:thetrees,the
chayllamanta astawan waliq kanan
wind,thedomesticanimals,the
tarpuyninchik. Kay watapaq para
cloudsandotherthings;formaking
imaynataq kanqa, mayqin makistataq
ourfarmfieldsbetter.Howwillthe
para yanapanqa, manachayqa luku
rainforthisyearbe,whowilltherain
parachu kanqa, imaynataq?
help,orwilltherainbeadownpour,
howwillitbe?
Thenewspaperinterviewsparticipatingeldersandpublishesthedifferent versionsoftheirforecastsfortheupcomingagriculturalyear.Attheendof 110 FernanDogarcésV.
eachcycle,thenewspaperevaluatesthecycleinrelationtothereaders’testimoniesandselectstheelderwiththeclosestprediction.Bymeansofthis contestthenewspaperseekstopreserveandstimulatethecirculationofthe Quechuayachayaboutweatherpredictionandhopesthatwritingwillsafeguardthisyachaygiventhatglobalclimatechangeisendangeringweather prediction: Ñawpa kuraqkuna astawan yachaq
Theeldersaretheoneswhoknow
kanku kay tiempo qhawaymantaqa.
moreabouttheseweatherpredictions.
Kay tiempo runasqa mana anchata
Thepeopleoftodaydonotknow
yachankuñachu. Yachaymanchus
verymuch.IfIknewhowtoread
ñawiyta, qhilqayta imaqa, tukuy
andwrite,Iwouldwritedownallmy
qhawasqayta sapa wata qhilqiyman
predictionsfortheyearonpaperso
papelpi mana qunqanapaq. Ikillapis
thattheyarenotforgotten.Probably,
tukuy yachankuman tiempoman
allwouldalreadyknowaboutthe
jinañachu. Chaytaq qhasiman rin
weatherinthatway(writtendown
llank’anku(FermínVallejos,in39:8).
onpaper).Buttheyworkinvain
(iftheydonotobservethesigns).
Thenewspaperworksaswelltopreserveknowledgesthatservetocontrol plagueslikethech’iñi laqatu(weevilsoftheAndes)anddegenerativediseaseslikethesaq’u.Asthenewspaperaffirms,Yachayninchiqwan khurukunamanta jark’akuna(104:14)(“Withourknowledgeletusdefendourselves fromtheplagues”).Thetopicoftraditionalmedicineiscoveredinarticles ontheusesoftraditionalmedicinalplantssuchasrosemaryandhorsetail (PCÑ 38:7). Thesecondrootthatsustainspeasantknowledgeisthesocialorganizationofthecommunity.Becausemoderntechniquesoftenseektodestroy communalorganizationsbyimposingadifferentrationalityofproduction onthem,oneoftheprincipaltopicsoftheQuechuayachaydealswiththe subjectandpracticesofdevelopment. PCÑ 32:8reportsthatstateinstitutionsaswellasagrochemicalcompaniesandtheirsalesrepresentativespressurepeasantsto“modernize.”Accordingtothem,peasantagriculturewould benefit through theintroduction ofimproved seeds, theincreaseduse of chemicalfertilizers,pesticides,herbicides,andinsecticides,andtheintroductionofmechanization.Mechanizationisalsoachievedthroughregularizingthesize(medianización)oftheagriculturalplots.Afterward,thenewspapercitescenDa experimentsthatshowaratherdifferentreality,namely, that“theintroductionofimprovedseedsortheincreaseinfertilizersand Quechua Knowledge and Writings 111
pesticidesareofsecondaryimportanceandsometimesdetrimentaltocrop yields;whiletraditionalpeasantknowledgeaboutweatherprediction(inrelationtosoilsandplants)continuestobewhatdefinesthesuccessorfailure ofacrop.”22 cenDa ,inagreementwithalocalorganization,carriedoutaseriesof testsonfifteenplotsoflandinRaqaypampacommunityduringthe1987–88 agriculturalcycle.Theresults,presentedin PCÑ 32,containedthreemain points.First,thelocalvarietiesofpotatoaremoreproductivethanthenewly introduced“improved”variety,sincetheyhavetheadvantageofsuitability tothetypeofrainandsoilsofthearea.Second,fertilizationdoesnotensuregreaterproductionbecauseahailstormorlackofraincanreverseits positiveeffects.Andthird,thetechnologicalelementofgreatestimportance is weather management, which implies weather forecasting in relation to suitablevarietiesforthetypesofterrain,thedatesofplantingchosenaccording to the types of soil and varieties, and the management of family members’labor.“Inotherwords,”thearticleconcludes,“themostimportant techniquesintheregion’sagriculturearebasedentirelyonpeasants’traditionalknowledgeand,bycomparison,‘moderntechnology’canmakefew solidandeffectivecontributions.”23 AseriesofarticlesintheConosurcritiquespatents,theappropriationof peasant-indigenousknowledgebytransnationalagro-foodandpharmaceuticalcompanies,andinstitutionsthatintroduceintothecommunitiestechnologicalpackagesinheritedfromthegreenrevolution.Examplesofthefirst casearefoundin PCÑ nos.76and77–78,whichdiscussthepatentofquinoa,theprotestbytheNationalAssociationofQuinoaProducers,andthe patent’ssubsequentannulment. PCÑ 86:8containsanarticledenouncing Monsanto’sattemptstointroducetransgeneticseedsintothecountry. Thelinkbetweentheyachayandcommunalorganizationisasubjectof greatimportancetothenewspaper.Itcouldbesaidthatknowledgeisvalued becauseofthewaysinwhichitcontributestostrengtheningcommunalorganization.Whileindividualknowledgemaybemoreprestigiousinanationalimaginedcommunity,itdoesnotworkatthecommunitylevel:24 ñawpata papasusninchik mana qill-
Inthepastourparentsdidnotknow
qayta, ñawiyta yacharqankuchu, jinapis
howtoreadorwrite,butinspiteof
organización sindical sumaq purichik
thistheymadetheUnionfunction
kanku. Nuqanchik ñawpata jina uk
well.Wehavetowalkasinthepast,
runa jinalla purinanchik tiyan, sut’inta
asonesingleman,speakingthetruth;
112 FernanDogarcésV.
parlana, nuqanchikqa uk chhika
knowingalittlebit,wearealready
yachaytawankama ñapis politikuq
grabbingthetailsofthepoliticians,
chupanta jap’itawan purichkanchik,
stickingtooneoranother;inthatway
ukman ukman k’askachkanchik,
wewillneverovercomethislifeof
chaywanqa mana ni jayk’aq kay llakiy
misery.
kawsay sarusunchu(56:6).
Modernknowledge,therefore,isunabletoofferorganizationalstrength, andeducationcannotconsistonlyinknowinghowtoreadandwrite;rather, itmustinvolveknowinglocalAndeantechnologyandcommunalorganizationalforms: Educacionqa mana ñawiriy-
Educationisnotonlyreadingand
qillqariyllachu, kawsayniykumanta
writing.WecreatedtheCommunal
‘tecnología andina’ yachayta, sindi-
CouncilofEducationbecausewe
calismota yachay wasiman churayta
wantedtointroduceAndeantech-
munaspa Consejo Comunal de Educa-
nologyandunionizationtothe
ciontaqa jatarichirqayku(Florencio
school.
Alarcón,in64:10).
Quechuayachayandthesocialorganizationthatsustainsitareintimatelyconnected:ifuniqueorganizationalformsarelost,socialknowledgeisalsolost. Consequently,itdoesnotmakesensetodefendpeasantknowledgeinandof itself,butincloseconnectionwiththepreservationofterritorialautonomy: Ñawpataqa yakuyuq jallp’akunapiqa
Before,therewaswaterforirrigation
karqapuni qarpanapaqqa, comunidad
andthecommunitywiththeunion
sindicatowan khuska apaykachaq
organizedturnsforeveryone.They
kanku mit’asta, paykuna rak’iq kanku
woulddistributethewater.Inrecent
yakutaqa. Kay qhipamanri Instituciones
times,however,developmentagencies
de desarrollo q’alata tukuyniqman
putusalltogetherandcarriedout
junt’aykamuwanchik, paykunataq
publicworksinthecommunities:
comunidadespiqa ruwanku obrasta:
irrigationcanalsthatarepavedand
canales de riego cementowan, jatuchik
blockedoff.Withpublicworkslike
quchas tukuy imata. Kay jina
these,theknowledgeofthecommu-
obraswanqa comunidadpaq yachay-
nitydisappears,neitheristhisinthe
ninqa chinkan, sindicatopis manaña
handsoftheunions;theseinstitutions
makinpichu jap’in, chay institucionesqa
orderedustocreatenewassociations
kamachinku jatarinanta Asociaciones
orcommitteesforirrigation.
manachay Comités de Riego”(68:11). Quechua Knowledge and Writings 113
Thelinkoftheyachaywithcommunalorganizationandterritorialautonomyis,however,locatedinabroadercontextthatseeksindependence fromtheinstitutionsandforeignnationsattemptingtochangepeasantlife inordertoincorporateitintocapitalism: Campesino yachan, tukuy imamanta
Thepeasantknows.Hehasexperience
experiencia tiyan: tiempota qhawan,
witheverything:hewatches(predicts)
jallp’ata llank’ayta, mujuta churayta,
theweather,worksthesoil,sowsthe
trojaspi mikhunapaq waqaychayta,
seeds,knowswhattostoreforeating
vendenanpaq ima. Tukuy kayta organi-
andwhattosell.Allofthisisdone
zacionninwan mana dependespa ni
independently,withtheorganization,
pimanta. Wakin Institucionesqa mana
withoutdependingonanyone.Some
qhawankuchu, mana yuyankuchu.
institutionsdonotsee,donotthink.
Mana kay culturasta respetaspalla,
Withoutrespectingtheculturethey
cambio socialta mask’anku nispa ninku. striveforsocialchange.Theywantus Jawa nacionesmanta dependenanta
todependonothercountries,to
munanku chaywan culturanchista
changeourculture.
cambiananta (DirigentesdeCampero, in37:11).
ThecommunalorganizationoftheQuechuapeasantry,then,isnotsimply anadministrativeapparatus,butalsothemainlineofdefenseandcontrol ofterritoryinordertopreservepoliticalautonomyinthefaceofattempts atdestructuringbythestateandtransnationalcapital.Asthefundamental elementinthehistoricalcontinuityofQuechuacommunities,italsooverseesotherentitiespresentinthecommunity,suchastheschool,andcontrolsaccesstoresources.Itisforthisreasonthattheresolutionsofapeasant congressinCamperoprovince(PCÑ 42:5)prohibitmerchantsfromcutting treesintheforestandsellingthewood;requestthatthecsutcb guardthe communities’forestsby,amongothermeasures,ensuringthatthelumber companiesdonotprofitfromthesaleofcommunalforests;andprohibit merchantsfromstealingandsellingtreesthatbelongtothecommunities.
Conclusions: Rethinking Power, Knowledge, and Linguistic Practice Historically, Quechua’s process of inscription and system of writing have beenunabletogetbeyondtheiruseforspecificends,suchasreligiousconversionandtraining,education,andsoon.Ingeneral,linguisticpolicyin relation to minority or oppressed languages basically exists solely to pro114 FernanDogarcésV.
motethewritteninscriptionoftheselanguages.IntheBoliviancase,over thepastfewyearsthemainefforthasbeentodevelopaprocessoftheinscriptionofQuechuathroughtwofundamentalmechanisms:thestandardizationofQuechuawritingthroughaunifiedorthographicnormative,the creationofneologismsandtheestablishmentofacertainmorpho-syntactic normative;andthediffusionofthisgeneralizedsystemthroughtheEducationalReform.25 BolivianlinguisticpolicytowardQuechua,evenifsupposedlyapolicy ofrecovery,isbeingformulatedonthebasisoffourarguableassumptions: (1)thatthemaintenanceandrevitalizationofQuechuamustbebuiltfromits inscriptioninwritingandthroughteachingitintheschools;(2)thatapan- AndeanunificationofQuechuawillpromotetheempowermentandthedestigmatization ofQuechua speakers; (3) that thewritten form’s standardizationiskeytothelanguage’sdevelopmentandfortification;and(4)that historicalcriteriaarethebestguidefordevelopingastandardformwhen facedwithexistingdialecticalvariation(Luykx2001).AsLuykxnotes,these assumptionsemphasizealinguisticpolicythat(a)directseffortstosituations in which Quechua is at a disadvantage with Spanish; (b) prioritizes thepreoccupationsoflanguageandeducationalplannersabovethoseofthe Quechua-speakingmajority;and(c)linksdialecticalvariationtotheprestigeandhierarchyofoneclass,whichstigmatizesnonstandardizedvarieties. ThispolicystartsfromasetofcriteriadevelopedwithreferencetoSpanish and the interests of policymakers, including criteria of inscription in writing,scholasticization,pan-Andeanstandardization,andhistoricism.In anattempttoovercomediglossia,policymakersareelaboratingaprestige- based, academicist model that prioritizes intellectualization and writing. Theydonotbeginfromthelinguisticrealityofthemajorityofspeakersor fromtheirconcretecommunicationalinterestsandnecessities.Intheend, theydonotpayattentiontothelanguage’sownsociocommunicativecapital, butinsteadseektoimposeitsstandardizationthroughacomparisonwith thepracticesofthelanguageandthegroupinpower. What I have attempted to show here is that the Conosur Ñawpagman newspaperoffersawaytoresearchwritingasitemergesfromconcretelinguisticpractices.Thisisespeciallyinterestingbecauseitdealswithanextra- scholasticexperiencethatseekstoinscribespeakers’oraldiscourse.Ithink thatinthisprocessthereispotentialfordevelopingawritteninscriptionthat hasnotreceivedmuchattentionintermsoflinguisticplanning,onethat seekstoovercomenormativeandelitistvisions.TheverycreationofneoloQuechua Knowledge and Writings 115
gisms would benefit from the incorporation of speakers’ everyday metaphors,ratherthanresortingtodesktopcreationsortotheresurrectionof obsoletehistoricalformswhich,evenifpassionatelysoughtafterbythelinguist,soundstrangetocontemporaryspeakers. AsforthetopicoftheQuechuayachay,Ithinkitisimportanttoreflect— evenifhypothetically—ontherelationsbetweenknowledgeandterritoriality.Asthetopicoflocal,indigenous,ornativeknowledgehasbecomecentraltotheacademicagendaofmanyintellectuals,whetherindigenousor not,weriskbuildingadecontextualized,abstractdiscourseaboutindigenousknowledgethatcanbemanagedbyglobalcapitalism.Ifthishappens, indigenousknowledgeswouldbedisqualifiedinthenameofscienceand progressevenasglobalcapitalismsought,throughlegalmechanisms,toappropriateandpillagethoseverysameknowledges. Withinthecurrentsystemofglobalization,thedevelopmentofbiotechnology and the appropriation of the collective knowledge of indigenous- peasant communities could constitute an important resource for capitalismwhenfacedwithcrisis.Weareonthevergeofaqualitativeleapinhow knowledgecanbelinkedtorelationsofneocolonialdominationinthecontemporaryworld,inthesensethatitcan“immediatelyanddirectlycreate newformsofsubordinationandnewrelationsofdominationandexploitation”(Lander2002b,73). Forthosewhohavecreatedtheglobalorder,Westernknowledgeisobjective and universal and therefore worthy of protection through private property rights. Other knowledges are nonknowledge and can therefore beappropriatedthroughpillageandpiracy.Scientificandentrepreneurial knowledgeistheknowledge,meaningithastobeprotectedbyexactingpaymentforitsuse.Herewehave“oneofthemostimportantmethodsforthe concentrationofpowerandtheincreaseintheinequalitiesthatcharacterize thecurrentglobalizationprocess.Forthatreason,itconstitutesoneofthe moresignificantdimensionsinthegeopoliticsofcontemporarycapitalism” (Lander2002b,74). Thedevelopmentofbiotechnologyhasrecentlyseenimpressiveadvances withexperimentsincloning,geneticallymodifiedcrops,andthedecoding ofthehumangenome.Torealizesuchdevelopment,biotechnologyrequires legal and commercial-economic security mechanisms, designed over the courseofseveralyears,toallowitunfetteredaccumulation.Inrecentinternationalagreementsandtreaties,suchasnaFta ,thecreationin1995ofthe WorldTradeOrganization,effortstosubscribetotheMultilateralInvest116 FernanDogarcésV.
mentAgenda,andnowattemptstoformalizeevenfurther“freetrade”negotiationssuchasthe Ftaa andtheAndeanfreetradeagreement,thetopics relatedtoagricultureandintellectualpropertyrightsreceiveagreatdealof attention. Itwasnoaccidentthatintheseagreementsandtreatiestheconceptof intellectual property rights was expanded; it no longer is limited to that whichisinvented,butnowincludesthatwhichisdiscovered.Ashasbeen trueforoverfivehundredyears,colonialmodernitycontinuesdiscovering andconquering.Before,colonialmodernitydiscoveredAmerica,meaningit becameawareofthatwhichwaspreviouslyunknowntoit,andthatawarenesstranslatedintoconquest,domination,andaccumulation.Today,colonial modernity discovers genetic diversity and privatizes the rights to accessanduseoftheplanet’sgenetic-biologicalwealth.Inbothcases,previous knowledge—collective,orallycirculated,andindigenous—doesnotcount orevenexist.Onlycolonial–imperialjurisprudencehasthepowertocreate andtogivetheabilityto betonature,tohumanbeings,andtotheirknowledge. Afewyearsagoduringthetriumphantgreenrevolution,whichpromisedtoabolishworldhunger,theknowledgeofallegedlyignorantIndians andpeasantswasdeniedinthenameofamodernscientificperspectivethat boastedobjectivity,precision,andveracity.Drivenbythisdenial,missionariesofdevelopmentpouredintopeasantandindigenouscommunitiesto teachIndianshowtosow,whatseedstouse,andhowtoincreaseproduction.Today,peoplecontinuetodenythatIndianknowledgeisknowledge (conocimiento)—atmost,itgetstobewisdom(saber)orethnicwisdom— butcommunityknowledgeissurreptitiouslyusurped,robbed,plundered. TheknowledgeofIndiansisnotworthyofwrittenlegalprotection,butitis veryusefultounfetteredcapitalistaccumulation. In the PCÑ , indigenous peasant knowledge and Quechua yachay are linkedtothepoliticalandterritorialautonomyofcommunitiesandtheir organizations.Quechuayachaydefendstheindigenouspeasantwayoflife andisaweapontocombatgovernmentalandnongovernmentaldevelopmentpolicies.Inthissense,yachayninchik~yachayniyku(“Ourknowledge [inclusive]~knowledge [exclusive ofsecondperson]”)isrelatedtokawsayninchik~kawsayniyku(“Ourlife~life”)asanexpressionofaterritorialpresence.Inthevoicesrepresentedbythenewspaper,almosteverything mustbekawsayninchikman jina(“Accordingtoourlife”):theorganization, education,environmentalmanagement,health,andsoforth. Quechua Knowledge and Writings 117
Assuch,itdoesnotmakemuchsensetospeakoflocalorindigenous knowledgeintheabstract.Defendingitmakessenseonlyinthecontextof thestrugglefortheterritorialrevindicationofBolivia’sindigenouspeasant movement.Thisknowledgeislinkedtothecontrolofterritoryunderstood as a defense of communal jurisdiction and peasant autonomy before the stateandadefensefromtheattacksofglobalcapitalism. This struggle against racism is expressed in multiple ways and has inspireddonRobertoAlbarracíntosay: Maypi yachayninchiq, rimayninchiq,
Wherehaveourknowledgeand
wich’usqa kasanman karqa. Nuqanchiq
ourwordsbeenwasted?Wewere
yachananchiq karqa. Nuqanchiq
supposedtoknow.WeareQuechuas.
qhiswaruna kanchiq. Nuqa chayta
Iaskmyselfthat,Iwouldliketo
tapurikuni, yachayta munayman
know.
(RobertoAlbarracín,in46:1).
TheideaspresentedinthisessayrunparalleltothequestiondonRoberto asksfromwithinhiscommunity.Takingasapre-textthevoicesoftheConosur Ñawpagmannewspaper,Ihaveattemptedtounderstand,throughcontinualdiscussionwithcommunitymembersandleadersinRaqaypampaand Ayopaya,whereandhowtheknowledgeandwordsthatareuncomfortable forglobalcapitalarebeinglost.Iamconsciousthat,asaq’ara,andsinceI amknowntobelongtothisspaceofacademicpower,Icanbeadiscursive toolandactasajawamanta yachay(“knowledgefromabroad”),enabling theinterstitialresistanceofQuechua’syachay.InthiswayIseektoconvey theideathatdonRoberto’squestionisnotfinal,thatsuchknowledgeand suchwordshavenotbeenentirelylost.Theyareworththeimpertinenceof continuingtolive,theimpertinenceofcontinuingtobloom,asTataFermín knewsowell: Kay pata chiri jallp’akuna pampas
Thesehighandcoldlandsareours,
ñuqanchikpata, ñawpa tatakunanchik
ouroldancestors’inheritance,welive
saqisqanku, kaypi tiyakunchik. Chay-
here.Andthatisnondisappearing,
taqrimana chinkaq, mana tukukuq,
neverending,wecontinuelivingeven
kunankamapis kawsachkallanchikpuni,
tothisday,left(tolive)here,todiein
kay kikinpi saqisqas, kikinpi wañuq,
thesameplace,toliveinthesame
kikinpi kawsaq. Mana waq llaqtaman-
place.Wehavenotappearedin
tachu rikhurinchik, kay kikin llaqtayuq
anotherland,webelongtothisland,
118 FernanDogarcésV.
kanchik, qhurajina kanchik mujumanta
weareasweedsthatreturnfromthe
watanpaq watanpaq kutirin mana
seedsyearafteryear,neverending,we
tukukuq, qhura jina mana tukukuq
areasweedsthatdieoutnot.
kanchik(FermínVallejos1995:3–4).
Notes IthankFlorenciaMallon,notonlyforinvitingmetotheconferencethatprovided theframeworkforthispaper,butalsoforhercommentsonmywork.Ialsothank PedroPlaza,whohelpedmewiththetranslationofQuechuatextsintoEnglish,and SoledadGuzmán,whohelpedmeshortenthepresentation.Idedicatethisarticleto mybrother,ArmandoMuyulema,whoknowsthecreativeandtransformativepower oflanguage,bothinitsoralanditswrittenforms. 1.ThroughoutthisessayIoptforusingthephraseinscription in writingandthe wordwritinginplaceofliteracidad,evermorecommonintheexistingbibliography asaloanwordoftheEnglishliteracy.InspiteofZavala’sjustification,IthinkliteracidadevokesinSpanishtheworldofliterature,markedbyitselitistandacademic(ilustrado)character.IagreewithZavala’sdefinitionoftheterm:“Asocialphenomenon thatisnotrestrictedtotechnicallearningintheeducationalarena”(Zavala2002,15). IwillrefertothispublicationastheConosur,thePCÑ ,orthe newspaperthroughout thetext.Ñawpagmanmeans“goforward.” 2.Yachaycanbetranslatedas“knowledge.”However,itisthebasisofanentire semanticfieldrelatedtoknowledge,learning,teaching,andeventoawayoflife.For anethnographicstudyonthisconcept,seeGarcía(2005). 3.TheCunapeoplesusethetermAbya Yala,meaning“matureandfertileearth,” tonameAmerica.Manycountries’indigenousorganizationshaveadoptedthisterm torefertoageographicalspace.Iftonameistostruggle,asMuyulemastates(2001, 328),andifAmericaandLatinAmericaresultfromnamingpoliciesthatpartially implanted the conquistadors in this communication, then I insert myself in that struggle.IthusopttouseAbya Yalatorefertowhathasusuallybeenconstructedas AmericaorLatinAmerica. 4.IntwooftheregionsthatwitnessedrecoveryofterritoryinCochabambaDepartment,peasant organizations stated theirorganizational positionintheirlegal documents as “Unified Regional Trade Union of Indigenous Peasants of Raqaypampa”and“UnifiedRegionalTradeUnionofIndigenousPeasantWorkersofAyopaya.” 5.Thetermpachaisoneoftherichest,mostcomplextermsinQuechua’ssemanticuniverse.Itreferstotheentireandveryamplespectrumofspaceandtimein whichwearelocated. 6.Thissectionisasynthesisofapreviousdiscussion(Garcés2005b,82–104). Quechua Knowledge and Writings 119
7.ThesamegroupthatstartedthenewspaperhadcreatedcenDa ,anongovernmentalorganization,thepreviousyear.Atfirst,cenDa workedontheissueofintroducedtechnologiesandtheireffectsonpeasantcommunities,primarilythecommunityofRaqaypampa. 8.EvoMorales,leaderofthePeasantFederationsfromCochabamba’sTropical Region,foundedtheMas politicalparty.InJune2002Mas participatedinnational electionsandwon20percentofthevotes(1percentlessthantheMovimientoNacionalistaRevolucionario,GonzaloSánchezdeLozada’sparty)andthirty-fiveparliamentaryseatsintheCongress(Postero,2005). 9.Atonepointthenewspapercarriedoutanexperimentinwhichthereaders themselveswrotethearticles.Theexperimentdidnotworkbecause,amongother things,leaderscritiqueditforwantingtocreateaselectgroupofwriters. 10.Diglotticisasociolinguistictermreferringtotheconflictivecoexistencewithin aterritoryoftwoormorelanguagesorvariantsofalanguageinasymmetricconditionsofuseandvalue.Oneofthelanguagesappropriatestoitselfalltheusesand functions,whiletherestrestricttheirusesandfunctionstodomesticandagriculturalarenas.Fortheterm’stechnicalspecificities,seeAlbó(1998),Fishman(1995), andLuykx(1998). 11.Icitetextsofthe PCÑ byindicatingthenumberoftheissuefollowedbythe pagenumbers. 12.Theseexamplesaremerelyillustrativeandintendedtosupporttheassertions Imake. 13.ForthecaseofAymarainradio,seeCondori’swork(2003).Currently,Soledad GuzmánisinvestigatingthebroadcastingofQuechuainaCochabambaurbanarea aspartofhermaster’sthesisattheproeib Andes(Guzmán2005). 14. In addition, cenDa publishes a Children’s Supplement in Quechua called theAñaskitu.Itisamonolingualmagazinethatseeksthesocializationofchildren’s Quechuaknowledgethroughinterschoolcorrespondenceandthevaluationofcommunityknowledge. 15.OnthestrongpresenceofSpanishinBolivianQuechuaandespeciallyCochobambino,seeSichra(2003,105–16). 16.TheQuechuaalphabetcurrentlyusedinBoliviaisbasedontheAlfabeto Único para el Idioma Quechua(UnifiedAlphabetfortheQuechuaLanguage),madeofficial andpublishedintheSupremeDecreeNo.20227(Gaceta Oficial de Bolivia25:382, 10April1984)byPresidentSilesSuazo.BolivianQuechua’snormativewritteninscriptionisdevelopedonthebasisofscholasticizedPan-Andeanstandardizationand historicizedcriteria(Luykx,2001).ThisdevelopmentseekstorecovertheetymologicalformsofQuechua’spreviousstates.Ittakesintoaccountregionalvariationasa wayofdiagnosingcurrentformsofusage,buttheseusagesabsolutelydonotimpact thenorm’sdefinition. 17.Thetopicofwritingwithanoralbaseisnotanentirelynovelphenomenon. 120 FernanDogarcésV.
ForthecaseofSpanish,seethestudiesofOesterreicher,Bustos,Cano,Eberenz,and StollintheeditionofKotschi,Oesterreicher,andZimmermann(1996). 18.ThislastoneisapracticewithalongtraditionintheAndeanworld(Guamán Poma1615;PachacutiYamquic.1613;Yupanqui1570;Lienhard1990). 19.VirginiaZavala(2002,62)questionswhetherobjectivityisinfactanintrinsic characteristicofwriting,orinsteadapartoftheimaginarycreatedbythescholastizationassociatedwithit. 20.Beneaththeheadingonthecovertherearetwophotosoftheindigenouspeasantmobilizationsof12October1992. 21.SeePari(2005,77–79),whopositsthatnatureisoneoftheteachersofpeasant knowledge. 22.See PCÑ 51,whichhasafour-page(9–12)critiqueofchemicalsinrelationto “natural”peasantproduction. 23.WhatIaminterestedinshowingwiththesedataisthatthengo thatpublishes thenewspaperusesthesametoolsofWesterntechnologicalknowledgetodelegitimizeit.Moreover,itshowsthesingularinteractionbetweenthengo ’spoliticalpositioningandpeasantknowledgeinanefforttovalidatethisknowledge.Thismeans thatfortheConosurorforcenDa ,knowledgeisatoolusedtostruggleagainstdevelopmentandprepackagedtechnologyratherthananendinitself. 24.AconnectionwiththistopiccanbefoundintheresearchofRomero(1994). Heshowsthatthech’ikimakesreference,inthecommunityofTiticachi,toatypeof socialintelligenceadultsvaluepositively.Thech’ikiistheintelligentchildwhoknows howtobehavesociallyinthepropercontext.Bycontrast,saqrareferstochildren whodazzleotherswiththeirindividualcognitiveintelligence,butwhodonotreceive positivereinforcementfromthecommunitybecausetheirindividualizedbehavior locatesthemjustoutsideitsborders. 25.Onthislastaspect,seeArnoldandYapita(2000).Theauthorsproposethat writingpromotedbytheBolivianEducationReformfulfillsthesamedominating roleasthatimplantedbythecolonialevangelizationmodel.
Quechua Knowledge and Writings 121
Joanne raPPaPort anD abelarDo ramos PacHo
CollaborationandHistoricalWriting Challenges for the Indigenous–Academic Dialogue
Morethanthreedecadesago,DelmosJonesproposedthata“nativeanthropology”wouldbecomeviableonlywhenitdeveloped“asetoftheoriesbased onnon-Westernpreceptsandassumptionsinthesamesensethatmodern anthropology is based on and has supported Western beliefs and values” (1970,251).JoneswasthinkingofminorityscholarsintheUnitedStateswho, armedwiththedoubleconsciousnessaffordedbytheirpositionstraddling the boundary between the dominant society and their own subordinated groups,couldpotentiallydevelopwhatW.E.B.DuBois(1989[1903],2–3) called “second-sight,” a privileged minority vantage point from which to analyzesociallife. WhileDuboisianconceptsresonateinveryspecificwayswithintheAfro– NorthAmericancontext,thenotionofdoubleconsciousnessprovidesfertile groundfortheinterpretationoftheroleofintellectualswithinLatinAmericanethnicmovements,whereeffortshavebeenmadetodevelopwhatmight becalledanindigenoussecond-sight:inotherwords,thediscoveryfrom withinNativeculturesofthoseconceptualelementsthatmayenablenew interpretations of reality consonant with the epistemologies and political prioritiesofindigenousorganizations.1Theorization—thecreationofsuch conceptualtools—isoneofthefundamentalobjectivesofintellectualsaffiliatedwithLatinAmericanindigenousorganizations.2Thisprocessranges fromthedevelopmentofnarrativemodelsthatdecenterWesternnotions ofhistoricalchronology(FernándezOsco2000;Vasco,Dagua,andAranda 1993)totheuseofconceptsinNativelanguagesasframeworksforadapting Westernconceptstoindigenousends.Butsuchconceptualtoolsnotonly functionasmodelsforinterpretingexperience;theyalsoassistindigenous
organizationsinactingpoliticallyuponthesocialrealitiesinwhichtheylive. Inotherwords,the“second-sight”stimulatedbytheseintellectualpractices isaimedattransformingreality,notonlyanalyzingit. Inthisessayweprobethenatureofthismomentofindigenoustheorizing,inquiringintotheintellectualconditionsofitsemergenceanditsepistemologicalcharacter.Forus,thisprocessismorethanthesimpleappropriationofprimordialvaluesinamoderncontext.Indigenoustheorizing emergeswithinamultiethnicsocialsphere,arealitythatimpactsbothits epistemologicalnatureandthewaysinwhichitisputintopoliticalpractice. Itemergesoutofaprocessofappropriationofknowledgesystemsframedby indigenousthoughtandsustainedbyacriticalappreciationofothercultures. Suchstrategiesoriginateinthepoliticalcontext,giventhattheindigenous movementseekstobuildwhatcouldbecalledaradicallypluralistdemocracy(LaclauandMouffe1985),anationalimaginaryinwhichsocialjustice isconstructedthroughtheinfusioninthesocialprocessofamultiplicityof ethnicdemandsandpoliticalpractices. Whatthismeansisthatitisnotalwayseasytoidentifytheindigenous inNativetheorizingbydistinguishingitscomponentsasbelongingtoone indigenouscultureoranother.Muchoftheconceptualmatrixemployedby indigenousorganizationshasbeenappropriatedfromprogressiveacademic scholarshipineducation,anthropology,history,linguistics,andpoliticalscienceaswellasfromthemethodsandconceptsdevelopedbypopularmovementsandnongovernmentalorganizations(ngo s).ThereisadesiretocreateconceptualvehiclesthatdonotprivilegeaspecificNativecultureoverthe othersthatcompriseindigenousorganizations,whicharefrequentlymultiethnic.Whatmakesthistheorizingindigenousisthespaceinwhichitis appropriated—theindigenousorganization—andthefactthatitisfiltered throughindigenouslanguagesand,throughtranslation,istransformed.Itis morethelocusoftheorizinganditslinguisticpracticesthanitscontentsper sethatareatstakehere. The process of creating conceptual vehicles is at once methodological (inthesenseofprovidingnewresearchtools)andpolitical(becausethese methodologiesmakepossibletheestablishmentofNativeautonomyinspecificareas).Inthissense,indigenoustheorizingissomewhatakintofeminist research,whichissimultaneouslyacademicandpolitical.Butwhatisdifferentabouttheindigenoustheorizingwedescribehereisthefactthatittakes placeatagreatdistancefromtheacademy.WhileitistruethatLatinAmerican academics and a small number of foreigners collaborate on an intelCollaboration and Historical Writing 123
lectuallevelwithindigenousorganizations,theirnumbersarefarsmaller proportionally in comparison to the collaboration of academics with the feministmovementor,intheUnitedStates,ofAfricanAmericanscholars withblackorganizations.Perhapsthediscrepancyisduetothefactthatthe resultsofindigenousresearchrarelyappropriateacademicformatsfortheir dissemination,beinginsteaddirectlyabsorbedintotheprojectsofNative organizations.Moreover,feministscholars,particularlyfemaleacademics, haveadirectstakeinthefeministmovement,whichisnotastrueofthe mostlynon-NativeacademicswhoworkwithLatinAmericanindigenous organizations;thenatureofLatinAmericanuniversitieshaslargelyexcluded the hiring of Native and African-descended faculty, producing a marked ethnicorracialdifferencebetweentheacademyandgrass-rootsorganizations.Insomeways,then,theresearchcurrentlyunderwayinLatinAmericanindigenousorganizationsissuigeneris. Weexaminetheprocessofindigenoustheorymakingthroughacritical analysisofarecentresearchexperienceinwhichwestudiedthehistoryof theBilingualandInterculturalEducationProgram(pebi)oftheRegional Indigenous Council ofCauca (cric),aColombian indigenous organizationthatoverthecourseofthepastthirty-oneyearshascometooccupyan importantroleasaninterlocutorbetweentheindigenouspopulationand theColombianpublicatlarge.Inthecourseofourcollaboration,whichincludedbilingualteachers, cric activists,andthreeresearchers—onefrom the Nasa ethnic group, a nonindigenous collaborator with cric , and a NorthAmericananthropologist—wecametorealizethatindigenoustheorizingfindssignificantsourcesinthecultureoftheindigenousorganization,whichinitselfisakindofinterculturalmicrocosm,includingnotonly differentNativeethnicgroups,butnon-Nativecollaboratorsaswell.Several methodologiesandkeyconceptsinformedourresearch.
Translating Theory IndigenoustheorizinginCaucaaroseoutoftheintersectionofvariouscircumstances. On the one hand, in the mid-1980s a Master of Arts degree inethnolinguisticswasofferedforthefirsttimeattheUniversidaddelos AndesinBogotátoindigenousstudentssponsoredbyethnicorganizations. Thisdevelopmentaffordedactiviststheopportunitytodiscoverthepossibilitiesthatlanguageholdsasasourceoftheoreticalframeworks.3Onthe other hand, the experience of translating the Colombian Constitution of 124 JoannerappaportanDabelarDoraMos
1991,whichincludesprovisionsregardingtherightsofNativepeoples(Van Cott2000),intoNasaYuwe,thelanguageoftheNasaofCauca,createdapoliticalcontextinwhichthelinguisticmethodologiesacquiredinthecourse ofgraduatestudycouldbeappropriatedbyNativeleaders. TranslationpresentsaninnovativestrategythroughwhichNasaactivists appropriateconceptsoriginatinginthedominantsocietyandreconfigure theminanindigenousframework.Nasa-speakersfrequentlyreflectupon thepossiblearrayofmeaningsofatermintheirownlanguage,withaneye towardadjustingitssignificancetobringitinlinewiththeirownobjectives. Thisstrategyisengagedwhentranslatorsencounter,forexample,termslike development, interculturalism, and culture whose significance has limited resonancewithintheNasasphere,butwhosemeaningcanbeadaptedtothe politico-culturalprojectofthemovement.Followingthesuggestionsofthe filmcriticReyChow,webelievethatthetranslatingofsuchwordsintoNasa YuweimprovestheoriginalSpanishterm,injectsitwithanewNasasignificancethatliberatesitfromitsoriginallimitations(1995,186). Thestrategyoriginatedwhen cric setouttotranslatetheConstitution of1991(RamosandCabildoIndígenadeMosoco1993;cf.Rojas2000).The interculturalteamthatwasformedtoundertakethetaskwascomposedof thetraditionalauthoritiesoftheindigenouscommunityofMosoco,bilingualteachers,indigenousandnationallinguists,andarangeofprofessionals fromthenationalsociety,amongthemlawyers,sociologists,psychologists, philosophers,andeconomists.TheteamwasforcedtoconfrontthechallengeofrenderingaseriesofuniversalpoliticalconceptsinNasaYuwe.The exercise transcended one of preparing a simple translation or of creating mereneologisms.TheteamsoughttorethinktheseconceptsfromaNasa perspective,andtheresultwassomethingthatwentfarbeyondaglossaryof newtermsinNasaYuwe:theexerciseintranslationopenedupthepossibility ofreconceptualizingthenotionsofjusticeandnationfromthevantagepoint ofindigenousculturesandorganizationalneeds.Thatis,theConstitution wasnotsimplytranslated;instead,itsfundamentalpreceptswerereimagined fromaNasasubjectposition,offeringaNasacritiqueoftheColombianstate (Rappaport2004).Inthissense,translationintoNasaYuwe,asaresearch— andpolitical—methodology,providedthemovementwiththephilosophical foundationsofitspluralistpoliticalproposal. Atthesametime,theintroductionoftranslationasamethodologyfosterednewapproachestotheindigenousstudyofsocialreality,anewformof Nasa“autoethnography.”TwodecadesagoTalalAsadsuggestedthatethnogCollaboration and Historical Writing 125
raphyisakindoftranslation,“addressedtoaveryspecificaudience,which iswaitingtoreadaboutanothermodeoflifeandtomanipulatethetextit readsaccordingtoestablishedrules,nottolearntoliveanewmodeoflife” (1986,159).Translationisequallycrucialtotheindigenousproject,butits functionistheinverseofwhatAsadproposedforethnography.WhenNasa activistsengageinculturaltranslationtheydoit“tolearntoliveanewmode oflife”:theyappropriateexternalconceptswithinanindigenouspolitical matrixwiththeaimofintroducingnewstrategiesforculturalsurvival.In otherwords,theirobjectiveistotakeholdofculturalpotentialities,notto textualizeculturaldifferences.Thisautoethnographicmethodologycanbe bettercomprehendedasoneofaseriesofinterculturalapproachesthatthe indigenousmovementemploystonegotiateamultiethnicmilieu.
Interculturalism ThetranslationoftheConstitutionshedslightonafundamentalaspectof indigenoustheorizing inColombia:itemergesfromanintercultural dialogue.Thetranslationprocesswas,infact,adoubleinterculturaldialogue: betweenindigenousactivistsandprofessionalsfromthenationalsocietyas wellasbetweenNasaphilosophiesandWesternjurisprudence.Indigenous organizations are themselves intercultural contexts in which indigenous militantsandnon-Nativecollaboratorsinteractdaily,constantlyexchanging ideasoriginatingasmuchinnationalandinternationalspheresoftheorizing asinNativecultures.Althoughtheseorganizationswereinterculturalfrom themomentoftheirinception—cric ,forexample,wasfoundedbyGuambianos,Nasas,andmestizoactivists—inthepasttwodecades,astheconcept ofinterculturalismwaspromotedbyLatinAmericaneducators,itscontents wereappropriatedwithinindigenousorganizationalpractice. Interculturalism developed in Latin America alongside the popular strugglesofthe1970sand1980s,whengrass-rootsorganizationsposedconcretealternativestotraditionalnotionsofelectoraldemocracy(López1995). InthecaseofColombia,wheretheConstitutionof1991establishedthelegal potential for the creation of a pluralist nation, interculturalism provides aradicalalternativetotheconceptofmulticulturalism.Thelatterposesa threattopluralisminsofarasitpromotesasimpletoleranceforethnicminorities,fosteringtheirparticipationinanelectoralsystemthatdilutestheir impactuponthenation(Hale2002).Bycontrast,interculturalism(onpaper,
126 JoannerappaportanDabelarDoraMos
atleast)seeksnewformsofestablishingconditionsofequalityandconsensusbyenhancingthecontentsofminorityvoices(Heise,Tubino,andArdito 1994).Theobjectivesofinterculturalismtranscendthoseofmulticulturalism becauseinterculturalistsseekmorethanacross-culturalencounterframed byhegemonicrelations.Theirobjectiveistocreatenewhorizontalrelationships(Gottret1999)withinapluraliststate(López1999).Inaddition,interculturalistsaimatinjectingculturaldifferencewithinthedemandsofthe Leftforaradicallypluralistdemocracy(LaclauandMouffe1985). Interculturalismisanemergentproject,notanexistingsocialreality.It originated in Latin America within indigenous education, where radical educatorsbuiltlocalbilingualprogramsbaseduponitsprecepts.InterculturaleducationmakesculturaldifferenceexplicitthroughitsaimoffosteringtheincorporationofnewideaswithinemergentNativeculturalconstellations(Mengoa1999).Weemphasize theemergent natureofindigenous culturalprojectsbecausethenotionofculturalrevivalisorientednottoward theretrievalofcustomsfromthepastbuttowardthefuture(Heise,Tubino andArdito,1994).Interculturalism transcendsthetaskofschoolingchildreninaculturallysensitivemanner.Itpresupposesalinkbetweeneducationandsocialchange,suggestingthattheschoolisacriticalscenariofor theconstructionofdemocracy.Thepromotionofself-esteemandthecreationofnonhierarchicalinterethnicrelationscanprovidefirmfoundations forbuildingpoliticalpluralismbeyondtheschoolhouse(Heise,Tubino,and Ardito1994;Gottret1999;López1996,1999). Indigenous theorizing is an example of putting interculturalism into practice. Interculturalism provides the conceptual tools needed to create indigenoustheory,butitdoesmorethanthat:ithasapoliticalobjective. InterculturaldialogueisvaluedbyindigenousorganizationsinColombia precisely because Native people are also Colombians; they recognize that theirparticipationinpopularstrugglemusttranscendpurelyindigenousdemands.Butwhileethnicorganizationsparticipateactivelyintheconstructionofanewnation—thebestcurrentexampleistheorganizationbythe indigenousmovementofapopularreferendumonColombia’sacceptance oftheFreeTradeAreaoftheAmericasandindigenousrejectionsofneoliberalpolicy—thecreationofnewconceptualtoolsalsoimpactsuponlocal effortsatculturalrevival,nourishingtheemergenceofnewindigenousculturalforms.
Collaboration and Historical Writing 127
Culture and Political Autonomy In this essay we problematize the nature of theorizing within the indigenousmovement,analyzingitfromaninterculturalperspective.Frequently, as was the case in the translation of the Constitution, the theoretical vehicles are the product oflinguistic research, but cosmological knowledge isalsoanimportantsourceoftheory.Oneofthemodelsmostfrequently employedbyindigenousorganizationsisthespiralmotif,aniconthatappears on petroglyphs, is reproduced in the hand movements of shamans duringritualséances,andhasbeenadducedinthegrammaticalstructures ofvariousCaucanNativelanguages(MuelasHurtado1995).Adoptionofa spiralsenseoftimeallowedtheGuambianoHistoryCommitteetogenerate analternativetolinearchronologicalnarration,permittingthemtoreorganizehistoricaleventsbyprivilegingmythicheroinesandsacredspaceasanchorsforapoliticalhistoryoftheGuambianos(Vasco,Dagua,andAranda 1993;cf.Rappaport2005).4Butitisalsopossibletogroundtheorizationin theorganizationalcultureoftheindigenousmovement,whereactivistshave appropriateduniversalconceptslikeautonomyandterritoryastheprimary interpretive threads for historical and sociological research (Allen 2002; Field1999),transformingtheircontentssothattheyareinaccordwiththe principlesanddemandsoftheorganization.5Thediscourseofpoliticalautonomyfeedssimultaneouslyupontheworkofculturalactivistsandonthe demands of nonethnic social movements. The notion of territory, for instance,whichhascometoreplaceearlierdemandsforland,impliesadegree ofsovereigntyoverapopulationanditslandscape.Butterritoryalsoemerges outofacosmologicalrelationshipwiththatlandscape,thusmergingpoliticaluniversalswithspecificNativenotionsofspace. Inreality,discoursesofculturaldifferenceandpoliticalautonomyoperateintandemwithinindigenous organizations. AsBruceAlbertexplains soconvincinglyinhisinterpretationofthediscourseoftheBrazilianYanomamileaderDaviKopenawa,theindigenousmovementmustnegotiatean ethnicallyheterogeneouspoliticalfield.Ethnicorganizationssurvivethanks totheirsimultaneousappropriationofpoliticaluniversalsandculturalspecifics:“Iftheindigenouspoliticaldiscoursewerelimitedtothemerereproductionofwhitecategories,itwouldbereducedtoemptyrhetoric;if,on theotherhand,itremainedintheexclusivesphereofcosmology,itwould notescapefromculturalsolipsism.Inanycase,thelackofarticulationbetweenthesetworegistersleadstopoliticalfailure”(Albert1995,4).Thena128 JoannerappaportanDabelarDoraMos
tureoftheindigenousprojectspansbothuniversalpoliticaldiscoursesand Nativeculturalspecifics,itsobjectivesinterweavingvariousconstructions ofpluralismthatoriginateasmuchfrominsideasfromoutsideindigenous communities,establishedthroughinterculturaldialogueamongindigenous ethnicgroupsandwithmembersofthenationalsociety.Inshort,ifweare tounderstandthisproject,weneedtotakeadualapproachthatcaninfiltrate theintersticeswhereuniversalandspecificdiscoursesmeet. Inrealitybothpolesofthisequationareheterogeneous.Aftermorethan fourcenturiesofcolonizationandinthewakeofdecadesofdialoguebetweenindigenousorganizationsandsympatheticpopularmovements,one cannotspeakoftwototallyincommensurablelogics.Theprocessofcultural resistancehasforcedtheethnicmovementtodevelopcontestatorycultural formsthataredeeplymodernandareindialoguewithnationalforms.As PaulGilroyindicates,echoingDuBois,thepowerofminorityculturalforms “derivesfromadoubleness,theirunsteadylocationsimultaneouslyinside andoutsidetheconventions,assumptions,andaestheticruleswhichdistinguishandperiodisemodernity”(1993,73).Intheprocess,minorityforms arereimagined,mixedwithappropriatedculturalformsfromthemajority societyinadynamicantiphony(1993,74).WhatGilroysuggestsisessential. Minoritytheorizingappropriatesconceptsandmethodologiesfromdominantparadigmsandreconfiguresthemwithinaminorityconceptualspace, atthesametimethatindigenousculturalformsarereimaginedwithinthe spaceofstruggle.Inthissense,thereisacertainurgencytomaintainingthe balancebetweencultureandautonomy,sothatoneregisterdoesnoterase theother. Inrecognitionofthischallenge,indigenoustheorizinginCaucacenters on the relationship between an inside and an outside. Native researchers havereflectedonthemeaningoftheprocessofconstructingculturaldifferencewithinthesocialsystemthatsurroundsthem.Theyseektodefine, throughresearchandpoliticalaction,waystomaintainaculturalinsidedifferent from the outside of the national society (Rappaport 2005, chap. 1; 2008).Theinsideisnotaculturalessenceastraditionalanthropologywould haveit,althoughitisbasedonconstellationsofvaluesandstructuresofbehavior;theculturalformsoftheinsidearticulatedbytheindigenousmovementdonotcorrespondtoanobservableculturalreality.Afterfourhundred yearsofcolonialdomination,theculturaltopographyofCaucaisheterogeneousandsyncretic,somethingactivistsnotonlyrecognizebutappropriateintotheirfieldofaction.Yetthereareafewlocalitiesthatdemonstrate Collaboration and Historical Writing 129
theconstellationofvaluesthatthemovementseekstorevitalizeandproject acrossthevastexpanseofindigenousterritory.Forthisreason,theinside isnotreallylocatedinaconcretesite,butintheutopiasthatthemovement hopestobuildonthebasisofmodelsgeneratedbytheirresearchers.6
Collaborative Theorizing Inwhatfollowswereflectuponthecomplexitiesofindigenoustheorizingon thebasisofourcollaborativeworkonthehistoryofthepebi ,aprogramof thecric .Twomembersoftheteam,AbelardoRamos,aNasalinguistand pebi member,andJoanneRappaport,aNorthAmericananthropologist, aretheauthorsofthisessay;athirdmemberoftheteam,GracielaBolaños, isanon-Nativecollaboratorwith cric andamemberof pebi .7Sinceour workassumedtheformofaninterethnicdialogue—whatinthemovement iscalledadiálogo de saberes,anexchangeofepistemologies—theremainderofthisarticleiswrittenasascript.Ourtwovoicesaremarkedbydifferentfonts. Joanne: Indigenous theorizing is the product of the complex negotiation of the ethnic movement’s priorities and discourses aimed at bridging different epistemologies and methodologies so that they are not incommensurate. Thus, as we have argued, the task of the collaborative researcher presupposes a conversation between several subject positions, in particular, between representatives of national society and indigenous groups. But we haven’t yet touched upon the organization of the production of such knowledge, which is inseparable from its theoretical qualities. In distinction to academic practice, which in anthropology is generally a solitary endeavor or organized into a relatively homogeneous group of researchers, in the indigenous movement research is profoundly collective; this presupposes a distinct methodology. Given that indigenous organizations include a range of activists, not only Native people from various ethnic groups but also nonindigenous collaborators, the research groups that coalesce within these organizations are also culturally—and epistemologically—heterogeneous.8 When external researchers collaborate in such enterprises, their methods and theory are subordinated to those created by the group (Vasco 2002, 449). This implies an acceptance not only of the equality of the different forms of knowledge, but also of their partial commensurability. Above all, it means that indigenous priorities must provide the general framework for 130 JoannerappaportanDabelarDoraMos
research, although external theory also enters into discussion. That is to say, the contributions of external researchers are appropriated and transformed just as the movement refashions external cultural and political elements in its everyday activities. It is imperative to understand that a collaborative dialogue is not between two monolithic poles—non-Native academics and indigenous researchers. Given that the research taking place in indigenous organizations emerges out of the joint work of indigenous actors and non-Native collaborators, who construct their research methodology as a team, it might be more fruitful to comprehend this process as a dialogue between activists (both indigenous and nonindigenous) and academics. I have discovered that the epistemological differences between my vision and that of my indigenous interlocutors is easily bridged, thanks to the anthropological training I received, which focused on Native epistemologies. However, I was not trained as an ethnographer to decipher the differences between activist and anthropological methodologies, where distinctions can be considerably more subtle. Research in an indigenous organization frequently takes place in workshops, whose collective methodology presupposes that the community itself, and not just the researchers, participate in framing the project and analyzing its results. In this sense, workshops are exegetical spaces where theory is produced, not simply occasions for collecting data (Vasco 2002). Under such conditions, theory emerges out of a process of “co-theorizing,” in which activists, the community, and external researchers all play a role. What makes this theorizing indigenous is its articulation with the priorities of the organization, which are developed collectively by traditional community authorities, the organizational leadership, shamans, bilingual teachers, nonNative collaborators, and others. In other words, what makes this knowledge indigenous is the particular way in which it is created and transmitted.9 Abelardo: The process of co-theorizing can be conceptualized in terms of local indigenous practice, through the application of the metaphor of the minga—collective work activities that benefit the community or a family— to the organization as a whole. It was in the experience of translating the Constitution of 1991 into Nasa Yuwe that we began to reconceptualize research as a minga in which various groups of people participated: the bilingual teachers of the community of Mosoco, cultural and political authorities recognized by the community (the cabildo, shamans, artisans, midwives), Collaboration and Historical Writing 131
students from the local high school, and specialists in linguistics and in law, the latter being non-Native. The work done by this collective had a concrete result, a book that could be read by both Native people and members of the national society (Ramos and Cabildo Indígena de Mosoco 1993). Our metaphor merged physical labor, which is what is generally done at a minga, with intellectual work. Frequently, local indigenous community members do not understand that intellectual labor is also a kind of work. Like work in the fields, intellectual work requires effort, produces fatigue, and creates results. But the comparison goes further than that. In Nasa Yuwe, both types of labor are referred to as majï, a term which is also used to describe the ritual activities of the shaman and the collective work of the cabildo in the building of territory (in particular, the walking of boundaries). Intellectual labor, when framed by the political priorities of the indigenous movement, fits neatly into this amplified notion of majï. The metaphor of the minga transcends the simple definition of collective labor, because it allows us to recognize that the notion of work is multifaceted. Majï is a concept that unites various interests and collectivities. Similarly, collaboration cannot be reduced to a simple dialogue between individuals belonging to different cultures. The institutional interests of the participants are always in the background—the interests of the university or of academic theory, the objectives of ngo s, the program of the indigenous movement. That is to say, collaboration and co-theorizing involve much more than interpersonal dialogue; they promote a conversation in which individuals articulate the collective interests of the groups they represent or of which they are members. This distinction is important because in some instances such interlocution can lead participants, especially academics, to transcend the interests of their institution and merge, perhaps temporarily, with an interethnic and nonacademic collectivity. When research funding has been acquired by the movement itself, the academic is at liberty to function independently of her or his institution in order to embrace indigenous priorities.10 The profile of the researcher is equally significant. He or she must recognize that research is not a neutral process, that one must choose dialogue. It is not just a question of respecting indigenous positions, but also of entering in active conversation with them. This is difficult for academics to accept since they are accustomed to treating indigenous ideas as ethnographic data, not as potential conceptual tools. 132 JoannerappaportanDabelarDoraMos
Despite the generosity of the participants, such a dialogue cannot but produce tensions. These may be due to the prejudices each member brings to the table, to the underlying sense of competition, and to the epistemological differences between them, whether academic or organizational epistemologies or those of the Native culture. Such conflict requires that participants act responsibly. Tensions can easily turn into nonnegotiable conflicts, or they can be fruitful. It is the responsibility of the participants to aim toward negotiation, not toward rupture. The balancing of institutional and cultural interests involves a highly complex process. There are cultural differences even among the members of indigenous organizations, since they include representatives of different ethnic groups and non-Native collaborators. This is to emphasize that conflicts will arise not only among academics and activists, but also in the movement itself. Collaborative research, with all of its institutional conflicts and cultural differences, is like two roads that cross each other, even if ultimately they are headed in the same direction. That is to say, difference is not necessarily negative, nor is it something that must be transcended. Assumed with responsibility, difference can produce new approaches to social reality, if the participants commit to the objectives of the indigenous organization. In other words, an intercultural framework, not the academic appropriation or concealing of indigenous ideas, must guide the research. The academic, who has been trained through a model of individual intellectual production, must recognize two fundamental realities: that collaborative work cannot be individual and that indigenous elements cannot be subsumed under an academic model. The two paths must nourish one another, being always conscious of their difference but also aware of their common goals. In the course of the research process, individual participants will be enriched intellectually by learning from one another. In the end, collaboration makes a contribution not only to the collectivity, but also to each of the participants.
The History of PEBI : Collaborative Research at the Grass Roots Inthecaseofthehistoryof pebi ,collaborationwasnotgroundedexclusivelyinthedynamicsofourthree-memberresearchteam,butalsorequired initiatingdialoguewiththebroadergroupofactivists. pebi was founded at the end of the 1970s as an initiative of the Fifth Congressof cric and,particularly,ofitsvicepresident,BenjamínDindiCollaboration and Historical Writing 133
cué. pebi wasconceivedasanorganizingspaceinwhichcommunitiesin strugglecouldbemobilizedaroundregionaldemands.11Although pebi is an educational program—including curricular design, historical and linguisticresearch,thegenerationoftheory,andteachertraining—itscentral objectivesfocusonthecreationofschoolsasavanguardfortheorganizingofpolitical,social,andculturalactivitiesinindigenouscommunitiesin conjunctionwithcabildosandothertraditionalauthorities.Inotherwords, fromthestart pebi ’sobjectiveshavetranscendedpedagogy,anditsmemberscharacterizetheirprojectascontestatory,nourishedbyacriticaland politicizedappreciationofinterculturalpedagogicalmethods.Incontrastto otherpopulareducationprojectsinLatinAmerica,pebi originatednotfrom within an educational movement, but in apolitical organization. Schools werefoundedinthosecommunitiesthatexhibitedintenseinvolvementin politicalorganizing,andthefirstteacherswerechosenfromapoolofthe mostcommittedactivists,irrespectiveoftheirlevelofschooling.Communitymembersservedasevaluatorsandadvisors,developingtheirideasin workshopsandcommunityassemblies.Morethanaspacefortrainingchildren,theschoolwasconceivedasthepivotoftheentirecommunity. Initsmorethanthreedecadesofexistence, pebi hasenteredintodialogue with educators across Colombia and Latin America, contributing innovativeculturalandcurricularprojectsthathaveservedasmodelsfor ethnoeducationattheregionalandnationallevels.Ithastrainedasignificant numberofindigenousteachersandpoliticalleadersinCauca.Itsinterculturalandculture-specificproposalsfortheconstructionofethnicpluralism have permeated cric as a whole, and increasingly cric ’s leadership has drawnuponpebi memberstofillimportantpoliticalrolesintheorganization. Around2000pebi undertookthetaskofresearchingandwritingitshistory.Theprojectwasconceivedasalearningexperienceandaspaceforcollectiveanalysis,requiringthebroadparticipationofprogrammembersin theresearch.Tothisend,aseriesofworkshopsandmeetingswereheldin 2000and2001,gatheringsatwhichactivists,includingstaffmembersinthe regionalprogramaswellaslocalbilingualteachersandleaders,compileda listoffifty-onequestionsmeanttoorienttheresearchprocessandprepare grass-roots activists for collecting relevant information in their localities. pebi ’sprogramiscrystallizedintheseguidingquestions.Thequestionsexhortresearcherstoillustratehoweducationisapoliticalvehicle,howitleads
134 JoannerappaportanDabelarDoraMos
communitiestodevelopacosmicandhistoricalrelationshipwiththeirterritory,howthisprojectlaysthebasisforforgingpoliticalautonomy,economic reconstruction,andcommunitydevelopment.Thequestionsemphasizethe centralityofinterculturalappropriationofideaswithinaprojectthatisnot merelyeducational,butpolitical.Theyoutlinehow pebi objectivesaredirectedattheentireorganizationandnotjustatitseducationalsector.They illustratehowtheprogramactsasavanguardpromotingindigenouscontent intheorganizationatlarge. However,almostallofthequestionsengagepebi ’scurrentpolicies.They arenotatallretrospective,inpartbecausesomanyoftheworkshopparticipantswereyoung,mostwithascantdecadeofexperienceintheorganization.Theirpresentistcastposedachallengefortheresearchteam,whichwas chargedwithwritingahistoryoftheprogram. Abelardo: For me, those fifty-one questions were challenging methodologically because I felt that they constrained the nature of the project, forcing us to focus on current organizing strategies instead of engaging in a politicalhistorical analysis. The latter was my primary political interest. For some of us who are Nasa-speakers, the idea of doing history was appealing because it would help us to trace the educational process retrospectively. We wanted to study the political nature of the process over time. In particular, we hoped to communicate to future generations the hopes of the elders who founded CriC and PeBi at the end of the seventies: how they fought to build a feeling of dignity as a people and how they gained their rights by building an educational system based upon our own culture. Doing history would permit us to engage in a dialogue with those first generations. In the final workshop we built a consensus in favor of the history project, with testimonies collected from the protagonists in the process.12 The truth is that the guiding questions were composed before we made the decision to write a history of PeBi . As a result, our team was forced to adapt them to the historical framework we had chosen. This meant we would have to engage in a negotiation, using the questions as conceptual guides for thinking retrospectively, and in the course of this reflection we would have to find a way to engage and foreground the voices of the narrators. I think that the questions helped me to see that a history of education was of necessity a political history. We would need to interpret the testimonies within this framework, bring together today’s political priorities with the memory of the past. Collaboration and Historical Writing 135
Joanne: The workshop participants did not seek answers to their questions in a historical narrative that highlighted the earlier experiences of PEBI but hoped to resolve them through reflection on their own experiences, which, on the whole, went back only a decade. In a sense, their questions contained the answers they sought, calling up accepted discourses instead of historical explanation. But although the questions expressed the concerns of the present, they would have to serve as a fulcrum around which we could organize our interpretation of the past. At the outset I resisted this arrangement because I did not fully comprehend it. The three-person research team began to debate the ways in which we hoped to frame this history. In numerous PEBI meetings, ranging from curricular planning and program evaluation to political meetings, I had observed that local teachers frequently made use of the spiral motif to organize their presentations. At one curricular meeting, the teachers from the experimental school in the community of Juan Tama presented their pedagogical projects—community history, organic agriculture, the school garden, Nasa literacy—in a chart organized into a spiral. PEBI ’s magazine, Çxayu’çe, published a board game to stimulate use of Nasa Yuwe among schoolchildren, also organized as a spiral (Anonymous 2000).13 I enthusiastically recommended that we consider the spiral as an organizing motif for our history project. The lukewarm response I received indicated that PEBI hoped to produce a document whose analytical character and sphere of circulation would be considerably wider than that which the culturally specific spiral motif could assume. There was a great desire to produce an intercultural history that incorporated the experiences of the various ethnic groups under the CRIC umbrella, despite the fact that the bulk of PEBI ’s work had been with Nasa speakers. Such a set of objectives obviated the possibility of employing the spiral as a conceptual model. I was confronted with the naiveté of my understanding of indigenous theorizing as something that could arise only out of Native cultural forms. The regional space of indigenous politics, where concepts originating in national and international debates could be appropriated, was a more apt space for theorizing the history of PEBI . Despite their presentist orientation, the fifty-one guiding questions provided us by the workshops supplied useful tools for conceptualizing movement history from the vantage point of a discourse of political autonomy, as opposed to one with a culturalist perspective.
136 JoannerappaportanDabelarDoraMos
Community Control, Interculturalism, and Cosmovision Joanne: In my three decades of ethnographic research in Colombia I had never followed such a conceptual itinerary: a research agenda that was more political than academic, a research plan for historical study based on presentist referents, a project whose conceptual framework originated outside of the academic community and whose objectives were determined by a group of nonacademics who were not directly involved with the research team. I quickly learned that when a social movement conducts research, its methodology is vastly different from that employed by academics. However, the broad participation of PEBI members in the establishment of our conceptual framework does not mean that activist research lacks rigor. In the course of collecting oral narratives from early indigenous activists and collaborators, I discovered that activist researchers have access to a much more extensive range of information than academics, and they are constantly submitting these data to collective evaluation and analysis. Where they differ from us is in their objectives, which lead them to produce analyses based upon explicit political criteria, whereas the politics inherent in academic research is frequently made imperceptible by academic discourse. Thebookthatresultedfromourresearch(Bolaños,Ramos,Rappaport, andMiñana2004)drawsitsthreeconceptualthreadsfromthepoliticalprogramof pebi :communitycontrol(aneducationalprogramthatstimulates communityorganizing),interculturalism(theconstructionofaninterculturaldialogueframedbyindigenousvalues),andcosmovision(theneedto maintainharmonyintheuniverse).Allthreeguidingideashavebeenembracedthroughoutthecontinentbyethnicorganizationsand ngo s;however, we instrumentalized them in our narration of pebi history by emphasizingthespecificconstellationofpoliticalcontextsinwhichtheywere articulated.Communitycontrolprovidedtheconceptualframeworkfora chapterdealingwithhowandwhyeducationispoliticsfor cric .Theconceptofinterculturalismallowedustotakeacriticallookatrelationsover timebetweennonindigenouscollaboratorsandNativeactivists.Cosmovision,embodiedinacreationstorygeneratedthroughcollectiveresearchby pebi withalmost twohundredshamans, provideduswithanalternative historicalchronologyrootedinhownotionsofcultureevolvedwithinthe organization.
Collaboration and Historical Writing 137
Joanne: The way I visualize the interaction of the three conceptual threads we selected is that community control provides the political foundations for the educational activities in which PEBI has always engaged. Interculturalism allows for an outward-looking orientation, permitting educational activists to never lose sight of the larger picture, the fact that education is part of a general political struggle for recognition as participants in the construction of the Colombian nation. Cosmovision provides the tools for an introspective orientation that values indigenous lifeways and ideologies, providing a specific cultural framework for interculturalism and, ultimately, for political action. Abelardo: Our organizing strategy has always consisted in strengthening an indigenous cultural identity that has been impacted by colonization. This objective cannot be undertaken without the participation of the community, yet it also permits us to relate to other peoples and resolve our problems in conjunction with them. Our concept of identity is intimately related to one of community power. This is a principal axis in our political work and must necessarily mediate our analysis of our historical experience. The notion of interculturalism is related to the conceptual thread of community control. Cauca is a multicultural province, one in which the future of the Nasa people can be strengthened only by forging links of cooperation with other indigenous groups as well as with the rest of the social fabric, including mestizo peasants, Afrodescendants, and popular urban sectors. This means that we must stake out a clear intercultural position founded in respect and the sharing of survival strategies. Interculturalism is profoundly political for us: it leads us to demand that we be recognized as culturally different peoples and as national actors. Cosmovision is the accumulation of ancestral knowledge that, from our point of view, affords us important tools for interacting with others. Cosmovision defines our cultural difference, marking our participation in a diverse nation. It is only through recourse to cosmovision that we can put interculturalism into practice because cosmovision provides us with the conceptual model that permits us to act as Natives.
Joanne: Each of us experienced conceptual conflicts in the course of the process. Once having constructed our conceptual framework, we began the task of historical interpretation. It was not an easy process. Having opted for a retrospective approach, as opposed to a systematic organizational analysis, we had to construct a narrative of the evolution of the three unifying concepts. That meant accepting that some of these concepts, particularly 138 JoannerappaportanDabelarDoraMos
cosmovision and interculturalism, were only incipient during the first decade of the organization, not full-blown as we observe them today. Cosmovision was a particularly difficult concept to historicize. As it is articulated today, cosmovision is the product of an intensive research process that was undertaken in the 1990s, giving rise to an integrated cosmology and ritual complex that is being adopted by Nasa communities throughout Cauca. It is thus a recent arrival on the scene in the sense that although much of this knowledge existed among shamans, it was piecemeal and had never been verbalized in a coherent narrative. Cosmovision is an attempt to integrate cosmological knowledge and to give it a didactic form that can be internalized by the indigenous population. The challenge for us, as historians, was to explicate the origins and evolution of this concept without denying the millenarian existence of cosmological knowledge. But cosmovision was not the only sticking point we encountered. Abelardo: My personal preoccupation, as both an actor in and an interpreter of the process, was with transcending anecdotal narrative. This meant negotiating the constant tension I felt between these two roles, which implied a movement between orality and writing. The founding leaders of CriC eloquently expressed their political thought orally. With the exception of Manuel Quintín Lame, the elders had no experience in writing down their ideas.14 Therefore, in the development of a contestatory political process writing was not necessarily a task of the leadership, although they controlled the written production of other indigenous activists and of the nonindigenous collaborators. I was educated in such contexts, not as a leader, but as a cultural activist, a role that implied a command of written communication. Because Nasa Yuwe was my first language, my entry into the activity of written reflection has been an ongoing process, one in which my training as an activist unfolded parallel to the development of my literate sensibilities. I have written works in various genres, including educational documents, texts inspired by Nasa mythology, and linguistic analysis. But this was the first time in my experience that I was to participate in the production of a historical narrative, a story in which I was also an actor. For me, writing the history of PeBi has been a process of confronting the difficulties of thinking retrospectively in dialogue with other team members. I had to strive to transcend a recounting of everyday experience, which was what I, as an actor, could most easily narrate. Instead, I had to attempt to elaborate an interpretation that included, simultaneously, my own experiCollaboration and Historical Writing 139
ence, the objectives of the bilingual teachers and PeBi activists who formulated our guiding questions, and the evaluation of the actions of the elders.15 To weave all this into a written narrative that was pleasing to read and at once preserved the voices of the protagonists and situated them in their historical contexts: all of this forced me to be attentive to my responsibilities within the team. I could not adopt the role merely of an informant but had to exercise political and cultural responsibility, not only as a member of PeBi and of the indigenous movement, but also as a Nasa. I needed to transcend the biases that indigenous actors generally felt toward academics and collaborators, but in addition I had to ensure that what we wrote reflected an indigenous ideology. This was my role: to ensure that in the course of the project the intercultural team maintained the transcendence of the indigenous discourse.
Conclusion What did we learn in the process? That collaboration necessarily implies beingopentoothermodesofthought,todifferentwaysofformulatingresearchquestions,tothepossibilityofpoliticalanalysis.Butthesedifferences donotalwaysariseoutofthefaultlinesbetweenWesternacademicculture andtheradicalculturalalterityofanindigenousresearcher;theymorefrequentlyresultfromthedisparitiesbetweenacademicsandactivists,whose culturaldifferencesaremoresubtleandnotaseasilyrecognizable.Wemust also understand that the political aspirations of cultural activists are frequentlyembeddedwithinaculturaldiscoursethatobscurestheirpolitical nature—atleast,fortheexternalobserver,butnotfortheinternalparticipant.Whatwemustaccomplishistobuildmethodologicalandconceptual bridgesacrossdivergentbutnotalwayscompletelyapparentpositions.This canbeachievedonlybyadoptingaframeworkinwhichacademicanalysis occupiesasecondarypositionthatrespectsanddoesnotviolateorganizationalpriorities;evenifacademiccontributionsintroduceconceptsexternal totheindigenousculture,theobjectiveistointernalizethembyresignifying themthroughtranslation.Ifanacademicacceptstheserules,sheorhealso acceptstheinterculturalorientationoftheproject. Such are the priorities that determined the nature of our work.When weenteredintoconversation,wecametorealizethattheguidingconcepts of pebi history would have toassume adiscourse ofpolitical autonomy,
140 JoannerappaportanDabelarDoraMos
notoneofindigenouscultureandmuchlessoneofanacademicnature.To theorizefromanindigenousperspectivedoesnotalwaysmeanthatcultural alterityisforegrounded,butitdoesmeanthatculturaldifferencemustbe groundedinaninterculturalperspective. ReyChow(1995,180)distinguishesbetweenethnographyandautoethnography by suggesting that the autoethnographer is simultaneously the subjectandobjectofherresearch:assheengagesinstudysheiscognizant ofthefactthatothershavestudiedher,somethingthatChowcallsastateof “being-looked-at-ness.”Autoethnographyistherebymorecontestatorythan conventionalethnography.Inaway,ourhistoryofpebi aroseoutofasense ofbeing-looked-at-ness:thefactofbeinganobjectofconventionaleducationinfluencedcric ’sdesiretoachieveindigenousprotagonism,tobecome asubjectineducation.Equally,thethreemembersofourhistoryresearch teamexperiencedbeing-looked-at-ness.ThiswascertainlythecaseforAbelardo,who,asactorandanalyst,wassimultaneouslyasubjectandobjectof historicalresearch.Butbyvirtueofthecollaborativenatureoftheproject, JoanneandGracielaalsocametoexperiencethiseffect,aseachofuswas exposedtothegazeoftheotherteammembersandofthe pebi collective whosequestionsguidedourwork.Thecomplexdialoguethataroseoutof thisexercisehelpedusunderstandthedeepandmultifacetedmeaningof collaborationandinterculturalism.
Notes Acknowledgments:TheGermanfoundationTerredesHommesfunded cric inits effortstowriteahistoryofitsbilingualeducationprogram.JoanneRappaport’sresearchwasfundedbyaninternationalcollaborativegrantfromtheWenner-Gren Foundation for Anthropological Research during 1999–2002. We thank Florencia MallonandtheUniversityofWisconsinforinvitingustoparticipateinthe“Narrating Native Histories” conference, where this book originated. Portions of this essaywerepublishedinchapter5ofJoanneRappaport’sIntercultural Utopias: Public Intellectuals, Cultural Experimentation, and Ethnic Pluralism in Colombia(Duke UniversityPress,2005);inthisessay,however,therepublishedsectionsappearin dialoguewiththeobservationsofAbelardoRamos,thustransformingtheirintent. 1.TheDuboisiannotionofdoubleconsciousnessaroseataparticularmoment inthehistoryofinterracialrelationsintheUnitedStatesandoutoftheveryspecificintellectualtrajectoryofDuBoishimself.Butnotwithstandingitsoriginsinthe highlypolarizedracialatmosphereoftheUnitedStatesintheearlytwentiethcentury
Collaboration and Historical Writing 141
anditsinsertionintoadiscourseofracialpride,theconceptofdoubleconsciousness presupposes a complex and heterogeneous experience, not a simple essence (Chandler1996,85).Inthissense,itisametaphorthatcanbefruitfullyappliedacross geographicandhistoricalcontexts.Inaworkshopwithsomefortybilingualteachers affiliatedwiththe cric ,theconceptwasreconfiguredaccordingtoindigenouspoliticalprioritiesas“arevaluingofourowncultureasdifference.”Oneoftheparticipantsofferedthefollowingrereadingoftheconcept:“Thepainofbeingindigenous, withalloftheimplicationsofrejectiontowhichwearesubjectedand,atthesame time,prideinbeingdifferent,withaclearanddefinedidentity”(ChocuéGuasaquillo 2000,14).Forananalysisofthisexercise,seeRappaport(2005,chap.1). 2.Theoryisamajorchallengetoday,whenNativegroupsacrosstheAmericas haveproposedthecreationofindigenousuniversities(PanchoAquiteetal.,2004). 3.AbelardoRamosgraduatedfromthisprogram. 4.ThereisnotsufficientspaceheretodescribeotherattemptsatindigenoustheorizationinBolivia(FernándezOsco2000);Guatemala(Montejo2002;cf.Warren 1998,chaps.5,6);andNewZealand(Bishop1994;Smith1999),whichalsopresent richsourcesforthecreationofNativeconceptualtools. 5.BothAllenandFieldemploythetermsovereigntyintheiranalysesbecauseitis afundamentaldemandofNativeAmericans.However,inacountrylikeColombia, whereindigenouscommunitiesexistonthebasisofcolonialroyaltitlesinsteadof treaties,thenotionofsovereigntyisnotasrelevantasthatofautonomy,whichpermitsthemtothinkofthemselvessimultaneouslyasNativepeopleandasColombians. 6.Ouruseofutopiatosignifyadreamthatispartiallyattainablecomesfromthe usageincric itself. 7.Thefinalproductofourresearch(Bolaños,Ramos,Rappaport,andMiñana 2004)wasalsocoauthoredbyCarlosMiñana,ananthropologistattheNationalUniversityofColombiainBogotáwhohasworkedonanumberofpebi projects;Carlos assistedinthewritingofthefinalchapteronpebi ’spedagogicalactivities. 8. We refer specifically here to cric , whose various programs in education, health,agriculturalproduction,andgenderoperatewithinterethnicpersonnel.In theIndigenousAuthoritiesofColombia(aico),aparallelindigenousorganization thatworksinCauca,therearenonon-Nativecollaborators.Instead,nonindigenous supportersformedadistinctsolidaritymovementparalleltoaico ;however,evenin thiscase,researchtakesonthecharacterofaninterethnicdialogue,asthetwoorganizationsenterintocollaboration(Vasco2002). 9. The term traditional authority is used in Cauca to refer to annually elected reservationcouncils(cabildos).Theexecutivecouncilof cric wasrecognizedrecentlyasatraditionalauthorityafteraprotractedstrugglewiththenationalgovernment,entitlingthemtocarrystaffsofoffice,ascabildomembersdo.However,in practicethereisanimplicitdistinctionmadebetweencommunityauthoritiesand líderes(leaders)intheorganization. 142 JoannerappaportanDabelarDoraMos
10. Joanne: Colombian academics are frequently constrained by their institutions in ways that are unfamiliar to those of us who work in U.S. universities. For instance, their research must be approved by the university administration if they are to conduct it during the academic year—which extends for considerably more weeks than in the United States. The constraints that operate upon academics in the United States are more subtle, generated by the venues in which we publish our research. Nevertheless, Abelardo, who has an M.A. in linguistics from a major Colombian university and was trained by French academics, is acutely aware of the ways in which the international academy limits the activities of its members. 11.Until2004, pebi wascalled peb ,theBilingualEducationProgram.Asaresultofresearchintopebi ’shistoryitwasdecidedthatinterculturalismwasacritical componentoftheprogram,andsoitsnamewaschangedtotheBilingualandInterculturalEducationProgram. 12. Joanne: Until the last of the three workshops, the general membership of PEBI did not have an opportunity to discuss the nature of the project. Many of them assumed that it would take the form of a sistematización, a collective analysis of current goals and objectives, evaluating their progress in the different components of the education program. In fact, the guiding questions were prepared with a sistematización in mind. It was only at the third workshop that the idea of writing a history was broached and subsequently chosen as a viable option by the Nasa-speakers at the meeting, who were in the majority. For more on these negotiations and on the nature of the guiding questions, see Rappaport (2005, chap. 5). 13.AuniversalorthographyforNasaYuwewasadoptedin2000.Inanearlier alphabetusedby cric ,Çxayu’çewaswrittenasC’ayu’ce.Wewillcitearticlesinthe magazinethatwerepublishedbeforetheadoptionoftheneworthographyinthe earlieralphabet. 14.ManuelQuintínLamewasaNasaleaderwho,inthefirsthalfofthetwentieth century,organizedindigenouscommunitiesintheprovincesofCaucaandTolima. Hisdemandsformthebasisofcric ’spoliticalprogram.Lamewroteatreatise,Los pensamientos del indio que se educó dentro de las selvas colombianas(Thoughtsofan IndianeducatedintheColombianforests),whichhasbecomeafoundationaltextfor theColombianindigenousmovement(Lame2004[1939]). 15.GracielaBolaños,thethirdmemberoftheteam,alsohadtoconfrontthischallenge,giventhatshewasafoundingmemberofcric .
Collaboration and Historical Writing 143
Jan rus anD Diane l. rus
TheTallerTzotzilofChiapas,Mexico A Native Language Publishing Project, 1985–2002
Between1976and2002theTallerTzotzil(Spanishfor“TzotzilWorkshop”) publishedmorethanthirtybookletsbyindigenousauthorsinTzotzil-Maya, a language spoken by some four hundred thousand people in Mexico’s southernmoststateofChiapas.TheTallerfollowedthemodeloftheBrazilianeducatorPauloFreire(forexample,1969),andtheoriginalpurpose ofthepublicationswastoputonpaperthereflectionsofTzotzil-speakers astheyfinishedliteracycoursesintheirownlanguageasanexerciseinconcientización(consciousness-raisingorempowerment.)1Typicalthemeswere theimportanceofcommunallabor,therevitalizationoflocalfiestas,andthe achievementofindigenouscontroloverschoolsandtownhalls—topicsthat essentiallyfocusedinsideofindigenouscommunitiesandreaffirmedtheir solidarityandcontinuity.Beginninginthemid-1980s,however,asMexico’s economiccrisismadelifewithintraditionalcommunitiesmoreandmore precariousanddroveincreasingnumbersofpeopleintocitiesanddistant labormigrations,theTallerbeganprovidingaspaceinwhichtoexamine Tzotzilpeople’splaceinthelargersocietyandeconomy,todiscusseconomic and organizational alternatives, to explore alternate indigenous-centered histories,andthentosharethosediscussionswithotherTzotzil-speakers. Publications began focusing outward, taking on contract labor on coffee plantations,thestruggleforland,organizationofartisanandagricultural cooperatives,indigenousrightsinthecity,undocumentedmigrationtothe UnitedStates,andreactionstotheZapatistaRebellion. ThisessayisareflectiononthecourseoftheTallerinthissecondperiod. Mostofthequestionsaddressedcouldbeaskedofanypublishingproject: Howweretopicschosen?Howwerethetextscomposedandedited?How
werethepublicationsdistributed?Beyondtheextraordinaryhistoricalcircumstancesofthe1980sand1990s,however,thefactthattheTallerwasin twosensesaninterculturalprojectaddsadditionallevelsofcomplicationto thesequestions. Onthefirstlevel,becausetherewasnorecentprecedentforwrittenas opposed to oral communication within the larger community of Tzotzil- speakers,theveryfactofpublishingraisedquestionsaboutnewversusold cultureamongTzotzilsthemselves.2Who,forexample,hadtheauthorityto beanauthor?Althoughtheyareincreasinglyathingofthepast,inthe1980s therewerestilldeeplyfeltdisagreementsovertherighttowrite—toexpress apublicopinion—oftheyoungasopposedtotheold,womenasopposedto men,andpeoplewhohadnotachievedofficeswithintheircommunitiesas opposedtopeoplewithsociallydefinedstatus.Whatdialectandorthographyshouldbeused?Whatformats,themes,andaudienceswereappropriate? Thatis,wasitbettertopublishmonolinguallyforanindigenousaudienceor bilinguallysononindigenouspeoplecouldlistenin?Weretherethemestoo sensitivetosharewithnonindigenouspeopleorwithindigenouspolitical rivals—ortowriteaboutatall? Onthesecondlevel,questionsarosefromthefactthattheTaller’scoordinators—thatis,we,theauthorsofthisessay—werenonindigenousparticipantsinwhatotherwiseaspiredtobeanindigenousproject.Justwhosecultureandpoliticscameintoplayinmakingchoicesaboutformandcontent, evenwhentheseweremadecollectivelywithindigenouscolleagues?How muchdidourpresenceaffectthewayinwhichpeopleparticipatedinthe Taller—theircomfortwiththemes,linguisticforms,andprocessesofproduction—oreventheirwillingnesstoparticipate?Howmuch,finally,wasa publishingproject,asopposed,forinstance,toaprojectofcommunitydiscussionswithoutawrittenrecord,“ourthing,”itselfaculturalartifact,not tosayanimposition? BythetimewewenttoworkintheTallerwehadlivedforextendedperiods in indigenous communities in Puno, Peru, and in highland Chiapas andwerenotnaiveaboutourstatusasoutsiders.Atthesametime,RigobertaMenchú’sI, Rigobertahadappearedonlyayearandahalfbeforewe began our project, and the arguments about testimonio, representation, andwhetherthesubalterncouldeverspeakinasupposedlycolonialform suchaswriting,withalltheexquisiteself-consciousnessthesearguments wouldeventuallyevokewithintheacademy,hadbarelybegun.3Duringthe 1970swehaddoneextensiveoralhistoryandethnohistoryinterviewingin The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 145
Tzotzilandhadalsoestablishedmanypersonalrelationshipsandalliances withmembersofTzotzilcommunities.ThusweknewthatamongTzotzil- speakersspeakinginTzotziltherewasaninternal,indigenousconversation abouthistoryandpoliticsthatwasnotonlydifferentfrom,butalsoopposed tothewaysthosesamethemesweretalkedaboutinSpanish,evenbythe same people. Through stories and gossip, people discussed and analyzed exploitative labor conditions, repressive government, and discrimination againstIndiansaswellaswaystocombattheseills.Theseconversationshad alwaysexistedandhadjustascertainlyalmostalwaysbeenkeptwithinthe communityofthosewhospokeTzotzil,secretfromladinos(non-Indians). Ourproposal,inallitsstraightforwardsimplicity,wastohelpdisseminate someofthisinternal,face-to-faceanalysis;toencouragecommunitiestotalk witheachotherintheirownlanguageacrosstheregion,withusactingtemporarilyas“midwives”forwhattheyhadtosay. IfourgoalwastohelpTzotzil-speakersexpressthemselvesinprint,however,itshouldalsobeclearthatwehadinterestsandpointsofviewofour own.FromthebeginningofourtimewiththeTaller,wecontinuedtostudy andwriteaboutthedeepeconomicandpoliticalchangesoccurringinrural Chiapas.Wewerecriticaloftheinwardlyfocusedcommunitystudiescharacteristic of most Chiapas anthropology through the mid-1980s, and althoughweappreciatedtheeffortsofotherstopublishinnativelanguages,we werealsoimpatientwiththetendencyofmanywritingandliteracyprojects tostayatthelevelofmythsandanimalstories.Tousitseemedobviousthat Tzotzil-speakingpeoplewerestrugglingwiththesameworldwideforcesthat affectedusaswell.VirtuallyallofthebookspublishedbytheTallerfrom itsinceptionhadbeenprecededbyextensiveconversationsandseminars withincommunitiesabouttheirownhistory;abouttheexploitation,repression, and discrimination they had experienced; and about how they had dealtwiththem.Asmuchaswehopedtocontinuetheselocaldiscussions and to connect them to wider conversations involving others who might pickupandreadabookinTzotzil,wealsolookedforwardtoparticipating inthemourselves,tobeingpartofwhatAndrésAubry(2005)calledthe“co- productionofknowledge.” Itseemstousthatthemostnaturalwaytogettothesequestionsistotake themonchronologically,aswecameuponthem,ortrippedoverthem,in thecourseofworkingintheTaller.Thefollowingessaythustakestheform ofasortofdiary,describinginordertheprojectscreatedbytheTallerduring theyearsofourparticipationandthenprobingtheevolutionofourpractice 146 JanrusanDDianel.rus
witheachnewproject—thatis,thepuzzlesthatarose,and,asbestwecan reconstructthem,thediscussionsandthinkingbehindtheTaller’ssolutions.
Chiapas in the Mid-1980s: Beginning Considerations WhenwestartedourcollaborationwiththeTallerinlate1985,ithadbeen eightyearssincewehadfinishedourlongethnographicfieldworkinChiapas inthemid-1970s.Thefirstchangewediscovered,althoughittookusafew monthstorecognizeit,wasthatwhichwehadformerlythoughtofasindigenous communities’ dissenting, critical, often angry private conversations amongthemselveshadbecomeincreasinglypublic.Bythatpoint,Chiapas’s indigenous communities were deeply immersed in the economic depression,la crisis,whichofficiallydatesfromtheMexicanfinancialcollapseof 1982butwhichinfacthadbeguninthecountrysidealmostadecadeearlier. Theseasonal,oftenmigrant,agriculturallaboronwhichindigenouscommunitiesdependedfortheirlivelihoodshadstagnatedinthemid-1970s,and bythemid-1980sthedemandforworkerswasactuallyslightlylessthanit hadbeenin1975.4ForawhileMexico’sborrowingagainstitsoilreserves hadunderwrittenconstructionprojectsthattookupsomeoftheemploymentslack,butafter1982thatworkalsodisappeared.Underthesecircumstances,indigenouspeoplemaderadicalchangesintheirlivestosupport themselves.Tensofthousandsabandonedtheirancestralcommunitiesin ordertohomesteadlandintheLacandónjungle.Manytensofthousands moremovedintoshantytownsaroundChiapas’scities,citiesthathadnever beforehadsizableindigenouspopulations.Economicchoicesalsochanged lifewithinfamilies.Menbeganmigratinggreaterdistancestofindworkand stayingawayforlongerperiodsoncetheyhadfoundit.Givenmen’sabsences andtheirfamilies’pressingneeds,women,inturn,beganlookingforways tomakemoneyoutsideoftheirhomes.Forthefirsttime,manywomenbecameagriculturalwagelaborersinregionsneartheirhomes.Manyothers turned their traditional weaving and embroidery into artisan goods they couldselltotourists. Mostofall,indigenouspeoplethroughoutthestate,previouslyrenowned fortheinsularityoftheircommunalsocialandculturallives,increasingly joinednewregionwideassociations,someofthemindependentpoliticaland economicorganizations,othersreligiousgroups,bothCatholicandProtestant(Harvey1998;Rus,HernándezCastillo,andMattiace2003,1–26;Collier1994).Someofthesegroupshelpedresettlethosewhomigrated,others The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 147
helpedwiththeproductionandmarketingofnewkindsofgoods,andstill othersorganizedprotestsaboutinjusticesandinsomeregionsevenledland invasions.Therisingreorganizationandreorientationofthestate’sindigenouspopulationarebeyondthepresentdiscussion,excepttotheextentthat theyareathemeofmanyoftheTaller’sbooks.Whatmostinterestsushere isthatbythemid-1980speoplealloverthestatehadbeguntosaypublicly thingsthatinthepasttheyhadsaidonlyamongthemselves.Withoutquite understandingtheextentofthisbreakoreven,atthebeginning,thatitwas abreak,weclearlyhadcomeintoaverydifferentpoliticalandculturalenvironmentfromtheoneinwhichwehadlivedduringthe1970s. Foritspart,theTallerTzotzilhadalreadybegunrespondingtothechange evenbeforewearrived.ThefirsthistoryoftheMexicanRevolutioninthe TzotzilhighlandsproducedbyTzotzil-speakersthemselves,withacute,bitingcommentaryaboutthebehavioroflandownersandthegovernmentduringthedecadesaftertheRevolution(K’alal ich’ay mosoal / Cuando dejamos de ser aplastados;Whenwewerenolongercrushed),wascoordinatedby AndrésAubry,theTaller’sfounder,andpublishedinTzotzilandSpanishin 1982.ThiswasfollowedinFebruary1985byadeeplyfeltbookbytheTaller’s principalTzotzileditorandtranslator,JoséGonzálezHernándezofZinacantán,andhisgreat-uncleAntonioLópezPérez,Zinacantán’sfirstNative municipalsecretary.Thebook(Ja’ k’u x’elan ta jpojbatik ta ilbajinel yu’un jkaxlanetik / Cómo escapamos del control de los ladinos;Howweescapedthe controloftheladinos)wasabouttheircommunity’ssuccessfulfightatthe endofthe1950stooverthrowthestategovernment’scustomofimposing nonindigenous municipal secretaries to supervise the community’s local council.Neitherofthesestories,abouttheRevolutionofthe1910sandthe fightfor local self-government inthe1950s, wasanewone, butinretellingthem,publishingthem,inthe1980stheauthorsofthetwobookswere holdingthemupforreflectionduringanewperiodofdoubtandvulnerability. Wedidnotfullyrealizetheextentofthechangesthathadalreadybegun whenwearrivedinthefallof1985,norcouldwehavepredictedthatanew historical period was beginning. In the new configuration, most Tzotzils wouldnolongerbeoccupiedfull-timeinagriculture,andculturalandpoliticalleadershipwouldincreasinglyswingfromlocalcommunitiestocity andevenregionalorganizations.Afteracoupleofmonthsoftalkingwith our Tzotzil friends, however, we did begin to understand the urgency of theireconomicworries.Inthe1970s,asacouplewithasmallchild,wehad 148 JanrusanDDianel.rus
studiedmigrantlabor,accompanyingTzotzilworkerstocoffeeplantations, sugar-canefields,andcornhaciendas,stayingandworkingalongsidethem for brief periods. We knew that mention of such labor had been left out ofmostethnographiesofthehighlandTzotzils.Itoccurredawayfromthe communitiesthatwerethesitesofresearch,andinanycasewasnot,accordingtomostanthropologists,anitemofNativeculture.5Wealsoknew, however,thatamongTzotzilsthemselvesthatworkhadbeenanimportant topicofconversationinthe1970s,whenitwasamainstayoftheirfamilies’ incomes.Ifanything,itwasanevenmoreimportanttopicinthe1980s,when itwasdisappearing.Wethusdecidedthatourfirstbookletshouldbeabout seasonalmigrantlabor,specifically,coffeelabor,andthewaysitwaswoven intocommunitylife.6Everyonehadastoryaboutworking,andnotworking, incoffee.Asathemethatmightsparkdiscussionsofworkandeconomic change,itseemedideal.Andsoinearly1986webeganinterviewingforAbtel ta Pinka(“LaboronCoffeePlantations”).
1985–1986: “Turning Talk into Paper” Abtel ta PinkawaspublishedinamonolingualTzotzileditioninSeptember 1986andrepublishedinabilingualTzotzil–Spanishversionin1991.ItconsistedofselectionsfromthetestimoniesofcoffeeworkersfromthemunicipioofChamula,threemenandawoman,plusthewivesofthemen,who hadfelttheeffectsofenganche,contractlabor.Inall,thetextsspannedthe periodfromthelate1930stotheearly1980s.Thesectionswereorganizedby theme:theplanters,laborcontracting,thecoffeeworkers’union,lifeonthe plantation,whatitwasliketobethewifeofaworkerwhostayedbehindin thevillage,whatitwasliketobeawomancoffeeworker,andsoforth.After recording and transcribing the open-ended testimonies, several of which weredoneoverseveraldays,themembersoftheTaller—thetwoofusand twocolleagues,onefromthecommunityofZinacantánandtheotherfrom Chamula—editedthetextsandthensubmittedthemtotheauthorsforapproval.Inallbutonecase,thismeantreadingtheentiremanuscriptaloud forthosewhocouldnotread,checkingbothcontentandlanguage.Finally, weaddedphotographs,bothhistoricalandrecent,andprovidedcaptions withadditionalinformationabouttheplantations,suchasthedatesthey werefounded,thenationalitiesoftheowners,thevalueofChiapas’scoffee productionthroughtheyears,andsoon.Thefinalbookletwastwenty-eight pageslong. The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 149
Following the precedent of earlier Taller publications, we printed two hundred copies. Most were sold for thirty cents, far less than the cost of printing them, but we felt it was important that the books have a value.7 Copiesweregiventotheauthorsandtheirfamilies,andmanymore(some forty)weredistributedtoTzotzilschoolteachersandcatechistsforsharing with their classes or community discussion groups ( grupos de reflexión). Tooursurprise,thelargestsinglemarket,however,consistedofthemostly ProtestantsettlersinthecoloniassurroundingSanCristóbal,whobought seventytoeightycopiesforthefullprice.Smallernumbers,perhapstwenty- five,werepurchasedbyresidentsofotherruralTzotzil-speakingcommunities. Thesecondedition,publishedin1991,was,asnoted,bilingualandconsistedoffourhundredcopies.Mostoftheeditionwassoldthroughbookstores,whereitwasstillavailableatthebeginningoftheZapatistaRebellion in1994.Soonthereafter,asoneofthefewpublicationsthatdescribedindigenouspeople’slivesintheirownwords,itsoldout.Overthenextseveral years,partsofthetextwerepublishedmultipletimesinSpanishandEnglish (forexample,PazParedes,Cobo,andBartra,1996;Womack1999,111–18;see alsoCollier1991). Practice: Initial Decisions Voices:Fromthebeginningwesetouttocounterthehomogenizingtendency of typical ethnographies and histories, with their single narrative voice.Beginningwiththistestpublication,allbuttwooftheTaller’spublicationsafter1986hadavarietyofvoices:menandwomen,oldandyoung, and,ifpossible,individualsfrommorethanonecommunity.Inthespecific caseofAbtel,wehopedtoconveythetestimonies’messagethatthesystem ofmigrantlaboraffectednotjustthemigrantsbuttheirentirefamilies,and notonlyduringthemonthsmigrantswereawayatworkbutthroughoutthe year.Lifeincoffeeworkers’communities,hundredsofmilesfromtheplantations,wasorganizedaroundthecalendarofcoffee.Schedulingofcommunityworkdays,planting,fiestas,marriages,andbaptismshadtotakeinto accounttheprolongedseasonalabsencesofadultmen.Everyone’slifewas affected,eventhosewhoneverlefttheirhomemunicipios.Bylettingavariety ofpeoplespeak,Abteltriedtodemonstratethevarietyofwaysinwhichthis impactwasexperienced. On women’s participation:Withonlytwoexceptions,webelieve,women’s voiceswerenotpresentinnativelanguagebooksinChiapasbeforeAbtel, 150 JanrusanDDianel.rus
either in the state projects, or among Protestant and Catholic missionaries’books,orevenintheearlyTallerTzotzilpublications(1975–85).8Nor,as farasweknow,hadscholarlywritingaboutcoffeeworkandothermigrant laborinChiapasevermentionedtheimpactofsuchworkonthewomenand childrenwhostayedathome.Asithappened,however,includingwomen seemedasnaturaltoourcollaboratorsasitdidtous.Menandwomenboth knewthatlabormigrationsaffectedtheentirefamily,andbothunderstood andacceptedthatthepointwastoexploretheexperiencesandhardships ofmenandwomenalike.Indeed,oneoftheformercoffeeworkersencouragedhiswifetocomeforwardwiththepainfulstoryofherfightswithher firsthusbandeverytimehehadtodepartforthefincas.Anotherwoman talkedabouttheeconomicsurvivalstrategiesshelearnedduringherhusband’slongabsences.Stillathirdtoldofthedifficultiesofbeingasingle motherandoneoftheveryfewwomenwhohiredonasacoffeepicker. Monolingual vs. bilingual publication:Becausewestartedwiththeidea thattheseweretobeindigenousbooks,weworkedsolelyinTzotzilonthe first two projects only, Abtel and Lo’il yu’un Kuskat (see below). One unexpected effect of this choice was our almost immediate popularity with urbanProtestants.Manyadultconvertshadbecomeliterateinordertoread theBibleinTzotzil,andbytheearly1980stheywereprobablythelargest singlecategoryofTzotzilreaders.Havinglearnedtoread,theywerecontinually searching for new material, and when it appeared, word spread quicklythroughtheircongregationsandcolonias.Asideeffectofthispopularity,however—andaparadoxicalone,giventhatwehaddecidedtowork inTzotzilpreciselytoemphasizetraditionallanguageandculture—wasthat manytraditionalistsbecamequitesuspiciousofus.Bythemid-1980smunicipiosthroughoutthehighlandswererivenbybitterandbloodyconflicts betweentraditionalistsandProtestants.Manytraditionalists,seeingAbtel (whichmostofthemcouldnotread),concludedthatwemustbeProtestantmissionaries.Werewenotgringos,likethemissionaries?Weregringo missionariesnotthemainproducersofbooksinTzotzil?Wereourbooks notwidelyreadintheProtestantsettlements?Giventhebitternessofthe religiousstruggle,thisassumptioncouldhaveclosedsomecommunitiesto us,particularlyChamula,wherewehadhopedtoconcentrateourefforts. Luckily,twoofthefamiliesthathadcontributedtoAbtelwerethemselves leadingtraditionalists.Althoughatfirsttheywerediscreetabouttheirparticipationinthebook,eventuallytheyhelpeddispelsuspicionsofus.Forour part,weattemptedtocountergossipagainsttheTallerbygivingChamula’s The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 151
leadersfreecopiesofAbtelaswellascopiesofsomeofthebook’shistoric photos.Morethanthat,wemadeaconsciouschoicethattheTaller’ssecond publicationwouldbeanaccountofaChamulauprisinginthenineteenth centurybyoneofthecommunity’smosttraditionalreligiousleaders. Editor-written introductions vs. letting the books speak for themselves:To avoidintrudingintothecontentofthebooks,weresolvedatthebeginning totrytokeepeditorialintroductionstoaminimum.Welimitedourselvesto statingthetimeperiod,thelocationsinwhichthebookswereset,andperhapsbriefdescriptionsoftheauthors.Theonlyexceptiontothisruleinall ofthebookswasthesecondbook,Lo’il yu’un Kuskat. Orthography: Spelling and alphabet in Chiapas’s indigenous languages arestillnotsettled.Since1988governmentandseculargroupshavebeen usingconventionschoseninmeetingscalledbytheNationalInstitutefor AdultEducation(InstitutoNacionaldeEducaciónAdulta,inea ),inwhich we participated. Publishers of Protestant materials, on the other hand— successorsoftheWycliffeBibleTranslatorsandSummerInstituteofLinguistics (Wbt/sil)—who havethe overwhelming majorityofnative languagereaders,useanorthographydevelopedfiftyyearsagoinconsultation withtheInstitutoNacionalIndigenistaoftheMinistryofEducation.The Wbt/sil orthographyismoresimilartoSpanishandwasthuspresumedto bemoreappropriateforliteracyprogramsseekingtouseTzotzilasatransitiontoSpanishreading.AgainstourlargelyProtestantmarket,wechose tousethesimplifiedgovernmentalphabetratherthantheProtestantone. Although the actual differences between the orthographies are slight, the symbolic importance of the choice was enormous. In practice, we found thatreaderswhowerecomfortablewiththeWbt/sil orthographyhadlittle troublewiththeinea variety.Nordidtheyseemtocare.Choosingthesil ’s “missionarywriting,”ontheotherhand,wouldhaveclinchedourassociationwiththeProtestantsandmadeitalmostimpossibletobeacceptedin othercommunities.9Inthelongrun,theacceptanceofaconventionalorthographywillbedecidedbywritersandreaders. Dialect choice:ThereisconsiderabledifferenceamongTzotzil’sstillmutuallyintelligibledialects.Asaresult,amajorconcernofsomeanthropologists andeducationspecialistswhenwewerebeginningtoworkintheTallerwas whichdialectwewoulduseandwhetherthatwouldprivilegesomepeople overothers.Wouldwepickacentraldialect,supposedlyaccessibletomore speakersandreaders,participateinthedevelopmentofastandardizedone, or,ourpreference,transcribedialectsaspeoplespoke?Inthe inea meet152 JanrusanDDianel.rus
ingsonorthographyin1988,JacintoAriasSojom,aTzotzil-speakerfrom ChenalhówhohadstudiedanthropologyatPrincetonandisstillthemost accomplishedTzotzilwriter,arguedthatthiswouldbeworkedoutbythe writersthemselvesastheychosealanguageinwhichtowrite—justashad happenedlongagoinSpanishandotherEuropeanlanguages.Inpractice, wediscoveredthatsophisticatedspeakersofallthedialectsnotonlyunderstood,buttookgreatdelightinmimickingtheothers,intheprocessplayingwithdifferentcommunities’stereotypes.Indeed,farfrompushingfor standardizationoverthepasttwentyyears,writersappeartohavefoundthe differencesamongdialectstobearealresource:afterreadingthreeorfour wordsmostreaderscantellwherethewriterorcharacterisfrom,andoften howoldtheyare,whethertheyaremaleorfemale,andeven,fromtheincidenceandshapingofwordsborrowedfromSpanish,wheretheystandwith respecttomodernizationandpolitics. Photographs:Wesetupadarkroomandwereabletotakenewphotosas wellascopyhistoricalphotostoillustratetheTaller’sbooksandtopresentas giftstoourcollaborators.Almostnoonehadeverseenlatenineteenth-and earlytwentieth-centuryphotographsofChiapas,manyoffamousindigenousleaders,sotheywereagreatconversationopener. Authorship:WhilewemadenosecretofwhoparticipatedintheTaller, ourinitialdecision wasnottoattribute authorship toparticular passages ortheirtranslations.Authors,editors,andhelperswerealllistedalphabetically, by the Tzotzil versions of their names, at the back of the books. In retrospect,weprobablyweretryingtodownplay,perhapsevendisguise,our roles:wewereidentifiedinthelistsofnamesasXalikKurusandTinaKurus, thenamesbywhichwehavealwaysbeenknowninChamula.10Inaddition tothetwoofus,theTallerconsistedofaverysmallpermanentteamwho movedfromoneprojecttoanother.Bothofourlong-termcollaborators, ChepErnantes(JoséHernández)ofZinacantánandXalikKusman(SalvadorGuzmán)ofChamula,hadworkedastranslatorsandfieldassistantsfor ethnographersbeforeworkingwithus.Asforpay,theTallerofferedallofus slightlymoreperdaythanruralschoolteachersmade.
1987–1988: Publishing and Politics InthemonthsafterAbtelappearedtworeactionswerecommonamongthose whoreaditorhearditread.First,manyexclaimed,“Yes,that’sthewayitwas! That’smystorytoo!”Afteralittleprobing,itturnedoutthattheyhadseen The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 153
schooltextsandotherbooksabout“ladinothings”andmayalsohaveseen religioustextsinTzotzil.Butfewseemeventohaveimaginedbooksintheir ownlanguageabouttheirownlives.Indeed,manyproceededtoaskwhy schoolbooksnevertoldhistoryfromtheirperspectiveandexpressedpleasurethat“theirown”historymightbesavedfortheirdescendants.Second, andoftenalmostsimultaneously,manywentontosaythatitwasashame thatladinosandIndianswhodidnotspeakTzotzilcouldnotreadthebook andlearnaboutthe“Tzotzils’truth.”Perhaps,somesuggested,Abtelcould beprintedagain,inSpanish.Evenbetter,saidothers,wouldbeabilingual editionsothatwhileotherscouldreadit,itwouldstillbecleartothemthat itwastheTzotzils’history. Ournextprojectbeganinearly1987withasuggestionfromcolleagues inourumbrellanongovernmentalorganization(ngo)whowonderedifwe wouldbewillingtoundertakeacollaborativehistorywiththemembersof theejido(landholdingcollective)ofLosChorrosinthemunicipioofChenalhó,northofSanCristóbal,asawaytohelphealwhathadbecomeabitter factionalfight.Perhapstheprocessofrecallingwhattheyhadincommon mightdrawthetwofactionsbacktogether.Weagreedtoinitiatetheproject, andlateinthespringof1987wemadeseveralovernighttripstothecommunity.Afterthefirsttrip,wetookalonghistoricaldocuments,agrarianreform files,andmapsaswellasourtaperecorderandbegantalkingaboutthepast withsmallgroupsofeldersonbothsidesofthesplit.Butthefactionalism wasbrutal:peopleononesidewouldseeustalkingwithmembersofthe otherandeithergrillusaboutwhattheyhadsaidorangrilyrefusetospeak tous.Thereseemednowaytogettheleadersofthetwosidestogether,but becausetheywereleaders,itwasalsohardtoworkverylongwithanyone elsewithouttheirhelp.11Aftermanyvisitsandsomeinitiallyveryfruitfulrecordedconversationsoverthecourseoffourmonths,wereluctantlygaveup onanyhopeoffinishingahistoryasacommunityproject. Earlierinthe1980soneofthefactions,lookingforsupportagainstits rivals,whoruledthecommunityinthenameofthestateparty,thePartido RevolucionarioInstitucional(pri),hadaffiliatedforatimewiththePartido SocialistadelosTrabajadores(pst).FollowingtheZapatistaRebellionin 1994,youngmenfromthedominantfactionusedtheirconnectionstothe stategovernmentandsecurityforcestoexpelmanyoftheseformerly pst , nowpresumablypro-Zapatista,neighbors.Trainedbythearmyasparamilitaryforces,someofthesesameyoungmenparticipatedinthemassacrein
154 JanrusanDDianel.rus
the neighboring community of Acteal in December 1997 (see Arias 1984; AubryandInda,1998,2003). ThefirstgroupofurbanTzotziltoapproachusontheirown,inthesummerof1987,wererepresentativesofSanCristóbal’smostlyProtestantTzotzilcolonias.Expelledfromtheirnativecommunitiesbytheirtraditionalist neighborsbeginninginthemid-1970s,oftenfollowingbeatingsanddestructionoftheirproperty,thefirstofthesemigrantshadbytheendofthatdecadebeguntoestablishthemselvesonrockyhillsidesandformerpastures onSanCristóbal’speriphery(seeJ.Rus2005).FollowingMexico’sfinancial collapsein1982,theseoriginalsettlerswerejoinedbysurgingnumbersof otherindigenouspeopledisplacedbytheeconomiccrisis.Attheendofthe 1970s,therewereperhapstwothousandindigenous“exiles”inSanCristóbal, peoplewhowereacceptedasrefugeesbymostofthecity’sSpanish-speaking residents.Bythesecondhalfofthe1980s,however,therewereasmanyas twenty thousand, and Cristobalenses had begun to react xenophobically totheso-calledinvasion.Innewspapers,throughpoliticalcampaigns,and eventothemigrants’faces,ladinostoldthemtheyshouldgo“home”totheir ownmunicipiosandleavetheladinoswith“theirs.”Invitedtoameetingof urbanTzotzilactivists,JantookalongcopiesofAbtel ta Pinka,whichmost hadalreadyseen,aswellashistoricalphotographsfromasearlyasthe1880s ofindigenousmendoingtheconstructionworkonthecity’smostimportantbuildings.Inresponsetoquestions,hementionedthatnotonlyhadthe valleylandbeenpartofMayanstateswhentheSpaniardsarrived,butalso thatinthecolonialperiodindigenouspeoplehadbuiltandpaidforthecity’s manychurchesaswellasprovidingtheworkers,tribute,andfoodthatmade the city’s existence possible. Several of those in attendance became quite enthusiasticaboutthepicturesandaskedifabookcouldbemadetoshow thishistoryandjustifytheirpresenceinthecitytoday.AndsoBuch’u Lasmeltzan Jobel? / ¿Quién Hizo San Cristóbal?(WhoMadeSanCristóbal?)was born.UnlikeanyoftheTaller’sotherproductions,thisonewascomposed bythemembersoftheTallerinconsultationwiththecouncilofurbanmigrants.PublishedinMay1988,itwasabrief,illustratedaccount,inTzotzilandSpanish,ofindigenouspeople’scontributionstothehistoryofSan Cristóbal.Threehundredcopieswereprinted,and,atthirtycentseach,more thanonehundredwerequicklysoldinSanCristóbal’scolonias.Mostofthe restwenttothecity’stwobookstoresandbytheendof1988weresoldout. Forabriefperiodtherewasintenseinterestinthecityaboutwhohadbeen
The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 155
responsiblefortal provocación(suchaprovocation.)AsinotherTallerpublications,thecontributors’names,includingourown,werelistedintheback inTzotzil. During the preparation of Buch’u Lasmeltzan Jobel close questioning about the book and about the pattern of distribution of Abtel by friends inChamulafinallyledustorealizethatwewerebecomingidentifiedwith Protestantactivistsinthecityandthatthismightjeopardizeourabilityto continueworkinginthemoretraditionalistcountryside.Bythistimethe expulsionofProtestantconvertshadspreadfromChamulatoindigenous municipiosthroughoutthehighlands,andastheProtestanturbancolonies becamemoreestablishedandsuccessfulandtheirattractivenesstounemployed rural families grew stronger, animosity deepened (Rus and Vigil, 2007;RusandMorquecho,2008).SinceoneofourgoalsattheTallerwasto encouragereconciliationwithincommunitiesbygettingthemtothinkabout theircommonhistories,webeganlookingforawaytokeepthedoorsopen tobothsides. Thesolutionwehituponwasanotherbook,toappearatthesametime as Buch’u. Entitled Lo’il yu’un Kuskat: Sk’op mol Marian Koyaso Panchin (Kuskat’sStory:TheWordsofMarianKoyasoPanchin;inSpanish,Mariano CollazoPanchín),itwasanaccountoftheChamulas’brief,rebelliousattempttofoundanautonomousmarketandpoliticalcenterinthelate1860s andtheensuingmassacreofitsparticipantsbythestatemilitia(Bricker1981, 260–72).Insucceedingyears,ladinohistoriesandfolklorehadturnedthese eventsontheirheadandsensationalizedthemasanindigenousbloodletting,withfanatical,crazedTzotzilskillinginnocentladinos.Bypublishing Koyaso Panchin’s very accurate oral history of these events, we hoped to countertheinflammatoryversionthatwasstillcurrentinstatetextbooks, servingasanimpliedwarningaboutthedangersofindigenousgovernment. Atthesametime,molMarian(“elderMarian”)wasarespected,conciliatoryfigureamongChamula’straditionalleaders.Bydoingalittlebookwith him,tobepublishedconcurrentlywithBuch’u Lasmeltzan Jobel,wehoped toestablishthattheTallerwelcomedtraditionalists;thatitwasnotaProtestantactivityandwewerenotmissionaries.Weprintedonehundredcopies, andmostweredistributedwithKoyasoPanchin’shelpintheheadtownof Chamula—often as part of a two-book set with Buch’u. The Tzotzils who hadbuiltSanCristóbaloverthecourseofseveralcenturiesandwhohad struggledforautonomyinthe1860swere,afterall,theancestorsoftraditionalistsandProtestantsalike. 156 JanrusanDDianel.rus
Practice: Refinements Bilingual Editions:Bothofthecommunitieswhereweworkedthrough mostof1987specificallyrequestedbookswithbilingualorSpanishtexts.In thecaseoftheurbanProtestants,thereasonforthiswaspreciselythatthey wanted ladinos to read their history and recognize their legitimate claim toashareofthecity.InmakingBuch’u Lasmeltzan Jobelourfirstbilingual publication,wedeterminedthatifweweregoingtousetwo(ormore)languages,theyweregoingtobeonfacingpagesandstrictlyparallel,sentence- by-sentence,paragraph-by-paragraph. Meanwhile,forthoseinLosChorroswhowouldparticipateinourconversations,thetextwasgoingtohavetobeSpanishalonebecauseoneofthe riftsintheejido(althoughnottheonlyone)wasbetweenTzotzil-speakers andTzeltal-speakerswhohadbeenforcedtolivetogetherdecadesearlier. Infact,bothgroupsunderstoodbothlanguages,andaftertheirlongcoexistencehadevenintermarried.ButifwecouldnotpublishinbothTzotziland TzeltalaswellasSpanish,theypreferredthatneitherindigenouslanguagebe used. Practices and politics:IfBuch’uwas,initsbilingualism,morelikelater publications, the simultaneously published Lo’il yu’un Kuskat was in severalwaysananomaly.Becauseanimportantreasonforpublishingitwas tobroachtheideaofbooksinTzotziltotheChamulatraditionalists,itwas monolingual,likeAbtel ta Pinka.Atthesametime,unlikeAbtelandBuch’u butlikethelaterbooks,itcreditedmolMarianastheauthorandevenincluded a photo of him on the title page. In part, this was the result of a changingviewofauthorshipwithintheTaller(apointtowhichweshallreturnbelow).However,itwasalsoapoliticaldecision,tomakeaspublicas possiblethatweandmolMarianhadworkedtogether.Finally,unlikethe booksthatcamebeforeandafter,wecomposedanintroductioninTzotzilto enumeratethewaysinwhichKoyasoPanchin’soralhistoryoftheeventsof thelate1860s—likethoseofotherChamulaelders—differedfromthedominant,ladinoversionandwasmoretruetothelatesthistoricalreconstructions(J.Rus,1983,1989).
1988–1990: Community Collaborations Bythespringof1988wehadbeguntounderstandmorefullytheextentof Tzotzilcommunities’adaptationtothepost-1982crisis.Beyondcolonizing thejungleandmovingintocities,beyonddevelopingnewwaysofmakinga The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 157
living,fromflowergrowingtoproducingtextilesfortourists,highlandTzotzilswerealsoexperimentingwithnewformsoforganization.Mostvisible weretheindependentregionalorganizationsandurbancouncilsmentioned earlier.However,evenwithinapparentlysettledmunicipiosstillconsidered traditional, the structure and orientation of extended families and local hamletswereshifting,challengingageandgenderhierarchies,andeventuallyentrenchedpoliticalpower. Manyoftheselocalchangeswerenotapparentfromoutside.Bythetime Buch’uandKuskatwerepublishedinthespringof1988,however,wehad beendrawnintoaseriesofnewprojectsthatwouldplacetheTalleratthe centeroftheconversationsaboutthesechanges.DianehadbeguntointerviewwomeninChamulaabouttheirresponsestotheeconomiccrisis,eventuallycompletingasurveyofhouseholdeconomicsinaChamulahamletin collaborationwiththewomenofthehamlet(D.Rus1990).Atthesametime, sheundertookin-depthconversationswiththewomenabouthowtheirlives andfamilieshadbeenchangedbythefactthattheirhusbandsandfathers hadtroublefindingwork.Thisledtoabookonthelifehistoryofoneofthe women,MaruchKomes(MaríaGómez),andherroleinbuildingalocal,independentartisancooperative,Ta jlok’ta chobtik ta ku’il / Bordando Milpas (“EmbroideringCornfields,”abeautifulwordplayonthefactthatsinceshe andherhusbandhadstoppedplantingcornshehadbegunembroidering stylizedcornplantsonblousesfortourists). AsMaruch’sstoryrevealed,thecooperativehadbeguninthemid-1980s, aswomenbegangatheringtowatchtheirchildrencollectivelyastheywove andembroidered.Withinafewmonthstheywerepurchasingthreadtogether andsoonthereafterwerestartingtotaketurnscarryingproductsmadeby thegrouptothecitytosell.Bythetimetheycametotheattentionofartisan organizationsrunbystateandnationalgovernmentsin1988,theywerea functioning,independentcooperative(forcomparison,seeNash1993;Eber andRosenbaum1993;EberandTansky2001).Unlikeothertextsaboutindigenouswomenartisans,inBordando MilpasMaruchtalkednotonlyabout herartanditsmeaning,butalsoaboutthedifficultiesindigenouswomen encounteredinworkingwithexternalorganizationsandtravelingtodistant marketswithoutknowingSpanishorbeingliterate.Shealsodiscussedthe profoundchangesinhouseholddynamicswhenwomentookleading,entrepreneurialroles.Finally,shedescribedthedireeconomiccircumstancesthat forcedhertosellhergoodstocoyotes,intermediaries,fullyawarethatby doingsoshewasundersellingherownproductsinthecooperativestore. 158 JanrusanDDianel.rus
ThiswasthehistorycapturedbyTa jlok’ta chobtik ta ku’il,whichwaspublishedin1990withaprintrunoffourhundredcopies.Onehundredofthese weredistributedimmediatelytootherartisansthroughMaruchandhercooperative.Almostsimultaneouslythebookalsocametotheattentionofthe FondoNacionaldeArtesanías(Fonart),thefederalgovernment’sagency forpromotingfolkart,whichinformedusthatMaruch’stestimonywasthe firsttheyhadseenofanativeartisaninallofMexico.Somewhatcontraryto ourintentionsforthebook,Fonart boughtfiftycopiestodistributetoits employeesandmembercooperativesandinvitedMaruch,Diane,andour Chamulacollaborator,XalikKusman,toMexicoCitytopresentthebookin thenationalartisanstore.TopromoteindigenousartandalsoFonart ,they arrangedforMaruchtobeinterviewedonthemorningcultureprogramof thenationalnetworkRadioEducación.Withinashorttime,Ta jlok’ta chobtik ta ku’ilwasrepublishedinSpain,France,andItaly. Jan,meanwhile,atthesuggestionoftheagronomistoftheInstitutode Asesoría Antropológica para la Región Maya, A.C. (inareMac), Alain Retière,beganatwo-yearcollaborationwithfiveconstituentcommunities oftheUnióndeUniones(u du ),anindependentpeasantorganizationconcentratedintheLacandónjungleandadjacentlowlands.Theu du hadahistoryofaggressivelyconfrontingladinoplantersforcontrolofthelandand offarmingandmarketingcollectivelyonthelandstheyacquired(Harvey 1998;Legorreta1998;Leyva2003).Takingadvantageofagovernmentloan- guaranteeprogramthatenabledpeasantstobuyladinohaciendas(aprogramwhich,notincidentally,bailedoutwealthyownerswhosefailingfarms nooneelsewouldbuy),thefivecommunitieshadbought,in1986,thecombined coffee and cattle plantation on which their families had served for generationsasindebtedworkers.By1988theywantedtoproduceamemoir oftheirpassagefromdebtservitudetoco-ownershipoftheplanation,from sufferingforcedlabortodreamsofstartingacheesefactoryandfounding apeasantuniversity(universidad campesina)toteachagriculturalscience andhumanitiestothenextgenerationofthe u du .Atthesametime,they alsowantedastep-by-stepaccountoftheprocessoflabororganizationand strategiclandinvasionbywhichtheyhadfinallyconvincedtheownerto sell.Theyfeltthattheu ducoulduseittoproselytizeotherindigenousrural laborers.TheresultwasKipaltik: K’u cha’al lajmankutik jpinkakutik / Cómo compramos nuestra finca(“Kipaltik:Howweboughtourplantation”),publishedin1990.Aneighty-pagebookbasedonthetestimoniesofmenand womenmembersofthecooperative,withphotographsofcollectivelabor The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 159
andgovernance,halfofKipaltik’sfourhundredcopieswenttothemembers ofthecollectiveandtheu du .Onehundredofthesewereforthemembers themselves,sothatsomeday,asoneofthemputit,“ourgrandchildren’schildrencouldreadabouthowwegotourfamiliesoutofpoverty.”Severaldozen moreweredistributedthroughtheTalleritselfandSanCristóbalbookstores. Therestwereforinternalpromotioninotheru du communitiesandtouse inorganizingcampaigns,oftenclandestine,onotherplantations. Practice Authorship:After1988wedecidedtoattributeauthorshipandeditorship moreovertly,namely,ontitlepages.Theproblemwithnotnamingthoseresponsiblefortextswasthat,intheabsenceofobviousattribution,journalistshadseveraltimescommissionedtranslationsofpassagesfromAbteland thencitedthemwithoutmentioningthesource.Unfortunately,evenwhen authors’namesweregiven,asinTa jlok’ta chobtik,suchpiratingcontinued. Inthemostegregiouscase,aself-describedproindigenoussolidaritygroup inEuroperepublishedtheentiretextandincludedthephotooftheauthor, MaruchKomes,withoutmentioningeitherhernameorwherethetexthad comefrom.Itseemedtousthatindigenous“artifacts,”includingstoriesand testimonies,wereviewedas“naturallyoccurringobjects”that,likerocksor flowers or birds, could belong to whoever “found” them. When we complainedaboutthefailuretoattributeauthorship,weandtheauthorreceived aformalapology.Butwealsoheardfrommutualfriendsthatthereasonno creditwasgivenwasthat“indigenouspeoplearen’tcontaminatedbyideas ofindividualismandproperty”andthatthepreoccupationwithnamingauthorswasoursalone. More on translation:PublishingtestimoniobilinguallyalsoledtoquestionsaboutwhatlevelandtoneofSpanishshouldbeused.Inthepast,representationsofindigenousspeechinChiapas,whetherinfictionortranslationsoftestimonies,hadoftenusedarural,backwoodsSpanish,suggesting an equivalence between rural indigenous people and poor, rural ladinos. Sometextsevenmimicked thegrammatical errorsTzotzil-speakerscommonlycommitinSpanish,suggestingasortofminstrel-speak.Wedecided thatsinceourTzotziltextswereinperfectlyproperandsometimeselegant Tzotzil,theSpanishtranslationsshouldbestraightforwardandcorrect. Beyondtheseconcerns,eachofthetwonewprojects,Ta jlok’ta chobtik and Kipaltik, brought its own demands. From the beginning of our publishingprojecttheeditingwedidwasaimedprimarilyatcuttingrepetition. 160 JanrusanDDianel.rus
Tzotzillanguage,particularlyprayersandformalorritualspeech,frequently coupledwordsandphrases,andoccasionallyrepeatedwholepassagesindifferentwords.Tomakethetextsreadsmoothlyandtoachieveeconomiesin theprintingprocesswehadtoeditoutsuchduplicationbeforethetranslationsweremade.Wealwaysreadtheeditedtextswiththeauthors,manyof whomwereunlettered,andneverconsideredthemfinisheduntiltheyhad agreedtothechanges.Butwedidcut. An amusing result of such editing was that during the national radio interviewaboutTa jlok’ta chobtik,theintervieweraskedMaruchKomesto saytheweaver’sprayerthatappearedattheendofherbooksotheradio audiencecouldhearTzotzilbeingspoken.Whenpraying,Maruchalways closeshereyesandchants,composingthephrasesasshegoesalong,and theyoftenlastfifteentothirtyminutes.Theprayerinthebook,however, hadbeenabbreviatedtothirty-sixshortlines.WhenMaruch’sprayeronthe radiobegantorunbeyondtwominutes,thenthreeheadingforfourwithno signofending,theinterviewerbegantopanic.Howtomakeitstop?Eventually,Maruchunderstoodwhytheinterviewerwasnervousandbrought theprayertoanend.WiththehelpofDianeandXalikKusman,shethen explainedthattherewasnosetprayer,thatwhatshedidwasenumerateand repeatindifferentwaysthehelpshewouldneedwithherworkandaskfor guidanceandpatiencefromGodandthesaints.Althoughonthisoccasion everyonefinallyunderstoodwhathadhappened,insomesensetheoriginalprayerhadbeenviolatedbybeingshortenedforpublication,truncating whattheauthormighthavethoughtthemostimportantpartofherbook. Giventheexpenseofmakingbooksandtheneedtobeconcise,wewere unabletofindanalternativethatwouldmeeteveryone’sideasofwhatmattered. SoonafterworkbeganonTa jlok’ta chobtik,thewomen’sartisancooperativedescribedinthebookbegantoreceiveoffersofloansandgrantsfrom the government. Although they had not sought these funds, the women oftheco-op,includingMaruchKomes,weremorethanwillingtoaccept them.Traditionally,suchgovernmentresourceswouldhavebeenbrokered throughtheregionalindigenouscaciques(politicalbosses)intheheadtown ofChamularatherthancontracteddirectlybycommunitymembers,much lesswomencommunitymembers(RusandCollier2003).Althoughtheproductionofabookwasanentirelyseparateprojectfromtheorganizationof thecooperativethatwasattractinggovernmentfunds(infact,whenwewere askedouropinion,weadvisedcautioninacceptinggovernmenthelp),bythe The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 161
timethecaciquesbecameawareofthecooperative’sfundingthebookhad appeared,andthewomenwereabletousethebookasacallingcardtomaintaintheirindependencefromcaciquecontrol. After1990Maruchandhergroupalsousedthebookasanentrypoint tomakecontactwithngo s,everhopefulthatsuchcontactswouldbroaden theirsupportandperhapshelpthemestablishtheirownstore.Atthesame time,Maruch’spublishedandthereforepublicexplanationofwhyhergroup solditemsoutsidethecooperativestores,intheprocessdrivingpricesdownward,couldhaveendangeredhertiestothegovernmentagenciesandngo s thatsponsoredthosestores.Asitturnedout,however,theyfoundheranalysisinstructive. Finally,outsideoftheirimmediatefamilieswomenhadrarelyexpressed themselvesabouthowtheirinsertionintothemarketeconomyhadaffected theirrelationshipswiththeirhusbands.Maruch’sadmissionthatatfirsther husband and other women’s husbands had tried to destroy the women’s workandendtheirparticipationinorganizationsthatbroughttheminto relationshipswithmestizosintownpotentiallymadehersubjecttomarital problems.Whatactuallyhappenedwasthattheappearanceofthebookand hersubsequentinvitationtovisitMexicoCityhelpedlegitimateherandthe women’snewrolesintheirhusbands’eyes. OurworkonKipaltikbroughtupotherquestions,mostnotablyinregard toediting.Previously,editinghadbeendoneforreasonsofstyleandeconomyofexpression.InthecaseofKipaltikwewerefacedforthefirsttimewith theproblemofeditingascensorship.ThestoryofKipaltikisonenotonlyof thetriumphofagroupofTzotzilsinbuyingtheplantationonwhichthey hadbeenvirtualslaves,butalsooftheirfamilies’century-longfighttorecovertheirland,expropriatedinthelatenineteenthcentury.AftertheMexicanRevolution,fromthe1920stothe1970sthestrugglewasrarelyanopen one.Debt-laborerssabotagedproductionandresistedworkwhentheycould, butthelandownerhadoverwhelmingforceonhissideandwithimpunity couldbeat,expel,andevenkillthosewhodefiedhim.Thebalanceofpower betweenthetwosidesbegantochangeinthe1970s,whendecliningagriculturalpricesledlandownerstoexpelresidentworkersandturncropland intopasturageforcattle.Simultaneously—andnotbychance—independent peasantandindigenousorganizationsaroseandbecameincreasinglymilitant as they pushed back against the landowners’ attempts to expel them from land that had belonged to their ancestors (see Harvey 1998; Toledo 2002;Bobrow-Strain2007;GarzaandToledo2008).Violencebetweenthe 162 JanrusanDDianel.rus
twosidesescalatedthroughoutnorthernChiapas,withindigenousworkers cuttingfences,killingcattle,andinvadingland,whileownersrespondedby gettingthestatepoliceandarmytorepresstheirformerworkersandhiring privategunmen,guardias blancas,todothejobwhenthestatewouldnot. SomeofthepassageswetranscribedinpreparingKipaltikdescribedthefirst realattackonlandownersandtheirladinoemployeesinthisisolatedregion in1974. Aftertheyhadinvadedaneighboringfinca,menfromthecommunities that eventually bought Kipaltik beat the overseer, who had cheated them ofwagesandtreatedthembrutallyfortwodecades,andthenassaultedhis particularlycruel,arrogantwife.Thedescriptionisarawone.Thoseofusin theTallerandothersworkingintheregionwhoweconsulteddidnotknow whattodowithit.Theactsitdescribedwereuglyandcertainlyillegal.Yetthe menwhohadparticipatedwerequiteopenabouttheirdeedsasjustifiedvengeancefordecadesofmistreatment.ItwasanexampleofthekindofrevolutionaryviolencedescribedbyFrantzFanon.Aseditorsandsympathizers, wewereespeciallyconcernedaboutpreservingtheanonymityofthoseinvolved—oftheperpetratorsbutalsoofthevictim,whostilllivedinasmall townnearby.Duringalong,attimescontentiousdiscussion,Janfinallyconvincedthementhatthestoryshouldbecutonthegroundsthatitdescribed thedetailsofacrime,anditwasimpossibletopredictwhatwouldhappenif wecommittedevidenceofittopaper.Cautionprevailed,butwestillwonder whetherwedenaturedhistoryintheprocess.Could,orshould,adifferent decisionhavebeenmade? Elsewhere in Kipaltik, as in the Taller’s other books, individuals and placeswereidentified:landowners,politicians,settlements,andplantations. Therisk,facedmoreoftenbyjournaliststhanbyacademicwriters,wasnot onlythatmanyofthosewhowerenamed orwereidentifiable fromtheir landholdingswerestillalive(certainlytheirfamilieswere),butalsothatthey were still likely to be in powerful positions in the region. Publishing accountsoftheirdeedsmighthavehadnegativeeconomic,political,orpersonalrepercussionsfortheactorsthemselves,forcommunitymembers,or fortheTallershouldtheytakeoffense.Nevertheless,theTaller’spurposewas totrytopresentforanalysishistoryaspeoplehadlivedandrememberedit, andifsuchdetailshadbeenomitteddiscussionwouldhavebeenimpossible. Onlyinthecaseinwhichsomeonecouldbehurtgratuitouslywasaname suppressed.12 AtthebeginningoftheKipaltikcollaboration,thecommunitymadeit The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 163
clearinanassemblythatitwastobeacollectiveproduct,noneofwhich couldbepublisheduntilithadbeenreadandapprovedinsubsequentassemblies.Norwerewetointerviewanyoneseparatelyandrepresentthemas spokespeopleforthegroup.Accordingly,alltheinterviewswereconducted withgroupsofatleastfourorfiveandonoccasionasmanyasfifteenor twenty.JanandXalikKusmaninterviewedthemenoverthecourseofhalfa year,oftenduringrestperiodsoncommunalworkdays.Dianeinterviewed thewomenintheschoolyard.Infact,ahandfulofseniormenandwomen didmostofthetalkingbutneverapartfromthegroup. Thissharing,ordiffusion,ofauthorship—and,inasense,ofresponsibility—seemedtousanotherexpressionofthe u du customsofcollective, consensualdecisionmakingandofprotectingtheidentitiesofleaders,practicesthathavebecomewellknownthroughtheZapatistas.Duringdemonstrations,scoresandevenhundredsofdemonstratorswouldhuddletightly whentheyhadtomakeadecisionsothatnoonefromoutsidecouldsee whowastalkingoridentifytheleaders.Giventheassassinationsofsome 195indigenousandcampesinoactivistsinruralChiapasbetweenthemid- 1970sandlate1980s,thisprecautionwaswellwarranted(BurgueteandMontero,nd.).
1991–1994: Transitions AspublishingventuresandevenaspoliticalprojectsTa jlok’ta chobtikand Kipaltik were successes: widely read by the measure used in indigenous Chiapas,whereprintrunsnumberinthelowhundreds,andusefulasrepresentationsoftheirauthors’projects.Evenastheywerebeingprinted,however,MexicoandruralChiapasalikewereenteringanewpoliticalandeconomicenvironment,onethatwouldeventuallyundothesuccessesofboth MaruchKomes’scooperativeandthecollectivefarmofKipaltik. Attheendof1988CarlosSalinasdeGortaribecamepresidentofMexico andimmediatelyacceleratedthepaceoftheneoliberaleconomicreforms thathadbegunintheearly1980s.Overthenextsixyearshewouldprivatize mostoftheremainingstateenterprises,removecontrolsonforeigninvestment,anddismantlethelawsoncommunallandholdingthathadbeenone ofthetriumphsoftheMexicanRevolution.Almostunrememberedamong these sweeping reforms is that during the first weeks of his term Salinas underminedtheInternationalCoffeeAgreement,thecartelthatmaintained thestabilityofworldcoffeeprices.OneofSalinas’soverallgoalswastohelp 164 JanrusanDDianel.rus
theadministrationofGeorgeH.W.BushconvincetheU.S.Congressand publicopinionintheUnitedStatesofMexico’sworthinessasapartnerin theNorthAmericanFreeTradeAgreement.FromSalinas’sperspectivehis actwaslittlemorethanatokenofhiscommitmenttofreemarkets.Forproducersaroundtheworld,however,includingthoseinMexico,itwasadisaster.Byspring1989theinternationalcoffeemarkethadcollapsed,plunging millionsintopoverty.Amongthosewhoseplansforthefutureweredashed werethemembersoftheKipaltikcollective,wholostthecoffeeincomethey hadcountedontomaketheirmortgagepayments.Forthenexttwoanda halfyears,thecollectivemanagedtosurvivebyobtainingemergencycredit fromvariousgovernmentagencies.Theconditionforsecuringthelastof theseloans,inearly1992,wasthattheelderlypresidentofthecollective,a formerdebt-laborerwhohadfoughtallofhislifefortheland,hadtostand behindPresidentSalinaswithtwootherhistoricpeasantleaders,innative dress,asSalinassignedtheendofagrarianreform.Whenthenewsphotos oftheeventappeared,Kipaltikfractured,andevensomeoftheleader’ssons refusedtospeaktohimorfacehim.Withnocreditforthcomingforthefall harvestof1992,Kipaltik’smembersandtheu du ’sofficersdividedtheland amongthemselvesbeforethebankcouldforeclose.Thecollectivewasdissolved. Althoughthemechanismwasdifferent,theimpactofSalinas’sreforms ontheartisancooperativewasnolessdestructive.Concernedwiththeindependenceandtheincreasinglyoppositionalstanceofthegrass-rootsorganizationsthathadtakenupmuchoftheburdenofsustainingthepoorduring theyearsofgovernmentneglectafterthefinancialcrisisof1982,theSalinas governmentcameintoofficewithaplantobuybacktheirloyalty:theProgramaNacionaldeSolidaridad(NationalSolidarityProgram—pronasol ) (Dresser1991).Inreturnforaffiliatingwithgovernmentorganizationsand confederations of organizations, pronasol funneled to so-called populargroupsashareoftheprofitsfromtheprivatizationofstate-ownedbusinesses.InthecaseofMaruchKomes’scooperative,thisaidcameintheform ofalargeloancomposedofinferiormaterialsandacomplicatedscheme tyingrepaymenttogovernmentparticipationinthecommercializationof thegroup’sproducts.Tocementtherelationship,womeninthecooperative werealsocompelledtoparticipatein pri electoralcampaignsin1988and 1991,forwhichpurposetheywerebusedaroundChiapaswithotherbrightly costumedindigenousgroupssothattheycouldtakeaprominentplaceinthe frontrowoftelevisedevents.Unfortunately,thewomen’sproductionwasnot The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 165
sufficienttopaybacktheloansthathadbeenfoistedonthem,andinmid- 1992thestateheldbackboththepaytheyweredueforproductstheyhad turnedoveronconsignmentandthefeestheyhadpaidtoincorporateasan officialcooperative.Thetwolossesaddeduptofarmorethantheyhadever receivedinloans.Theirprotectionasmembersofafavoredcooperativenow removed,the pri bossesoftheirmunicipio,whoresentedthemforhaving madecontractswiththestateovertheheadsofthemunicipio’ssupposedly legitimaterepresentatives,preventedthemfromsharinginanyofthelocal pronasol fundstowhichtheywereentitled.Asaresultofwhattheyconsideredaswindle,manyofthewomenandtheirfamiliesbecamestaunchly anti-pri after1992.Buttheirgroup,whichhadcometogetheroutofcommonneedandgrownintoapowerfulforceinthewomen’slivesthroughthe 1980s,brokeintofactionsthatblamedeachotherfortheirlosses(Rusand Collier2003). IftheSalinasgovernment’sgoalhadbeentoreinintheorganizationsof thepoor,bytheendof1992ithadsucceededinthecasesoftheKipaltikcollectiveandMaruchKomes’scooperative:bothhadceasedtoexist.Although everycaseisdifferent,similarfatesbefellindependentorganizationsacross Chiapas.Ifthiswas“success,”however,theeventualcosttothegovernment wasahighone.Thosewhosepainfullyorganizedprojectsfailedoftenbecame bitter opponents of the government and the pri , and those whose organizationssurvivedwereusuallymoredeterminedthanevertomaintain theirindependence. Atthebeginningofthisperiodofrenewedgovernmentintervention,in thefallof1988,ourfamilymovedbacktoCalifornia.Westillhadprojects andgrants,sothrough1992JanspenthalfofeachyearinChiapasovertwo orthreevisits,andDianetwoandahalfmonthsduringthesummers.Jlok’ta chobtik,Kipaltik,andathirdbook,Slo’il cha’vo’ kumpareil / Cuento de los dos compadres (Story of the two compadres), were finished under these conditions and published in 1990.13 While we did begin two new publishing projectsbetween1990and1993,theincreasingdistressofthecommunities andorganizations withwhichwehadcollaborated ledustospendmuch ofourtimewiththem,talkingabouttherapidlychangingconditionsand discussingalternatives.Beforeanyofuscouldactonthem,however,these conversations,likealmosteverythingelseinChiapas,wereovertakenbythe Zapatistas’invasionofSanCristóbalonNewYear’sDay,1994.
166 JanrusanDDianel.rus
Post-1994: Zapatismo Aftertheeconomicdepressionandofficialneglectofthe1980s,andthenthe assaultonindigenousorganizationsoftheearly1990s—nottomentionthe centuriesofexploitationandhumiliationthathadgonebefore—thearmed rebellionof1994wasalmostoverdetermined.Followinganinitialperiodof confusiononthepartofthosewhowerenotZapatistas,withinafewweeks of January 1 indigenous people throughout Chiapas, indeed, throughout Mexico,rememberfeelingasurgeofpridethatotherslikethemhadoccupied a mestizo city and defeated the Mexican army in initial encounters. Friendsofourssaythatformonthsafterwarduponencounteringotherindigenouspeopleonthesidewalktheysmiledknowinglyateachother,proud oftheiridentity. AlthoughtheypalenexttotheothereffectsoftheZapatistaRebellion,the impactsoftherevoltonindependentprojectslikeourswerealsoprofound. Whiletherewasmorethanenoughtolearn,talk,andwriteabout,forseveralyearsworkingonpublishingprojectswithincommunitiesbecameproblematic.Bythesummerof1994,asthestate’sreactiontotheZapatistasbecameorganized,therebegantobeparamilitarypatrols,assassinations,and randomshootingsthroughoutruralChiapas.Asaresult,whereasformerly ithadbeenourpracticetostayovernightinpeople’shousesandparticipate inlocaldiscussions,nowweworriedaboutbringingunwantedattentionto thosewithwhomwecollaborated. Asidefromanydanger toourselves— which we actually judged to be slight14—we worried about how this surveillanceandviolenceandthereactiontothemmightaffectourfriendsand hosts.Wouldsomeonemistakeusforgovernmentrepresentativesorsubversivosandtakeitoutonourcollaborators?15Asfornativelanguagepublishingitself,inthehighlypolarizedatmosphereofthesecondhalfofthe1990s everyonewasforcedtochoosesides.Inthesummerof1994thegovernment heldmeetingsofnativelanguagewritersandpublishersandsoonafterbegan subsidizingmanyasawayofpromotingtheideathatthestatewas“with”indigenouspeople.TheEjércitoZapatistadeLiberaciónNacional(eZln)and thegenerallypro-Zapatistaindependentpoliticalorganizations,meanwhile, alsopublishedmanifestosandnewslettersinindigenouslanguages—both sidesdemonstrating,parenthetically,thatinjustafewyearswritinginnative language had become a well-established means of communicating across entireregions.16Therewasnoquestionofwhichsideourngo ,inareMac , wasoninthisdivision.Atgreatpersonalrisk,thosemembersofinareMac The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 167
whowereresidentinChiapastraveledtothemostconflictivepartsofthe stateanddocumentedhumanrightsabuses.17Assummervisitors,however, thetwoofuswerenotinapositioneithertosustainacontestatorypublishingprojectortoencourageindigenouscommunitieswhosedangerswedid notsharetodoso.Instead,overthefirstseveralyearsafter1994wecontinuedtomakeopen,publicvisitstoplaceswherewewereknown,concentratinglessonpublishingthanondocumentingeconomicdeteriorationand politicalchange(seeRusandRus2004).18 Nevertheless, two Taller Tzotzil productions did appear during this period.Thefirstwasapairoftranslationsfornonindigenousaudiencesof Tzotzil-languageaccountsoftherebellionof1994anditsaftermath:“Losprimerosmesesdeloszapatistas”(“ThefirstmonthsoftheZapatistas”)(1995) and“Conversacionesinterrumpidas”(“Interruptedconversations,”2000),by MarianoPeresTsu(thepseudonymourpartnerXalikKusmanhadchosen for himself). The two translations present vignettes of indigenous life in Chiapas after 1994. The first told of the emotions and reactions of differentgroupsimmediatelyfollowingtherebellion,andthesecondofevents in an urban colony in the late 1990s as the state tried to reassert control andtheinhabitantstriedtoevadeit.Bothchronicleshavebeenpublished severaltimesinfourcountriesandin2002werepublishedtogetheras“A TzotzilChronicleoftheZapatistaUprising”inGilbertJoseph’sandTimothy Henderson’sMexico Reader(Duke,2002.)Unlikeearlierpublicationsofthe Taller,mostofwhichweretranscribedoralhistories,theseessayswerewritteninTzotzilbyanativewriter;weprovidedonlythetranslationandediting. The second publication, Jchi’iltak ta Slumal Kalifornya (“Chamulas in California”), which appeared in 1996, originated from one of the two projectswehadbegunbetween1990and1993andgrewoutofourcontact withsomeofthefirstundocumentedTzotzilworkerstoarriveinCalifornia. FourhundredcopiesofthetestimoniesofthebrothersManuel,Salvador, and Pedro Pérez were printed, and they were distributed largely through ngo sandchurchesworkingintheTzotzilregion.“Goingnorth”wasstill almostunheardofinruralChiapasinthe1990s,andinadditiontotellinga storythebookattemptedtooffercounseltothoseplanningtomakethetrip. Inadditiontothebrothers’adventuresgettingtoandcrossingtheborder andlearningtosurviveintheUnitedStates,wovenintothestorywasadvice aboutobtainingandsafelyusingfalseidentification,avoidingbeingcheated byemployersorcaughtbythemigra(borderpatrol),andgettinghelpafter
168 JanrusanDDianel.rus
beingdetainedanddumpedbackontheMexicansideoftheborderwithoutmoneyordocuments.Inappendiceswhichwerelatercopiedseparately asflyers,Jchi’iltakalsoprovidedinformationinTzotzilandSpanishabout groupsalongbothsidesoftheborderthatofferedaidtomigrantsandabout therightsofundocumentedworkers. Thebiggestdifferencebetweentheprojectsundertakenafter1994and thosebeforeisthatinthelaterprojectsauthors’identitiesweresometimes hidden.InthecaseofJchi’iltakwehadconductedtheinterviewsinCalifornia, and neither wenortheinterviewees were surewhat pressures the brothers’familiesmightexperienceinChiapasiftheirabsenceanddollar incomewerepublicized.Tobesafe,weallagreedtomasktheiridentities. WhenthebrothersreturnedtoChiapasafterthebook’sappearance,however,andrealizedthatitwascirculatingintheshantytownsandthatXalik KusmanoftheTallerhadbeeninterviewedaboutitonaTzotzil-language radioprogram,theywereproudtoclaimauthorship.Onebrotherlaterused itinhiscampaigntobethefirstindigenousmemberofSanCristóbal’scity council,andinradiointerviewselaboratedonthebook’saccountofhisexperiences.InthecaseofXalikKusman’sownvignettesoftheZapatistaRebellion,ontheotherhand,thedisguisehasbeenmaintainedforyearsbecauseofXalik’swell-foundedfearofreprisalsfromtheladinoauthoritieshe sohumorouslyportrayed.19 Ingeneral,ourpracticehadbeentokeepfromintrudinginthetextswith introductionsandexplanatoryfootnotes.InthecaseofJchi’iltak,however, wherethepurposewasinparttowarnreadersaboutthehardshipsofundocumentedmigration,wefeltitwasnecessarytosaysomethingaboutwhy peoplemigratedandtoelaborateontheconditionsmigrantsfaced.Wealso wantedtoexplainthatmostU.S.citizenswerethedescendantsofmigrants. Abriefsocio-politico-historicalsectionwasadded.Inthecaseofthetranslatedchronicles,introductionswereprovidedtoexplaintheunusualorigin ofthedocuments. ThisbringsthestoryoftheTalleruptothepresent.AlthoughtheTaller neverformallyclosed,itsactivitywanedafterthe1990s.Oneprojectisstillin progress:aTzotzil-languagehistoryofSanCristóbal’sshantytowns.UndertakenincollaborationwiththeTzotzilwriterXalikKusmanin1990,ithad, bythesummerof2009,generatedmorethanthirty-eighthundredhandwrittenpagesoftestimonyandstories.Allthatremainstobedoneisediting andorganization.20
The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 169
Final Reflections Aseconomicandthensocialandpoliticalconditionsdeterioratedduring the1970sand1980s,thetraditionofcriticalhistoricalnarrativeandanalysisthathadalwaysexistedwithinTzotzilandotherindigenouscommunitiesincreasinglytranscendedsocialandculturalbordersandspreadacross Chiapas.Whatnativespeakerstalkingtoeachotherintheirownlanguages hadformerlysaidonlyamongthemselveswasnowincreasinglyexpressedto indigenouspeoplebeyondtheirlocalgroupsaswellastoSpanish-speakers. Information traveled the other way as well, deepening Tzotzil-speakers’ knowledgeofthechangesaffectingallMexicans,notjustthemselves.Bythe secondhalfofthe1980sallofindigenousChiapaswasengagedinanearnestintellectualandpoliticaldebate,aswithineveryfamilydifferentmembers triednewwaysofmakingaliving,organizingthemselves,andeventhinking aboutlife.Whatwasthenewsfromthosewhohadmovedtothecity;hadthey foundworkandplacestolive?Whatofhomesteadinginthejungle,didclearinglandandplantingcoffeeseemtoofferasafefuture?Whataboutthemany independentorganizationsandcooperatives,whatdidtheyoffer?WereProtestantism,initsmanyvarieties,orliberationCatholicismbetterwaysoforganizingandthinkingaboutlifethantraditionalcommunitiesandreligion? Nativelanguagewritingandthebirthofmediacontrolledbyindigenous people were among the by-products of this effervescence. The plantation economy and the community structures bound to it were swept away so quicklythatpeoplewhospokeTzotzilandChiapas’sothernativelanguages hadlittlechoicebuttotalkaboutthechangeanddiscussalternativesintheir own tongues. In the process, they made Tzotzil—including written Tzotzil—notonlyameansofcommunication,butalsoabasisofsolidarityinthe newurbanandnationalenvironmentstheywereentering.Ifweandothers helpingwithcommunicationsprojectsfoundreceptiveaudiences,inturn, thereasonwasnotsomuchourownpersuasivenessasthischangedcontext. Bytheearly2000s,inaregionwhereonlythirtyyearsearliernativelanguagespeakerswereonlybeginningtowrite,universitythesesarenowbeing completedinindigenouslanguages;theinternationalandnationalnewsare translateddailyintoTzotzilandcirculatedinxeroxed“newspapers”inthe market;unregulated,low-powerFM radiostationsbroadcastinTzotzilfrom San Cristóbal’s shantytowns; and the numberofgovernment institutions, churches,ngo s,independentorganizations,andprivatepressesthatpublish inTzotzilandotherindigenouslanguagescontinuestomultiply. 170 JanrusanDDianel.rus
Thinkingaboutindigenouspeopleindevelopingsocietiesfromthecomfortable,urbanizedNorth,itispossibletodespair.“Our”worldissystematicallysqueezingtheirsoutofitsenvironmentalandeconomicniches,in theprocessunravelingtheirsocietiesandwaysoflife.Seeinghowone-sided thischangeisandalwayshasbeen,onemightwellbelievethatthepeopleof smallculturesandlanguagesdonotseewhatishappeningtothem,andthat eveniftheydo,whetherthroughourfaultortheirs,theycannotmakethemselvesheard.ThoseofuswhohavehadtheopportunitytobeindirectcontactwithpeopleinplaceslikeChiapas,however—tohaveexperiencedboth theireagernesstocommunicateandthepoweroftheirideas—areprobably morehopeful.Writingandpublishinginnativelanguagescannotrollback thecurrentglobalorder.Butbygivingasmanypeopleaspossiblethemeans andtheconfidencetoexpresstheirviews,theydomakeitpossibleforever morevoicestojoinourcommonconversation,forthesubalterntospeak.
Notes Acknowledgments: We would like to thank John Burstein, George Collier, María ElenaFernándezGalán,EdwardFischer,ChristineKovic,ÁmbarPast,PedroPitarch, StephenLewis,andJuanPedroViqueirafortheircommentsandsuggestions.ParticularthankstoFlorenciaMallonforhercarefulreadingsandediting.Theessay isdedicatedtothememoryofAndrésAubryandAngélicaInda,whofoundedthe TallerTzotzilin1974andentrustedittousin1985.Fromthenuntiltheendsoftheir livestheysharedfriendshipandcounselandalwaystheirfullestsupport.Wenever stopmissingthem. 1.TheInstitutodeAsesoríaAntropológicaparalaRegiónMaya,A.C.(inareMac ) wasfoundedbyAndrésAubryin1973withthesponsorshipofBishopSamuelRuiz, whofeltChiapas’sliberationistCatholicChurchneededindependentanthropologicaladvice.FollowingtheCongresoIndígenaof1974(Morales1992),inwhichitplayed arole, inareMac actedashostforexperimental,community-directedprojectsin organicagriculture,healtheducation,afurniturecooperative,andtheTallerTzotzil. InitsfirstyearstheTallerorganizedlanguageclassesforclergyandsocialworkers. UnderthedirectionoftheanthropologistJohnBurstein,however,itsoonturnedto providingliteracycoursesinTzotzilcommunities.Thefirstbooklettofollowthese courseswaspublishedinthefallof1976(Aubry1988).Duringourowntimeinthe Taller,fundshavebeenprovidedbytheFrenchComitéCatholiqueContrelaFaim etPourleDévellopement,theEuropeanCommunity,inareMac ’sFrenchsupport group, inareMac ’sChiapasboardofdirectors,headedbyAmadoAvendañoand CarlosRodríguez,andtheJacobsResearchFundofBellingham,Washington. The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 171
2.TherearenoknowndocumentswritteninTzotzilbynativespeakerstoberead by other native speakers from the arrival of Europeans (1524) through the 1940s. Duringthe1940swritingwasreintroducedinTzotzil,asinChiapas’sotherMayalanguages,bythemissionarylinguistsoftheSummerInstituteofLinguistics/Wycliffe BibleTranslators(sil/Wbt).After1951 sil/Wbt linguistsproducedthematerials for the bilingual education programs of the Instituto Nacional Indigenista (ini), whichbecamethesourceofChiapas’snewindigenousliteracy.Thefirstpublishing bynativewritersappearedafterthemid-1970s.AmongthosewhoproducedthismaterialinadditiontotheTallerTzotzilwereTallerLeñateros(1979–)(seenote8);Sna Jtz’ibajom(1982–),foundedbyformerlanguageassistantstoanthropologistswith helpfromRobertM.Laughlin;thewriters’projectofthestategovernment(1982–88), ledbyDr.JacintoAriasSojom;LaCastalia,advisedbyGudrunandCarlosLenkersdorf,whichpublishedinTojolabalfromthemid-1970sthroughthe1980s;theInstituto de Estudios Indígenas of the Universidad Autónoma de Chiapas, which has publishedoccasionallyinnativelanguagessince1985;andvariousirregularprojects ofindependentorganizations,churches,andMexicanuniversitieswithprogramsin Chiapas.Sincethemid-1990s,thenativewriters’ownorganization,celali ,hasalso publishednativelanguagetextsorplacedthemwithotherpublishers.(Formore,see Laughlin1993;Benjamin2000;andPast2005.) 3.Menchú(1984[1983]),inreaction,seeStoll(1999),J.Rus,ed.(1999);Chakravorty- Spivak(1988),Gugelberger(1996). 4.Chiapas’scommercialagriculturerequiredsome125,000seasonalworkersin the early 1970s, and only a few thousand more in the mid-1980s. Meanwhile, the numberofindigenousmenlookingforsuchworkalmostdoubledbetween1970and 1990,from150,000tomorethan300,000(seeCollier1994;J.Rus1995). 5.Thiswastrueofvirtuallyallstudiespublishedbeforethe1980s.Theexception wasRicardoPozas(1952;1962),whoseJuan, the Chamula,althoughclassifiedasa novelwhenitfirstappearedin1948,wasarguablytheMayaregion’sfirsttestimonio. SeeJ.Rus(2004). 6.Originallyweintendedtoproducebothbookletsandtapecassettesofsound documentaries blending the interviews with music. Thinking about all the time peoplespentinminibusesandcolectivos,withtheiromnipresenttapesofranchero music,wethoughttapeswouldbroadenouraudience.Afterafirstexperiment,however,werealizedthatrecording,mixing,producing,anddistributingtapeswasbeyondourcapacity. 7.Atapanelentitledthe“CurrentStateandFutureProspectsofMayaLanguage Literature”attheCongresoInternacionaldeMayistasin1989,therewasanenergetic discussionaboutthedistributionandsaleofnativelanguagematerials.Minimum wageinChiapasisregularlyadjustedtoremainatapproximatelythreedollarsper day,withagriculturalworkerstypicallymakinghalftotwo-thirdsofthatwage,often paidinkind.Potentialreaders’abilitytopayisseverelylimited.ini hashistorically 172 JanrusanDDianel.rus
givenawayitsmaterials,whilethesil/Wbt andmostofthewritingprojectscharged low,highlysubsidizedprices.Forexample,botheditionsofAbtelsoldfortheequivalentoftwentycentsinindigenouscommunities,andthesecondeditionforfivedollarsinbookstores. 8.TheexceptionsbothinvolvedÁmbarPast(1989;1980),andinBurstein,Past, andWassestrom(1979).Pastbegancollectingwomen’sstoriesandlorein1975and hashelpedindigenouswomenpublishcontinuouslysince1979throughTallerLeñateros.Sincethelate1980stherehavebeenanumberofotherwriting,theater,and mediaprojectsmanagedbywomenanddedicatedtowomen’sthemes,amongthem Fortaleza de la Mujer Maya (FoMMa) (1992–), inspired and advised by Miriam Laughlin;andtheProyectoFotográficoMaya,foundedbyCarlotaDuarte. 9.Theprincipaldifferencesbetweentheorthographiesisinea ’suseof“k”versus sil/Wbt ’suseof“c”and“qu”forthesamesound,andslightdifferencesinconventionsaboutglottalstops.Ironically,indiscussionswithMayawritersfromGuatemala attheCongresoMayistaof1989,itturnedoutthattheAcademiadeLenguasMayas deGuatemalachosetouse“c/qu”over“k”becauseinGuatemalathelatterwasassociatedwiththedespisednationalgovernment.InChiapas,thesil/Wbt orthography receivedaboostasauniversalconventionattheendofthe1990swhenBibletranslationsinTzotzilandTzeltal,originallyundertakenbytheProtestants,wereapproved bytheprogressiveCatholicdioceseofSanCristóbal(e.g.,SociedadBíblica1997). 10.OurTzotzilnamessinceourfirstsummerinChiapaswereXalikforJan,and TinaforDiane.Whenweadded“Rus,”Jan’snamesoundedtoTzotzil-speakerslike “XalikKurus,”Tzotzilfor“SalvadorCruz.”Kurusthusbecameourlastname. 11.Mostofthoseononesideweredescendantsoftheejido’soriginal Tzotzil- speakingcommunity,dispossessedbyaladinoplanterinthemid-nineteenthcentury.MostofthemembersoftheotherwereTzeltalspeakerswhoseancestorshad beenbroughttoLosChorrosasdebtlaborersafterthe1890s.Inalltheyearsofinhabitingthesamespace,manyoneachsidespoketheotherside’slanguage,andthere wereevenintermarriages.Butsincethe1970stheyhadjoinedrivalpoliticalparties andbythemid-1980swerelockedinconflict(seeArias1984;AubryandInda1998; HernándezCastillo2001). 12.IntheUnitedStates,whethertousenamesornotisstilldebatedamongoral historiansandtheuniversityandgovernmentofficialschargedwithprotectionof researchsubjects.SeethewebsiteofPerspectivesoftheAmericanHistoricalAssociationfortherangeofviews:www.historians.org/Perspectives(accessed30January2006). 13.Slo’il cha’vo’ kumpareil / Cuento de los dos compadreswasaZinacantecofolktaletranscribedbyourcolleagueChepErnantes.Editedasabilingualchildren’sstory byChepandDiane,withillustrationsbyElizabethRoss,itwaslatertranslatedinto FrenchbyIsabelleDuquesneof inareMac fordistributiontoTallersupportersin France.AfourthbookfromthisperiodwasHistoria de un pueblo evangelista: Triunfo The Taller Tzotzil of Chiapas 173
Agrarista(1993),byRicardoPérez.AladinocampesinofromChiapas’sCentralValley,PérezreadtheTaller’sbooksandthenwrotehisownhistoryofhisProtestant refugeecolony,illustrateditwithhisownsnapshots,andpresentedittotheTallerfor publication. 14.AsidefromexpulsionforinterferinginMexicanpolitics,occasionalheavy- handedsurveillanceandinterrogation,andahandfulofcasesofofficialassault,foreignerswerelargelyimmunetotherepressionafter1994.Thehopethatthiswould besowasthebasisforstationingforeigncitizensinPeaceCampsinthemidstof threatenedcommunities.Thatnonehavebeenkilleddoesnotinanywaydiminish thecourageofpeacecampers,whostill,asthisiswrittenin2006,facetheprospect ofviolence. 15.Thisdidnotapplytoour“home”hamletinChamula,whereoursons’godparentsresidedandeveryoneknewus.Eventhere,however,althoughithadnothingtodowithus,aparamilitarypatrolsurroundedandmenacedaprimaryschool graduationweattendedin1997untillocalmencalmedthemdown. 16.Forthelargercontextofthisshift,seeBenjamin(2000). 17.AngélicaInda,oneofinareMac ’ssixmembers,wastheeZln ’ssecretaryat theSanAndrésPeaceTalks.AndrésAubryworkedfull-timewritingandeditingthe summariesandcommuniquésofBishopSamuelRuizandthemediatorsatthetalks. Atgreatpersonalriskandeventuallycosttotheirhealth,theyalsodocumentedand spokeoutabouthumanrightsabusesthroughouttheperiodafter1994(seeAubry andInda,2003).Stillathirdassociate,MichelChanteaux,aresidentofChiapasfor morethanthirty-fiveyears,wasexpelledfromMexicotwodaysaftertheActealmassacreinDecember1997forhavingbeenthesourceofthefirstnewsreportsthatthe armywasnearbyanddidnotintervene(Chanteaux1999). 18.OutsideofMexicowefeltfreerandlecturedandwereinterviewedfrequently. Wealsohelpedorganizeaninternationalcampaignin1998tokeepChiapasopento scholarsandhumanrightsobserversandtofreeaMexicanscholarwhohadbeen sweptupinamilitaryraid. 19.InconfimationofthecontinuingpowerofXalik’swords,inSubcomandante Marcos’sspeechcelebratingthefifteenthanniversaryoftheZapatistas’rebellionof 1994,hequoteddirectlyandatlengthfrom“Losprimerosmesesdeloszapatistas” (SubcomandanteMarcos,“Sietevientosenloscalendariosygeografíasdeabajo,”reprintedinLa Jornada,MexicoCity,4January2009). 20. Meanwhile, beginning soon after the San Andrés Peace Accords of 1996, AndrésAubrysupervisedthetranslationoftheaccordsandrelateddocuments,more thanonehundredpages,intotenindigenouslanguagesspokeninChiapas,including Tzotzil(Los Acuerdos de San Andrés2003).
174 JanrusanDDianel.rus
decade of the twenty-first century, as globalized indigenous movementscompletedtheirfourthdecadeofstruggle,anewgenerationof Nativeintellectualstookshapeandfounditsownvoice.Asthetwoessays inpart3makeclear,theseyoungerNativeintellectualsarewellversedin postcolonialtheoryaswellasindigenousmethodologies.Theystraddlethe linebetweenactivismandacademicwork,committedandaspiringtoboth. BrianKlopotekandEdgarEsquitarebothcommittedtobuildingwhatis, inessence,an“insider’scritique”oftheaccomplishmentsandlimitationsof Nativepoliticalandintellectualproduction.Butneitherwishesthiscritique tostayonlyinsideNativecircles.Inasense,theydemonstratethatinthenew generationitisimportanttoeschewfalseunitiesinordermorefullytobuild trueandenduringones. In addition to these generational similarities, however, Klopotek and Esquit exhibit the differences generated by their distinct locations in the Americanhemisphere.Whilebothaspiretoaplaceintheacademy,Klopotekismorefirmlyplacedwithinitgiventhecomparativelygreaterpresence thatNativeintellectualshavecarvedoutinacademeintheUnitedStates.The politicalandhistoricalcontextinwhicheachhaslivedisalsoquitedistinct. Klopotekhascomeofageinatimeofantiracistactivismthatisattempting tobuildcoalitionsacrossthedistinctexperiencesofvariousethnicandracial minoritieswithintheUnitedStates.Esquit,ontheotherhand,ispartofthe firstgenerationofMayaintellectualstocomeofageaftertheGuatemalan civilwarof1962–96,whenmorethan83percentoftheapproximatelytwo hundredthousandvictimsofviolencewereMaya.1Heisattemptingtoplace theMayastruggleforself-determinationthatemergedmoststronglyasa reactiontothiscivilwarintohistoricalcontext.Foreach,then,themeaning ofmulticulturalismisdifferent,and,asweshallsee,forEsquititcannotbe separatedfromquestionsofneoliberalism. BasinghisworkonthatoftheMaorischolarLindaTuhiwaiSmith,Klopotek reflects deeply on the double meaning of the phrase “decolonizing methodologies.”Notonlydosomemethodologiesdecolonizeresearchand knowledge,heargues,butwemustalsolearntodecolonizethemethodologiesweuse.Inaddressingtheverysensitiveissueofracismagainstblacks among southern Natives in the United States, Klopotek sees opportunity withinthedangerof“speakingsecrets.”Whilerecognizingthatformany in tHe First
yearssubalternpeoplehavereactedtoacademicresearchersbyclosingranks andnotbeingopenaboutinternalissues,Klopotekalsoconsidersthepossibilitythatspeakingthetruthaboutinternaldivisionsmaybeaformofactivisthealing. Forhispart,EsquitisinterestedinwhospeaksforwhomintheMaya movement.Heexploresthehistoricaldynamicsandoriginsofthepan-Maya movementacrossthetwentiethcentury,focusingonprosperous,educated Maya elites in certain urban regions and among certain Maya linguistic groups,mostnotablytheK’ich’eandKaqchikel.Esquitdemonstratesthat theuseofMayanistdiscoursetoclaimspaceinparticularworlds,suchasnationalpolitics,thatwerepreviouslyclosedtotheMayahasatraditiongoing backtotheendofthenineteenthcentury.HeshowsthatthisformofMaya empowermenthasbeenusedbyMayaelitesinrelationtobothladinosand topooranduneducatedMaya.Whatisdifferentinthepost–civilwarperiod, hesuggests,isadiscourseofpeoplehoodwhich,onemightpresume,has anewethnicinclusivenesstoit.Takingthisinclusivenessseriously,Esquit concludes,meansbeingattentivetoallsectorsoftheMayapeopleandfindingwaystogetbeyondinternalclass,gender,andethnicdifferences.And itisinthissensethattheeconomicproblemsexacerbatedbyglobalization musttakecenterstage.UnlesstheMayamovementtakesaccountoftheways inwhichglobalizationhurtsallthepoor,Mayaandladinoalike,theneducatedMayawhoparticipateinthegovernmentwillultimatelybecomecomplicitinthedeploymentofmulticulturalismasatoolofstatecontrolandin thecontinuedoppressionandexclusionofthepoormoregenerally. Takentogether,then,thesetwoessayssuggestthatamoreopenandself- critical perspective on indigenous cultural and political issues, when formulatedfromwithinindigenousintellectualcirclesthemselves,canprovide newinsightsaboutthepastandnewcluesforthefutureofindigenousactivism.Thiscombinationofunityandloyaltytoone’sgroup,yetawillingness tocriticizefromwithinandtodosoopenly,witheyesonthefuture,isan importantmarkofthenewgenerationofindigenousactivist-intellectuals takingshapeacrosstheAmericas.
Note 1.Guatemala: Memory of Silence,ReportoftheCommissionforHistoricalClarification,http://shr.aaas.org/guatemala.
Indigenous Activism and Debates 177
brian kloPotek
DangerousDecolonizing Indians and Blacks and the Legacy of Jim Crow
ForthepasttenyearsIhavebeendoingethnologicalandhistoricalresearch inthesoutheasternUnitedStatesthatrevolvesaroundfederalrecognitionof Indiantribes.OneofthethorniestissuestonegotiatewithpeopleIinterview hasbeentheplaceofblacknessinsouthernIndiancommunities.Thesubject quicklyraiseshacklesbecauseofthewaysinwhichthepresenceofblacknessunderminesclaimstoadistinctIndianidentity;asaresultofthisand otherfactors,antiblackracismremainsanunresolvedinternalandexternal conflictintheSouth.AsaChoctawwithrootsinLouisianaandanactivistforracialequality,Ifeelobligedtodiscussthematterpubliclytocounter antiblackracismandfreeindigenouscommunitiesfromwhatisultimatelya self-defeatingsupportofwhitesupremacy.Bydoingso,however,IamforcingothersouthernIndianstotalkaboutthematteragainsttheirwilland discussingahistorythatsometimesreflectspoorlyonus.Onthebasisofthe conflictsandmethodologicalproblemsIhaveencounteredinthisprocess,I suggestsomerevisionstoindigenousmethodologiesanddiscusstheimplicationsofthisknowledgeforindigenousstudiesasafield. This essay addresses the stories we are not supposed to talk about, a thoughtthatgivesmepause.Decadesofsubalterngroupstalkingbackto academicshavemadeitclearthatcolonialgazing,airingdirtylaundry,and treatingindigenouspeopleaslaboratoryanimalsunderminethesafetyand integrityofthecommunitiesbeingstudied.Inlightofthesecritiques,indigenouspeoplesandscholarshavedevelopedanewmodelbasedincollaborationwithandrespectforindigenoussovereignty,andscholarstryto beself-criticalandself-aware,ensuringthatscholarlyworkbenefitsthecommunityinsomedirectway.Collaboration,mutualbenefit,andscholarlysup-
portoftribalendeavorsarecentralbothtoindigenousmethodologiesandto myethicalconcernsasanindigenousresearcher.1 ButtheproblemofantiblackracisminIndiancommunitiespresentsa theoreticaloversightinindigenousmethodologiesinacoupleofways.First, indigenousmethodologiesneedtobeabletoaccountforindigenouspeoples asentitieswithblurredboundariesandinternalheterogeneityratherthanas discretelybounded,homogeneouscommunities.Whilescholarshaveoften acknowledgedtheblurredboundariesbetweenindigenousandcolonizing populationsthatresultinmestizaje,middlegrounds,andcolonialdominationinAmericanIndianstudies,wehaveonlyrecentlybecomemorecareful aboutaccountingforthewaysinwhichIndiancommunitieshavecomeinto contactwithothermarginalizedgroupsandattimesreproducedsystemsof oppressionfromthecolonizerswithinourowncommunities.Moreover,we toorarelyaccountforthemultiplicityofsocialandpoliticalpositionswithin acommunity,preferringthesimplicityofwell-intentioneddeclarativestatementsaboutsupportingtribalsovereigntythatcarryasecret,homogenizing, nationalist “conceptual prison” for Indians within them.2 Indigenous methodologiesinsomewaysdependonapresuppositionofatidypower relationshipbetweenatightlybound,oppressedsubjectgroupandaseparate,oppressiveexternalworld,andapresuppositionthatallofthevalues oftheindigenouscommunityareworthyofupholdingandinlinewiththe valuesoftheresearcher.Sowhatshouldwedowhenthatisnottrue?Or, moreaccurately,whatdowedoonceweunderstandthatitis,infact,animpossibility?Canweclassifyascollaborativeworkthatwhichseekstochange thevaluesofacommunity?Inthiscase,Iviewitaspartofapainfulprocess ofdecolonizationandaconversationlongoverdueinIndiancountry,butit raisesthequestionofhowtomaketheseethicalconsiderationsfitintoacollaborativemodel. Thatleadstothesecondareaofconcern,whichisthatinthecontextof U.S.indigenousstudies,weneedtohaveabetterinfusionofthestudyof racemorebroadlythansimplyintheIndian–whitecontext.Inmanyways, thenative–whiterelationshipisunique.WeneedtokeepthisinmindbecauseasafieldU.S.ethnicstudiesdoesnothaveasolidunderstandingof thedistinctionbetweenindigenousgroupsandracialminoritiesandtypicallyfailstoseetheways inwhichthecolonizer–indigenous relationship iscentraltounderstandingotherracialprojects.Atthesametime,Indian studiesasafieldhasfocusedsointentlyonwhatsetsindigenousnations apartfromracialminoritiesthatwehavefailedtofullyaccountforourcom180 brianKlopoteK
monexperiencesasracialminorities.Indiansarepartofaracialsystemthat goesbeyondthebinaryracialrelationshipwithwhitesandbeyondthecolonialrelationship;wearepartofadynamicconstellation,anentiresystemof race,andeverynodeinthatsystemaffectsNativepeopletosomedegree. Weunderstand,forexample,thatwhiteracializationsofIndianpeopleaffecteverythingfromthegovernment-to-governmentrelationshiptotheway Indiankidsaresocializedineducationalsystems.ButIndiansarepartofand participateinanationalconversationaboutrace,andweneedtounderstand morefullyhowracialformationsandindigeneityaretiedtogether,too.How do ideas about whiteness, Indianness, and blackness, for example, shape tribal identities? How were shifting attitudes toward Indians in the 1920s tiedtotheclassificationofChicanosaswhiteinthecensusof1930(Foley 2002)?HowhaveJapanese-andAnglo-Americanmythsofracialequalityin Hawai‘iunderminedindigenousHawaiiansovereigntyefforts(Trask2000)? Stories from my experiences in Indian communities in Louisiana exemplifythecomplexhistoricalrelationsbetweenblack,white,andIndian peoples,butthispatternofantiblackracismisevidentinmanyIndiancommunities in the southeastern United States, as other scholars have documentedextensively.JamesMerrell,forexample,makesthestarklyillustrativestatementinanarticlefrom1984that“asrecentlyas1981,informants onthereservationcalledavoidanceofandcontemptforblacks‘aCatawba tradition’”(1984,374).Similarly,AricaColemandiscussestheRappahannockidentityofMildredLoving,oneoftheplaintiffsinLoving v. Virginia, thefamouscourtcasethatstruckdownVirginia’santimiscegenationlaws. WhilewidelyperceivedasanAfricanAmericanwoman,inaninterviewin 2004LovingdeniedhavinganyAfricanancestry,arguingthat“theRappahannocksneverhadanythingtodowithblacks”(Coleman2006,75).Helen RountreediscussesthewaysinwhichVirginia’sracialpuritylaws,beginning immediatelyaftertheCivilWar,became“averitablecornerstone”ofIndian self-identityinVirginiabecauseofthewaysitdistinguishedthelegalrights ofIndianswithnoAfricanancestryfromthosewithAfricanancestry.3The MississippiChoctaws,atribenotableforitshighdegreeoflanguageandculturalconservatism,historicallyrefusedtoassociatewithblacks(Thompson andPeterson1975,180).TheLumbees,atribewhosestatusassuchiscalled intoquestionbysomewhothinktheyaremulattoesmasqueradingasIndians,havehistoricallyexhibitedsomeofthesamebehavior,refusingtosend theirchildrentoblackschoolswhentheywerenotallowedtoenrollinwhite schoolsunderJimCrow(Blu2001,62–65).Eachoftheso-calledFiveCiviIndians and Blacks 181
lizedTribesofOklahomahasinvaryingdegreesexcludedpeoplefromtribal enrollmentbecauseoftheirAfricanancestry,leadingsomeoftheremaining tribalmemberswithAfricanancestrytohidetheirheritagebehindparticularlyloudantiblackrhetoric.4Thelistgoeson,buttheseexamplesshould sufficetoestablishthebroad,deeplysetpatternofantiblackracismamong southernIndiansthatreachesbeyondthebordersofanyindividualtribeor state.Infact,thepatternreachesbeyondthesoutheasternUnitedStatesand beyondindigenouscommunities,tobesure,butIwilllimittheconversation heretomyareaofexpertisetomaketheargumentsmosteffectively.Istate thisattheoutsettohelpframethediscussionthatfollowsandtoshieldtribes Iamdiscussingspecificallyfrombeingsingledoutforanyspecialcontempt theyhavenotearned.Ihopethefactthatweareallinthisnarrativetogether providessomeconsolationtothefactthatIamdiscussingheremattersthat manywouldratherbury.Thisisourcommonheritageascolonizedsubjects ofaracistnation,andthisismyattempttocontributetoourdecolonization.
Research in Louisiana Indian Communities IamaNativeAmericanstudiesscholarratherthanananthropologistora historian,andtheresearchforthisprojectgrewoutofmyinterdisciplinary dissertationinAmericanstudies.Whilecertainlyinformedbyanthropologicalmethods,theories,andmethodologies,myresearchwasneverastrictly anthropologicalendeavor.Myprimarysourceswereoralhistoryinterviews andarchivalresearchfocusingonthefederalrecognitionprocess,though moretraditionalfieldworkduringtenmonthsinLouisianaalsoprovided valuablecontextandpointsofdiscussionthatwouldnothavebeenavailable tomethroughformalinterviewsorarchivalresearchalone. Ratherthanimmersingmyselfinonetribalcommunity,Iworkedwith three tribal communities within an hour’s drive of each other because I wanted to be able to examine their experiences with the federal recognitionprocessfromacomparativeperspective.Thedissertationfocusesonthe Tunica-BiloxiTribe,federallyrecognizedin1981,theJenaBandofChoctaw Indians,federallyrecognizedin1995,andtheClifton-Choctaws,currently petitioningforfederalrecognition.Withinthesetribesandseveralothersin theregion,Iinterviewedtriballeadersalmostexclusively—morethanthirty people who had been involved in the tribal governments or tribal enterprisesinsomecentralwayoverthepreviousdecades—peoplewhoIthought wouldbeabletogivemethemostinformationaboutthefederalrecogni182 brianKlopoteK
tionprocess.Theresultingproductmightbecalledanintellectualhistoryof recognitionactivisminLouisiana.Thisparticulardesignhasitslimitations, butitprovidedinsightsintopatternsofracialthinkingthatwouldnotlikely havebeenasvisiblewithanotherresearchplan. WhilethestoriesofeverytribalcommunityinLouisianacouldsupply ample material for discussion on this topic, I will focus on the Clifton- Choctawspresentlybecausetheyepitomizethedilemmaunderstudy.The Clifton-Choctawsareastate-recognizedtribeintheprocessofpetitioning forfederalrecognition.Somelocaltribesandtribalmemberssupportthe Clifton-Choctaws’bidforrecognitionwhileothersopposeit.Asubstantial partoftheoppositiontorecognitionstemsfromthefactthatsomeofthe membersofthecommunityhaveAfricanancestry,whichmakesthemautomaticallyblack,regardlessofanyotherancestryunderlegalandpopularU.S. racialcodes.Asaresult,theissuebecomescentraltoClifton-Choctawidentityconstruction. WhenIvisitedthecommunitybetween1998and2000,thetribalmemberservingasthefederalrecognitionliaisonandunofficialofficemanager lookedtobeofNative,African,andEuropeandescent,asdidhersonand severalotherfamilymembers.HernamewasMariaDixon,andsheoccupiedapositionofvisibilityandpower,adiplomaticpositionthatinmany waysmadeherthefaceofthetribe.5Iassumedherpresenceinthatposition meanttheClifton-ChoctawswereuninterestedindownplayingtheirAfrican ancestry,despitereportstothecontraryfromoutsiders. During my first interview with her I asked Dixon about the Clifton- Choctaws’ relations with surrounding black and white communities. She said the Clifton-Choctaws have good relations with some blacks, such as the state representative from Alexandria, but that typically distrust flavorstherelationship.ShequicklyaddedthatdistrustalsotypifiesClifton- Choctawattitudestowardwhites.Theyhavegoodrelationswithsome,bad withothers,shesaid,citingconflictswiththesheriff ’sofficeandtheschool boardasexamplesofthelatter.Sheassertedthatperceptionsdependedon theindividualsinvolvedintherelationship,giventhatmanyCliftonpeople distrustoutsidersingeneral,regardlessoftheirrace.Thereisanelementof truthinherstatementaboutdistrustofalloutsiders,butafterabouttensecondsofsilence,anothertruthburstoutfromitsplacejustbeneaththesurface.“Butonthewhole,”Dixontoldme,“theytrustwhitesmorethanthey trustblacks.”6 Settingasideforthemomentheruseofthewordtheyratherthanwe, Indians and Blacks 183
itisclearthatDixonwasabundantlyawareoftheantiblackracismamong herfellowcommunitymembersbutwastrying,nodoubtforanumberof reasonsbothpersonalandpolitical,toconveythatrealityinanunderstated way.Otherleaderstiptoedaroundthesubjectofantiblackracism,too,distancingthemselvesfromit,feelingmeout,withoutnecessarilyperforming anovertdisplayofcontemptforblacks.Consider,forexample,thewordsofa Cliftonmaninhisseventies,amanwhomightpassforwhiteinmanyplaces. Inhisyouth,herecalled,“they’dcallyouRedbone,they’dcallyoumulatto, they’dcallyoueverythingbutprobablywhatyouare.So,wealways,itwasa fightwithuswhenthey’dcallusalltheseothernames,’causewealwayshad beentaughtthatwewasfromIndianpeople.”Thenarrativeimpliesthatthe inaccuracyofthelabelsmulattoandRedbonewasatissue;antipathyhides inthesubtext,whereitisobviousthattheblacknessofthelabelscausedthe offense.TheelementofIndianidentitythatdependedonnotonlyalackof blackancestrybutalsoantipathytowardblacks,itseemedtome,wasaholdoverfromtheoldergenerations,afadingtradition,vergingonbecoming coverteveninthisolderman’sstatementabouthischildhood.Irecognized thatitwasapartofcommunityhistory,butIcategoricallyseparateditfrom themoderncommunity.Ilaterrealizeditwasamistaketotietheseattitudes tospecificgenerationsandassumedecliningacceptanceofthesetraditions merelybecauseofDixon’scentral,visiblepositioninthecommunity. AfterIhadbeenawayfromthecommunityforthreeyears,aseriesof incidentsmademerealizeIhadbeenunderestimatingtheimportanceof antiblackracismandtheextentofcommunitydenialsofblackancestry.In December2003,aspartofthecollaborativeprocessmandatedbyindigenous methodologies,IresentadraftoftheClifton-ChoctawchapterfrommydissertationtoDixonsotribalmemberscouldreadandcommentonitbefore itwasfinalized.DixonhadleftherpositionshortlyafterIsenttheoriginal draft,andapparentlynoonehadseenitthefirsttimearound.Thenewrecognitioncoordinatorwasawhitewoman,thewifeofatribalmemberwhowas eagertoreadthechapter.Isentofftwocopiesandwaitedforthemarked-up copytobereturnedtome.Iwaitedandwaited,butnothingcame.Icalleda coupleoftimesintheinterveningtwomonthsandleftmessagesbutnever heard back. Finally, one day I reached her by phone and asked her what sheandothersthoughtofthedraft.Iwasanxiousbecausecommunityapprovalrepresentsahurdleatleastassignificantasacademicapprovaland infinitelymorechallengingandfraughtwithdanger.Morethanmerecourtesy,collaborationmakesformorerigorousacademicworkbecauseitmakes 184 brianKlopoteK
scholarsaccountabletotheexpertiseandauthorityofcommunitymembers aslifelongparticipant-observers.Thenewcoordinatorwashesitant,andI couldsensethatasignificantcritiquewasabouttoemerge.Shetoldmethat “allthisinformation”wasnewtoherandthatshewasshockedbyit.Iasked herwhatinformationspecificallywassoshocking.Shestartedtalkingina tonethatletmeknowshewaschoosingherwordscarefully.“Youknow,the stuffaboutthe[pause]...muhlahtas.” Shewasreferringtomydiscussionsofblacknessinthecommunity’sancestry,tothefactthatmanyoftheancestorsofcommunitymemberswere identifiedasmulattoesinthecensusof1910,tothehistoryofintermarriage withthenearbyCaneRiverCreolesofColor,tothefactthatIhaddescribed thecommunityasmixedIndian,black,andwhite.Shesaidherhusbandwas angryaboutthischaracterization,butthatheacknowledgedthattheperceptionofhispeopleasmulattoeshadbeenpresentforanumberofyears.She guessedthatmanyothercommunitymemberswouldbesimilarlyangry,but onlyabouttheissueofmixingwithblacks—mixingwithwhiteswascompletelyacceptable. Asitturnsout,shewasright.WhenInextvisitedtheClifton-Choctaw community,shewasnolongerworkingforthetribe,soItalkedwiththe newtribalrecognitioncoordinator.Ibroughttwocopiesofmycompleted dissertationonthistrip:onetogivetothetribalchairandonetothetribal council.WhileIhadmadesomeminoradjustmentsinphrasingtoindicate thatsomeofthecommunityhadAfricanancestryandsomepotentiallydid not,Ididnotremovediscussionsofblacknessaltogether.Italkedwiththe newcoordinator,whowasatribalmember,andtoldherabouttheconcerns ofherpredecessor.Sheconcurredthatitcertainlywouldgooverpoorlywith manytribalmembers,anditdidnotsitwellwithher,either.Shesaidthat blackshadalwaysbeenexcludedfromthecommunityandthatifshehad anysayinthematterthetribewouldupholdthattradition.Shetoldmethat Dixonhadalways,infact,beenmarginaltothecommunitybecauseofher blackness,atroublingstatementthatopenedawindowontoDixon’sexperiencesofbelonginginhercommunity. Ihadaconversationwiththetribalchairabouttheissuelaterthatweek, andshespokeinthemorediplomatictonesIhadheardfromotherofficials, thoughshe,likeothers,expressedconcernthatIhadsuggestedthatthecommunityhadblackancestryandblackculturalinfluences.Perplexed,Itold herIthoughtitwascommonlyacknowledgedthatsomemembersofthe Clifton-Choctawcommunityhadblackancestry,inparticularthroughits Indians and Blacks 185
tiestotheCaneRiverCreolesofColor.Hereyesbrightenedinrecognition andwhatappearedtoberelief,andshesaid,“Oh,well,yes,theCaneRiver Creoles,wedoshareancestrywiththem.”Inlocalterms,theCaneRiver Creoles,whohaveAfrican,French,andNativeancestry,weredistinguished fromblacksbytheirlargepercentageofEuropeanancestry,theirhistoryas freepeopleofcolorandslaveholdersthemselves(whichcarriesconnotations aboutbothraceandclass),theirfrancophonetraditions,andtheircelebrity asbearersofauniquetraditionthatsetsLouisianaapartfromtherestofthe UnitedStates.IncentralLouisiana,theywere“araceapartfromblacks,”certainlyintheirownmindsandtoasignificantdegreeinlocalcustomaswell.7 ThesewerenottheblacksthatmanyClifton-Choctawswereloathtobeaffiliatedwith.FrenchandLatinAmericanstyleracialgradations,whichare multifacetedratherthanbinary,arestillinoperationintheareatotheextent thatthetermsblackandCreole of Colorconnotedifferentsetsofpeopleand differentlevelsofprejudice.Thisclarifiestosomeextenttheprotestationsby Clifton-Choctawsagainstthesuggestionthattheyhadblackancestry. Thoughthetribalchairacknowledgedhercommunity’sconnectionswith the Cane River Creoles of Color, she insisted that whatever racial ancestry the community had, they had been largely isolated from mainstream blackandwhiteinfluencesandintermarriageformanyyears.Thatis,while therewasintermarriagewithCreolesofColorandwhiteoutsidersatvarious points,thecommunityhadbeenlargelyinsular,marryingamongthemselves forthebetterpartof150years.Certainlytherewaswhiteinfluenceand(less so,shepointsout)blackinfluenceinthecommunity,butonsomelevelshe believesadiscussionofblackinfluencesinparticulardiminishesthecommunity’sdistinctiveIndianidentity.Intermsoftheperceptionsofthecommunityandofthefederalrecognitionprocess,whichisatitsheartabout perceptions,shemayberight.
Regulating Racial Categories The origin of antiblack racism among southern Indians rests in Anglo- Americanracismandcolonialism,twophenomenathataresocloselyrelated thattheymightbebetteraccountedforifweunderstandthemasbehavior resulting fromanideologycentered inwhite supremacy—an ideology in whichwhitepeopleandtheirancestorsareunderstoodtobemorally,intellectually,politically,andspirituallysuperiortononwhitesandthereforeentitledtovariousformsofprivilege,power,andproperty.8Thisideologywas 186 brianKlopoteK
forcedonsouthernIndiancommunitiesgraduallybutsurelythroughthe twinhammersofmilitaryconquestandassimilationism.AnumberofscholarshavedocumentedsouthernIndians’adoptionofAnglosystemsofracial thinkingasonecomponentofamultifacetedresponsetoU.S.aggression;in mirroringthepeculiarnotionsofcivilityheldbysouthernAnglosaround raceandgender,tribeshopedtoprotectthemselvesagainstconquestbased onconstructionsofIndiansavagery(Saunt2005,1999;Miles2004;Perdue, 1979,1999;Littlefield,1977).ClaudioSauntsuggeststhatasaresult,racebecame“acentralelementinthelivesofsoutheasternIndians,notjustasa markerofdifferencebetweennativesandwhitenewcomersbutasadivisiveanddestructiveforcewithinIndiancommunitiesthemselves”(2005,4). Thoughtherewasconflictwithinthetribesovertheissuesofslaveryand blackness,southeasterntribesincreasinglyadoptedAnglo-AmericanracializationsofAfrican-descendedpeopleoverthecourseofthenineteenthcentury. Formuchofthetwentiethcentury,segregationpolicieswerethearenain whichtheboundariesofraceandprivilegewereofficiallypoliced,andbecauseofthishistoryineducationalpolicyspecificallyIndiansintheSouth learned to define themselves in ways that distanced them from blacks as much as possible. While there were simultaneous impulses toward isolationism from whites, when southern Indians, of African ancestry or not, wantedaccesstoeducationtheyfoughttohavetheirchildrenenrolledin whiteschoolsandrefusedtosendthemtoblackschools.Ratherthanchallengingtheexistenceofthecolorline,mosttriedtopositionthemselveson therightsideofit.Bysayingtheywouldnotgotoschoolwithblacks,anact ofself-defensetakenwiththeintentionofamelioratingracialdiscrimination against Indian people and maintaining a distinct Indian identity, Indians werecomplicitinthesegregationandoppressionofblacks.9Consequently, antiblackracismseepeddeeperstillintotheconstructionofIndianidentity. TheClifton-Choctaws,likeothersouthernIndians,continuetograpplewith thislegacytoday. Morerecently,federalIndianpolicythatdetermineswhetherpreviously nonfederal tribes should qualify for federal recognition has been amuch clearervenuefortheregulationoftheboundariesofIndianidentity,and byextensioninthiscaseofblack,white,andCreoleofColoridentitiesas well.Blacknessanditsabsencecomeintothefederalrecognitiondiscussion in several ways. The first is the significance of previous recognition from governments,surroundingcommunities,andsocialscientists.10Becauseof Indians and Blacks 187
Anglo-Americanconceptionsofraceandtheone-droprule,anyonewith visibleorknownAfricanancestry(“onedrop”ofAfrican“blood”)wasconsideredblackorcoloredformostpurposes.AnIndiancommunitywitheven asmalldegreeofblackancestryismuchlesslikelyhistoricallytohavebeen acknowledgedasanIndiancommunitybygovernments,socialscientists, and surrounding populations than a community with greater degrees of whiteancestry.11 Thecensusisagoodexampleofthisbiasinhistoricalrecords.Thecensusof1910forRapidesParish,forexample,listsmanyofthefamiliesinthe Cliftoncommunityasmulattoes.12ThespecialIndianScheduleforRapides Parishin1910listsnoneofthesevenfamilysurnamesrepresentedinthe Clifton community in recent years. The census enumerators in 1910 were instructedtousetheIndianSchedules“principallyfortheenumerationof Indians living on reservations or in tribal relations, and also by the enumeratorsincertaincountiescontainingaconsiderablenumberofIndians” (UnitedStatesCensusBureau2002,55).Theyweregivenfurtherinstructions on deciding how to group mixed communities: “Detached Indians living either in white or negro families outside of reservations should be enumeratedonthegeneralpopulationscheduleasmembersofthefamiliesin whichtheyarefound;butdetachedwhitesornegroeslivinginIndianfamiliesshouldbeenumeratedonthisspecialIndianscheduleasmembersofthe Indianfamiliesinwhichtheyarefound.Inotherwords,everyfamilycomposedmainlyofIndiansshouldbereportedentirelyonthisspecialschedule,andeveryfamilycomposedmainlyofpersonsnotIndiansshouldbe reportedentirelyonthegeneralpopulationschedule”(UnitedStatesCensus Bureau2002,56). This presents a problem for the Clifton community. People of mixed black,white,andIndianancestrywereclassifiedasmulattoesbythecensus, undifferentiated from people of solely white and black ancestry. The surroundingpopulationdidacknowledgeIndianancestryintheCliftoncommunitywhentheycalledthemRedbones,aderogatorytermthatconnotes Indian,black,andwhiteancestry,buttheofficialcensusrecorddidnothave acategorytoreflectthatdistinction,whichwouldallowpeopletoconclude thattherecordstatedtheyweresolelyblackandwhiteinsteadofIndian.13 The census enumerator’s decision also reflected the broader AmericanunderstandingthatthepresenceorabsenceofIndianancestrydidnot usuallyalteradesignationasmulatto,atermthatcouldmeananymixof blackandnonblackancestryintheUnitedStates.ThepresenceofAfrican 188 brianKlopoteK
ancestryamonganyoftheCliftonfamiliesmayverywellhaveclosedthe enumerator’seyestothepossibilitythatthismightbeanIndiancommunity asmuchasanythingelse,particularlyifanylinkstotheCaneRiverCreoles wereknowntotheenumerator.14Moreover,JackForbes’sresearchonVirginiacensusrecordsattheveryleastsuggeststhatoneneedstobecautious inassigningAfricanancestrytopeoplelistedinhistoricalrecordsasmulatto.CertainlypeopleofvisibleAfricanancestrywereclassifiedassuch,but sowerepeopleofundeterminedracialancestry.Adesignationasmulattois notinitselfconfirmationofAfricanancestryandcertainlyisnotconfirmationofalackofIndianancestry(Forbes1993).Theonlyfirmconclusionone candrawisthattheenumeratorsbelievedthepeopletheylistedasmulatto shouldnotbeconsideredwhite. Similarly,intermsofpreviousfederalacknowledgmentofIndiancommunities,theBureauofIndianAffairsofthe1930swasextremelydisinclined toservecommunitieswithblackancestrybecauseoftheone-droprule.BureauofficialsexpressedconcernthattheymightbecalledontoserveLouisianaIndianswhowere“mixedwithnegroes”likeother“so-calledIndians inLouisianaparticularlyinTerrebonneParish[inreferencetotheHouma tribe],suchpeoplebeingofvariousracialmixtures.”15BureaurecordsindicatethatblackancestryamongsomeLouisianaIndiangroupsmadeofficials lessinclinedtoserveanyoftheLouisianatribes,buttheydidbrieflyserve thosewhocoulddemonstratethattheyhadnotmixedwithblacks,suchas theJenaChoctawsandtheCoushattas.Thus,tribeswithblackancestrypetitioningforfederalrecognitionareatadisadvantageinthisaspectaswell. Perhapsthemostdifficultrejectiontodealwithisthatwhichcomesfrom otherIndians.WhileseveralTunica-BiloxitriballeadershaveexpressedsupportforClifton-Choctawtribalstatus,someoftheneighboringandnow federallyrecognizedJenaChoctawshavebeenfairlycriticaloftheClifton- Choctaws’claimstotribalstatus.IndividualswithintheJenaBandrespond totheClifton-Choctawsindifferentways,though,soanyimpressionthat theyuniformlyrejectClifton-ChoctawsbecauseofAfricanancestryinthe communitywouldflattenandcompresstherangeofopinionsotherIndian peoplehaveaboutClifton. OneJenaChoctawleaderarguesthattherecertainlyareIndianindividualsintheClifton-Choctawcommunity,butthatthepresenceofIndianancestryinsomeofthemembersdoesnotmakethematribe.Afterattendinga festivalsponsoredbytheLouisianaInter-TribalCouncilinCliftoninthelate 1990s,shenotedthat“oneofthenewleadersorcouncilmembersorsomeIndians and Blacks 189
thing,helookedjustlikeaperfectoldChoctawIndianmanwouldlooklike, youknow,justIndian.Imean,he’sIndian.”Shefeelsthesamewayabout other state-recognized tribes, acknowledging that some members clearly haveIndianancestrybutwithholdingsupportfortheirfederalrecognition. Ifthecommunityasawholecoulddemonstratemoresocial,cultural,and, frankly,racialmarkersofIndianidentity,theywouldseemmorelikeacohesiveIndiancommunitytoher,onethatcouldbeclassifiedasatribe. AJenaChoctawelderaddsthatitisunfairtowithholdrecognitionfrom the“real”IndiansatplaceslikeCliftonandHouma,butbythesametoken itwouldbeunfairtorecognizenon-Indianswiththem.Herdefinitionof whatconstitutesarealIndianisnotterriblycomplex—shebelievesanyone whocantracetheirgenealogybacktoanydocumentedIndiancanbeareal Indian.Anyrelationisreal,shesays,andthatancestrycannotbecutoffor erased. While she was a full blood, her tribe’s minimum blood quantum isone-eighth,andshebelievedthatwouldchangesoonsincemostofthe youngpeopleweremarryingwhitesatthetime.TheClifton-Choctawsmay meetherstandardsfortribalrecognitioniftheycandocumentthattheyall haveatleastoneIndianancestor. Another Jena Choctaw leader believes the Clifton-Choctaws have no Indian ancestry at all and should have their state recognition revoked. Hisopinionrelieson—andcontributedto—agenealogicalargumentthat eruptedin1988betweentheClifton-ChoctawsandMaryCarter,aspecialist inIndiangenealogywhoworkedforbothJenaandClifton.16Carterconcluded,afterresearchingCliftongenealogyforsixmonths,thattheClifton- ChoctawswerenotIndiansbut“really”blackswithsomeIndianancestry. ApparentlyafterarguingwiththespouseoftheCliftontribalchairin1988, Carterwenttothenewspaperswithher“revelation,”leadingtoarticlesthat publiclydeclaredthemnon-Indianposeurs.OneJenaChoctawleaderdescribedthearticlesasbeinghorrible.Thearticlesweresupposedtosaythat theClifton-Choctawswereprimarilymixedblackandwhitewithonlyalittle Indianancestry,butthatfinding,theJenaChoctawleadercontends,ended upbeingdistortedtosaythattheywerenotIndianatall.17 DuringanotherformalinterviewwithMariaDixon,Iaskedherabout accusationsmadeinthosearticlesthattheCliftonswerereallyblackandnot Indianatall.Shebristled:“MaryCartercameupwiththat,whoalsoworked forthetribe.Asamatteroffact,she’stheonethatstartedtrainingmetodo genealogy.Andsheand[aformerrecognitioncoordinator]gotinitabout something,Idon’treallyknow.Andnextthingweknew,shedidhavetwo 190 brianKlopoteK
articles inthepaperabout it....Iwould put itthis way.Wehave documentedourIndianancestry.Now,whether—andI’mnotgoingtosaythere’s noblackbloodinthetribe,becausequiteafewpeopleinthecommunityare triracial.Butthemajorityare—Imean,itallgoesbacktoNativeAmericans. Wehavebeenabletodocumentthat.AndIreallydon’tthinkthere’satribe inLouisianathatcansaythattheydidnothavemaybeadropofblackblood orCaucasianoranythingelsewithinthem.” MembersoftheClifton-Choctawcommunitywhoappeartohaveblack ancestry,peoplesuchasDixon,bearauniqueburdeninbeingdiscriminated againstwithinthetribe,withintheirfamilies.Doubtsabouttribalauthenticitythatarelinkedtoaccusationsofblacknessareplacedontheirshoulders or, more accurately, on their faces. This situation presents an ethical andscholarlydilemma:howdoIencourageClifton-Choctawstoembrace oratleastacknowledgeblackancestryintheircommunitywhenthereisa strongsentimentinthecommunitytodenyitaltogether?Icontendthatit wouldhelptheirrecognitioncaseiftheydealtwiththeirblackancestrydirectly; skirting around it gives the impression they are trying to hide the truth,neveraproductivestanceintheacknowledgmentprocess.Itwould alsohelpeasetheirsenseofshameovertheissueandtakesomeoftheburdenoffphenotypicallyblacktribalmembers.Whatismyresponsibilityasa LouisianaChoctawresearchertothisotherLouisianaChoctawcommunity, ofwhichIamnotamemberbutwithwhomIshareChoctawheritage?How doIimplementthesupportive,collaborativemodelofindigenousmethodologieswithoutunderminingmypersonalresponsibilitiesasaracialactivist?IftheClifton-ChoctawsknowthattalkingaboutAfricanancestryinthe communityhascausedthemproblemsinthepast,Iamputtingmyselfina positionofbetrayingtheirtrustandsayingthatIknowbetterthantheydo abouthowandwhentotalkaboutthesethings. CornelPewewardy,ingrapplingwithhisownroleasanindigenouspersonwithintheacademy,similarlyconcludesthat“sometimeswe(asIndigenousscholars)havetoredefineourrolesasscholarsinacademetobecome involvedasfacilitatorsandinformantsintheprocessoftribalcommunity empowerment.Totakeontheroleoffacilitatoristodenymyownactivism. Imustrecognizethatmyownliberationandemancipationinrelationship withmytribalcommunityareatstake,andthatcontinuedmarginalization andsubjugationaretheperils”(Pewewardy2004,14).Itisinthatspiritof activismfortheliberationofmypeople,ofIndianpeople,fromwhitesupremacythatImoveforwardwiththisdiscussion. Indians and Blacks 191
InTies that Bind: The Story of an Afro-Cherokee Family in Slavery and Freedom,TiyaMilesnotesthatvariousindividuals,blackandIndian,discouragedherfromdiscussingthehistoryofCherokeeslaveholdingandof Cherokeesascolonizedandcolonizingsubjects.Thedesireto“disremember”thesepainfulsharedhistoriesamongcommunitiesofcolorisentangled withcontemporarydesiresandanxietiesaboutimaginedhistoriesof“naturalaffinity”or“naturalanimosity”amongcommunitiesofcolor,theways weconstructraceandrighteousness,thewayswedrawconnectionsorconstructboundaries.Butthereisastorytotell,evenifitis“notastorytopass on,”notastoryanyonewantstorememberoraddresspublicly.18However, asMileswrote,drawingonthetheoreticalunderpinningsofToniMorrison’sBeloved,“Thevoidthatremainswhenwerefusetospeakofthepastis infactapresence,apresencebothhauntinganddestructive.”19Whenweexaminethesehistories,wegainknowledgethatopenswaystoworkthrough thetheoreticalandemotionalconflictsinherentinthesubject.IfIthought thisconversationhadnoimplicationsacrossIndianCountry,Iwouldnot addressitinthispublicforum,butweneedhealingandredemptionaround thisissue.Andweneeddecolonization. Wearedynamicpeople,andwehavethepowertochangeandadaptour strategiesasnewinformationcomestolight.Whenweunderstandthatthe ideologyofwhitesupremacyperformsmultipletasks,divertingmultipleresourcesawayfromoppressedgroupsandtowardwhitesthroughmultiple kindsofbehavior,wecanseemoreclearlythatantiblackracism,whenperformedbyIndians,confirmsaracialformationthatplaceswhitesatthetop ofaracialhierarchy.20Suchanideologyhardlyseemstobeinthebestinterests of Indians, especially when we connect it to the “cultural bomb” describedbyNgugiwaThiong’oasthemostdevastatingweaponofthecolonialproject.Itseffect,hewrites,“istoannihilateapeople’sbeliefintheir names,intheirlanguages,intheirenvironment,intheirheritageofstruggle, intheirunity,intheircapacitiesandultimatelyinthemselves.”21Ratherthan pathologizingIndians,weneedtorecognizethesourceofIndianantiblack racismwithinabroadercolonialprojectandacknowledgeitshiddenimpact notonlyonIndianresources,butalsoonIndiansensesofself. In terms of the scholarly dilemma, the double meaning in the title of LindaTuhiwaiSmith’sfoundationalbook,Decolonizing Methodologies,clarifiesandjustifiestheroleofscholarlyactivisminacasesuchasthis(1999). First,itspeaksofcreatingmethodologiesthatdonotperpetuatecolonial practicesofexploitationandassimilation,thatis,methodologiesthathave 192 brianKlopoteK
beendecolonized.Second,itisaboutpursuingdecolonizationasagoalthat canbeachievedthroughmethodologiesdesignedforthetask,thatis,itis aboutdecolonizingindigenouspeoplesthroughspecificmethodologies.The seconddefinitionmotivatesmydecisiontohavethisconversationinthis essay:adesiretodecolonizemindsandillustratethewaysinwhichantiblack racismsupportsawhitesupremacistracialformation.22Whitesupremacy clearly does not support indigenous people. Its pathology is well known, but,intheabsenceofamoreinclusiveunderstandingofhowraceworks, wedonotalwaysseewhomitinfectsandhow.Racialtheoryandracialhistorieshelpusrethinkindigenousstudies,indigenousmethodologies,and thecollaborativeprocesstobetterserveindigenouscommunities.Decolonizingcanbedangerous,butthatmomentofdangerisalsoamomentof opportunity.
Notes 1.LindaTuhiwaiSmithisoftencreditedwithdevelopingthisfieldasanareaoffocusedstudythroughherbookDecolonizing Methodologies: Research and Indigenous Peoples(1999).Herworkdrawsonandbuildsuponmanytraditionalcritiquesofthe relationshipoftheacademytosubalterngroups,includingtheworkofscholarsin postcolonialstudiesandNativeAmericanstudiesaswellasthewritingsoffeminist womenofcolor,feministanthropologists,andpostmodernists.Generally,seeVine Deloria,Jr.,Custer Died for Your Sins: An Indian Manifesto,(1988,78–100);LilaAbu- Lughod,“WritingAgainstCulture”(1991,137–62);EdwardSaid,Orientalism(1978); NgugiwaThiong’o,Decolonising the Mind(1986);FrantzFanon,The Wretched of the Earth(2004);NannerlO.Keohane,MichelleZ.Rosaldo,andBarbaraC.Gelpi,eds., Feminist Theory(1982). 2.Deloriacritiquesthe“conceptualprison”createdforIndiansbyanthropologists throughnotionsofauthenticityinhisfoundationalworkof1969(1988).PaigeRaibmonoffersausefulhistoryofthedevelopmentoftheconceptofauthenticityandits impactonindigenouspeoplesinAuthentic Indians: Episodes of Encounter from the Late-Nineteenth-Century Northwest Coast(2005).Abu-Lughodarguesthemeritsof “ethnographyoftheparticular”asawayofavoidingtheflatteningtendencyofculturaltheory(1991). 3.AnyIndianpersoninVirginiawhohadmorethanone-quarterAfricanblood (laterone-sixteenth)wouldbeclassifiedascoloredandhaveaccesstofewerrights and resources than those classified as Indians, people who had more than one- quarterIndianblood(laterone-sixteenth)(Rountree1990,200,211). 4.OnCherokees,seeSturm(1998)andMiles(2004).OnCreeks,seeSaunt(2005). Generally,seeMilesandHolland(2006);Brooks(2002). Indians and Blacks 193
5.“MariaDixon”isapseudonym. 6.Aclosereadingofthisstatementwouldnoteheruseofthewordtheytoreferto theCliftoncommunity,whenitwouldseemmoreappropriateforhertousewe.This seemslikeevidenceofdiscomfortinincludingherselfinthatopinionbysaying“we trustwhitesmorethanwetrustblacks.”Butitalsoseemstobealong-standingreflex todistancethecommunity“onthewhole”fromblacksandblacknesseventhough sheisunwillingtoallyherselfwithsuchthinking. 7.(Mills1977,xiv).LalitaTademy,aCaneRiverCreoleherself,wroteabestselling novelandOprah’sBookClubselectionaboutherpeople,givingperhapsthemost visiblemomentinrecentCaneRiverhistory(Tademy2002). 8.Whiletypicallythetermwhite supremacyconjuresimagesofKlanrobesand neo-Naziskinheads,thetermasitisusedincontemporaryethnicstudiesalsorefers totheeverydayideologyofwhiteracialsuperiorityanddominationcarriedevenby peoplewhodonotconsiderthemselvesracistandevenbypeopleofcolor.ForageneraldiscussionofwhiteracialideologyandmaterialadvantagesintheUnitedStates, seeRothenberg(2002)andLipsitz(1998). 9.NeilFoleydrawsheavilyonToniMorrison’sideasaboutsouthernEuropean immigrantsbecomingwhiteintheUnitedStatesbydemonstratingtheirhatredof blacksashegrappleswithsimilarracialformationissuesinMexican-AmericanintegrationactivisminTexasinthe1930s(2002,49–59). 10.SusanGreenbaumadeptlyandpreciselyaddressesthismatter,thoughothers haveaddresseditelsewhere(Greenbaum1991;Paschal1991;Starna1996;Campisi 1991;Clifford1988).AnumberofsignificantcontributionscanbefoundinMilesand Holland(2006)andinBrooks(2002). 11.CirceSturmdiscussesthisissue(Sturm1998). 12.TheCensusof1910,RapidesParish,Louisiana,listsmanyClifton,Tyler,and Smithfamiliesasmulatto.Thisisnotacomplete,diagnosticgenealogicalconnection, butobviouslythesearetheancestorsofatleastsomeofthemodernCliftonfamilies. 13.SeealsoWilliams(1979). 14. United States Census Bureau 2002, 56: “Proportions of Indian and other blood.—IftheIndianisafull-blood,write‘full’incolumn36,andleavecolumns37 and38blank.IftheIndianisofmixedblood,writeincolumn36,37,and38thefractionswhichshowtheproportionsofIndianandotherblood,as(column36,Indian) 3/4,(column37,white)1/4,and(column38,negro)0.ForIndiansofmixedbloodall threecolumnsshouldbefilled,andthesum,ineachcase,shouldequal1,as1/2,0,1/2; 3/4,1/4,0;3/4,1/8,1/8;etc.Whereverpossible,thestatementthatanIndianisoffullblood shouldbeverifiedbyinquiryoftheoldermenofthetribe,asanIndianissometimes ofmixedbloodwithoutknowingit.” 15.A.C.HectortoW.CarsonRyan,Jr.,12September1934,file68776-1931-800, partI,NationalArchivesRecordGroup75. 16.“MaryCarter”isapseudonym. 194 brianKlopoteK
17.“La.TribeFightstoProveItsHeritage,”Times-Picayune,14August1988,C8. 18.Miles(2004,xv),citingMorrison(1987,274–75). 19. Miles (2004, xvi). Miles and many others witnessed the calamity and pain ofthisghostlypresenceataconferenceonblack–Indianrelationssheorganizedat Dartmouthin1998called“‘EatingOutoftheSamePot’:RelatingBlackandNative (Hi)stories.”Severalpieceshavebeenwrittenaboutthedramaticconflictsthatsurfacedthroughout:Phillips(2002);Saunt(2005,6–9);TiyaMiles,“Preface:Eating OutoftheSamePot?,”inMilesandHolland(2006);Warrior,“Afterword,”inMiles andHolland(2006). 20.GeorgeLipsitzsuggeststhevalueofthisformulationinhiswork(1998). 21.Thiong’o(1986,3),citedinSilva(2004,2). 22.FollowingOmiandWinant’sdefinitionofracialformationas“thesociohistoricalprocessbywhichracialcategoriesarecreated,inhabited,transformed,anddestroyed,”andaracialprojectas“simultaneouslyaninterpretation,representation,or explanationofracialdynamics,andanefforttoreorganizeandredistributeresources alongparticularraciallines”(1994,55–56).
Indians and Blacks 195
eDgar esquit
NationalistContradictions Pan-Mayanism, Representations of the Past, and the Reproduction of Inequalities in Guatemala
For over three decades the Maya peoples of Guatemala have been transformingthewaysinwhichtheystruggleagainstcontinuingcolonialpower relationsinthecountry.Localprocessesofprotestarenowaccompaniedby protestswithanationalcharacterthatchallengenotonlythestate,butalso otherdominantideologies,likepatriarchy,ProtestantandCatholicvisions, andcertainpopularconstructionsofhistoryandidentity.Now,newdiscussionsabouttheMaya’snationalpositionoccurbetweendifferentactorsand acrossopposingspaces.Accordingtotheseanalysts’differentconceptions, theso-calledpan-MayanistorMayanmovementisengagedinacomplex processofdefiningdemands,discourses,ideologicalconstructions,diverse formsofpoliticalstruggle,newrelationshipsofpower,andtheconstruction ofotheridentities(Warren1998;Fischer2001;CojtíCuxil1991;Bastosand Camus2003).Asthismovementprogresses,contradictionshaveemerged inrelationtodemands,representativeness,theconformationofintellectual elites,andwaysofimaginingthepast. InthisessayIdelineaterelevantaspectsoftheMayapoliticalmovement, principallythereconstructionofhistoryanditslinktothepresent.TheMaya political movement is primarily guided by an intelligentsia that produces andadoptsaseriesoforganizinganddiscursiveideologicaldefinitionsand strategiesaboutthestruggleinwhichitisengaged.Theseleaders,linkedto debatesonhumanrights,religion,education,languages,Mayarights,and racism,belongtodifferentorganizationsthatgetreorganizedduringeach crisisthemovementsuffers.Theygenerateaseriesofideasandimagesabout theMayapastwiththedoubleaimofpinningdowntheideaoftheMaya
people(Mayaunity)andchallengingtheexclusionarymakeupoftheGuatemalannation-state. Thegeneralquestionsguidingtheessaycanbestatedasfollows:Inwhat way does this emerging sector of educated Maya delimit a new narrative aboutthepast?Howisthisnarrativelinkedtothedefinitionofnewidentitiesandtheformationofunexpectedpowerrelations?BeingaMayaanda researcher,Iampersonallyinvolvedinthisprocessofconstructingimaginaries(imaginarios)aboutthepast. WeunderstandthenotionofMayaasbothaconstructthatevolvedas theMayamovementdevelopedandasatoolfordefiningtheethnicidentity ofthosewhouptonowhavebeencalledindigenous,Indians,oraboriginals (naturales). This definition acknowledges the contradictions and political differencesthatMayaindividualsencounterastheyappropriateotheridentities.TheMayanists,astheyaredefinedinthisessay,arethepeopleand institutionsthatopenlypromoteMayapoliticalrightsandrecoveraculturalistdefinitionoftheirownpast.Theydosowiththepurposeofassigning meaningandgivinghistoricalsupporttothenotionofMayapeoplesand multiculturalism. Finally,sinceIwillbespeakingaboutthecolonialformsofpowerrelationsinGuatemala,IconsiderhowsomeoftheMayamovement’sintellectualshavecharacterizedtheconceptofcolonialism.Someofthemdefine colonialisminrelationtotheGuatemalanstateandladinos,affirmingthat onlyonecommunity,theladino,currentlycontrolsthestate.1Theyassert thatladinosinstrumentalizethestatetocontrolandlimitthedevelopment ofsubordinateindigenousnations.Accordingtotheseintellectuals,Guatemalaisacolonialstatethatmanifestsaninternalcolonialisminwhichone nationalgroupoppressesotherswithinthesameenvironment(CojtíCuxil 1989,140–41). Demetrio Rodríguez posits that colonialism, bydefinition, starts from thepoliticaldomination,economicexploitation,andculturalandlinguistic assimilationofonepeopleoveranotherandinvolvesdiversehistoricalconditions like invasion, conquest, or annexation (Rodríguez 2004, 46). Followingthesamelineofthought,DemetrioCojtíproposesthatcolonialism isadoctrinethatlegitimizesonepeople’sdominationoveranotherandemploys various arguments to justify Maya subordination (Cojtí Cuxil 1995, 148).ThesenotionsattempttoexplainthepoliticalrelationsbetweenindigenouspeoplesandladinosinGuatemala,understandingthelatterasalmost homogeneousentities. Nationalist Contradictions 197
Colonialrelations,however,arehighlycomplexandmustbeobserved atdifferentmomentsandinspecificspaces.Colonialismtraversesrelations betweensocialsectors,genders,classes,regionsandlocalities,institutions, anddiverseorganizations.Inthiscase,onecantalkaboutthecolonialshape ofpowerrelationsinGuatemala,whereclassrelationsarestronglytiedto society’sethnicmakeup,establishingaracialhierarchythatactsasthebasis forexchangeamongsocialgroups.2
Imagining New Histories Intheirarticle“TheMayaWorkshopofHieroglyphicWriting”LindaSchele and Nikolai Grube describe a series of activities related to teaching and learningtheMayas’ancientwritingthattheyandotherepigraphistsdevelopedtogetherwithagroupofMayaactivistsandintellectuals(1999).The authorsnotethatsomeMayaintellectualsrequestedthattheycarryoutdifferentworkshopsfrom1987to1995.Theworkshopstookplaceinthecityof AntiguaandinarcheologicalsiteslikeTikal,Copán,andIximchéaswellas incertainmunicipalitiesandsmallerlocalitieslikeSanAndrésSemetabaj inthedepartmentofSololá.AttendeesattheseactivitiesincludedMayas linkedwithorganizationsdedicatedtostrengtheningandstudyingindigenouslanguages,professionalsinlinguisticfields,andpeoplewithlessformal academicandprofessionaltraininginthesefields. According to the authors, the Mayas who participated in these events showedagreatdealofinterestinthewritings’meaningsandwereverycreativewhencomparingtheinterpretationsthespecialistsproposedwiththose thatwererecognizedintheirmothertongues.Theparticipantswerekeenly interestedinstudyingtheglyphsinordertounderstandancientMayahistoryandparticularlyMayaculturaldevelopment.ScheleandGrubepropose thattheworkshopontheclassicalperiod’sstoryofcreationwasoneofthe mostmeaningfulbecauseitrelateddirectlytoreligious,social,ritual,and agriculturalpracticesofthemodernMaya.Accordingtotheauthors,the participants’reactionsandconversationsoverthefollowingyearsuggestthat theinformationextractedfromtheepigraphictextscreatedstrongtiesbetweencontemporaryexperienceandtheancientpre-Colombianpast(Schele andGrube1999). InadditiontotheworkshopsinGuatemala,ScheleandGrubedeveloped aworkshopinMérida,Mexico,attendedbyasizablenumberofYukateco
198 eDgaresquit
speakers.Duringthefinalevent,heldattheruinsofChichén-Itzá,aparticipantnamedKokomaffirmedthatonhispreviousvisitstotheruinshe hadnottakentheglyphsandtheirmeaningsintoaccount.Yetonthisoccasionhehadnoticedthathislastnamewaswrittenintheglyphs.Theauthors thinkitisimportantthattheYucatekanandGuatemalanMayameetinthe future to share their knowledge. This and other experiences led different Guatemalanorganizationstousetheglyphsinnewwaystosupportsharing theirnewfoundknowledgeandnewlyrecognizedhistory.Byparticipating insimilarworkshops,otherMayatookthisnewfoundknowledgetotheir communitiesoforigin,suchasChimaltenango,Cobán,Palín,andTecpán, andshareditwithcommunitymembers.Theauthorsproposethatthisrepresentedthetransferanddisseminationofasystemofteachingandwriting intoMayahands. KayWarrenwroteanarticleaboutaweeklongworkshopdevelopedin 1992byagroupofKaqchikellinguists.Theparticipantsstudiedthebook Annals of the Kaqchikels,aworkwrittenbyKaqchikelauthorities(principales)duringthecolonialera(Warren1999).Warrenexplainsthattheparticipatinglinguistshadtakenpartinothercommunityeducationprojects andhaddevelopedaseriesofactivitiesand,later,publishedextractsofthe book,whichwereusedasmaterialininformaleducationalprograms.Warren argues that Maya culturalists see these ancient texts as both vital resourcesforlearningaboutthepastandfundamentalguidesforcontemporaryprojects. AccordingtoWarren,theparticipantsbelievedthestudyoftheancient texts could reveal that Kaqchikels have a unique origin. However, some oftheparticipantsthoughtthisrevisionwasnotnecessarilyanargument againstofficialhistory,butasearchforthetruthsthathavenotbeencompletely understood. Citing another participant in the workshop, Warren highlightsnewperspectivesontheancienttexts.SomeMayaactivists,she says,thinkthisbookdescribesofficialMayahistory.Inotherwords,theysee thebookasaretellingofMayaorigins,cosmology(cosmogonía),andexperienceswiththeEuropeaninvasionaswellasofthegenealogicalcontinuityof oneofGuatemala’smostimportantpeoples. Warren’stextproposesthattheculturalistsargueheatedlyamongthemselvesastheytrytostripMayacosmovisionofitscontactwithEuropean religions,otherideologies,andintentionalmanipulations.Thenewreadings ofcertainpartsofthetextarecounterposedtotraditionalonesmadebyna-
Nationalist Contradictions 199
tionalandforeignscholarsinrelationto,forexample,thearrivaloftheSpanishandtheensuingarmedstruggle.Intheireagernesstoimaginecontinuity inMayadescent,culture,andlanguages,Mayaactivistsfacethechallengeof confrontingofficialhistoriesthattalkaboutconquestandassimilation(Warren1999). ThetextsIhavecitedshowsomeoftheactivitiesMayanistsareengagingintorecoveranddefineanotherrepresentationoftheirpast.Thisinterest,however,isnotrecent.Theefforttodevelopanewperspectiveonthe Mayapastandpresentlikelyhasitsoriginsintheseindividuals’firstattempts tostudytheirmothertongues.Inthemid-twentiethcenturyAdriánInés Chávez,aneminentK’icheintellectual,organizedcongressesofMayaeducatorstodiscusstopicsrelatedtolanguages.Sincethen,Chávezhasposited theneedtoestablishtrulyindigenoussymbolstowriteK’iche,whileemphasizinglinguisticandculturalunity(Fischer1990,90).In1979,hetranslated andpublishedthePopWuj(PopolVuh)intographicsthatlaidoutanew alphabetexclusivelyforthislanguage(Chávez2001). Inthe1980sand1990sMayaintellectualsbeganshapinganewcontent and meaning of Maya history by organizing activities such as meetings, workshops, andseminarsaswellasbyeditingbibliographic anddidactic material.Theyproducedanumberofimportanttextsonthisissue,forexample,thosebyVíctorRacancoj(1994),Raxche’DemetrioRodríguez(1995), Demetrio Cojtí Cuxil (1991, 1995), and Víctor Montejo (1997). Important Mayaleadersandinvestorsfoundedapressthatreprintedbooksbynational andforeignauthors,amongthemRobertCarmack,CarlosGuzmánBöcklerandJean-LoupHerbert,andRobertM.Hill,thatanalyzethehistoryof theMaya.3Currently,variousinstitutionsarealsoeditingpopulartexts,includingchildren’sstoriesthatevoketheMayapast.Manypeopleareputting agreatdealofeffortintobuildingnewwaysofrepresentingandanalyzing Mayahistory. Theserepresentationscanbesynthesizedastheconstructionofahistoricalbase,whichrecognizestheprinciplesthatunitetheactionsandknowledgeoftheancientMayawiththosethatnourishthecontemporaryMaya. Byexaminingthesesortsofancienttextsaswellasworksbyarcheologists, anthropologists,linguists,andhistorians,Mayaniststrytorebuildaversion oftheirpastthatspecifiestheparticularityoressentialityofMayaculture. Theyalsoattempttoreconstructthehistoryofresistanceandleadershipthat theybelievecanhaveanimportantroleinthinkingaboutandimaginingresistancetoday. 200 eDgaresquit
MayanistslooktocontributetoadefinitionofMayaunitywiththisnew historicalnarrative.ThroughtheseeffortstheyaffirmthatweMayashare commonancestorswhobequeathedusacommoncultureandlanguagesof originthatweneedtoprotect.WeMayaparticipateinaspecificwayoflookingattheworldandatourselves,recognizingthatallMayaintellectualshave sharedasimilaradversitysince1524—anadversityMayaintellectualshave definedasinternalcolonialism.4 Thenewhistoricalnarrativefeedingthepan-Mayanistmovement’spoliticalstrugglehasdefineddatesandperiodsofhistoricsuccession,tracingthe greatnessandcatastropheslivedandsufferedbytheMayapeople.Now,we couldsaythatasapeopleweprobablyhaveadateofbirth(somefivethousandyearsago)andofgrowth,somethingthatuntiljustafewdecadesago wasnotdefinedinthehistoricalnarrativesthatourparents,grandparents, eldersingeneral,andtheleadersandcommunityguidespresentedtous.In differentwaysthisnewhistoricMayanistimaginaryisexpressedasthereal Mayahistorythatrevealsapasthiddenordistortedbyofficialhistory.These discoursesformthenotionoftheMayapeopleandaretiedtothespeeches aboutmulticulturalismthataregeneratedbyMayanistintellectualsandtheir organizationsaswellasbythestate. ThiswayofevokingthepastrepresentsanimportantbreakintheMaya imaginaryandinthewaystheyarerecreatingthemselvestobuildandconfronttheirownpresentandthatofGuatemala.Thisnarrativegeneratespride amongthosefamiliarwithit,primarilyMayanists.Mayaindividuals,forexample,canmakereferencetotheirmillenarianpastwhentheypresenttheir demandstothegovernment,justastheycancitetheirhistoryofgreatness whentheyappearinpublic,attenduniversities,ortalkonnationalandinternationalstages. MayaeducatorswhoaredirectingschoolsknownasMayaschoolsare teachingchildrenthisnewwayofunderstandingthepast.Here,theancient MayaarenotseenasacivilizationofgreatinventorswhodisappearedbeforethearrivaloftheSpanish,asthestateschoolstaughtandcontinueto teach.Instead,teachersinstructstudentsthattheyarethegrandchildrenof Mayaancestorswhocreatedagreatcivilization,asevidencedinarchitecture, mathematicaladvances,andhieroglyphicwriting,intheartisticcreations foundinoursacredcentersandinourancientbooks,aswellasinourrestoredpoliticalandreligiousceremonies.Inaddition,somecommunityhistoriesandhistoriesofmunicipalitieswithaMayamajorityincorporatethis wayofviewingthepast. Nationalist Contradictions 201
Educated Maya and Narratives about the Past ItisprimarilyonesectorofeducatedMayawhoconstructandevokethis newnarrative.FromChávezinthemiddleofthetwentiethcenturytoMontejoatthestartofthetwenty-firstcentury,whatcharacterizesthesehistorical narratorsistheirprofessionalformation.5Inthiscase,thenewimaginaryor historicalrepresentationisgeneratednotonlyfromcommunities’oraltradition,butalso(andmoreextensively)fromotherknowledgesacquiredas aresultofclosecontactwithschools,organizations,andotherworlds,from WesternorladinotoNorthAmerican. Sincethe1960s,asectoroftheMayafromdifferentcommunitiesentered secondaryschoolsanduniversity(BastosandCamus2003).Insubsequent decades,inspiteoftherepressionthispopulationsufferedinthe1970sand 1980s,somecontinuedthistrajectory,addingtothenumberofMayawho havegraduatedfromsecondaryschoolanduniversity.Thesewell-educated Mayaassumedotheridentitiesthatpartlycontrastedwiththoseofuneducated(iletrados)Maya,menandwomenwhocultivatetheearthandmaintainasubsistenceeconomy.6Thoseidentitiesalsocontrastwiththoseofthe ladinoswithwhomtheyhadlivedintheircommunitiesaswellaswiththose ofcolleaguesinschoolsandworkplaces(SincalCoyote2004). Thistraditionofeducationsincethe1960swasmostevidentamongthe KaqchikelsandK’iche,butsimilarprocessescanbeobservedinotherethnic groups. An exemplary case is that of the Comalapa municipality, located inthecentraldepartmentofChimaltenango,wherethemajorityoftheinhabitants are Kaqchikels. From the beginning of the twentieth century a smallgroupofdistinguishedfamiliescharacterizedbytheirstatusasintermediaries,theireconomicresources,andtheircapacityforpoliticalnegotiation,begantoimplementaseriesoftransformations attheproductive level,inpoliticalparticipation,andintheeducationalformationofsomeof theiryoungmembers.Inthe1920sasmallgroupofMayateachersfromthis communitygraduatedfromthecountry’snormalschools.Theyreturnedto theircommunity,wheretheyservedasprimaryschoolteachersinaschool foundedbyprominentfamiliesspecificallyforindigenouspeople.Fromthe 1970suntilthepresent,thenumberofprofessionalsemergingfromthismunicipalityhasincreasedsignificantly.Theydistinguishedthemselvesinseveralimportantprofessions.Manygraduatedasprimaryschoolteachersand othersasaccountants,engineers,doctors,lawyers,linguists,soldiers,priests, andadministrators.Manylivedthroughprocessesofculturalchangeand 202 eDgaresquit
economicascentthattransformedtheirwaysofrelatingtooneanotherand tothepeopleintheircommunitieswhoareinvolvedinagricultural,artisanal,andcommercialactivities.Mostoftheseprofessionalscontinuedifferentiatingthemselvesfromladinos,butatthesametimetheyvaluehighly theirprofessionalidentitiesandtheirtieswithurbancenterslikethedepartmentcapital,Chimaltenango,orthecountry’scapital,GuatemalaCity.They alsorecognizetheimportanceoftheirlinguistic,ideological,andnationalist connections. Thesewell-educatedMayanowdefinethemselvesasKaqchikels,Mayas, Chimaltecos,inhabitantsofthecapital,andasGuatemalan.Theiridentificationwithliberalstateideologyisprominentwhentheyspeakaboutcitizenship,democracy,thelegalsystem,theirpoliticalparticipation,andhuman rights.Theyhavesocapitalizedontheirtimeandknowledgethattheycan now reject so-called traditional forms of cooperation and ties with other groupsandpeoplesinComalapa.TheremainingComalapans,agriculturalistsandmerchants,cansimultaneouslyrejectorlegitimizethesenewprofessionalidentities,thoughts,andpracticesaccordingtothespecificcircumstances. Startinginthe1970speoplefromthiscommunitywithalowerlevelof education began participating in different organizational bodies, such as ProtestantandCatholicchurches,politicalparties,andguerrillagroups— althoughcertainlysomeprofessionalsdidlikewise.Throughthisparticipation,theseless-educatedMayadiscoveredotherwaysoflivingandunderstanding their communities’ social reality and thereby devised their own waysoftransformingthelivesofComalapansandoftheMayaingeneral. OtherComalapanshaverecentlyoccupiedimportantpostsinthegovernment,includingtheNationalCongressandsomeministries. SomenationalleaderswhosupportMayanismarefromComalapaand aremembersofthisprofessionalsector.7TogetherwithactivistsandintellectualsfromotherGuatemalancommunities,principallyKaqchikelsand K’iche,theseleadersfosterthenoveldiscourseabouttheMayapast.Nevertheless,atpresentmostoftheseComalapanscansimultaneouslyresortto discoursesandpoliticalpracticesinherentlytiedtotheliberalstate’sideology. On the basis of these facts (paraphrasing Dipesh Chakrabarty), I muststillinsistonasking,WhospeaksinthenameofourMayaancestors (Chakrabarty1999)?Theanswerisobviouslynotsimplebecauseitrequires understandingotherimportantfacts. HeretoforetheanalysisofGuatemala’spre-Hispanicandcolonialhistory Nationalist Contradictions 203
has been in the hands of Creoles, ladinos, and foreigners, commentators whohaveconstructeddifferentimagesabouttheMayaandtheirpast.8At othermoments,thestatehasusedthishistoriographyandarcheologytodelineateanationalhistorythatistaughtinschoolsandtransmittedthrough official discourses. That history has been expressed in racist and colonial terms.ItfostersavisionoftheMayaandofindigenouspeopleingeneralas backward,childlike(mozos),uncivilizedpeasantssubjecttointegrationand incapableofrealizing,touseacontemporaryconcept,developmentwithout outsideintervention.9 Despite these tendencies, people in the communities continue to narratetheirownhistories,whicharealsocategorizeddisdainfullybyliberal andracistGuatemalanideology.Inanycase,Mayanarrativesdelineateand constructimagesaboutrecentandremoteancestors.Indiversewaysthese histories have given life to past indigenous communities, to their identitiesandwaysoforganizingaswellastotheconditionsofresistanceproducedatdifferentmomentsandindistincteras(Florescano2001).Inmany of these stories the ancestors remembered are nameless and the dates of eventsarenotpreciselydefinedbecausethestoriessimultaneouslyrelateto thedailylifeoflistenersandnarrators.10ManyMayapeopleincommunitiesandvillageshaveneverstoppedsharingandlisteningtotheseremembrances.Nevertheless,thesenarrativesdonotcomprisethedominanthistory.Eventhoughtheyformpartofthesocialandideologicalreproduction oftheMaya,theydonotresonatenationally.Instead,othervoicesaretaken tobethetrueones,primarilyCreoleandladinonarrativesthatuptonow havetoldushowourpasttrulyhappened. Forthepasttwodecadeswell-educatedMayahavebeentellingtheirown stories,talkingabouttheMayapastthroughtheuseofwesternizedimages andnarrativestyles.Asarule,thesenewstoriesquestionedtheliteraryconstructionsofnationalandforeignacademicsandofofficialdiscourses.For somepeople,suchself-expressionmeansthattheMayaarestartingtotake theirturnatspeakingabouttheirpast,andconsequentlythehistorythey aretellingnowrepresentsthetruthforthem.Now,well-educatedMayaare thenarratorsandareoftenlegitimatedassuchandwelcomedbydifferent sectors.Carmack,forexample,affirmsthatgreatcivilizationsliketheK’iche aredestinedtoinfluencethemodernworldandthatthisgreatculture’stime hascomeinsideGuatemalaandmustbewelcomed(Carmack2001;seealso Warren1998;Fischer2001;CojtíCuxil1991;BastosandCamus2003;Fischer andBrown1999).Theseassertionsraisemanyquestions:Whoreceivesus? 204 eDgaresquit
Inwhatspacearewewelcome,andwhyareweappreciatednow(ornotuntil now)?Finally,ifthisistheMaya’stime,whatimportancecanacritiquehave forimaginingnewwaystogivingmeaningtothepast?
Elites, Narratives about the Past, and Fragility EventhoughithasbeensaidthatMayanists’newversionsofthepastchallengeofficialhistory,therealityisnotthatsimple.ThecontemporaryGuatemalan state also speaks about Guatemala’s history, about the history of theMayaasapeople,andaboutinterculturalism.ThisrepresentsanapparentacceptanceofMayanistdiscourseanddemandsfromthefourpeoples (Maya,Garífuna,Xinka,andladino),theirmulticulturalismanddiversity.11 ThestatehastherebysupposedlyacceptededucatedMayas’versionofhistoryandrights.
Mayanists and the State Construction of Multiculturalism InthepasttwodecadesMayaleadershavecreatedaseriesoforganizations liketheConsejodeOrganizacionesMayasenGuatemalaandtheCoordinacióndeOrganizacionesdelPuebloMayadeGuatemala.Usingtheseassociationsasplatforms,theMayaleaderswrotedocumentsandnegotiated,protested,andelaborateddiscoursesabouthistory,culturaldiversity,rights,and identity.Throughthisprocess,theycreatedtieswiththegovernmentandthe state,settingthetermsoftheirrelationships. Thediscussionandsigningin1995oftheIdentityandRightsoftheIndigenousPeoplesAccordbetweentheUniónRevolucionariaNacionalGuatemalteca (urng)andthegovernment isconsidered oneofthekeymomentsintheconsolidationoftheserelations.Mayaniststookpartinthis process,andtheirproposalswereincorporatedintothedocument’sformal definitions.Inthisway,theGuatemalannation’smultiethnic,pluricultural, andmultilingualcharacterwasformallyrecognized.Thisaccordembraced Mayanists’conceptofapeople,aconceptthatalludestoandisbasedupon theirnewnotionsofhistory.12 Currently,thegovernmenthaspromulgatedsomesecondarylawsthat give legal support to Maya rights, spirituality, languages, and education. TherearegovernmententitiesdesignedtosupporttheMayapeoples’effort, suchastheFondoIndígena(IndigenousFund),theAcademiadelasLenguasMayasdeGuatemala(AcademyofMayaLanguagesofGuatemala),and Nationalist Contradictions 205
theDefensoríadelaMujerIndígena(IndigenousWomen’sDefenseOffice). SchooltextssponsoredbytheMinistryofEducationincludenewlessons abouttheMaya’smillenarianhistory,andchildreninpublicschoolseven learn Maya numeration. From the moment the multicultural discourse gainedlegitimacy,thestatebegandefiningethnicdifferenceinGuatemala andrecognizedMayaorganizationsandtheirleadersasinterlocutorsand representativesoftheGuatemalanMaya. Manywouldinterpretthisnewsituationtomeanthatthestate’srecognitionofGuatemala’sculturaldiversityimpliesthatthenationisnowademocratic,pluralbody.13Alternatively,onemightseethestate’srecognitionasa MayanistvictoryintheMaya’sideologicalandpoliticalstruggletoinfluence dominanthistoryandthought.Thisvictory,however,wasnotsostraightforwardbecauseitalsorepresentedthestate’sinfluenceinthepoliticaldefinitionofmulticulturalism,identity,andrights.EventhoughthestatepurportstosupportMayanistclaims,thisrecognitionalsorestrictsMayanists’ capacitytoestablishtheirownparametersanddiscoursesofthepastand oftheiridentity,theirrights,andtheelaborationofproposals(Bastosand Hernández2005).ThissuggeststhattheGuatemalanstateandgoverning elitesareabletonourishthemselveswithMayanistideologyanddiscourse toagainimposeandredefinetheirownlegitimacyatthelocalasmuchas theinternationallevel.BracketteWilliamshasdefinedthisprocessastransformisthegemony;inotherwords,aprocessthroughwhichthestateappropriatescertainresourcesdefinedbysubalterngroups,leavingthesepeoples onceagainatthemarginsofthenationalprocess(1989). Aninteresting example in this regard is that of a group of Kaqchikels fromthewesterndepartmentofSololáwho,inearly2005,protestedagainst theestablishmentofaminingcompanyintheGuatemalanhighlands.They claimed that nature (“Mother Earth,” they said) was being damaged and thatthegovernmenthadnotconsultedindigenouspeoplesorcommunities regardingthecompany’snewinstallations;somegroupsinvokedConvention169oftheInternationalLaborOrganizationontherightsofindigenous peopleswithinexistingstates.Theprotestswereviolent,andthegovernment usedthepoliceandthearmytorepressthepopulationopposedtothemine’s operations.TheMayasintheregionsucceededinachievingstrongpoliticalcohesionaroundtheso-calledindigenousmunicipalityandmanagedto sustainanimportantdiscourseandpracticeregardingthe“traditional”conservationoftheirnaturalresources.Becauseoftheirprotests,theywererepressed.14 206 eDgaresquit
Wecanseehere,asRachelSiederposits,thattherecompositionofthe stateandofLatinAmericanmulticulturalismtieintootherprocesses,such asneoliberalismandsubsequentsubalternchallengestothesepolicies.TensionsemergebetweenthestateandMayagroupswhenstateactorsseekto exploitnaturalresourceslocatedinterritorieshistoricallyoccupiedbythe Maya,territoriestheywishtocontinueusingaccordingtotheirlocalinterests.SiederproposesthatthepublicpoliciesimplementedbyLatinAmericangovernmentscontributedtothereorganizationofthestatebutdidnot necessarilyreduceexistinginequalities.Thisestablishesthatamodelofa multiculturalsocietymustnotonlyaddresstherightsofethnicgroupsbut alsoconfrontpatternsofdevelopmentestablishedbyneoliberalismorcapitalism(Sieder2004). TheinterventionofMayapeoplesiscentralindefininganewmodelof thenation.Theirideologicalconstructionsofthepastoverlapwithcurrent notionsandimagesofamulticulturalGuatemala.Hereonehastoanalyze howthestatelegitimizesitselfthroughMayanistdiscoursesofthepastand ofMayaculturebutatthesametimeusesforceandviolence,alsolegitimized,againstthosesupposedlyrepresentedinthepluralnationtoimpose therealitiesandnewlogicsoftheglobaleconomy. ThenewlydeployedhistoricaldiscourseaboutMayannessandmulticulturalisminfluencesofficialacts,includingtheteachingofnationalhistory andthediscursivedefinitionoftherightsofthepeopleswholivetogether in Guatemala. Nevertheless, images of our past greatness and discourses aboutamulticulturalcountryhavelittleimpactonotherprocesses,includingthedefinitionofcoexistence,development,theestablishmentofrights andobligations,andcitizenship.Thequestionthereforeis,Whatistheplace ofapeople,oftheircultureandtheirrights,inthedefinitionandnegotiation ofthecountry’sdemocracyandeconomy?Withinliberal,capitalistlogic,the questionisoflittleimportanceandmightevenbeunderstoodasimprudent. Yetitishighlyrelevantifonethinksofthecolonialmannerinwhichpower, democratization,andculturalandsocialdiversityareexercisedinGuatemala. How are the discourses about the Maya past and about multiculturalismthatareformulatedbyMayanistintellectualsused?Andwhatstatusare theygranted?Ratherthanconstitutingasimpleoppositiontoofficialhistory, Mayanisthistorycanitselfconstitutethebasisfordevelopingnewdiscursive perspectivesthatthestatethenreplicates.Mayanistscanbelievetheyhave achieved their objectives when the government begins to print books reproducingtheirnewhistoryandrecreatedsymbols.Theministersandvice Nationalist Contradictions 207
ministersofeducationwhoencouragethepublicationanduseofthesenew textsmayevenbeMayasthemselves,yetthemajorityoftheMayacontinue tobeseenasbackwardandignorantwhenthestatesupposedlybringsthem progressanddevelopmentthattheyoppose. UnfortunatelyfortheMayanists,theystilldonothaveenoughpowerto control the reconstructions and ideologies that their movement has generatedandthatarenowreshapingthestateandgovernment.Theirincipientparticipationasgovernmentfunctionariesstilldoesnotrepresentasignificantforce,yettheirideologicalcreationsaboutthepastandthepresent aremoldingthenarrativesthatstrengthennewimagesofthemulticultural nation.Thesenarrativesalsoconstructotherformsoflegitimacyandstate powerthatdolittletoeliminateprivilegesorequalizetheconcentrationof resourcesandpower. Inlightoftheprecedingdiscussion,wearenowinabetterpositionto determinewhospeaksinthenameoftheMayapast.Nowthattheyarewell educatedandhavethepowertodoso,Mayaeliteseffectivelydiscusstheir past.Nevertheless,thepowerachievedbysomeMayanistleaderscoexists with other conditions and contexts that may generate contradictions. On theonehand,Mayanistsdonothavethecapacitytocontrolhowothersuse theirdiscoursesandimages.Ontheotherhand,someMayanistsaresatisfied when they hear government functionaries talking about Guatemala’s culturalwealth.ManyMayanistsspeakinthenameofallMayaandtheir past,buttheirnewdiscoursesofthegloriousMayapastruncountertothe realitythatmanyMayaindividualsandcommunitiesstillfaceapowerthat responds to their concerns with violence and continues to exclude them fromthenation.
Mayanist Elites: Redefining Identities and Power Relations OnecanaskhowMayanists,oratleastsomeMayanists,livethesenewhistories.Inotherwords,howaretheyusingthesenewdiscoursestonurture theirsociallife,theiridentity,andtheirpoliticalactivity?Theintellectualsof theMayamovementareprimarilyeducatedmenandwomenwhoarehighly visibleatthelocalandnationallevels.Insomecentralhighlandcommunities,principallyinthedepartmentofChimaltenango,theyarepresentinsizablenumbers.Eventhoughmanydonotliveintheircommunitiesoforigin, butincitieslikeChimaltenangoorthecapital,atcertainmomentstheyrun intoandgreeteachotherintheirlocalcommunities.Likewise,whenthey 208 eDgaresquit
convergeonplaceslikeGuatemalaCity,theyalsodistinguishtheirfellow Mayawhocomefromspecifictowns,regions,andlinguisticgroups.They alsocrosspathswithMayawhoprofessMayanistideologyonlymoderately ornotatallbutwhoarealsoeducatedorholdpositionsintheprofessions andwhoarefamiliarwithladinoandWesternspacesandperspectives.15 ThestoryofaMayapoliticalleaderfromthedepartmentofChimaltenango,amanwhowasprominentatthelocalandnationallevels,isinstructiveinthiscontext.Inthemid-twentiethcenturythemanwasanimportant promoterofAcciónCatólicainhismunicipalityandoneofthemostwidely knowncatechists.Hisallegiancetothisorganizationledhimtoparticipate inthelocalbranchofamajornationalpoliticalparty,asaresultofwhichhe rosetothepostofmayorinhishomemunicipalityduringthesecondhalf ofthetwentiethcentury.Inthe1970shispartynominatedhimtofillaseat inthefederalparliament,makinghimoneofthefirstMayadeputiestosit inGuatemala’sCongress.16Althoughlittlewasheardabouthispoliticalactivitiesatthenationallevelduringthe1980s,hisnamewasassociatedwith Mayanistorganizationsinthe1990sanduptothepresent.Atonepoint,he wasamemberoftheConsejodeAncianosdelFondodeDesarrolloIndígenadeGuatemala(CouncilofEldersoftheIndigenousDevelopmentFund ofGuatemala),agovernmententityfoundedatthedemandofandledby Mayanists.Hewasalsoanactivememberoforganizationsthatencourage Mayaspirituality. Thoughthemanlivedhislastyearsoutsideofhismunicipality,hisremains were transferred there after his death. The day of his funeral, his friends and relatives, myself included, attended a Mass celebrated in the communitychurch;severalofthesepeopleheldimportantpositionsinthe national politicalarena,eitheratthegovernmental levelorinpopularor Mayanistorganizations.DuringtheEucharistceremonythepriestspokeof howthiswasanuncommonandevenspecialceremonygiventhedignity andtrajectoryofthedeceased.Oncethereligiousserviceended,weleftfor thecemetery,whereacustomaryprayerwassaid.Afterward,acloseK’iche relative of the deceased climbed onto a podium and spoke in his native tongueabouthowthedeceasedwasnowreunitedwithMayaelders(abuelos).ThespeechwastranslatedintoSpanish.Somesaidthatthedeceasedhad probablyheardthesesamewordsaboutrespectfortheancestorsspokento himbyhismotherinK’ichewhenhewasachild.Thesamerelativereada textaboutthedeceased’slife,highlightinghisparticipationintheCongress andinorganizationsthatfoughtforanddefendedMayarights.Mostofthose Nationalist Contradictions 209
attendingthewakereturnedtothehouse,whereavigilwasheldandcoffee andbreadwereserved.Atthevigilsomeonecirculatedaphotographofthe deceased,explainingthatithadbeentakenintheCongressduringhistenure inthatlegislativebody. Several conclusions can be arrived at from this anecdote. On the one hand,eventhoughthedeadman’sancestorswerenotexplicitlylabeledas Maya,suchlabelingwasimplicitinthediscourse.WhenMayapeasantsremembertheirdead,theygenerallyaffirmthatthedeceased’ssoulnowrests inpeacetoberesuscitatedbyGodwhentheworldends.Thespeechesatthe wakelikewisemadereferencestotheancestorsusingallusionstoMayanist discoursesaboutelders.Ontheotherhand,manypeoplewhoattendedthe wakewerepromotersofMayanism,andbytranslatingtheK’ichespeeches intoSpanishtheywerepositioningMayanistvaluesandsymbolsatcenter stageandtherebyusingSpanishinaninstrumentalway. WhatIwanttohighlighthereistherelationshipbetweenMayahistorical discourse,thenewidentitiesoftheprofessionalsandleaderswhopromote thisdiscourse,andtheirlinkagewiththestatethroughpoliciesregarding Mayarightsandmulticulturalism.Whatishappeningamongtheseelites? ThedescriptionofthefuneralhighlightshowMayaprofessionalscanlink differenteventsorfactsbyarticulatingthemwiththeirnewhistoricaldiscourseandwiththeirconnectionstostatepolicyonrightsandculture.We canseethatinthiscaseMayanistsarenotdeployingadiscourseabouthistoryandcultureinanisolatedway,soastodefinetheirnationalism,difference,andprideonlyinrelationtotheirgloriouspast,astheymightdoin otherspeechesandtexts.Incaseslikethis,forMayahistoricaldiscoursesto succeedtheymustinterconnectwithothernarrativesaboutcontemporary Mayas’abilitytoenterthestateapparatus,becomeprofessional,andengage otherworldsassumedtobeclosedtomostMaya.Theymustalsoconnect with arguments and proclamations about theirown capacity torepresent anddefendtherightsoftherestoftheMayapeople.Evidentlyinoperation hereisacomplexprocessofattemptedlegitimationinwhichnewpowerrelationsarebeingconstructed. Tounderstandallofthis,Iwanttocontinueexploringthehistoricaleffects ofWesternmodernity,liberalideology,capitalism,governmentpoliciesregardingeducationandintegration,andracisminthelivesofMayanistsand therestoftheMayapeople.Itisimportanttoanalyzeboththeparticular waysinwhichpoliticalandeconomicelitesareconstitutedhistoricallyand thelinkstheyestablishwithsystemsofinequality. 210 eDgaresquit
GregGrandinandIrmaAliciaNimatujenteredintothisdiscussionwith their analyses of historical processes lived by the Quetzaltec elites in the nineteenthcenturyandthetwentieth.GrandinproposesthatK’icheleaders ofthisareareconfiguredtheircommunalrelationsandmaintainedtheirsocial and cultural authority by forming alliances with the colonial and republicanstates.Amidstthepoliticalandeconomicchangesoftheeighteenth centuryandthenineteenth,K’icheelitestransformedQuetzaltenangointoa commercial,multiethniccity.Ethnicleaders(principales)usedCreoleelites to sustain their domination over K’iche cultural processes, strengthening theirpoliticalpowerandaccesstocapital.Withthesupportofindigenous principales,Creolesmaintainedthecity’scastedivisionsandtherebycontrolled the population and the possibility of multiethnic alliances. These nineteenth-century elites pursued similar alliances with the Guatemalan presidentRafaelCarreratoprotecttheirprivileges. Thesealliances,incombinationwithlatenineteenth-centuryliberalideologyandcapitalisteconomy,ledK’icheelitestodevelopalternativeunderstandingsofethnicityandnationalism.Theelitesbuiltaconceptionofethnicity that was intimately tied to ideas of progress encouraged by liberal intellectuals.Theythoughtthatindigenouspeople’sregenerationwouldnecessarilyleadtocivilandpoliticalequality.Theseideologicalconstructions ultimatelyjustifiedK’icheelites’positionsofauthorityaswellasthoseof ladinosatthelocalandnationallevel.PrivilegedK’ichelookedtoreproduce anethnicidentitybasedontheircommonoriginandonthemaintenanceof culturalmarkersprimarilygroundedinwomen’sroles(Grandin2000). Nimatuj, inturn, observes that these elites were not homogenous and respondedindifferentwaystohistoricalprocessesandconcretesocialcontexts.Similarly,sheshowsthatthisQuetzaltecsector,characterizedbytheir commercialeconomicpower,sharedandcontinuetosharediversecontexts withtherestoftheGuatemalanMaya.Theytherebyreproduceapatriarchal systemthatsubordinatesMayawomen.Liketherestofthecountry’sMaya, they confront the racism dividing Guatemalan society and share general Mayaculturalpatternslikedress,collectivememory,languages,anddiverse wisdoms(VelásquezNimatuj2002). At the beginning of the twentieth century and in a way similar to the K’icheelitesinQuetzaltenango,indigenouselitesfromdifferentChimaltenangomunicipalitiessimultaneouslyactedasintermediaries,speakingon behalfofChimaltenango’sindigenouspeoplesandtheirrights,whilealso competingwithlocalladinoelitesevenastheysharedsomeprivilegeswith Nationalist Contradictions 211
thoseelites,suchastherighttovoteandexemptionsfromforcedlaborand taxes.Indigenouselites’competitionwithladinosledthemtonotonlydiscussanddemandcitizenshiprights,butalsototakeaction.Theyfounded schoolsforindigenouspeopleandeducatedasmallgroupofyouthwhoin certainwaysandatcertainmomentscouldcompetewithladinos. Atthepresenttimeladinosinmanyofthisdepartment’scommunities nolongerhavedecisivepoliticalpower,anditisMayawholeadlocalpolitics.Butaswehaveseen,theMayaarealsogainingprominencewithinthe governmentalapparatusatthenationallevel.Indiversewaystheyoftenact asintermediariesspeakinginthenameofallMaya,doingsobybuildinga lineardiscourseaboutthepast,demandingrights,andestablishingdevelopmentprogramsfortheMaya. Manyoftheseindigenouseliteshavebeensuccessfulbecausetheyunderstoodandenteredtheworldofnationalpoliticsandfamiliarizedthemselves withthepracticesandcustomsofladinoelites.Muchofthisawarenesswas theresultofeducationandadaptation.Eventhoughtheindigenouselites stillendurewhattheyviewasvirulentracism,theydonotexperienceitin thesamewayorunderthesameconditionsasotherMaya.Educationhas beencentraltotheelitesinachievingrecognitionandrelativeacceptancein somenonindigenouscircles;onceeducated,theyarestillindigenous,but “civilized.”Likewise,theMayanistversionoftheirpasthasacquiredmoderateacceptancebycertainintellectuals,politicians,andbusinessmenbecause itentailsarational,asopposedtoamythical,wayofcomprehendingthe past,whileatthesametimeservingtominimizetheviolenceusedagainst Mayaprotests.17 TheseprocessesempowerMayanists(andalsootherprofessionalMaya whodonotfollowthisideology)intheeyesofsomeladinoandCreolesectorsandalsoofcommunityandvillage-basedMaya.Mayastudentsandprofessionalsenjoygreaterprestigewheretheyliveororiginatefrom,notonly becauseoftheirknowledge,butalsobecauseofthetiesandnetworksthey presumablyhavedevelopedwithladinos,organizations,andinstitutionsat thenationallevel.Animportantdifferentiationthusarisesbetweensectors oftheMaya,onethatcannotbeanalyzedsimplyintermsofadescription ofsocialstratificationwithinlocalitiesormunicipalities,butmustconsider processeslikepowerrelations,thedevelopmentofideologies,andthehistoricalconstitutionandreproductionofelites. Duringthenineteenthcenturyandthetwentieth,someladinosandCreolesreproducedtheirpower,prestige,andlegitimacybyclaimingtobecivi212 eDgaresquit
lizedandmodern.Similarly,inthetwenty-firstcenturyMayanistsandsome non-Mayanistsareconstructingtheirprestigeandlegitimacyonthebasis ofeducation,professionalization, andlinkstothegovernmentapparatus. Newtothiscontemporaryconstruction,however,istheidentificationwith aPeoplethathasagloriousandmillenarianhistory,onethatisimaginedby theseselfsameactors.18 Apparently, Mayanists’ discursive control over the past and their demands regarding rights ultimately have produced results for these individuals.Nevertheless,thisdiscursivecontrolisdilutedbythecontroland powerrelationsestablishedbyGuatemala’soligarchyandpoliticalclass.As ClaudioLomnitz-Adlerproposedin1995intheMexicancase,intellectuals’ discoursesoftenservetogeneratecloserrelationshipsbetweentheintellectualsanddominantgroupsandinthiswaycontinuetoperpetuatestateideologies(Lomnitz-Adler1995).MuchthesamecanbesaidaboutcontemporaryMayanists’historicalnarratives.
Alternative Histories and the Present HowcanweMayabenefitfromthispowertolocatenotonlyourpastbut alsoourpresent?InwhatwaydoestheMayapeople’salternativehistory, asdevelopedbyMayanists,generatethepossibilityofimaginingadifferent nationandnationalism?Therearemanyanswerstothesequestionsbecause thesenewhistoricalnarrativesalsoquestiontheformsofexclusionhistoricallyreproducedbythestateandthedominantsectors.WecanseeneverthelessthatMayanisthistorypartlyconstructsitselfbytakingofficialhistoryas amodelwhenitestablishesorseekstorepresenttheunityofthefourpeoples livinginthisterritory. When Mayanists elaborate a historical narrative delineating the Maya people’sculturalinheritanceandtheirexistentialbasis,whileatthesame timeconstructinganimaginaryaboutthefourpeoplesofGuatemala,they arehelpingtobuildthemythofthemulticulturalnation.Thismyth,aswe haveseen,iseasilyappropriated,manipulated,andredefined,bothinthe discoursesofgoverningelitesandintheauxiliarylawstheyhaveproposed andapproved.Fromthishistoricaldefinitionofthefourpeoples,itispossibletobuildlinearanddiaphanousnarrativesaboutidentity,equality,and cultural inheritance—that is to say, about Guatemalan multiculturalism. Thesenarrativesunderestimatethedifferences,contradictions,powerrelations,andeconomicinequalityprevalentinthecountry. Nationalist Contradictions 213
Some Maya, for example, can now speak about multiculturalism and globalization processes like free trade treaties as inescapable realities in whichwemustnecessarilyinvolveourselves.TheseMayaholdthatmulticulturalismoffersaformulaforconfrontingglobalization,implyingthatso longaswemaintainouridentityasapeopleandremaincreative,wewillbe abletonavigatefreetradesuccessfullyandoffertheworldimportantgoods andproducts.19ThisMayanistreasoningiscenteredinmarketlogicsand leaveshistoryandthepresentagendaoftheoligarchyalmostunquestioned. Inthiscase,theMaya,too,canparticipateinthecolonialformtakenbyGuatemalanandglobalpowerrelations. UndersuchconditionsitiscrucialtobringdifferentMayahistoricalexperiencesintothediscussion,fortheyarecentraltothedefinitionofmulticulturalism’sideologicalandmaterialfoundations.Differentsectorsofthe Maya(andGuatemalan)peoplehavelongdeveloped,accordingtotheirown lifesituations,avarietyofrelationswiththeirsocialandnaturalsurroundings.Justlikewell-educatedMaya,peasants,women,merchants,andothers havehadcontactwiththenationalsociety,theglobaleconomyandpolitics, the culture and knowledge preserved by other societies, and diverse religious forms. The Maya have not been isolated from Guatemala’s politics,economy,andliberalandnationalistideologies,orfromtheladinoand Westernworlds.Itisunlikelytheyhavelivedinahomogeneousway.Their diversehistoricalcircumstanceshavegivenrisetodiverseviewpoints,interests,andidentities.AmongtheMaya,onecanthereforediscernmanyforms ofmemoryandthought.Inshort,weMayamustpaycloseattentiontothe relationshipbetweenmemoryandidentityinordertorecognizethatour ownimagesabouthistoryarenotuniformandinsteadreflectthecomplexity ofourlivesandrelations(Norval2001). Wemustthereforefocusourreflectionsonhowthesememoriescansupporttheconstructionofthepresentandcontrolofthefuture.Itisimportant toposit,asParthaChatterjeesays,thattheformofrememberingthepast and the power to represent oneself is nothing other than political power (Chatterjee1995).WeMayacanimagineamulticulturalsocietybytaking intoaccountthesemultiplehistoricalconditions.AlsocentraltoconstructingamulticulturalsocietyisanunderstandingofthewaysinwhichGuatemalanshavehistoricallylinkedthemselvesandbeenlinkedtotheirenvironment,keepinginmindtheirexperiences,positions,andrelationsofpower. Allofthiscanhelpusreflectmoredeeplyaboutthemanywaysinwhich we can construct our alternative histories, perhaps seek out a variety of 214 eDgaresquit
stylesofdevelopmentandunderstandandconstructamulticulturalnation. SantiagoBastosandDomingoHernández,forexample,highlightaninterestingcasedetailingtheprocessofstatecontrolandtheMayastrugglefor autonomy(BastosandHernándezIxcoy2005).Theyanalyzesomeofthe attemptstoadvancetherecognitionandindemnificationofthevictimsof armedconflict.Theyarguethatthesocialandpoliticalexperiencesofpeople involvedintheprocesshavepromptedthemtorethinkhowtheyimagined andspokeaboutthepastandaboutMayaneedsandrights. AccordingtoBastosandHernández,thepeopleandorganizationsinvolvedinthistaskhaveassumedthecategoryofMayaaspartofanideologicalconstructiontiedtotheindemnification,usingitasanethniccategory thatalsohelpsexplainthepastandtheviolencesuffered.Inthiscase,the processofrecoveringtheMaya’slong-termhistoryisalsolinkedwithmore recentmemoriesofpoliticalviolenceenduredbyMayapeasants,women, andstudents.Inthisway,peoples’ownactions,thatis,theirstrugglesand thepathstheychosetotake,markthemnotasvictimsbutasindividuals andasMayawhohavestruggledinthefaceofrepressionandexclusion.All thesefactorsformpartoftheMayaexperienceandthememorytheyare constructing. These efforts are fundamental, and their recognition through ethnographicdescriptioniscentraltothediscoveryofotherexplanationsrelated totheinteractionsofdifferentpoliticalactors(Hale2002).Theseacademic analysesareimportantcontributionsaslongastheydonotfallintoasimple celebrationofMayaresistance.Bytakingamorecriticalperspectivewecan seethecontradictionsgeneratedinthedifferentarenaswhereMayalaunch theirstrugglesandtheensuingconsequences.Byfocusingonthesemultiple arenas,wecanunderstandhowpoliticalresistanceandmemoryoftenchallengethecontrolandpowerofdominantgroupsandoftheircommonsense, evenastheycansometimesreinforcetheestablishedorderandneutralize thestrengthofMayaorganizationsandcommunities(Hale2002).
Epilogue NobodycouldarguethattheGuatemalanMayamovementhasnotbeenan importantforceinthetransformationofGuatemalansociety.Overthepast twodecadesanationaldiscussionofindigenouspeoples’culturalandpoliticalrightshasopenedmultipleopportunitiesforstruggleforpeopleindifferentregionsandlocalities.ManyMayawomen,forexample,nowmaketheir Nationalist Contradictions 215
voicesheardindiversecontexts,emphasizingtheirsuffering,desires,and strugglesandchallengingpatriarchaldominationintheirhomes,localities, andcountry(Chirix2003).Similarly,MayaspiritualityrepresentsanimportantchallengetotheProtestantandCatholicchurchesaswellastosocietyin generalthroughthepublicpresentationofreligiousritualsprohibiteduntil the1990s.Mayanistshavebroughttolightmanyissuesandproblems,includingracism,anoutdatededucationalsystemfromtheelementarytothe postsecondarylevel,politicalandsocialexclusion,andunequallandholdingpatterns. Myessaydoesnottalkintermsofbetrayal.Rather,ithasdealtwithsocial processesthatdeserverecognitionandcarefulanalysissoastofurtherclarifytherelationbetweenhegemonicprocessesandindigenousresistancein Guatemala(Scott2002).IhaveattemptedtorepresentandanalyzetherelationshipbetweenthenarrativesaboutthepastconstructedbyMayanist intellectuals and the vested interests present in the state that are also involvedindefiningGuatemalanmulticulturalism.Wehavebeenabletoobservethatthetiesestablished,thediscoursesandideologiespromotedand implemented,areoftencontradictorybecausetheybothrepresentandunfoldwithinGuatemala’scomplexsocialreality.EliteandnoneliteMayahave alsobeenfundamentalparticipantsintheconstructionoftheGuatemalaof thepasttwodecades.Theyparticipatenotonlybecausetheyhavebeenand continuetobethemostimportantlaborforceinthecountry’seconomy,but alsobecausetheymodeltheGuatemalanstatewiththeirideologicalconstructionsandpoliticalinterests.Theyremainlinkedtonationalistideologies—ideologieswhoseformdominantgroupsadoptedandusedtobuild theirhegemony—buttheyalsoconstituteanimportantsocialforceinthe transformationofoursociety. ThisworkisacriticalapproximationbytheMayathemselvestothesocial processeswelive.Ourexperiencesinthesediverseenvironmentsprovide evidencebothofwhatourstruggleshaveachievedandofthemistakeswe havemade.WeMayawillnotgivetoomuchawayifweseeourintellectual activityandcreationsinamoreproblematicwayandnotasdiaphanous,as wewouldlikeourrealityorourpasttobe.20Thismaybetoomuchtoask, givenhowweMayanistsmakestrategicuseofessentialistnotionsaboutthe continuityofourpastandpresent.21Yetwemustalsolistentoourmany voices,which,thoughcontradictory,influencetheprocesseswelive. Mayapeasants,businessmen,women,Catholics,andyouthhavemany historicalexperiencesandtalkinmanyways,andtheirdiscoursesandprac216 eDgaresquit
ticestieintotheideologiestheyemploy.Withtheirmultipleidentities,interests,anddreams,theyinevitably,togetherwithelites,takepartinthecontradictionsourcurrentnationalismsgenerate.
Notes 1.IntheGuatemalancontext,ladinoreferstomostnon-Indians,includingGuatemalansofEuropeanormixeddescent(translator’snote). 2.IncitingQuijano,WalterMignolo(2004)explainshowoneshouldunderstand theconceptofthecolonialityofpowerandtalksaboutthehistoricalestablishment ofaracialdivisionoflaborinAmerica.Aracialhierarchythatoverdeterminedsocial relationsandideologiesandinfluencedideasofequalityandlibertywasputinplace. Atthebeginningofthenineteenthcenturyandwiththeonsetofindependence,he argues, insteadofbeing overcome, colonialism wasrearticulated. Following Greg Grandin’s(2000)ideas,wecanalsosaythateventhoughalltheMayaofGuatemala arenotoppressedforbeingMaya,theysufferdominationasMaya. 3.Carmack(2001),GúzmanBöcklerandHerbert(1998),andHill(2001).Thefirst twobookswerefirsteditedinthe1960sandthelastin1992. 4.SeeEdgarEsquit(2004)foramorein-depthcriticalstudyofthistopicinrelationtorecentnarrativesaboutthepastbyMayaactivists. 5.Montejo(2004)isarecenttextaboutMayahistory. 6.InsomemunicipalitiestheseidentitiesalsocontrastedwithMayamerchants, mostofwhomhavealowlevelofeducationaltraining. 7.ManyotherprofessionalsfromComalapaortheregionhavefewornotieswith theMayamovementanditsdiscourse. 8.Creoles(criollos)referstoeliteGuatemalansofEuropeandescent(translator’s note).Forexample,seeBatresJáuregui(1989),MartínezPeláez(1973),andCarmack (2001). 9.Butthepolitical,cultural,andeconomicexclusionoftheMayawithinthenationdoesnotoccuronlyatthediscursivelevel.Thereareconcrete,materialpractices thatestablishexclusion,implyingthatthestate’shistoricnarrativecontributestothe constructionofcolonialformswithinGuatemala’spowerrelations. 10.IntheK’ichelanguage,forexample,najtir,meaning“ancient,”isusedonlyto talkaboutanancestor’spastandculture.IntheMamlanguage,ojtxereferstotheremotepast.GarcíaRuiz(1992). 11.MayanistshavecreatedtheimageofGuatemalaasmadeupoffourpeoples— theMaya,Garífuna,Xinca,andladino—eachwithitsrespectivehistory. 12.Minugua (2001). 13.SeeDonnaLeeVanCott’s(2000)discussionaboutconstitutionalmulticulturalism.SantiagoBastosdealscriticallywiththisissueinthenotionofcosmetic multiculturalism,whichreferstothecreationofnewstatepoliciesthatadoptlaws Nationalist Contradictions 217
anddiscoursesattemptingtoalwaysincludeindigenouspeople(Conferenceatthe ColegiodeMichoacán,2003). 14.SomepeoplehavesuggestedthatpoliticalmembersoftheleftistpartyUnión Revolucionaria Nacional Guatemalteca (urng) manipulated the Maya in these events.Thoughitisclearthatthe urng hasinfluenceintheIndigenousMunicipalityofSololáandotherdepartmentalorganizations,wecannotdisregardtheinterestsandagencyoftheregion’sKaqchikels. 15.UneducatedMayaarealsonotisolatedfromliberalGuatemalanpolitics,economics, and ideologyorfrom theladino and Western world.The problem is not whethertheMayaaretiedtonationalandglobalprocessesornot;rather,itisimportanttounderstandtheformsandconditionsinwhichsuchconnectionshappenand, extrapolatingfromthere,peoples’experiences,positions,andrelationsofpower. 16.TwoformerMayacongresspeopleweretheK’icheAugustoSacRacancoj,a lawyer,andPabloPastor,aprofessor.Theyobtainedtheirpostsinthe1940sonlybecauseofthespacetheRevolutionof1944opened.VelásquezNimatuj(2002). 17. Nevertheless, there are ladinos who question the way in which Mayanism recoversthepastthroughessentialistandfundamentalistarguments.SeeMorales (1998).SomeprovincialladinosalsoquestionMayanism,buttheirmainarguments originatewithinofficialhistory.Theyaffirmthatindigenouspeoplesnolongerhave the right to call themselves Maya because the Maya empire disappeared with the Spanish conquest and subsequent communities were no longer pure but mixed. Moreover,theseprovincialladinosbelievetheadhesionofindigenouspeoplestothe ancientMayaisastrategyofsomeopportunisticindividuals.Hale(2002). 18.Thiscomparisonisnotoverlyahistoricalbecausethenationisstillconstructed onexclusion,eventhoughthenationalandglobalsocial,political,andeconomic contextshavevaried. 19.ForWalterMignolo(2004)globalizationisarearticulationofthecoloniality ofpower,similartowhathappenedinthenineteenthcenturywiththefoundationof nationsinAmerica.ManyMayanistswhohaveadoptedaperspectivethatincludes theconceptofinternalcolonialismhardlyquestionglobalizationprocessesandthe contextsinwhichtheyareproduced. 20.Iusethetermproblematictodenotethecomplexityofoursociallifeandto argueaboutthemanypathsourstrugglescantakeifwepayattentiontoourmany realities. 21.Indiscussingculturalcontinuity,FischerandWatanabe(2004)affirmthatwe frequentlydonotrealizethedifferentwaysitcanhappen,suchasthroughtherecreationofthepresentorthroughprofilingthelegacyofourancestorsasunchanging. Accordingtotheauthors,Mayanistswouldhaveoptedforthefirstway.Theauthors’ conclusion may be quite correct; nevertheless, we also have to point out that the recreationofthepresentismediatedbypowerrelations,socialcontexts,andnew identities. 218 eDgaresquit
Florencia e. mallon
Conclusion
WhenNoenoeSilvaandStéfanoVareseattempted,atthecloseofourconferenceinMadison,tosummarizeourdiscussionsasaframeforourlast plenarysession,theyhighlightedboththepromisesandthedifficultiesin takingthekindofinternational andcomparativeperspectivewehaveattemptedinthisbook.InthisbriefconclusionIrevisitsomeofthegeneral themesandchallengesassociatedwithsuchaperspective.Icannotpresume torepresentheretherichnessoftheperceptionsandconclusionscontained ineachessay.Instead,Ihighlightthreegeneralpointsthatemergefromthe overallconversation,reiteratingthedesire—presentintheworkofallthe contributorstothisbookaswellasofallthosepresentattheconference— thatwecancontributeinsomewaytoadeeperandmoreproductivedialogueamongNativepeoplesandbetweenNativeandotherformsofknowledge. Atthecoreoftheprojectenvisionedbytheauthorsrepresentedinthis bookistheunderstandingofNativehistoriesandnarrativesininternational andcomparativecontext.Astherecenthistoryofindigenousmovements hasdemonstrated,internationalcollaborationhasfosterednewpossibilities forindigenousmobilizationandempowerment.Atthesametime,theprocessofexaminingNativehistoriesandnarrativesincomparativeandinternationalperspectiveextendsanddeepensourunderstandingofeachone. Boththesimilaritiesandthedifferenceswefindamongthemsharpenour appreciationofhow,andforwhatpurpose,thesenarrativesareelaborated andconstructed.Finally,ourcomparisonsofNorthandSouthAmericaas wellasofthecontinentalAmericaswiththePacificworldhelpremindus howdeeplygeographyitself,andthroughittherelationshipsamongdistinct indigenouspeoplesandtraditions,hasbeenaffectedbycolonialism. Asecondthemethatarisesfromtheessayscollectedhereisthatdecolo-
nizationbeginsathome.Takentogether,theauthorsdemonstratethemultiplewaysinwhichNativenarrativeandhistorycanberendered,fromlocal community history or personal story to discussions of indigenous rights onaninternationallevel.ThateachprovidesadifferentbutnecessaryperspectiveonNativehistoriesisanimportantlessonthatweallrelearn,again and again, as we labor to decolonize indigenous narratives with the very sametoolswehaveinheritedfromcolonialism.Andaswecontinuetostrive towardthisgoal,weseetheimportance,alsorepresentedinthisbook,ofthe workthathasbeendonebygenerationsofactivist-intellectuals,bothNative andnon-Native.Inthecontextofcollaborationandsolidarity,theauthors suggest,itisalsopossibletospeakaboutandanalyzeinternaldivisionsand differencesinproductiveandinclusiveways. Athirdandfinalsalientthemehereisthatindigenoustheorizingand translation—understood as the interpretation, reinterpretation, and improvementofideasandconceptsintheirtransitionfromonelanguageor epistemology to another—transform our understanding of national and globalprocessesandhistories.Indigenoushistoriesthemselveshavenever reallybeenlocal,exceptintheeyesofthecolonizers.Rather,theyhavefrom theverybeginningparticipatedandbeenembeddedin,transformedby,and resistanttoglobalization.Atthesametime,withthepowerfulrevitalization worldwideofindigenousidentity-basedpoliticsandinthenewglobalized contextthathasemergedafterthefalloftheBerlinWall,thelongandcritical engagementofNativepeopleswithworldhistoriesandprocessescanmore easilyandclearlycomeintoview.Ourgoalisthatthemultipleexperiences andperspectivesofferedherecancontributetoadeeper,moregroundeddebateoverourcommon,global,andhopefullyevermoredecolonizedfuture. As became clear from the plenary session at our conference, the work of decolonizationwillnotbedoneuntilNativenarrativesandepistemologies notonlyoccupyaprominentpositionwithinthecirclewhereknowledgeis produced,butalsoconstituteacentralpartoftheknowledgethateveryone seeksout.
220 Florenciae.Mallon
reFerences
Primary Sources: Websites, Unpublished Papers, Legislation, Newspaper Articles, Historical Published Sources Los Acuerdos de San Andrés.2003.BilingualeditionSpanish–Tzotzil.Tuxtla Gutiérrez,Chiapas:GobiernodelEstado. Akaka,D.K.2009.“AkakaBill.NativeHawaiianGovernmentReorganizationAct ReintroducedinSenateandHouse.”Pressrelease,4February. ———.2005.“HawaiiCongressionalDelegationIntroducesNativeHawaiianGovernmentReorganizationAct.”Pressrelease,25January. ———.2001a.“NativeHawaiianFederalRecognitionBillIntroduced.”Pressrelease,January22. ———.2001b.“StatementofSenatorDanielK.AkakaonRevisionstotheNative HawaiianFederalRecognitionBill.”16April.http://www.senate.gov/~akaka/ speeches(accessed11August2009). ———.2000.“NativeHawaiianRecognitionBillIntroduced.”Pressrelease, 20July. Apology Resolution to acknowledge the 100th anniversary of the January 17, 1893 overthrow of the Kingdom of Hawaii, and to offer an apology to Native Hawaiians on behalf of the United States for the overthrow of the Kingdom of Hawaii.ResolutionNo.19,knownastheApologyResolution,103dCongress,23November 1993;U.S.PublicLaw103–150. Barrientos,D.1998.“InformesobreelD.L.2.885ydelaLeyNo19.253.Referenciaal Régimenjurídicoaplicablealastierrasinsulares.”Paper. DePledge,D.2003.“LawmakersAgreetoReviseHawaiianRecognitionBill.Honolulu Advertiser,14May.http://www.the.honoluluadvertiser.com(accessed 11August2009). DocumentodelaMarina.1926.Memorias, Balances, Inventarios y Registro de Propiedades. Enomoto,K.2009.“AkakaBillMayHaveaShotatLaw:OppositionContinues,But SympatheticNewPresidentCouldBeKey.”Maui News,1March.http://www .mauinews.com/page(accessed11August2009). Gómez,R.2004.Informe final sobre Catastro de tenencia, dominio y transferencias
de Inmuebles en Isla de Pascua.IsladePascua.BienesNacionales.Unpublished document. GómezVargas,J.H.2006.“ConsultoríaInternacionalparaelasesoramientoenla elaboracióndelEstatutoEspecialparaIsladePascua.Informeprimeravisita.” Unpublisheddocument. Guatemala: Memory of Silence.2003.ReportoftheCommissionforHistorical Clarification.http://www.shr.aaas.org/guatemala. Informe de la Comisión Verdad Histórica y Nuevo Trato de los Pueblos Indígenas. Santiago:GobiernodeChile. Joint-Senate Resolution to Provide for Annexing the Hawaiian Islands to the United States.1898.ResolutionNo.55,knownastheNewlandsResolution,2ndSession,55thCongress,7July1898;30Sta.atL.750;2Supp.R.S.895. KingdomofHawai‘i—InternationalTreaties.Http://www.hawaiiankingdom.org/ treaties.shtml. Libro de Registros de propiedades llevado por la Armada de Chile, Isla de Pascua.1962. Ministerio de Marina: Oficios de la Dirección General de la Armada.1902. Namuo,C.2004.“MisinformationAboundsonRevisionstoAkakabill.”Honolulu Advertiser,2May.Http://www.thehonoluluadvertiser.com/article(accessed 8August2009). Omandam,P.2003.“NativeHawaiiansWillNotBenefitbyBill,SaySomeSovereigntyGroups.”Honolulu Star-Bulletin,25February. ———.1998.“Report:AnnexationCouldBeDeclaredInvalid.”Honolulu StarBulletin.11August. Revista de Marina: Publicación Bimestral de la Armada de Chile.1983.AñoXCVIII. May–June. TallerTzotzil.1982.K’alal ich’ay mosoal/Cuando dejamos de ser aplastados: La Revolución en Chiapas.2vols.SanCristóbal:EditorialTiempo.TzotzilofZinacantánandSpanish. ———.1983.Li’i ja’ sventa tzobol chij’abtej ta komon/Organización comunitaria del trabajo.TzotzilofSanAndrésandSpanish. ———.1985.Ja’ k’u x’elan ta jpojbatik ta ilbajinel yu’un jkaxlanetik / Cómo escapamos del control de los ladinos.TzotzilofZinacantánandSpanish. ———.1986.Abtel ta Pinka.TzotzilofChamula.Republishedin1990inabilingualTzotzil–Spanishedition. ———.1988a.Lo’il yu’un Kuskat: Sk’op mol Marian Koyaso Panchin.TzotzilofChamula. ———.1988b.Buch’u lasmeltzan Jobel? / ¿Quién hizo San Cristóbal?TzotzilofChamulaandSpanish. ———.1990a.Kipaltik: Lo’il sventa k’ucha’al la jmankutik jpinkakutik / La historia de cómo compramos nuestra finca, por los socios de la Unión “Tierra Tzotzil.” TzotzilofSanAndrésandSpanish. 222 reFerences
———.1990b.Ta jlok’ta chobtik ta k’u’il / Bordando milpas.TzotzilofChamulaand Spanish. ———.1990c.Slo’il cha’vo’ kumpareil / Los dos compadres.TzotzilofZinacantán andSpanish. ———.1993.Historia de un pueblo evangelista: Triunfo Agrarista.RicardoPérez. ———.1996.Jchi’iltak ta slumal Kalifornia / Chamulas en California.Tzotzilof ChamulaandSpanish. ———.1995.“Losprimerosmesesdeloszapatistas:Unacrónicatzotzilensiete escenasbyMariánPeresTzu(XalikKusman).”J.Rus(Trans.).Ojarasca,numbers40–41,January–February1995,13–16. ———.2000.“Conversacionesininterrumpidas:Lasvocesindígenasdelmercado deSanCristóbal.”MariánPeresTzu(XalikKusman).TranslatedbyJ.Rus.J.P. ViqueiraandW.Sonnleitner,eds.,Democracia en tierras indígenas: Las elecciones en los Altos de Chiapas (1991–1998),259–67.MexicoCity:ciesas /ColegiodeMéxico/InstitutoElectoralFederal. Toro,P.P.1892.“Informesdelacomisiónnombradaparaestudiarlacolonización (JuanFernandezyPascua).”Memoria del Ministerio de Culto i Colonización, 188–216.15November. UnitedNationsGeneralAssemblyResolution1514.1960.“Declarationonthe GrantingofIndependencetoColonialCountries.” UnitedStatesCongress.1900.“TheActofCongressOrganizingHawaiiintoaTerritory,AnActtoprovideagovernmentfortheTerritoryofHawaii,April30.” Rice v. Cayetano Governor of Hawaii(98–818)528U.S.495(2000)146F.3d1075, reversed. Viotti,V.2003a.“ConservativesBlamedforStallingAkakaBill.”Honolulu Advertiser,29August. ———.2003b.“Inouye:Maybe2004forAkakaBill.”Honolulu Advertiser,30August. Secondary Sources Abu-Lughod,L.1991.“WritingagainstCulture.”Recapturing Anthropology: Working in the Present,ed.RichardG.Fox,137–62.SantaFe:SchoolofAmericanResearch. Albert,B.1995.“Oourocanibaleaquedadocéu:umacríticaxamânicadaeconomiapolíticadanaturaleza.”Série Antropologica,no.174,1–33.Departamentode Antropología,UniversidadedeBrasília. Albó,X.1998.“Expresiónindígena,diglosiaymediosdecomunicación.”Sobre las huellas de la voz: Sociolingüística de la oralidad y la escritura en su relación con la educación,ed.LuisEnriqueLópezandIngridJung,126–55.Cochabamba: Morata,proeib Andes,Dse . reFerences 223
Albó,X.,andAnaya,A.2003.Niños alegres, libres, expresivos: La audacia de la educación intercultural bilingüe en Bolivia.LaPaz:uniceF ,cipca . Alfred,T.2004.“WarriorScholarship:SeeingtheUniversityasaGroundofContention.”Indigenizing the Academy: Transforming Scholarship and Empowering Communities,ed.D.A.MihesuahandA.C.Wilson,88–99.Lincoln:University ofNebraskaPress. Allen,C.2002.Blood Narrative: Indigenous Identity in American Indian and Maori Literary and Activist Texts.Durham:DukeUniversityPress. Anonymous.2000.“Sxabwes’‘Elombligo’:Eljuegodidácticodelasmatemáticas.” C’ayu’ce4,42–43.Popayán,Colombia. Anonymous.1988.“Informesobrelasituacióndederechoshumanosdelosgrupos étnicosaborígenesenChile.”Revista Chilena de Derechos Humanos16(May), 83–91.Santiago:AcademiadeHumanismoCristiano. AnduezaGuzmán,P.2005.“LatierraenRapanuicomodesafíojurídicointercultural.”PaperpresentedattheVIInternationalConferenceonRapaNuiandthe Pacific,inReñaca,Chile. Anzaldúa,G.1987.Borderlands/La Frontera: The New Mestiza.SanFrancisco:Aunt LutteBooks. Arias,J.1984.Historia de la colonia de “Los Chorros,” Chenalhó.TuxtlaGutiérrez, Chiapas:GobiernodelEstado. Arnold,D.,andJ.deDiosYapita.2000.El rincón de las cabezas: Luchas textuales, educación y tierras en los Andes.LaPaz:uMsa ,ilca . Arratia,M.2001.Wata Muyuy: Ciclos de vida en culturas agrocéntricas y tiempos de la escuela. Una aproximación sobre gestión educativa e interculturalidad en un distrito quechua de Bolivia.BuenosAires:unesco . Asad,T.1986.“TheConceptofCulturalTranslationinBritishSocialAnthropology.”Writing Culture: The Poetics and Politics of Ethnography,ed.JamesCliffordandGeorgeE.Marcus,141–64.Berkeley:UniversityofCaliforniaPress. Aubry,A.2005.“LaexperienciadeChiapasylademocraciaintelectual,testimonio deunaprácticaalternativadelascienciassociales.”Contrahistoria4(March– August),103–7. ———.1988.El rescate del ‘libro robado’: La producción histórica del Taller Tzotzil del INAREMAC .SanCristóbal:inareMac . Aubry,A.,andA.Inda.2003.Los llamados de la memoria: Chiapas 1995–2001. TuxtlaGutiérrez,Chiapas:coneculta . ———.1998.“WhoAretheParamilitariesinChiapas?”North American Congress on Latin America31:5(March–April),8–9. Barsh,R.L.1986.“IndigenousPeoples:AnEmergingObjectofInternationalLaw,” American Journal of International Law80,369–85. Bastos,S.,andM.Camus.2003.Entre el Mecapal y el Cielo: Desarrollo del Movi-
224 reFerences
miento Maya en Guatemala.Cholsamaj,Guatemala:FacultadLatinoamericana deCienciasSociales(Flacso)–SedeGuatemala. Bastos,S.,andD.HernándezIxcoy.2005.Resarcimiento y Reconstitución del Pueblo Maya en Guatemala: Entre la acción autónoma y el reconocimiento estatal. Guatemala:n.p. BatresJáuregui,A.1989.Los indios, su historia y su civilización.Guatemala:TipografíaNacional. Benjamin,T.2000.“ATimeofReconquest:History,theMayaRevival,andthe ZapatistaRebellioninChiapas.”American Historical Review105:2,417–50. Bishop,R.1994.“InitiatingEmpoweringResearch?”New Zealand Journal of Educational Studies29:1,175–88. Blu,K.2001(1980).The Lumbee Problem: The Making of an American Indian People. Lincoln:UniversityofNebraskaPress. Bobrow-Strain,A.2007.Intimate Enemies: Landowners, Territory, and Violence in Chiapas.Durham:DukeUniversityPress. Bolaños,G.,A.Ramos,J.Rappaport,andC.Miñana.2004.¿Qué pasaría si la escuela . . . ? Treinta años de construcción educativa.Popayán,Colombia:ProgramadeEducaciónBilingüeeIntercultural,ConsejoRegionalIndígenadel Cauca. Bricker,V.R.1981.The Indian Christ, the Indian King.Austin:UniversityofTexas Press. Brooks,J.F.,ed.2002.Confounding the Color Line: The Indian–Black Experience in North America.Lincoln:UniversityofNebraskaPress. Burguete,A.,andJ.MonteroSolano.N.d.“Morirenlaimpunidad:ViolenciapolíticaenregionesindígenasdeChiapas,Cronología1974–1988.”Manuscript.San Cristóbal,Chiapas,Mexico. Burstein,J.,Á.Past,andR.Wasserstrom.1979.En sus propias palabras: Cuatro vidas tzotziles.SanCristóbal:EditorialFrayBartolomédeLasCasas. Bushnell,D.,andN.Macaulay.1988.Latin America in the Nineteenth Century. Oxford:OxfordUniversityPress. Campisi,J.1991.The Mashpee Indians: Tribe on Trial.Syracuse:SyracuseUniversity Press. Carmack,R.2001.Kik’ulmatajem le k’iche’aab’ Evolución del Reino k’iche’.Guatemala:EditorialCholsamaj. Castro-Gómez,S.2003.“Apogeoydecadenciadelateoríatradicional:Unavisión desdelosintersticios.”Estudios culturales latinoamericanos: Retos desde y sobre la región andina,ed.C.Walsh,59–72.Quito:uasb ,AbyaYala. ———.2000.“Teoríatradicionalyteoríacríticadelacultura.”La reestructuración de las ciencias sociales en América Latina,ed.S.Castro-Gómez,93–107.Bogotá: Pensar.
reFerences 225
Chakrabarty,D.2000.Provincializing Europe: Postcolonial Thought and Historical Difference.Princeton:PrincetonUniversityPress. ———.1999.“Laposcolonialidadyelartilugiodelahistoria:¿Quiénhablaen nombredelospasados‘indios’?”Pasados Poscoloniales,ed.S.Dube,441–71. MexicoCity:ElColegiodeMéxico. Chandler,N.D.1996.“TheEconomyofDesedimentation:W.E.B.DuBoisandthe DiscoursesoftheNegro.”Callaloo19:1,78–93. Chanteaux,M.1999.Las andanzas de Miguel: La biografía del padre expulsado de Chenalhó.SanCristóbal:EditorialFrayBartolomédeLasCasas. Chatterjee,P.1995.“AlternativeHistories,AlternativeNations:Nationalismand ModernHistoriographyinBengal.”Making Alternative Histories: The Practice of Archaeology and History in Non-Western Western Settings,ed.P.R.Schmidt andT.C.Patterson,229–54.SantaFe:SchoolofAmericanResearchPress. ———.1986.Nationalist Thought and the Colonial World. A Derivative Discourse? Tokyo:ZedBooks / UnitedNationsUniversity. Chávez,A.I.,ed.2001.Pop Wuj.Guatemala:tiMach . Chirix,E.2003.Alas y raíces: Afectividad de las mujeres mayas rik’in ruxik’ y ruxe’il ronojel qajowab’al ri mayab’ taq ixoqi’.Kaqla’,Guatemala:n.p. ChocuéGuasaquillo,A.A.2000.“Nuestradobleconciencia.”C’ayu’ce4,14–15. Choque,C.1982.Criterios para la normalización en la escritura de la lengua quechua en Bolivia.Sucre:p.eib . Chow,R.1995.Primitive Passions: Visuality, Sexuality, Ethnography, and Contemporary Chinese Cinema.NewYork:ColumbiaUniversityPress. Clifford,J.1988.“IdentityinMashpee.”The Predicament of Culture: TwentiethCentury Ethnography, Literature, and Art,ed.J.Clifford,277–346.Cambridge: HarvardUniversityPress. Clifford,J.,andG.Marcus,eds.1986.Writing Culture: The Poetics and Politics of Ethnography.Berkeley:UniversityofCaliforniaPress. Cobo,J.M.1987.Study of the Problem of Discrimination against Indigenous Populations.Volume5:Conclusions, Proposals and Recommendations.un Doc. E/CN.4/Sub.2/1983/21/dd8.NewYork:UnitedNations. CojtíCuxil,D.1996.“ThePoliticsofMayaRevindication.”Maya Cultural Activism in Guatemala,ed.E.F.FischerandR.McKennaBrown,19–50.Austin:UniversityofTexasPress / InstituteofLatinAmericanStudies. ———.1995.Ub’aniik ri una’ooj uchomab’aal ri maya’ tinamit: Configuración del pensamiento político del pueblo maya.Guatemala:n.p. ———.1991.Configuración del pensamiento político del Pueblo Maya.Guatemala: AsociacióndeEscritoresMayances. ———.1989.“Problemasdela‘identidadnacional’guatemalteca.”cocaDi ,Cultura Maya y Políticas de Desarrollo.B’okob’,Guatemala:n.p.
226 reFerences
Coleman,A.L.2006.“‘TelltheCourtILoveMy[Indian]Wife’:InterrogatingRace andSelf-IdentityinLoving v. Virginia.”Souls8:1,67–80. Collier,G.A.1994.Basta! Land and the Zapatista Rebellion in Chiapas.Oakland: FoodFirstBooks. ———.1991.“MesoamericanAnthropology:BetweenProductionandHegemony.” Latin American Research Review26:2,203–10. Condori,G.2003.“ExperienciascomunicacionalesdelaAsociacióndeRadioemisorasAimarasdeLaPaz.”Los andes desde los andes: Aymaranakana, qhichwanakana yatxatawipa, lup’iwipa,ed.E.Ticona,81–121.LaPaz:Yachaywasi. El Consejo de Jefes de Rapa Nui. Te Mau Hatu’O Rapa Nui.1988.Santiago:Editorial Emisión. Coronil,F.2004.“¿Globalizaciónliberaloimperialismoglobal?Cincopiezaspara armarelrompecabezasdelpresente.”Comentario Internacional,no.5,103–32. Quito:uasb . Cristino,C.,etal.1984.Isla de Pascua: Proceso, Alcances y Efectos de la Aculturación. SantiagodeChile:UniversidaddeChile. Cruikshank,J.2002.“OralHistory,NarrativeStrategies,andNativeAmericanHistoriography:PerspectivesfromtheYukonTerritory,Canada.”Clearing a Path: Theorizing the Past in Native American Studies,ed.N.Shoemaker,3–27.New York:Routledge. DelgadoPop,A.2000.“¿Quéesserindígenaalaspuertasdelnuevomilenio?” Identidad: rostros sin máscaras. Reflexiones sobre cosmovisión, género y etnicidad,ed.M.McLeodandM.L.Cabrera,15–24.Guatemala:Oxfam-Australia. DeloriaJr.,V.1988(1969).Custer Died for Your Sins: An Indian Manifesto.Norman: UniversityofOklahomaPress. DeloriaJr.,V.,andC.Lytle.1984.The Nations Within: The Past and Future of American Indian Sovereignty.NewYork:Pantheon. Dirlik,A.,V.Bahl,andP.Gran,eds.2000.History after the Three Worlds: PostEurocentric Historiographies.Lanham,Md.:RowmanandLittlefield. Dresser,D.1991.Neopopulist Solutions to Neoliberal Problems: Mexico’s National Solidarity Program.LaJolla,Calif.:CenterforU.S.–MexicanStudies. DuBois,W.E.B.1989(1903).The Souls of Black Folk.NewYork:Bantam. Eber,C.,andB.Rosenbaum.1993.“‘ThatWeMayServebeneathYourFlowery HandsandFeet:’WomenWeaversinHighlandChiapas,Mexico.”Crafts in Global Markets,ed.J.Nash,154–80.Albany:sunY Press. Eber,C.,andJ.M.Tanski.2001.“ObstaclesFacingWomen’sGrassrootsDevelopmentStrategiesinMexico.”Review of Radical Political Economics33,441–60. Escobar,A.2000.“Ellugardelanaturalezaylanaturalezadellugar:¿globalización opostdesarrollo?”La colonialidad del saber: Eurocentrismo y ciencias sociales, perspectivas latinoamericanas,ed.E.Lander,113–43.BuenosAires:clacso .
reFerences 227
———.1999.El final del salvaje: Naturaleza, cultura y política en la antropología contemporánea.Bogotá:cerec ,ican . Esquit,E.2004.“LasRutasquenosOfrecenelPasadoyelPresente:ActivismoPolítico,HistoriayPuebloMaya.”Memorias del Mestizaje,ed.D.A.Euraque,J.L. Gould,andC.Hale,167–92.Guatemala:cirMa . Fanon,F.2004.The Wretched of the Earth.NewYork:Grove,2004. Fenton,S.,andP.Moon.2002.“TheTranslationoftheTreatyofWaitangi:ACase ofDisempowerment.”Translation and Power,ed.M.TymoczkoandE.Gentzler,25–44.Amherst:UniversityofMassachusettsPress. FernándezOsco,M.2000.La ley del ayllu: Práctica de jach’a justicia y jisk’a justicia (justicia mayor y justicia menor) en comunidades aymaras.LaPaz:pieb . Field,L.1999.“ComplicitiesandCollaborations:Anthropologistsandthe‘UnacknowledgedTribes’ofCalifornia.”Current Anthropology40(2),193–209. Fischer,E.2001.Cultural Logics and Global Economies.Austin:UniversityofTexas Press. Fischer,E.,andM.Brown,eds.1999.Rujotayixik ri maya’ b’anob’al. Activismo Cultural Maya.Guatemala:EditorialCholsamaj. Fishman,J.1995.Sociología del lenguaje.4thedn.Madrid:Cátedra. Florescano,E.2001.“Memoriaindígena:Unnuevoenfoquesobrelaconstrucción delpasado.”Trayectorias, Revista de Ciencias Sociales,no.4/5,133–41.Mexico City:UniversidadAutónomadeNuevoLeón. Foley,N.2002.“BecomingHispanic:Mexican-AmericansandWhiteness.”White Privilege: Essential Reading on the Other Side of Racism,ed.P.S.Rothenberg, 49–59.NewYork:Worth. Forbes,J.1993.Africans and Native Americans: The Language of Race and the Evolution of Red-Black Peoples.2dedn.Urbana:UniversityofIllinoisPress. Freire,P.1969.La educación como práctica de la libertad.Montevideo:TierraNueva. Garcés,F.2006.“Herramientasparapensarlaglobalización,elcapitalismoyla culturasinmorirenelintento.”Punto Cero: Revista de la carrera de communicación social,no.12:43–58.Cochabamba:ucb . ———.2005a.“Laspolíticasdelconocimientoylacolonialidadlingüísticayepistémica.”Pensamiento crítico y matriz (de)colonial: Reflexiones latinoamericanas, ed.C.Walsh,137–67.Quito:AbyaYala,uasb . ———.2005b.De la voz al papel: La escritura quechua del Periódico CONOSUR Ñawpaqman.LaPaz:cenDa ,Plural. Garcés,F.,andS.Guzmán.2006.“La‘escuelaayni’deRumiMuqu.”Escuelas y proceses de cambins,ed.AlejandraRamírez,35–44.Cochabamba:cesu . ———.2003.Educacionqa kawsayninchikmanta kawsayninchikpaq kanan tiyan. Elementos para diversificar el currículo de la Nación Quechua.Cochabamba: cenaq .
228 reFerences
García,F.2005.Yachay. Concepciones sobre enseñanza y aprendizaje en una comunidad quechua.LaPaz:Plural,pinseib ,proeib Andes. GarcíaRuiz,J.1992.Historias de nuestra historia.Guatemala:iripaZ . Garza,A.M.,andS.Toledo.2008.“Women,AgrarianismandMilitancy:Chiapas inthe1980s.”Latin American Perspectives35:6,61–78. Gilroy,P.1993.The Black Atlantic: Modernity and Double Consciousness.Cambridge: HarvardUniversityPress. GonzálezCasanova,P.1965.“InternalColonialismandNationalDevelopment.” Studies in Comparative Development1:4,27–37. Goody,J.1996(1968).“Introducción.”Cultura escrita en sociedades tradicionales, ed.J.Goody,11–38.Barcelona:Gedisa. Gottret,G.1999.“Interculturalidadenelaula.”Interculturalidad y calidad de los aprendizajes en ámbitos escolares urbanos,ed.N.Mengoa,31–40.LaPaz:CentroBolivianodeInvestigaciónyAcciónEducativas. Grandin,G.2000.The Blood of Guatemala: A History of Race and Nation.Durham: DukeUniversityPress. Greenbaum,S.“What’sinaLabel?IdentityProblemsofSouthernIndianTribes.” Journal of Ethnic Studies19:2(summer1991),107–26. Griswold,E.A.1996.“StateHegemonyWrit:InternationalLawandIndigenous Rights.”Political and Legal Anthropology Review19:1,91–104. GuamánPomadeAyala,F.1993(1615).Nueva Coronica y Buen Gobierno.Editedby F.Pease.TranslatedbyJ.Szeminski.MexicoCity:FondodeCulturaEconómica. Gugelberger,G.1996.The Real Thing: Testimonial Discourse and Latin America. Durham:DukeUniversityPress. Guha,R.,andG.C.Spivak,eds.1998.Selected Subaltern Studies.NewYork:Oxford UniversityPress. Guzmán,S.2005.“Elquechuaenlasradiosurbanas.”Presentationgivenatthe NationalSeminarLaslenguasandinasysuenseñanzaencontextosurbanos. Cochabamba,24–26November2005. GuzmánBöckler,C.,andJ.Herbert.1998.Guatemala: Una interpretación histórico social.Guatemala:EditorialCholsamaj. Hale,C.R.2002.“DoesMulticulturalismMenace?Governance,CulturalRights andthePoliticsofIdentityinGuatemala.”Journal of Latin American Studies34, 485–524. Hale,C.R.,andR.Millamán.2006.“CulturalAgencyandPoliticalStruggleinthe EraoftheIndio Permitido.”Cultural Agency in the Americas,ed.D.Sommer, 281–304.Durham:DukeUniversityPress. Harvey,N.1998.The Chiapas Rebellion: The Struggle for Land and Democracy.Durham:DukeUniversityPress. Hasager,U.,andJ.Friedman.1994.Hawai‘i Return to Nationhood.Copenhagen: InternationalWorkingGroupforIndigenousAffairs,Documentno.75. reFerences 229
Heise,M.,F.Tubino,andW.Ardito.1994.Interculturalidad: Un desafío.Lima:CentroAmazónicodeAntropologíayAplicaciónPráctica. HernándezCastillo,R.A.,ed.2001.The Other Word: Women and Violence in Chiapas before and after Acteal.Copenhagen:InternationalWorkGroupfor IndigenousAffairs. Herrero,J.,andF.SánchezdeLozada.1979.Diccionario quechua: Estructura semántica del quechua cochabambino contemporáneo.Cochabamba:ceFco . Hill,R.2001.Los kaqchikeles de la época colonial.PlumsockMesoamericanStudies. Guatemala:EditorialCholsamaj. Howe,L.2002.“TheStoryofAmerica:ATribalography.”Clearing a Path: Theorizing the Past in Native American Studies,ed.N.Shoemaker,29–48.NewYork: Routledge. HurtadodeMendoza,W.2002.Pragmática de la cultura y la lengua quechua.Quito: AbyaYala. James,D.2000.Doña María’s Story: Life History, Memory, and Political Identity. Durham:DukeUniversityPress. Jameson,F.1991(1984).El posmodernismo o la lógica cultural del posmodernismo avanzado.Barcelona:Paidós. Jones,D.J.1970.“TowardsaNativeAnthropology.”Human Organization29:4, 251–59. Kame‘eleihiwa,L.1992.Native Land and Foreign Desires.Honolulu:BishopMuseumPress. Kauanui,J.K.2008.“ColonialisminEquality:HawaiianSovereigntyandtheQuestionofUSCivilRights.”South Atlantic Quarterly107:4(October),635–50. ———.2005a.“TheMultiplicityofHawaiianSovereigntyClaimsandtheStruggle forMeaningfulAutonomy.”Comparative American Studies3:3,283–99. ———.2005b.“PrecariousPositions:NativeHawaiiansandFederalRecognition.” Contemporary Pacific17:1,1–27. ———.2002.“ThePoliticsofBloodandSovereigntyinRice v. Cayetano.”Political and Legal Anthropology Review25:1,100–128. Kent,N.1993.Hawai‘i: Islands under the Influence.2dedn.Honolulu:Universityof Hawai‘iPress. Kirch,P.V.2000.On the Road of the Winds: An Archeological History of the Pacific Islands before European Contact.Berkeley:UniversityofCaliforniaPress. Kotschi,T.,W.Oesterreicher,andK.Zimmermann,eds.1996.El español hablado y la cultura oral en España e Hispanoamérica.Madrid:Iberoamericana. Kristeva,J.1982.Semiótica I.Madrid:Espiral. Laclau,E.,andC.Mouffe.1985.Hegemony and Socialist Strategy: Towards a Radical Democratic Politics.London:Verso. Laime,T.1998.Qhichwata allinta qillqanapaq p’anqa. Manual de ortografía quechua. LaPaz:ceipliM . 230 reFerences
Lakoff,G.,andM.Jonson.1995(1980).Metáforas de la vida cotidiana.Madrid: Cátedra. Lam,M.C.2000.At the Edge of the State: Indigenous Peoples and Self-Determination. Ardsley,N.Y.:Transnational. ———.1992.“MakingRoomforPeoplesattheUnitedNations:ThoughtsProvokedbyIndigenousClaimstoSelf-Determination.”Cornell International Law Journal25:3,603–22. Lame,M.Q.2004(1939).Los pensamientos del indio que se educó dentro de las selvas colombianas.CaliandPopayán,Colombia:EditorialUniversidaddel Valle/EditoralUniversidaddelCauca. Lander,E.2002a.“Lautopíadelmercadototalyelpoderimperial.”Revista venezolana de Economía y Ciencias Sociales8:2,51–79. ———.2002b.“Losderechosdepropiedadintelectualenlageopolíticadelsaber delasociedadglobal.”Indisciplinar las ciencias sociales: Geopolíticas del conocimiento y colonialidad del poder, Perspectivas desde lo andino,ed.C.Walsh, F.Schiwy,andS.Castro-Gómez,73–102.Quito:uasb ,AbyaYala. Laughlin,R.M.1993.“Enlavanguardia:SnaJtz’ibajom.”Situación actual y perspectivas de las literaturas en lenguas indígenas,ed.C.Montemayor155–72.Mexico City:coneculta . Legorreta,C.1998.Religión, política y guerrilla en Las Cañadas de la Selva Lacandona.MexicoCity:CalyArena. LeyvaSolano,X.2003.“Regional,Communal,andOrganizationalTransformationsinLasCañadas.”Mayan Lives, Mayan Utopias: The Indigenous People of Chiapas and the Zapatista Movement,ed.J.Rus,R.A.HernándezCastillo,and S.L.Mattiace,161–84.Lanham,Md.:RowmanandLittlefield. Lienhard,M.1992.La voz y su huella: Escritura y conflicto étnico-cultural en América Latina 1492–1988.3dedn.Lima:Horizonte. Lipsitz,G.1998.American Studies in a Moment of Danger.Minneapolis:University ofMinnesotaPress. ———.2006(1998).The Possessive Investment in Whiteness: How White People Profit from Identity Politics.Philadelphia:TempleUniversityPress. Littlefield,D.F.1977.Africans and Seminoles: From Removal to Emancipation.Westport,Conn.:GreenwoodPress. Lomnitz-Adler,C.1995.Las salidas del Laberinto.MexicoCity:EditorialPlaneta. Loomba,A.,S.Kaul,M.Bunzl,A.Burton,andJ.Esty,eds.2005.Postcolonial Studies and Beyond.Durham:DukeUniversityPress. López,L.E.1999.“Ellenguajeeneldesarrollodelosconocimientosenámbitos escolaresurbanoscondiversidadcultural.”Interculturalidad y calidad de los aprendizajes en ámbitos escolares urbanos,ed.N.Mengoa,47–70.LaPaz:CentroBolivianodeInvestigaciónyAcciónEducativas. ———.1996.“Nomásdanzasderatonesgrises:Sobreinterculturalidad,democrareFerences 231
ciayeducación.”Educación e interculturalidad en los Andes y la Amazonía,ed. J.GodenzziAlegre,23–80.SerieEstudiosyDebatesRegionalesAndinos,93. Cusco:CentrodeEstudiosRegionalesBartolomédeLasCasas. ———.1995.La educación en áreas indígenas de América Latina: Apreciaciones comparativas desde la educación bilingüe intercultural.GuatemalaCity:Centro deEstudiosdelaCulturaMaya. López,L.E.,andW.Küper.2004.La educación intercultural bilingüe en América Latina.LaPaz,Cochabamba:pinseib ,proeib Andes. Loveman,B.2001(1979).Chile: The Legacy of Hispanic Capitalism.Oxford:Oxford UniversityPress. Luykx,A.1998.“Ladiferenciafuncionaldecódigosyelfuturodelaslenguasminoritarias.”Sobre las huellas de la voz: Sociolingüística de la oralidad y la escritura en su relación con la educación,ed.L.E.LópezandI.Jung,192–212.Madrid, Cochabamba,Bonn:Morata,proeib Andes,Dse . ———.2001.“DiversityintheNewWorldOrder:StateLanguagePoliciesandthe InternationalizationofQuechua.”AbstractofpaperpresentedattheSecond SpencerEarlyCareerInstituteinAnthropologyandEducation:Globalization andEducation,10–13May.Chicago. McCall,G.1976.“ReactiontoDisaster:ContinuityandChangeinRapanuiSocial Organization.”Ph.D.diss.,AustralianNationalUniversity. Makihara,M.1999.“Bilingualism,SocialChange,andthePoliticsofEthnicityon Rapanui(EasterIsland),Chile.”Ph.D.diss.,YaleUniversity. Mannheim,B.1991.The Language of the Inka since the European Invasion.Austin: UniversityofTexasPress. Marcone,J.1997.La oralidad escrita: Sobre la reivindicación y la re-inscripción del discurso oral.Lima:puc-p . Marcus,G.1995.“Ethnographyin/oftheWorldSystem:TheEmergenceofMulti- SitedEthnography.”Annual Review of Anthropology,24,95–117. Marcus,G.,andM.Fischer.1986.Anthropology as a Cultural Critique: An Experimental Moment in the Human Sciences.Chicago:UniversityofChicagoPress. Marimán,Pablo,SergioCaníuqueo,JoséMillalén,andRodrigoLevil.2006. ¡...Escucha,winka...!CuatroensayosdeHistoriaNacionalMapucheyun epílogosobreelfuturo.Santiago,Chile:loM Ediciones. MartínezPeláez,S.1973.La Patria del Criollo.CostaRica:eDuca . Menchú,R.1984.I, Rigoberta Menchú.EditedbyElisabethBurgos.London:Verso. Mengoa,N.1999.“Diversidadyprocesospedagógicos:Lineamientosparaunapropuestadeeducacióninterculturalenescuelasurbano-popularesdelaregión andinaenBolivia.”Interculturalidad y calidad de los aprendizajes en ámbitos escolares urbanos,ed.N.Mengoa,11–20.LaPaz:CentroBolivianodeInvestigaciónyAcciónEducativas.
232 reFerences
Merrell,J.H.1984.“TheRacialEducationoftheCatawbaIndians.”Journal of Southern History50:3,363–84. Merry,S.2000.Colonizing Hawai‘i: The Cultural Power of Law.Princeton:PrincetonUniversityPress. Métraux,A.1971(1940).Ethnology of Easter Island.Honolulu:BishopMuseumPress. Mignolo,W.2004.“Capitalismoygeopolíticadelconocimiento.”Modernidades Coloniales,ed.S.Dube,I.BanergeeDube,andW.Mignolo.MexicoCity:El ColegiodeMéxico. ———.2002.“Elpotencialepistemológicodelahistoriaoral:AlgunascontribucionesdeSilviaRiveraCusicanqui.”Estudios y otras prácticas intelectuales latinoamericanas en cultura y poder,ed.D.Mato,201–11.Caracas:clacso , Faces . ———.2001.“Introducción.”Capitalismo y geopolítica del conocimiento: El eurocentrismo y la filosofía de la liberación en el debate intelectual contemporáneo, 9–53.BuenosAires:Signo. ———.2000.Local Histories / Global Designs. Coloniality, Subaltern Knowledges and Border Thinking.Princeton:PrincetonUniversityPress. ———.1999.“Globalización,procesoscivilizatoriosylareubicacióndelenguasy culturas.”Pensar (en) los intersticios: Teoría y práctica de la crítica poscolonial, ed.S.Castro-Gómez,O.Guardiola-Rivera,andC.MillándeBenavides,55–74. Bogotá:Pensar. Mihesuah,D.A.2004.“ShouldAmericanIndianHistoryRemainaFieldofStudy?” Indigenizing the Academy: Transforming Scholarship and Empowering Communities,ed.D.A.MihesuahandA.C.Wilson,143–59.Lincoln:UniversityofNebraskaPress. Mihesuah,D.A.,ed.1998.Natives and Academics: Researching and Writing about American Indians.Lincoln:UniversityofNebraskaPress. Mihesuah,D.A.,andA.C.Wilson,eds.2004.Indigenizing the Academy: Transforming Scholarship and Empowering Communities.Lincoln:UniversityofNebraskaPress. Miles,T.2004.The Ties that Bind: The Story of an Afro-Cherokee Family in Slavery and Freedom.Berkeley:UniversityofCaliforniaPress. Miles,T.,andS.P.Holland,eds.2006.Crossing Waters, Crossing Worlds: The African Diaspora in Indian Country.Durham:DukeUniversityPress. Mills,G.B.1977.The Forgotten People: Cane River’s Creoles of Color.BatonRouge: LouisianaStateUniversityPress. Minugua .2001.Proceso de negociación de la Paz en Guatemala.Guatemala: Minugua . Montejo,V.2005.Maya Intellectual Renaissance: Identity, Representation and Leadership.Austin:UniversityofTexasPress. ———.2004.“AngeringtheAncestors:TransnationalismandEconomicTransforreFerences 233
mationofMayaCommunitiesinWesternGuatemala.”Pluralizing Ethnography: Comparison and Representation in Maya Cultures, Histories, and Identities, ed.J.WatanabeandE.Fischer,231–56.SantaFe:SchoolofAmericanResearch Press. ———.2002.“TheMultiplicityofMayaVoices:MayaLeadershipandthePolitics ofSelf-Representation.”Indigenous Movements, Self-Representation, and the State in Latin America,ed.K.B.WarrenandJ.Jackson,123–48.Austin:UniversityofTexasPress. ———.1999.Voices from Exile: Violence and Survival in Modern Maya History. Norman:UniversityofOklahomaPress. ———.1997.“Panmayanismo:Lapluriformidaddelaculturamayayelprocesode autorepresentacióndelosmayas.”Mesoamérica,no.33,93–123.Antigua,Guatemala:cirMa ,pMs . ———.1987.Testimony: The Death of a Guatemalan Village.Willimantic,Conn.: CurbstonePress. Morales,M.R.1998.La articulación de las diferencias.Guatemala:Flacso - Guatemala. MoralesBermúdez,J.1992.“ElCongresoIndígenadeChiapas:Untestimonio.” Anuario 1991,242–370.InstitutoChiapanecodelaCultura,TuxtlaGutiérrez. Morrison,T.1988.Beloved.NewYork:Plume. MuelasHurtado,B.1995.“Relaciónespacio-tiempoenelpensamientoguambiano.” Proyecciones Lingüísticas1:1,31–40. Muyulema,A.2001.“Delacuestiónindígenaaloindígenacomocuestionamiento: Haciaunacríticadellatinoamericanismo,elindigenismoyelmestiz(o)aje.”Convergencia de tiempos: Estudios subalternos/contextos latinoamericanos. Estado, cultura y subalternidad,ed.I.Rodríguez,327–63.Amsterdam:EditionsRodopi. Nannerl,O.K.,M.Z.Rosaldo,andB.C.Gelpi,eds.1982.Feminist Theory: A Critique of Ideology.Chicago:UniversityofChicagoPress. Nash,J.1993.Crafts in Global Markets: Changes in Artisan Production in Middle America.Albany:StateUniversityofNewYorkPress. Newcomb,S.2008.Pagans in the Promised Land: Decoding the Doctrine of Christian Discovery.Golden,Colo.:Fulcrum. Norval,A.2001.“ReconstructingNationalIdentityandRenegotiatingMemory: TheWorkoftheTRC.”States of Imagination: Ethnographic Explorations of the Postcolonial State,ed.T.BlomHansenandF.Stepputat,182–202.Durham: DukeUniversityPress. Olson,D.1998(1994).El mundo sobre el papel: El impacto de la escritura y la lectura en la estructura del conocimiento.Barcelona:Gedisa. Omi,M.,andH.Winant.1994.Racial Formation in the United States from the 1960s to the 1990s.2dedn.NewYork:Routledge. Ong,W.1992.“WritingIsaTechnologythatRestructuresThought.”The Linguis234 reFerences
tics of Literacy,ed.P.Downing,S.Lima,andM.Noonan,293–319.Philadelphia: JohnBenjamins. ———.1999(1982).Oralidad y escritura: Tecnologías de la palabra.MexicoCity: Fce . Osorio,J.K.2002.Dismembering Lahui: A History of the Hawaiian Nation to 1887. Honolulu:UniversityofHawai‘iPress. PachacutiYamquiSalcamaygua,J.1993(1613).Relacion de antiguiedades deste reyno del Piru.EstudioetnohistóricoylingüísticodePierreDuviolsyCésarItier. Lima,Cuzco:iFea ,cbc . PanchoAquite,A.,etal.2004.Educación superior indígena en Colombia: Una apuesta de futuro y esperanza.Cali,Colombia:iesalc –unesco . Pari,A.2005.“Epistemologíadelconocimientocientíficoandino:yachaymanta yachay.”Qinasay, Revista de Educación Intercultural Bilingüe3:3,67–81.Cochabamba:proeib Andes. Paschal,R.1991.“TheImprimaturofRecognition:AmericanIndianTribesandthe FederalAcknowledgmentProcess.”Washington Law Review66(1991),209–28. Past,Á.2005.“NotesontheCreators.”Incantations by Mayan Women,ed.Á.Past, X.Okotz,andX.Ernándes,257–84.SanCristóbal:TallerLeñateros. ———.1989(1980).Bon, tintes naturales.SanCristóbal:TallerLeñateros. Paz,S.2005.“PropuestabaseparapensarlasautonomíasindígenasenBolivia.” PapergivenintheSeminarTerritoriosindígenas,interculturalidad,participaciónyautonomías.Cochabamba,3–4March. PazParedes,L.,R.Cobo,andA.Bartra.1996.“Dossiglosdecafeticulturaen Méxicoamuchasvoces.”Ojarasca,no.46,26–49. Perdue,T.1999.Cherokee Women: Gender and Culture Change, 1700–1835.Lincoln: UniversityofNebraskaPress. ———.1979.Slavery and the Evolution of Cherokee Society, 1540–1866.Knoxville: UniversityofTennesseePress. PeresTzu,M.2002.“ATzotzilChronicle.”The Mexico Reader,ed.G.Josephand T.Henderson,655–69.Durham:DukeUniversityPress. Pérez,Calvo,J.1993.Pragmática y gramática del quechua cuzqueño.Cuzco:cbc . Pewewardy,C.2004.“SoYouThinkYouHiredan‘Indian’FacultyMember?:The EthnicFraudParadoxinHigherEducation.”Indigenizing the Academy: Transforming Scholarship and Empowering Native Communities,ed.D.A.Mihesuah andA.C.Wilson,200–217.Lincoln:UniversityofNebraskaPress. Phillips,V.J.2002.“Epilogue:SeeingEachOtherthroughtheWhiteMan’sEyes.” Confounding the Color Line: The Indian–Black Experience in North America,ed. J.Brooks,371–85.Lincoln:UniversityofNebraskaPress. Plaza,P.1995.Qhichwata qillqanapaq.LaPaz:MDh ,unst-p . Portelli,A.1997.The Battle of Valle Giulia: Oral History and the Art of Dialogue, Madison:UniversityofWisconsinPress. reFerences 235
———.1991.The Death of Luigi Trastulli and Other Stories: Form and Meaning in Oral History.Albany:StateUniversityofNewYorkPress. ———.1989.“Historiaymemoria:LamuertedeLuigiTrastulli.”Historia y fuente oral,no.1,15–32.Barcelona:UniversidaddeBarcelona. Porteous,D.1981.The Modernization of Easter Island.Victoria,BritishColumbia: UniversityofVictoriaPress. Postero,N.2005.“Movimientosindígenasbolivianos:Articulacionesyfragmentacionesenbúsquedademulticulturalismo.”Movimientos Indígenas y Estado en Bolivia,ed.L.E.LópezandP.Regalsky,53–96.LaPaz:proeib Andes,cenDa , Plural. Pozas,R.1962.Juan, the Chamula.Berkeley:UniversityofCaliforniaPress. ———.1952.“Eltrabajoenlasplantacionesdecaféyelcambiosocio-culturaldel indio.”Revista Mexicana de Estudios Antropológicos12:1,31–48. Prakash,G.,ed.1995.After Colonialism: Imperial Histories and Postcolonial Displacements.Princeton:PrincetonUniversityPress. Qayum,S.2002.“Nationalism,InternalColonialismandtheSpatialImagination: TheGeographicSocietyofLaPazinTurn-of-the-CenturyBolivia.”Studies in the Formation of the Nation-State in Latin America,ed.J.Dunkerley,275–98. London:InstituteofLatinAmericanStudies,UniversityofLondon. Quijano,A.2000.“Colonialidaddelpoderyclasificaciónsocial.”Journal of WorldSystems Research6:2,342–86. Quiroz,A.1998.Chichwa simipirwa.Qullasuyu,Bolivia:Mec yD ,uniceF . Racancoj,V.1994.Socioeconomía maya precolonial.Guatemala:EditorialCholsamaj. Raibmon,P.2005.Authentic Indians: Episodes of Encounter from the LateNineteenth-Century Northwest Coast.Durham:DukeUniversityPress. Rajpopi’riMayab’Amaq’coMg .1995.Ru junamil ri Mayab’ Amaq’ pa Rubi’inib’al Runuk’ik ri Saqk’aslemal. Construyendo un futuro para nuestro pasado.Guatemala:EditorialCholsamaj. Ramos,A.,andCabildoIndígenadeMosoco.1993.Ec ne’hwe’s’: Constitución política de Colombia en nasa yuwe.Bogotá:ccela -UniAndes. Rappaport,J.2008.“BeyondParticipantObservation:CollaborativeEthnography asTheoreticalInnovation.”Collaborative Anthropologies1,1–31. ———.2005.“LosnasadefronteraylapolíticadelaidentidadenelCaucaIndígena.”Retornando la mirada: Una investigación colaborativa interétnica sobre el Cauca a la entrada del milenio,ed.J.Rappaport,31–56.Popayán,Colombia: EditorialUniversidaddelCauca. ———.2004.“Imaginandounanaciónpluralista:Intelectualesylajurisdicción especialindígena.”Revista Colombiana de Antropología39,105–38. ———.1998.The Politics of Memory: Native Historical Interpretation in the Colombian Andes.Durham:DukeUniversityPress. 236 reFerences
Regalsky,P.2003.Etnicidad y clase: El Estado boliviano y las estrategias andinas de manejo de su espacio.LaPaz:cenDa ,ceiDis ,Plural. ReuquePaillalef,R.I.2002a.When a Flower Is Reborn: The Life and Times of a Mapuche Feminist.EditedandtranslatedbyF.E.Mallon.Durham:DukeUniversityPress. ———.2002b.Una flor que renace: Autobiografía de una dirigente Mapuche.Santiago,Chile:DibaM . Rivera,S.2004(1987).“Elpotencialepistemológicoyteóricodelahistoriaoral: Delalógicainstrumentalaladescolonizacióndelahistoria.”Peri-feria,no.4, 16–26.Neiva:EditorialUniversidadSurcolombiana. RiveraCusicanqui,S.,andR.Barragán.1997.“Presentación.”Debates Post Coloniales: Una Introducción a los Estudios de la Subalternidad,ed.S.RiveraCusicanquiandR.Barragán,11–19.LaPaz,Bolivia:Editorialhistorias/Ediciones Aruwiyiri/sephis . Rochna-Ramírez,S.1996.La propiedad de la tierra en Isla de Pascua.Santiago: conaDi . Rodríguez,D.R.2004.“Racismoydiscriminación:Conceptualizaciónysusmanifestaciones.”Genocidio, la máxima expresión del racismo.Guatemala:calDh . Rodríguez,D.R.,etal.1995.Nab’ey taq tzij pa ruwi’ ri maya’ k’aslemal. Introducción a la cultura maya.Guatemala:EditorialCholsamaj. RojasCurieux,T.2000.“Transportarlacosahabladaaotralengua:Laexperiencia delatraduccióndelaConstitucióndelaRepúblicaalenguasindígenas.”Concepciones de la Conquista: Aproximaciones interdisciplinarias,ed.F.Castañeda andM.Vollet,361–88.Bogotá:EdicionesUniAndes. Romero,R.1994.Ch’iki: Concepción y desarrollo de la inteligencia en niños quechuas pre-escolares de la comunidad de Titicachi.LaPaz:cee ,peib . Rothenberg,P.S.,ed.2002.White Privilege: Essential Readings on the Other Side of Racism.NewYork:Worth. Rountree,H.C.1990.Pocahontas’s People: The Powhatan Indians of Virginia through Four Centuries.Norman:UniversityofOklahomaPress. Routledge,K.1998(1919).The Mystery of Easter Island.Kempton,Australia:AdventurersUnlimitedPress. Rus,D.1990.La Crisis y la mujer indígena: El caso de Chamula, Chiapas.San Cristóbal:inareMac . Rus,D.,andJ.Rus.2004.“LosúltimosdiezañosenlascomunidadesdeLosAltos enelcontextodelosúltimostreinta.”Paperpresentedtothesymposium Chiapas,10añosdespués.SanCristóbal,23–27August. Rus,J.2005.“TheStruggleagainstIndigenousCaciquesinHighlandChiapas,1965– 1993.”Cacique and Caudillo in 20th Century Mexico,ed.A.KnightandW.Pansters,169–200.London:InstituteforLatinAmericanStudies. ———.2004.“RereadingTzotzilEthnography:RecentScholarshipfromChiapas, reFerences 237
Mexico.”Pluralizing Ethnography: Comparison and Representation in Maya Cultures, Histories and Identities,ed.J.WatanabeandE.Fischer,199–230.SantaFe: SchoolofAmericanResearch. ———.1995.“LocalAdaptationtoGlobalChange:TheReorderingofNativeSocietyinHighlandChiapas,1974–1994.”European Review of Latin American and Caribbean Studies58,82–91. ———.1989.“The‘CasteWar’of1869fromtheIndians’Perspective:AChallenge forEthnoHistory.”Memorias del Segundo Coloquio Internacional de Mayistas 2,1033–47.MexicoCity:CentrodeEstudiosMayas,unaM . ———.1983.“WhoseCasteWar?Indians,Ladinos,andthe‘CasteWar’of1869.” Spaniards and Indians in Southeastern Mesoamerica,ed.M.MacLeodandR.W. Wasserstrom,127–68.Lincoln:UniversityofNebraskaPress. Rus,J.,ed.1999.If Truth Be Told: A Forum on David Stoll’s “Rigoberta Menchú and the Story of All Poor Guatemalans.”SpecialissueofLatin American Perspectives 26:6. Rus,J.,andG.A.Collier.2003.“AGenerationofCrisisintheChiapasHighlands: TheTzotzilsofChamulaandZinacantán,1974–2000.”Mayan Lives, Mayan Utopias: The Indigenous People of Chiapas and the Zapatista Movement,ed. J.Rus,R.A.HernándezCastillo,andS.L.Mattiace,33–61.Lanham,Md.:RowmanandLittlefield. Rus,J.,R.A.HernándezCastillo,andS.L.Mattiace,eds.2003.Mayan Lives, Mayan Utopias: The Indigenous People of Chiapas and the Zapatista Movement.Lanham,Md.:RowmanandLittlefield. Rus,J.,andG.Morquecho.2008.“ElmovimientoindígenadeSanCristóbal, Chiapas,Mexico.”PaperpresentedtotheconferenceEnduringReform,ResponsestoCivilSociety-BasedReform.PortoAlegre,Brazil,22–24November. Rus,J.,andJ.D.Vigil.2007.“RapidUrbanizationandMigrantIndigenousYouthin SanCristóbal,Chiapas.”Gangs in the Global City,ed.JohnHagedorn,152–83. Urbana:UniversityofIllinoisPress. Said,E.W.1978.Orientalism.NewYork:Pantheon. Santos,B.2003.“Desigualdad,exclusiónyglobalización:Hacialaconstrucción multiculturaldelaigualdadyladiferencia.”La caída del Angelus Novus: Ensayos para una nueva teoría social y una nueva práctica política,ed.B.Santos, 125–65.Bogotá:ilsa ,UniversidadNacionaldeColombia. Saunt,C.2005.Black, White, and Indian: Race and the Unmaking of an American Family.Oxford:OxfordUniversityPress. ———.1999.A New Order of Things: Property, Power, and the Transformation of the Creek Indians, 1733–1816.Cambridge:CambridgeUniversityPress. Schele,L.,andN.Grube.1999.“ElTallermayadeescriturajeroglífica.”Rujotayixik ri maya’ b’anob’al. Activismo Cultural maya,ed.E.FischerandM.Brown,175– 86.Guatemala:EditorialCholsamaj. 238 reFerences
Scott,J.2002.“Prólogo.”Aspectos cotidianos de la Formación del Estado,ed. G.JosephandD.Nugent,17–23.MexicoCity:EditorialEra. Sichra,I.2003.La vitalidad del quechua: Lengua y sociedad en dos provincias de Cochabamba.LaPaz:proeib Andes,Plural. Sieder,R.2004.Del indigenismo institucional integracionista a la gestión pluralista de las políticas públicas.London:InstitutefortheStudyoftheAmericas,UniversityofLondon. Silva,N.K.2007.“IndigenousHawaiianPoliticalThought.”PresentationonNew ResearchProject,WesleyanUniversity,April. ———.2004.Aloha Betrayed: Native Hawaiian Resistance to American Colonialism.Durham:DukeUniversityPress. ———.1998.“KanakaMaoliResistancetoAnnexation.”‘oiwi: a native hawaiian journal.Inauguralissue(December),40–80. SilvaGaldames,O.1995.Breve historia contemporánea de Chile.MexicoCity:Fondo deCulturaEconómica. SincalCoyote,E.2004.“Eliteseidentidades:Ladiferenciaciónsocialdelsector profesionalindígenadePatzún,Chimaltenango.”Thesis,UniversidaddeSan CarlosdeGuatemala. SociedadBíblicadeMéxico.1997.Xch’ul C’op Jtotic Dios.MexicoCity:Sociedad BíblicadeMéxico,S.A. Spaulding,T.M.1923.The Crown Lands of Hawaii.Honolulu:UniversityofHawai‘i Press. Spivak,G.C.1988.“CantheSubalternSpeak?”Marxism and the Interpretation of Culture,ed.C.NelsonandL.Grossberg,271–313.Urbana:UniversityofIllinois Press. Starna,W.1996.“‘We’llAllBeTogetherAgain’:TheFederalAcknowledgmentof theWampanoagTribeofGayHead.”Northeast Anthropology51,3–12. Stavenhagen,R.1965.“Classes,Colonialism,andAcculturation.”Studies in Comparative Development1:6,53–77. Stoll,D.1999.Rigoberta Menchú and the Story of All Poor Guatemalans.Boulder: WestviewPress. Street,B.1984.Literacy in Theory and Practice.Cambridge:CambridgeUniversity Press. Sturm,C.1998.“BloodPolitics,RacialClassification,andCherokeeNationalIdentity:TheTrialsandTribulationsoftheCherokeeFreedmen.”American Indian Quarterly22:1–2(winter/spring1998),230–58. Subercaseaux,B.1997.Historia de las ideas y de la cultura en Chile.Vol.2:Fin de siglo: La época de Balmaceda.Santiago:EditorialUniversitaria. Tademy,T.2002.Cane River: A Novel.NewYork:Warner. Thiong’o,Ngugiwa.1986.Decolonising the Mind: The Politics of Language in African Literature.Portsmouth,N.H.:Heinemann. reFerences 239
Thompson,B.,andJ.H.Peterson,Jr.1975.“MississippiChoctawIdentity:Genesis andChange.”The New Ethnicity: Perspectives from Ethnology,ed.J.W.Bennett, 179–96.St.Paul:WestPublishing. Toledo,S.2002.Fincas, poder, y cultura en Simojovel, Chiapas.MexicoCity:UniversidadNacionalAutónomadeMéxico/UniversidadAutónomadeChiapas. ToledoLlancaqueo,V.,andS.FuenzalidaBascuñan.2005.“Reformaalartículo17 delaleyindígenaypolíticadesuelos(DL3.516):Análisispreliminardesus efectosjurídicoseimpactosterritoriales.”Notesforananalyticalworkshop. ColegiodeAntropólogosdeChile.Santiago,19May. Trask,H.2000.“SettlersofColorand‘Immigrant’Hegemony:‘Locals’inHawai‘i.” Amerasia Journal26:2,1–24. ———.1993.From a Native Daughter: Colonialism and Sovereignty in Hawai‘i. Monroe,Maine:CommonCouragePress. Trask,M.1994.“ThePoliticsofOppression.”Hawai‘i Return to Nationhood.iWgia Document75,ed.UllaHasagerandJonathanFriedman,68–87.Copenhagen: iWgia . TuhiwaiSmith,L.1999.Decolonizing Methodologies: Research and Indigenous Peoples.Dunedin,NewZealand:UniversityofOtagoPress;andLondon:Zed Books. UnitedStatesCensusBureau.2002.Measuring America: The Decennial Censuses from 1790 to 2000. Uyehara,M.1977.The Ceded Land Trusts: Their Use and Misuse.Honolulu:HawaiianaAlmanac. Vallejos,F.1995.Tata Fermin yachaq. Inti k’anchay jina yachayniyki qhipakuchkan. Cochabamba:cenDa . VanCott,D.L.2000.The Friendly Liquidation of the Past: The Politics of Diversity in Latin America.Pittsburgh:UniversityofPittsburghPress. VascoUribe,L.G.2002.Entre selva y páramo: Viviendo y pensando la lucha indígena.Bogotá:InstitutoColombianodeAntropologíaeHistoria. VascoUribe,G.,A.DaguaHurtado,andM.Aranda.1993.“Enelsegundodía,la GenteGrande(Numisak)sembrólaautoridadylasplantasy,consujugo, bebióelsentido.”Encrucijadas de Colombia amerindia,ed.F.Correa,9–48. Bogotá:InstitutoColombianodeAntropología. VelásquezNimatuj,I.A.2002.La pequeña Burguesía Indígena Comercial de Guatemala.Guatemala:serJus . Vergara,V.1939.La Isla de Pascua: Dominación y dominio.Santiago:Publicaciones delaAcademiaChilenadeHistoria. Viluche,J.2001.“¿Porquéunaorganizaciónsocialcomocric asumeunprocesodeinvestigaciónyconstruccióndelaeducaciónalternativa?”Manuscript. Popayán,Colombia. Wallace,R.1997.International Law.London:SweetandMaxwell. 240 reFerences
Warren,K.B.1999.“LalecturadelahistoriaunaformadeResistencia:Intelectuales públicosmayasenGuatemala.”Rujotayixik ri maya’ b’anob’al. Activismo Cultural maya,ed.E.FischerandM.Brown,133–54.Guatemala:EditorialCholsamaj. ———.1998.Indigenous Movements and Their Critics: Pan-Maya Activism in Guatemala.Princeton:PrincetonUniversityPress. Warrior,R.2006.“Afterword.”Crossing Waters, Crossing Worlds: The African Diaspora in Indian Country,ed.T.MilesandS.P.Holland,321–25.Durham:Duke UniversityPress. Watanabe,J.,andE.Fischer,eds.2004.Pluralizing Ethnography.SantaFe:Schoolof AmericanResearchPress. Wilkins,D.E.1997.American Indian Sovereignty and the U.S. Supreme Court: The Masking of Justice.Austin:UniversityofTexasPress. Williams,B.1989.“AClassAct:AnthropologyandRacetoNationacrossEthnic Terrain.”Annual Review of Anthropology,no.18,401–44. Williams,W.L.1979.“PatternsintheHistoryoftheRemainingSoutheasternIndians,1840–1975.”Southeastern Indians since the Removal Era,193–210.Athens: UniversityofGeorgiaPress. Wilson,A.C.2004.“ReclaimingOurHumanity:DecolonizationandtheRecovery ofIndigenousKnowledge.”Indigenizing the Academy: Transforming Scholarship and Empowering Communities,ed.D.A.MihesuahandA.C.Wilson,69–87. Lincoln:UniversityofNebraskaPress. ———.1998a.“AmericanIndianHistoryorNon-IndianPerceptionsofAmericanHistory.”Natives and Academics: Researching and Writing about American Indians,ed.D.A.Mihesuah,23–26.Lincoln:UniversityofNebraskaPress. ———.1998b.“GrandmothertoGranddaughter:GenerationsofOralHistoryina DakotaFamily.”Natives and Academics: Researching and Writing about American Indians,ed.D.A.Mihesuah,27–36.Lincoln:UniversityofNebraskaPress. Womack,J.1999.Rebellion in Chiapas: An Historical Reader.NewYork:FreePress. Yupanqui,T.C.1992(1570).Instrucción al licenciado Lope García de Castro.Edited byLilianaRegaladodeHurtado.Lima:puc-p . Zavala,V.2002.Desencuentros con la escritura: Escuela y comunidad en los andes peruanos.Lima:RedparaelDesarrollodelasCienciasSocialesenelPerú. Žižek,S.1993.“Multiculturalismo,olalógicaculturaldelcapitalismomultinacional.”Estudios culturales: Reflexiones sobre el multiculturalismo,ed. F.JamesonandS.Žižek,137–88.BuenosAires:Paidós.
reFerences 241
contributors
riet Delsing isanindependentresearcher.ShereceivedherPh.D.inanthropology fromtheUniversityofCaliforniaatSantaCruzin2009.Sheconductsresearchinthe historyandplaceofRapaNuiinthenarrativesoftheChileannation-state. eDgar arturo esquit cHoy isaKaqchikelMayahistorianandresearcherattheInstitutodeEstudiosInterétnicosinGuatemala.HeistheauthorofOtros Poderes, Nuevos Desafíos: Relaciones Interétnicas en Tecpan y Su Entorno Departamental, 1871–1935 (2002)andthecoauthor,withVíctorGálvezBorrell,ofThe Mayan Movement Today: Issues of Indigenous Culture and Development in Guatemala(1997). FernanDo garcés v. received his M.A. in social sciences from Flacso -Quito (Ecuador)andiscurrentlyaPh.D.candidateinLatinAmericanculturalstudiesat theUniversidadAndinaSimónBolívar(Quito).Inadditiontoworkinginbilingual andinterculturaleducationinbothEcuadorandBolivia,hecoordinatestheeducationalprogramattheCentrodeComunicaciónyDesarrolloAndinoinCochabamba,Bolivia,wherehehasalsoworkedwiththebilingualnewspaperConosur Ñawpagman.HehaspublishedseveralarticlesonQuichuaandQuechualinguistics and sociolinguistics and on the relationship between writing and orality in Quechua. J. keHaulani kauanui is an associate professor of anthropology and American studiesatWesleyanUniversity.Herfirstbook,Hawaiian Blood: Colonialism and the Politics of Sovereignty and Indigeneity,waspublishedintheNarratingNativeHistoriesseriesbyDukeUniversityPressin2008.In2008shehelpedfoundtheNative AmericanandIndigenousStudiesAssociationandwaselectedtoitscouncilthesame year.Inadditiontocoeditingthreespecialissuesofjournalsandpublishingwidely inprofessionaljournals,sheisworkingontwonewbookprojects,oneongender, sexualpolitics,andindigeneityinHawaiianidentitiesandtheotheronHawaiiand NewEnglandcolonialism. brian kloPotek isanassociateprofessorofethnicstudiesattheUniversityofOregon.HeistheauthorofRecognition Odysseys: Indigeneity, Race, and Federal Tribal Recognition Policy in Three Louisiana Indian Communities,intheNarratingNative Histories(DukeUniversityPress,2011).HehasalsopublishedanarticleonIndian
masculinityandisworking,withBrendaChild,onaforthcomingeditedbookon Indianeducation. Florencia e. mallon istheJulietaKirkwoodProfessorandchairoftheHistoryDepartmentattheUniversityofWisconsin,Madison.SheistheauthorofThe Defense of Community in Peru’s Central Highlands: Peasant Struggle and Capitalist Transition, 1860–1940(Princeton,1983);Peasant and Nation: The Making of Postcolonial Mexico and Peru(Berkeley,1995),forwhichshereceivedtheBryceWoodAwardfortheBest BookinLatinAmericanStudiesfromtheLatinAmericanStudiesAssociation;and Courage Tastes of Blood: The Mapuche Indigenous Community of Nicolás Ailío and the Chilean State, 1906–2000(DukeUniversityPress,2005),whichwasawardedthe Bolton-JohnsonPrizefortheBestBookinLatinAmericanHistorybytheConferenceonLatinAmericanHistory.SheisalsotheeditorandtranslatorofRosaIsolde ReuquePaillalef,When a Flower Is Reborn: The Life and Times of a Mapuche Feminist (DukeUniversityPress,2002).SheisoneofthefoundingeditorsoftheseriesNarratingNativeHistories. abelarDo ramos PacHo isaNasalinguistandactivistwiththeConsejoRegional IndígenadelCaucainColombia.HereceivedhisM.A.inethnolinguisticsfromthe UniversidaddelosAndesinBogotáin1987.HeworksintheInterculturalBilingual ProgramoftheConsejoRegionalIndígenadelCauca.Heisthecoauthor,withGracielaBolaños,JoanneRappaport,andCarlosMiñana,of¿Qué pasará si la escuela . . . ? Treinta años de construcción educativa(2004),andtheauthorofnumerousarticleson translation,ethnolinguistics,andtheNasaYuwelanguage. Joanne raPPaPort isaprofessorofanthropologyandSpanishandPortugueseat GeorgetownUniversity.ShehaspublishedthreebooksinEnglish:Cumbe Reborn: An Andean Ethnography of History (University of Chicago Press, 1994); Intercultural Utopias: Public Intellectuals, Cultural Experimentation, and Ethnic Pluralism in Colombia(DukeUniversityPress,2005);andThe Politics of Memory: Native Historical Interpretation in the Colombian Andes(CambridgeUniversityPress,1990;Duke UniversityPress,1998).Intercultural Utopias,theproductofcollaborativeresearch withindigenousactivistsfromtheConsejoRegionalIndígenadelCauca,isastudy ofindigenousintellectualsandculturalplannersinColombia. Jan rus andDiane l. rus haveworkedintheTzotzil-MayaspeakingregionofhighlandChiapassincetheearly1970s.In1985theybecamecoordinatorsoftheTaller Tzotzilandhelpedlocalcommunitiesorganizediscussiongroupsandpublishnative language books on such themes as the historical struggle for the land, labor contractingandcoffeeplantations,women’sartisancooperatives,theriseofurban indigenouscolonias,andthebeginningofundocumentedmigrationtotheUnited States.DianeisthecoauthorandeditorofBordando Milpas(1990),thelifehistory ofaChamulaweaver,andJaniscoeditorofMayan Lives, Mayan Utopias: The In244 contributors
digenous People of Chiapas and the Zapatista Rebellion(2003),andtheauthorofthe forthcoming“StillWeAreHere:HistoricalEthnographyoftheMayasofHighland Chiapas,1867–1994.”Together,theyarethecoauthorsofanumberofarticlesonmigrationandeconomicchangeandtheeditorsofaforthcomingbilingualcompilation ofTzotzilMayaoralhistories.
contributors 245
inDex
Abercrombie,Neil,42,53n15 Abu-Lughod,Lila,193n2 AbyaYala(matureandfertileearth),85, 119n3 AcademiadelasLenguasMayasde Guatemala(AcademyofMayaLanguagesofGuatemala),205–6 AcademiadeLenguasMayasdeGuatemala,173n9 academic/activistcollaboration,5,9. See alsocollaborationandhistorical writing AcciónCatólica(Guatemala),209 Actealmassacre(Chiapas,Mexico,1997), 154–55,174n17 activism,activists:academicsand,5,9, 124,131,137,140;antiracist,176;assassinatedinChiapas,164,167;Mapuche intellectualsas,9–10 “AgreementofWills”(“Cession”and “Proclamation”;RapaNui,1888), 56–57,68,73,75n2,76n11 agriculture,80,111–12,164–65 aico (IndigenousAuthoritiesof Colombia),142n8 Akaka,DanielKahikina,27–28 Akakabill,27–29,35–43,48–50,52n10, 52–53n14 Albarracín,Roberto,118 Albert,Bruce,128 Albó,X.,93 Alfabeto Único para el Idioma Quechua (UnifiedAlphabetfortheQuechua Language),120n16
Alfred,Taiaiake,15 Allen,C.,142n5 AmericanIndianLawAlliance,44, 53n19 AmericanIndianReligiousFreedomAct (U.S.,1996),50n1 Americas,the,andthePacific,6–7,24, 219 Añaskitu,120n14 Anaya,A.,93 AndeanCommunicationandDevelopmentCenter,89,110–12,120n7, 120n14,121n23 Annals of the Kaqchikels,199–200 anthropology,2,122,129.See alsocollaborationandhistoricalwriting; ethnography antimiscegenationlaws,181,193n3 Anzaldúa,Gloria,17 ApologyResolution(U.S.,1993),36, 52n13 ArchipelagoofJuanFernández,70, 72–73 ariki(chieforking),56–57,75n3 Arnold,D.,121n25 Asad,Talal,125–26 Atacamadesert(BoliviaandPeru),56 AtamuTekena,kingofRapaNui,56–57, 60 Aubry,Andrés,146,148,171n1,174n17, 174n20 Australia,onindigenousrights,45 authenticity,193n2 authority,intellectual/cultural,4
autonomy:inColombia,142n5;culture and,128–30,140–41;viadecolonization,7;viadeoccupation,7;internationalizationeffectson,22;inRapa Nui,71–72,74,78n22;sovereigntyand, 142n5 Avendaño,Amado,171n1 Aylwin,Patricio,63–64,70 Aymaralanguage,93,95 Aymarapeople(Bolivia,Peru,and Chile),55–56,86 AyniSchool(RumiMuqu,Bolivia), 106–7 Bachelet,Michelle,71 Balmaceda,JoséManuel,56,75n5 Basham,Leilani,17 Bastos,Santiago,215 BayonetConstitution(Hawaiʻi,1887),31 Beloved(Morrison),192 Bibletranslations,9.See alsosil /Wbt bilingualeducation,106–8,172n2,173– 74n13.See alsopebi biotechnology,116 bluewaterdoctrine,33–35 Bolaños,Graciela,130,141,143n15 Bolivia:agrarianreformin,80;indigenouspeasantmovementin,83–84; indigenousveinin,86;Warofthe Pacificand,55–56 BolivianRevolution(1952),81 Bordando Milpas(Ta jlok’ta chobtik; D.L.Rus),12,158–61,164 BureauofIndianAffairs,189 Burstein,John,171n1 Bush,GeorgeH.W.,164–65 Bush,GeorgeW.,37 Canada,onindigenousrights,45 CaneRiverCreolesofColor(Louisiana), 185–87,189,194n7 Caniuqueo,Sergio,19n12 248 inDex
capitalism:communalorganizationand, 114;indigenousknowledgeand,116– 18;onprivateproperty,57;transnationalmarketsneededforglobal,102 Carmack,Robert,200,204 Carmen,Andrea,53n19 Carrasco(Cochabamba,Bolivia),88–89 Carrasco,Patricio,76n7 Carrera,Rafael,211 CatholicChurch(Chiapas,Mexico), 171n1,173n9 CatholicChurch(RapaNui),59 CatholicChurch(Tahiti),56 Cauca,Colombia,24;communitycouncils(cabildos)in,132,142n9;cric in, 10,81–82,124–26,130,133–34,137, 142n1,142n8,142n9,143n14,143n15; culturalheterogeneityorsyncretism in,129,138.See alsopebi celali ,172n2 cenDa (AndeanCommunicationand DevelopmentCenter;Bolivia),89, 110–12,120n7,120n14,121n23 census,U.S.(1910),185,188–89,194n12 cessionofsovereignty,77n11 Chakrabarty,Dipesh,2,14,203 Chamula(Chiapas,Mexico),8,10,151– 53,156,158,161,174n15.See alsoTaller Tzotzil Chanteaux,Michel,174n17 Chapare(Bolivia),90 Chatterjee,Partha,214 Chávez,AdriánInés,200,202 Cherokees,192 Chiapas,Mexico,24;activistsassassinatedin,164,167;CatholicChurchin, 171n1,173n9;criticalhistoricalnarrativein,170;economiccrisisin,10, 147,155,157–58,171n4;humanrights abusesin,167–68,174nn17–18;landownersvs.debt-laborersin,162–63; minimumwagein,172n7;political
andculturalchangesin,147–49,164, 170;politicalandeconomicreformin, 80–81.See alsoTallerTzotzil Chicanos’classificationaswhite,181 Chichén-Itzá,(Yucatán,Mexico),199 ch’iki(sociallyintelligentchild),121n24 Chile:constitutionof,72–73,75;democracyin,63–64,68;imperialismof, 55–56;independenceof,fromSpain, 55;tradingby,56;victoryof,inWarof thePacific,6–7.See alsoRapaNui Chileancivilwar(1891),58,75n5 ChileanNationalTelevision(tVn ),54 Chimaltenango,Guatemala,24,202–3, 208,211–12 Choctaws(Mississippi),11,181.See also Clifton-Choctaws Chow,Rey,125,141 CivilCode(Chile),60–61 Cleveland,Grover,31–32 Clifton-Choctaws(Louisiana),182–91, 194n6,194n12 Clinton,WilliamJ.,36 Cobo,JoséMartinez,43 coca,90,92,96–97 Cochabamba,Bolivia,24;droughtin,88; ngo sanddevelopmentprojectsin, 88;peasantorganizationsin,10,119n4, 120n8;politicalmilitancyin,81–82 coDeipa (DevelopmentCommission; RapaNui),64–66,68 coffeemarket,164–65 coffeeworkers,149–51,165 CojtíCuxil,Demetrio,197,200 Coleman,Arica,181 collaboration:viadiálogo de saberes(exchangeofepistemologies),8,130;engagé,9;minga(projectofcollective workforcollectivebenefit),8,82–83, 131–32;overviewof,80–84;respectfor differenceandtheintegrityofcultures asunderlying,17;tension/negotiation
in,10,17,133;truthtellingand,inresearchmethodologies,4 collaborationandhistoricalwriting, 219;ofacademicsandactivists,5,9, 124,131,137,140;collaborativetheorizingand,130–33,142nn7–8,143n10; communitycontrol,interculturalism,cosmovision,and,137–40;co- theorizing,131–32;cultureandpoliticalautonomyand,128–30,140–41; indigenoustheory,anddefinition/ overviewof,122–24,127,131,142n2; interculturalismand,126–27,137–39, 141,143n11;minoritytheorizing,129; pebi ’shistory,124,133–37,141,143n11, 143n15;theorizinganddefinitionof, 220;translatingtheory,124–26 Collapeople(Argentina,Bolivia,and Chile),55–56 Colombia:academicsin,143n10;constitutionof1991of,83,124–26,128,131– 32;FreeTradeAreaoftheAmericas acceptedby,127;nationalintegration in,81;Nativeautonomyin,142n5 colonialism:ascentraltoindigenous peoples’history,7;coloniesdefined underinternationallaw,43;colonizationvs.occupationand,34;definitionof,197;internalcolonialism,12, 16,18n4,33,43,49,197,201,218n19; language,law,andarchivesasinstrumentsof,3;racialhierarchyestablishedvia,198,217n2.See alsodecolonization Comalapa(Chimaltenango,Guatemala), 202–3,217n7 ComitéCatholiqueContrelaFaimet PourleDévellopement(France),171n1 CommerceClause(U.S.Constitution),39 CommissiononHistoricTruthandNew RelationshipwithIndigenousPeoples (RapaNui),68–69
inDex 249
communalorganization,111–14,117–18 communitycontrol,137–38 conaDi (NationalCorporationforIndigenousDevelopment;Chile),63,66, 70,73,77n16 conceptualprison,180,193n2 concientización(consciousnessraisingor empowerment),144 CongresoInternacionaldeMayistas (1989),172n7,172n9 Conosur Ñawpagman.SeePCÑ conquest,sovereigntyvia,77n11 ConsejodeAncianosdelFondodeDesarrolloIndígenadeGuatemala(Council ofEldersoftheIndigenousDevelopmentFundofGuatemala),209 ConsejodeOrganizacionesMayasen Guatemala,205 ConsejoRegionalIndígenadelCauca. Seecric CoordinacióndeOrganizacionesdel PuebloMayadeGuatemala,205 cosmovision,137–39,199 Coushattas(Louisiana),189 Creoles(criollos;Guatemala),203–4, 211–13,217n8 cric (ConsejoRegionalIndígenadel Cauca),10,81–82,124–26,130,133– 34,137,142n1,142n8,142n9,143n14, 143n15.See alsopebi Cruikshank,Julie,14 csutcb (UnitedConfederationofBolivianWorkersandPeasants),89,114 culture:colonizervs.colonized,1–2; continuityof,218n21;minorityforms of,129;politicalautonomyand,128– 30,140–41;revivalof,127 Çxayu’çe,136,143n13 debt-laborers,162–63 DecadesofIndigenousPeoples(un ; 1990–2000,2000–2010),22 250 inDex
DeclarationontheGrantingofIndependencetoColonialCountriesand Peoples—Resolution1514(un ,1960), 33–34,43–44,51n5 DeclarationontheRightsofIndigenous Peoples(un ;2007),22,28,43–48, 53n19 DeclarationregardingNon-Self- GoverningPeoples(un ,1945),43 decolonization,25;tocombatracism, 192–93;definitionandscopeof,28; deoccupationvs.,23,28–29;racialand evolutionarybasesofcolonialpower and,2;violenceengenderedby,17 decolonizingmethodologies,6,176, 219–20 Decolonizing Methodologies(Smith), 192–93,193n1 DefensoríadelaMujerIndígena(IndigenousWomen’sDefenseOffice;Guatemala),205–6 Deloria,Vine,Jr.,193n2 Delsing,Riet,7,23 democracy,123,126–27 Denetdale,Jennifer,17 deoccupation:argumentsfor,35,46;decolonizationvs.,23,28–29;definition andscopeof,28;internalcolonialism deniedby,49;internationallawsof occupationand,34 DepartmentalPeasantFederation (Cochabamba,Bolivia),89 DepartmentofHawaiianHomeLands, 36–37 DevelopmentCommission(coDeipa ; RapaNui),64–66,68 diálogo de saberes(exchangeofepistemologies),8,130 Dindicué,Benjamín,133–34 Dole,SanfordBallard,32 doubleconsciousness(second-sight), 122–23,141–42n1
Duarte,Carlota,173n8 DuBois,W.E.B.,122,129,141n1 Duquesne,Isabelle,173–74n13 EasterIsland.SeeRapaNui EastTimor,34 Edmunds,Petero,72 education:bilingual,106–8,127,172n2; intercultural,127;forMaya,201–2, 206,212,216;socialchangeand,127. See alsopebi EducationReform(Bolivia),115,121n25 eib (EducaciónInterculturalBilingüe project;InterculturalBilingualEducation;Bolivia),107–8 EjércitoZapatistadeLiberación Nacional(eZln ;Chiapas),84,167, 174n17 El Mizqueño,88,93 El Totoreño,88,93 enganche(contractlabor),149 Ernantes,Chep(JoséGonzálezHernández),148,153,173–74n13 Esquit,Edgar,11–12,176–77 ethnicityandprogress,211 ethnicmovements,122,129–30 ethnicorganizations,124,127–28,137 ethnicstudies,U.S.,180 ethnography:autoethnographyvs.,141; ofparticular,193n2;perspectiveand methodologyin,24–25,125–26;as translation,125–26.See alsoanthropology Eurocentrism,102 EuropeanCommunity,171n1 exclusion,formsof,85 Explorahotels,65 eZln (EjércitoZapatistadeLiberación Nacional;Chiapas),84,167,174n17 Fanon,Frantz,163 feministmovement/research,123–24
Fermín,Tata,118–19 Field,L.,142n5 Fischer,E.,218n21 FiveCivilizedTribes(Oklahoma),181–82 Foley,Neil,194n9 FoMMa (FortalezadelaMujerMaya), 173n8 FondoIndígena(IndigenousFund; Guatemala),205–6 FondoNacionaldeArtesanías (Fonart ;Mexico),159 Forbes,Jack,189 forests,communalownershipof,114 FortalezadelaMujerMaya(FoMMa ), 173n8 freetrade.Seetradeagreements FreeTradeAreaoftheAmericas,127 Freire,Paulo,144 Frichner,TonyaGonnella,53n19 FriendsofEasterIsland(Chile),78n19 frontieraspainfuloruncomfortable,17 GarcésV.,Fernando,10–11,81–83 genderandpowerrelations,12,19n7.See alsowomen,indigenous Gilroy,Paul,129 globalization,82–83,116,176–77,214, 218n19,220 GómezVargas,J.H.,78n22 Grandin,Greg,211,217n2 GreatDepression,80 greenrevolution,112,117 Grube,Nikolai,198–99 GuambianoHistoryCommittee (Colombia),128 Guambianopeoples(Colombia),81 Guatemala:colonialismin,andMaya movement,197–98;fourpeoplesof (Maya,Garífuna,Xinka,andladino), 205,213,218n11;ladinocontrolof,197; miningin,206;powerrelationsof, 217n9.See alsoMaya
inDex 251
Guatemalancivilwar(1962–96),176 Guzmán,Salvador,153,159,164,168–69 Guzmán,Soledad,120n13 GuzmánBöckler,Carlos,200 HagueConventionIV(1907),34 Hale,CharlesR.,16–17 HangaRoa(RapaNui),59–60,62,67–68 Harrison,Benjamin,31 Hawaiʻi,24,43–45,47–50;autonomy movementin,7;capitalismandChristianity’seffectson,31;independence movementin,27–28,34–38;kingdom restorationmovementin,34–35,51n7; landclaimsin,32–33,37–38,41–42, 46,53n14;Mahelelanddivision(1848), 30–31,46;occupiedstateof,34–35; recognitionof,asindependentkingdom,7,23,28–30,39,51n2;Republic of,32,52n13;secessionvs.independenceof,46;self-governmentand self-determinationby,27,33–37,40, 46,51n3;sovereigntyclaimof,under internationallaw,28–29,34,38–39; statehoodof,29,33–36,51n3,52n13; territorialintegrityof,46;U.S.colonizationandannexationof,6,23,28–35, 46,52n13;use-rightsconcessionsby,6; U.S.militarismin,40–41;U.S.treaties with,29–30;whiteforeignpopulationin,30–31.See alsoKanakaMaoli; NativeHawaiianGovernmentReorganizationAct;State of Hawaii v. Office of Hawaiian Affairs HawaiianIndependenceActionAlliance,28 HawaiʻiInstituteforHumanRights,28 Henderson,Timothy,Mexico Reader,168 Herbert,Jean-Loup,200 Hernández,Domingo,215 Hernández,JoséGonzález(Chep Ernantes),148,153,173–74n13 252 inDex
Hill,RobertM.,200 Hill,Roberta,6 Historia de un pueblo evangelista (R.Pérez),174n13 historicalwriting.Seecollaborationand historicalwriting honi (HuioNaIke),28 HonoluluRifles,31 HotelHangaRoa(RapaNui),72 Hotus,Alberto,77n14,78n24 Hotus,Carolina,71 HuiAlohaʻAinaandHuiKalaiʻAina nationalistgroups,32 HuiPu(Hawaiʻi),28 I, Rigoberta(Menchú),145 Ibañez,Pedro,65 IdentityandRightsoftheIndigenous PeoplesAccord(Guatemala,1995),205 ilo Convention169(International LaborOrganization;1989),22,206 inareMac (InstitutodeAsesoría AntropológicaparalaRegiónMaya, A.C.),159,167–68,171n1,173–74n13, 174n17 IndianGamingRegulatoryAct(U.S., 1988),53n14 IndianReorganizationAct(U.S.,1934), 52n10 Indians’antiblackracism(southern UnitedStates),188;Anglo-American racistandcolonialistoriginsof,186– 87;decolonizationtocombat,192–93; Indianidentity/denialsofblackancestryand,183–87,189–91,194n12; overviewandbackgroundof,179–82; racialformationand,181,192–93, 194n9,195n22;regulatingracialcategoriesand,186–93;researchinLouisianaIndiancommunities,182–86, 194n6;researchmethodologiesfor studying,179–80,184–85,191–93,
193n1,193n2;traditionof,181–82,184; Virginiaantimiscegenationlawsand, 181,193n3;whitesupremacyand,179, 186–87,191–93,194n8 IndianSchedules(population),188 Indianstudies,180 IndianTradeandIntercourseAct(U.S.), 53n14 IndigenousAuthoritiesofColombia (aico ),142n8 IndigenousCaucus(un andoas ),47 indigenousidentity:definitionsof,12; doubleconsciousnessabout,142n1; Indian,anddenialsofblackancestry, 183–87,189–91,194n12;Rapanui,23, 54–55,67–68,74–75 indigenousorganizations,83,90,119n3, 122–24,127–31,133,162,177.See also under names of individual organizations “IndigenousPolitics:FromNativeNew EnglandandBeyond,”53n19 indigenousrights:Convention169 (InternationalLaborOrganization) on,206;DeclarationontheRights ofIndigenousPeoples,22,28,43–48; underinternationallaw,vs.states’ rights,29;NativeAmericanrightsand privilegesextendedtoKanakaMaoli, 27,50–51n1;ofpeoplesvs.people,44, 48;preexistinghumanrights,43;self- determination,33–34,43–48,51n5; sovereigntyand,46–47;territorial integrityand,46–47 indigenoussovereignty,4 indigenousuniversities,124,142n2 indio permitido(permissibleIndian), 16–17 inea (InstitutoNacionaldeEducación Adulta),152–53,173n9 ini (InstitutoNacionalIndigenista; Mexico),152,172n2,172–73n7
inscription,4 insidevs.outside,4,129–30 InstitutodeAsesoríaAntropológicapara laRegiónMaya,A.C.SeeinareMac InstitutodeEstudiosIndígenasofthe UniversidadAutónomadeChiapas, 172n2 InstitutoNacionalIndigenista(ini ; Mexico),152,172n2,172–73n7 integrationism,2,61–66 intellectualpropertyrights,116–17 interculturalism,126–27,137–39,141, 143n11,205 InternationalCoffeeAgreement,164–65 InternationalForumofIndigenous Peoples(Fipau ),69 InternationalIndianTreatyCouncil, 53n19 intertextuality,10–11,83,91–92 JacobsResearchFund(Bellingham, Wash.),171n1 Jaima,93 JenaChoctaws(Louisiana),182,189–90 Johnson,M.,98 Jones,Delmos,122 Joseph,Gilbert,Mexico Reader,168 Juan, the Chamula(Pozas),172n5 kainga(ancestrallands),58,60,65,73, 75n4 Kalakaua,kingofHawaiʻi,31 KaLeiMaileAliʻiHawaiianCivicClub, 28 KamehamehaIII,kingofHawaiʻi,30 KanakaMaoli(indigenousHawaiians): Akakabill’simpacton,42–43;assimilationistpoliciesimposedon, 35;decolonizationeligibilityof,34, 42–43;federalrecognitionfor,7,28, 48;Hawaiiansdefined,51n1;historicalstruggleof,22–23;HuiAloha
inDex 253
KanakaMaoli(continued) ʻAinaandHuiKalaiʻAinanationalist groupsamong,32;internationallaw strategiesof,28;kupuna(elders)and kumu(educators),49;asaminorityin Hawaiʻi,49;NativeAmericanrights andprivilegesextendedto,27,50– 51n1;NativeHawaiianGovernment ReorganizationAct,27–29,35–43,48, 52–53n14;oppressionandsubordinationof,bywhitesupremacists,35,49; “UrgentOpenLettertoU.S.President BarackObama,”49–50;U.S.apology to,36,51–52n8,52n13;votingby,31,33, 36,51n3.See alsoHawaiʻi KaPakaukau,28,34 Kaqchikels,177,199–200,202–3,206, 218n14 Katarismo,86 Kauanui,J.Kehaulani,5,7,22–23,80 K’ichelanguageandpeople,177,200, 202–4,209–12,217n10,218n16 Kimsa Pacha Ara Mboapi,93 Kipaltikcollective(Chiapas,Mexico), 159–66 Klopotek,Brian,5–6,11–12,176–77 knowledge:coproductionof,146;geopoliticsof,102–3,108;indigenous,and capitalism,116–18;jawamanta yachay (knowledgefromabroad),118;local vs.universal,102–3;modern,asessentialist/binary,102;neocolonialdominationand,116;peasant,technology’s appropriationof,112,116–17;Quechua peasantvs.Westernurban,103–5; racial/evolutionarybasesofcolonial powerasunderlyingconstructionof, 2;scientific,primacyof,116–17.See alsopeasantknowledge KoaniFoundation,28 Komes,Maruch(MaríaGómez),12, 158–62,164–66 254 inDex
KomikeTribunal,28,34 Kopenawa,Davi,128 Ko Tu’u Aro Kote Mata Nui(RapaNui), 58 Ko Tu’u Hotu Iti Mata Iti(RapaNui),58 KoyasoPanchin,Marian,156–57 Kurus,Xalid.SeeRus,Jan Kurus,Tina.SeeRus,DianeL. Kusman,Xalik(SalvadorGuzmán; MarianoPeresTsu),153,159,164, 168–69 labor,intellectual,132 LaCastalia,172n2 ladinos(Hispanicizedpeople;non- Indians),12,19n5,197,202–4,211–13, 217n1 Lagos,Ricardo,68 Lakoff,G.,98 Lâm,MaivânClech,46 Lame,ManuelQuintín,139;Los pensamientos del indio que se educó dentro de las selvas colombianas,143n14 language:diglottic,91,115,120n10;neologismsin,92,115–16,125;powerand empowermentand,3,11,13;subalternizedindigenous,86–87,108.See alsoQuechualanguageandknowledge;TallerTzotzil La Prensa,93 LatinAmerica:class-basedsocialand politicalmovementsin,16,80;indigenousintellectualsin,15,19n12;indigenousmovementsin,15–16;indigenouspeoplesof,vs.UnitedStates,80; national-popularstates’emergencein, 80–81.See also under names of specific indigenous movements Laughlin,Miriam,173n8 Laughlin,RobertM.,172n2 Lenkersdorf,Carlos,172n2 Lenkersdorf,Gudrun,172n2
Levil,Rodrigo,19n12 LeyIndígena(IndigenousLaw;Chile, 1990),63–66,68,74 LeyPascua(EasterLaw;Chile,1966), 61–63,67–68,74 LeyPinochet(PinochetLaw;Chile, 1979),62–64,74 Libro de registros de propiedades llevado por la Armada de Chile, Isla de Pascua (Chileannavy),59–60 Lili’uokalani,queenofHawaiʻi,31–32, 52n13 literacidad,119n1 LivingNation,28 llawar(blood),98,101 Lomnitz-Adler,Claudio,213 LópezPérez,Antonio,148 Los Acuerdos de San Andrés,174n20 LosChorros(Chenalhó,Chiapas, Mexico),154,157,173n11 Los pensamientos del indio que se educó dentro de las selvas colombianas (Lame),143n14 Louisiana,24.See alsoIndians’antiblack racism LouisianaInter-TribalCouncil(Clifton), 189–90 Loving v. Virginia,181 Lumbees(NorthCarolina),181 Luykx,A.,115 majï(labor),132 maki(hand),98,100 Mamlanguage,217n10 Mana (MovementforAlohaNoKa ʻAina),28 Mapuche(Chile),9–10,55 Marimán,Pablo,19n12 Maya:ancestorsrememberedby,204, 209–10;dominationof,217n2;educationfor,201–2,206,212,216;exclusionof,208,217n9;governmentsup-
portof,205–6;inGuatemalancivil war,176;historiographyandarcheologyof,203–4,217n9;ladinosand, 12,202,204,211–13;asmerchants, 217n6;perceivedasbackward,204, 208;politicaltransitionschallenged by,84;repressionof,202;strugglefor self-determinationby,176,215;subsistenceeconomyof,202;unifiedvs.self- createdofficialhistoryof,11;women, 211;women’sweavingandembroideringcooperative,12;Yucatekanand Guatemalan,198–99 Mayamovement,196–217;alternative historiesandpresent,213–17,218n20; colonialisminGuatemalaand,197– 98;definitionofMayaandMayanists, 197;educated/professionalvs.uneducatedMaya,202–3,217n6;elite-and state-constructedmulticulturalism and,201,205–8,210,213–16;elites’ identificationwithliberalstateideology,203;elites’redefiningofidentities andpowerrelations,196–97,208–13, 218n21;elites’versionofhistory, 202–5;guerrillagroups,203;imaginingnewhistories,198–201;Mayacontinuityvs.conquestandassimilation, 199–200;Mayademandforrights, 211–13;Mayaprotestsandrepression and,206,212,215,218n14;Mayaspirituality,205,209,216;memories’role in,214;overviewandbackground of,177,196–98;patriarchyand,196, 211,215–16;politicalpartiesand,203; professionals’rolein,203,210,217n7; ProtestantandCatholicvisionsand, 196,203,216;workshopsonancient writingand,198–99 McKinley,William,32 Memorias, Balances, Inventarios y Registro de Propiedades(Chileannavy),59
inDex 255
Menchú,Rigoberta:I, Rigoberta,145 Merrell,James,181 mestizos(Hispanicizedpeople),19n5, 126,162,167 MexicanRevolution(1910),80–81,148, 162,164 Mexico:agrarianreformin,80,164–65; economiccrisisin,10,144,147,155, 157–58,171n4;Salinas’sreformsin, 164–65 Mexico Reader(JosephandHenderson),168 Mignolo,Walter,102,217n2,218n19 Mihesuah,Devon,2,15 Miles,Tiya,195n19;Ties that Bind: The Story of an Afro-Cherokee Family in Slavery and Freedom,192 Millalén,José,19n12 Millamán,Rosamel,16–17 Miñana,Carlos,142n7 minga(projectofcollectiveworkforcollectivebenefit),8,82–83,131–32 MinistryofEducation(Guatemala),206 Mizque(Cochabamba,Bolivia),88–89, 106 MizqueProvincialTradeUnion(Cochabamba,Bolivia),89 MobileUnitforRuralPatrolling (Bolivia),92 Montejo,Víctor,2,19n6,200,202 Morales,Evo,81–84,120n8 Morrison,Toni,194n9;Beloved,192 Mosoco,Colombia,125,131–32 MovementtowardSocialism(Mas ; Bolivia),89,120n8 MovimientoAlSocialismo,81–83 MoyapampaUnion(Cochabamba, Bolivia),89 MoyopampaAgriculturalUnion(Totora, Carrasco,Bolivia),88 mulattoes,181,184–85,188–89,194n12 multiculturalism:inGuatemala,201, 256 inDex
205–8,210,213–16;interculturalism vs.,126–27;neoliberalismand,176, 207 Muyolema(alsoMuyulema),Armando, 15,119n3
naFta (NorthAmericanFreeTrade Agreement),116–17,164–65 najtir(ancient),217n10 NāPuaNo’eau(CenterforGiftedand TalentedNativeHawaiianChildren), 37 NarratingNativeHistoriesconference (UniversityofWisconsin,Madison, 2005),1–5,219 NarratingNativeHistoriesseries,2–4 Nasapeoples(Colombia),8,81,126 NasaYuwelanguage:alphabetand orthographyfor,143n13;boardgame and,136;translatingtheColombian Constitutioninto,125–26,128,131–32 NationalCorporationforIndigenous Development,63,66,70,73,77n16 NationalHistoricPreservationAct(U.S., 1966),50n1 NationalInstituteforAdultEducation (InstitutoNacionaldeEducación Adulta;inea ),152,173n9 NationalMuseumoftheAmerican IndianAct(U.S.,1989,amended 1996),50n1 NativeAmericanGravesProtectionand RepatriationAct(U.S.,1990),50n1 NativeAmericanLanguagesAct(U.S., 1990),50n1 NativeAmericanProgramsAct(U.S., 1974),50–51n1 NativeAmericans:Akakabill’simpact on,52–53n14;antiblacksensibilities among,11–12;federalclassification andrecognitionof,187–91,194n12, 194n14;landheldintrustfor,53n14;
tribalidentitiesof,181;whitesand, 180–81.See alsoChoctaws;Indians’ antiblackracism Nativeandindigenousmovements,2,4, 123,128 NativeHawaiianBarAssociation (nhba ),42,53n15 NativeHawaiianEducationAct(U.S., 2004),51n1 NativeHawaiianGovernmentReorganizationAct(Akakabill;U.S.,2009), 27–29,35–43,48–50,52n10,52–53n14 NativeHawaiianHealthCareAct(U.S., 1988),51n1 NativeHawaiianInteragency(U.S.),42 Nativeintellectualsintheacademy,6, 13,15 Nativepeoples’intellectualagency,2–3 nature,101,121n21 NavajoNation,45 neoliberalism,176,207 NewlandsResolution(U.S.,1898),32, 52n13 NewZealand,onindigenousrights,45 nFip —Hawaiʻi,28 nhba (NativeHawaiianBarAssociation),42,53n15 Nimatuj,IrmaAlicia,211 NorthAmericanFreeTradeAgreement (naFta ),116–17,164–65 NorthandSouth,219;differencesinindigenousintellectuals’place,4,15,17, 19n12;historicaldifferencesbetween, 4,15;North-centrism,102 “not-yet”principleofhistoricalevolution,2 Obama,Barack,37,49 objectivityinwriting,95,121n19 occupation,34,76n11 OfficeofHawaiianAffairs,36–37, 51–52n8,52n13
ʻOhanaKoa,28 ojtxe(remotepast),217n10 Omi,M.,195n22 one-droprule,11–12,189 oralhistory/tradition,13–14.See also Quechuayachay oralityvs.textuality,3,10,94–95,139 OrganicAct(U.S.,1900),32–33 OrganizationofAmericanStates(oas ), 47 pacha(spaceandtimeinwhichweare located),87,119n5 PanamaCanal,56 pan-Mayanistmovement.SeeMaya movement PapaOlaLokahi(NativeHawaiian Healthcare),37 Pari,A.,121n21 PartidoRevolucionarioInstitucional (pri ;Mexico),154,165–66 PartidoSocialistadelosTrabajadores (pst ;Mexico),154–55 Past,Ámbar,173n8 Pate,Timoteo,76n6 patriarchy,196,211,215–16 Paz,Sarela,86 PCÑ (Conosur Ñawpagman):articles for,120n9;backgroundon,88–90, 120nn7–9;bimonthlypublication of,90;oncommunalorganization, 112–13,117;distributionandsale of,10,89–90;oneducation,106–8; Garcés’scollaborationwith,81,118; meaningofÑawpagman,119n1;metaphorsandsimilesin,99–102;oral presencein,94–97;onpatentsand technologythatappropriatepeasant knowledge,112;onpeasantmobilizations(1992),121n20;onplagues,111; politicsofwrittenoralityand,90–93, 95;Quechuain,10–11,85,91–94;on
inDex 257
PCÑ (continued) Quechuapeasantvs.Westernurban knowledge,103–5;quotationsin, 96–97;researchingwritingvia,115–16; Spanishin,91–94;storiesin,concluding,94,97;subjectsaddressedin,90, 103;onweatherprediction,110–12.See alsoQuechuayachay PeaceCamps(Mexico),174n14 peasant,meaningsof,85–86 peasantknowledge:anthropomorphizationof,101–2;moderntechnologyvs., 88,110–12,117,121n23;natureasteaching,121n21 peasantorganizationsinCochabamba, 10,119n4,120n8 pebi (BilingualandInterculturalEducationProgram;Colombia):historyof, 124,133–37,141,143n11,143n15;influenceandsuccessof,134;objectivesof, 134;overviewof,82;politicalprogram of,134–35,137 PeresTsu,Mariano,153,159,164,168–69 Pérez,Manuel,Salvador,andPedro,168 Pérez,Ricardo,Historia de un pueblo evangelista,174n13 PeruinWarofthePacific,55–56 petroglyphs,128 Pewewardy,Cornel,191 Pinochet,Augusto,62 place,defenseof,102 plagues,111 pluralism,126–27,134 política de estado,70,78n20 popularmovements,129 PopWuj(PopolVuh),200 PortalesCenter(SimónPatiñoFoundation;Bolivia),88 Portelli,Alessandro,14 Pozas,Ricardo,Juan, the Chamula,172n5 prescription,sovereigntyvia,76–77n11 Presencia,93 258 inDex
pri (PartidoRevolucionarioInstitucional;Mexico),154,165–66 ProgramaNacionaldeSolidaridad (NationalSolidarityProgram; pronasol ;Mexico),165–66 progress,1–2,211 Pro-KanakaMaoliIndependenceWorkingGroup,28,34 pronasol (ProgramaNacionaldeSolidaridad;Mexico),165–66 Protestantsvs.traditionalists,151–52, 155–57 ProyectoFotográficoMaya,173n8 pst (PartidoSocialistadelosTrabajadores;Mexico),154–55 Quechualanguageandknowledge,85, 87–90,95–100,118–19,120n13;alphabet,120n16;Bolivianlinguisticpolicy toward,115;colonialsubalternization of,86;discriminationagainst,108–9; liberationvia,109;inMovimientoAl Socialismo,82–83;neologismsin,115– 16;innewspapers,93,120n14;normalizationof,94,114–15,120n16;orality asbasisof,120n17;pan-Andeanunificationof,115;onradio,93;revitalizationof,11,115;Spanishand,10–11, 91–93,109,115;written,promotionof, 114–15,121n25;yachayniyku(politicsof Quechuaknowledge),101–14,117.See alsoPCÑ ;Quechuayachay Quechuapeople(Peru,Ecuador,Bolivia, Chile,andArgentina),55–56,81,86 Quechuayachay:communityandculturalrootsof,103,110–14,117–18, 121n24;ondevelopment/modernization,111–12;formsoflocalknowledge in,vs.Westerncategories,83;knowledgeandterritorialityand,116–18; languageand,103,108–10;orality andmeaningsof,86–87;inschool
andcommunity,103,105–8;subjects relatedwith,103;valueof,103–5 Quetzaltenango(Guatemala),211 Racancoj,Víctor,200 racialformation,181,192–93,194n9, 195n22 racism:antimiscegenationlaws,181, 193n3;decolonizationtocombat, 192–93;one-droprule,11–12,189;segregationandoppressionofblacks, 187;“speakingsecrets”about,176–77; struggleagainst,118;U.S.racialatmosphereand,141–42n1;whiteprivilege and,2,11–12;whitesupremacyand,35, 49,179,186–87,191–93,194n8.See also Indians’antiblackracism RadioEducación(Mexico),159 Raibmon,Paige,193n2 RamosPacho,Abelardo,8,10–11,17, 82–83,130,141,142n3,143n10.See also collaborationandhistoricalwriting RapaNui(EasterIsland),24;“Agreement ofWills,”56–57,68,73,75n2,76n11; airportin,67;autonomyof,prospects for,71–72,74,78n22;casinodebatein, 65–66;Chileanannexationof,6,54, 56–57,60,66;Chileanconsolidation ofholdon,59–60;Chileanevolution/ imperialismand,23;Chileaninscriptionof(1933),60–61,76–77nn10–12; Chileannavalpresencein,58–60, 66–67,76n7,76n9;clansystemand leadersof,56–59,70–71,74,75n3, 76n9;collectivelandownershipproposalin,72,78n23;colonialismto self-determinationfor,pathof,66–73; CommissiononHistoricTruthand NewRelationshipwithIndigenous Peoplesin,68–69;Compañíain, 58–61,67;CouncilofEldersin,62,64, 66,69,72,77n14,77n16,78n24;Devel-
opmentCommission(coDeipa )for, 64–66,68;diseasesintroducedonto, 58–59;earlyChileancolonization, 57–61,66;foreigninvestmentsin,65; historyof,55–57;identity/memory in,revitalizationandrecoveryof,23; immigrationto,78n23;independence for,7–8;integrationismin,57,62–64, 73–74;kinshipin,7;landvs.territory in,56–57,59;LeyIndígena(1990)in, 63–66,68,74;LeyPascua(1966)in, 61–63,67–68,74;LeyPinochet(1979) in,62–64,74;millenniumcelebration on,54;nonislanders,influxof,67;partitioningof,58;privateproperty/land titlesvs.communal/ancestrallandsin, 57–65,67–71,73–74,75n4,75–76n6, 76n8,77n14;Rapanuiculturalidentity,54–55,67–68,74–75;Rapanui leadersandChileanpartypolitics,64, 77nn16–17;RapanuiParliament,69, 73;RapanuiresistancetoChileanrule, 54–55,69,74,76n8;Rapanui’sChilean citizenship,61,67;realestatemarketin,65;sheepfarmingon,58,60, 66,76n9;slaveraidson,58–59;SpecialTerritorystatusof,70–73,78n24; stonestatues(moai)on,54;use-rights concessionsby,6 RapanuiNationalPark,77n12 RapanuiUniversity,66 Rappaport,Joanne,8–11,82–83,130,141. See alsocollaborationandhistorical writing Rapu,Mike,65 RapuHaoa,Alfonso,78n19 Raqaypampa(Cochabamba,Bolivia),88, 106,110,112,118,120n7 ReciprocityTreaty(1875),30 researchsubjects,identificationof,163, 173n12 Retière,Alain,159
inDex 259
Reuque,Isolde,12,19n7 revolutionaryviolence,163 Rice v. Cayetano(U.S.SupremeCourt), 36 rights-baseddiscourse,16–17 Riroroko,Simeon,76n6 RiveraCusicanqui,Silvia,16–17 Rodríguez,Carlos,171n1 Rodríguez,Demetrio,197,200 Romero,R.,121n24 Ross,Elizabeth,173–74n13 Rountree,Helen,181 Ruiz,Samuel,171n1,174n17 Rus,DianeL.:legitimacyintheTzotzil community,8–9;TallerTzotzil,overviewof,8–10,82–83;Tzotzilnamesof, 8–9,153,173n10;workof,onTa jlok’ta chobtik(Bordando Milpas),12,158–61, 164.See alsoTallerTzotzil Rus,Jan:legitimacyintheTzotzilcommunity,8–9;TallerTzotzil,overview of,8–10,82–83;Tzotzilnamesof,8–9, 153,173n10.See alsoTallerTzotzil SalinasdeGortari,Carlos,164–66 Salomon,Frank,9 SanAndrésPeaceAccords(1996), 174n17,174n20 SanCristóbaldelasCasas(Chiapas, Mexico),10,155–56 SanJosédeMizqueCooperative(Cochabamba,Bolivia),88 saqra(cognitivelyintelligentchildren), 121n24 Saunt,Claudio,187 Schele,Linda,198–99 seeds,95,111–12 SettlersforHawaiianIndependence,28 shamans,128,132;cosmovisionand, 137–39,199 Sieder,Rachel,207 Silva,Noenoe,12–13,15,32,219 260 inDex
sil /Wbt (SummerInstituteofLinguistics/WycliffeBibleTranslators),152, 172n2,172–73n7,173n9 SimónPatiñoFoundation(Bolivia),88 sistematización,143n15 Smith,LindaTuhiwai,2,14–15,18n2,176; Decolonizing Methodologies,192–93, 193n1 SnaJtz’ibajom,172n2 Sojom,JacintoArias,152–53,172n2 solidarity,170 sovereignty:autonomyand,142n5; Hawaiian,28–29,34,38–39;indigenousrightsand,46–47;overterritories,76–77n11;territoryand,128 Spanish:inPCÑ ,91–94;Quechuaand, 10–11,91–93,109,115 Spanish-AmericanWar(1898),6–7 SpecialCommitteeof24onDecolonization(un ),51n5 spiralmotif,128,136 SpiritualNationofKā—HuiEaCouncil ofSovereigns,28 State of Hawaii v. Office of Hawaiian Affairs(U.S.SupremeCourt),38, 51–52n8,52n13 Stevens,JohnL.,31–32 storytellingtraditions’importance,4 Street,B.,95 struggle,13,22–23,119n3 Suazo,Siles,120n16 Subercaseaux,Bernardo,75n5 SummerInstituteofLinguistics/Wycliffe BibleTranslators.Seesil /Wbt sunqu(heart),98–100 Tademy,Lalita,194n7 Tahiti,56 Ta jlok’ta chobtik(Bordando Milpas; D.L.Rus),158–61,164 TallerLeñateros,172n2,173n8 TallerTzotzil(Chiapas,Mexico):author-
shipof,145,153,156–57,160,163–64, 169;bilingualeditionsof,151–52,154, 157,160;Chiapasinmid-1980s,147– 49;communitycollaborations,157–64; dialectchoicefor,152–53;distribution andsaleofpublications,150,155–56, 159–60,172–73n7;documentingnarratives,149–53;economiccrisisand,10, 144,147,155,157–58;editingof,161–63; editors’introductions,152;funding for,171n1;goalsof,10;monolingualvs. bilingualpublication,151–52;orthographyof,152,173n9;overviewand backgroundof,8–10,82–83,144–47, 171–72nn1–2;photographsin,153,155; politicalandculturalfactionsand, 153–57,173n11;reflectionson,170–71; tapecassettesconsideredfor,172n6; transitionsand,164–66;translationof, 160–61;voices,150;women’sparticipationin,150–51;Zapatistauprising’s effectson,10,83,167–69 TallerTzotzil,publicationsof:Abtel ta Pinka,149–57,160,173n7;Buch’u Lasmeltzan Jobel?155–58;“Conversacionesininterrumpidas,”168;Historia de un pueblo evangelista,174n13; Ja’ k’u x’elan ta jpojbatik ta ilbajinel yu’un jkaxlanetik,148;Jchi’iltak ta Slumal Kalifornya,168–69;K’alal ich’ay mosoal,148;Kipaltik: K’u cha’al lajmankutik jpinkakutik,159–64;Lo’il yu’un Kuskat,151–52,156;“Losprimerosmesesdeloszapatistas,”168– 69,174n19;SanCristóbalshantytowns’ history(inprogress),169;Slo’il ch’vo’ kumpareil,166,173–74n13;Ta jlok’ta chobtik ta ku’il(Bordando Milpas),12, 158–62,164,166;“ATzotzilChronicle oftheZapatistaUprising,”168 TaskForceonNativeHawaiianIssues,36 Teave,DanielMaría,75–76n6
technology,modern:biotechnology,116; fromgreenrevolution,112;peasant knowledgevs.,88,110–12,117,121n23 Tepano,Juan,76n9 territory:integrityof,andindigenous rights,46–47;landvs.,56–57,59,128; sovereigntyand,128;spaceand,128 testimonio,160,172n5.See alsoTaller Tzotzil theorization.See undercollaborationand historicalwriting Thiong’o,Ngugiwa,192 Tiawuanakumanifesto(Bolivia,1973),86 Ties that Bind: The Story of an AfroCherokee Family in Slavery and Freedom(Miles),192 Titicachi(Peru),121n24 Toro,PedroPablo,57–58,73 ToroHurtado,Policarpo,56–57 Totora(Cochabamba,Bolivia),88–89 tradeagreements,116–17,127,164–65, 214 traditionalauthority,142n9 transformisthegemony,206 translation,4 translationvs.writing/inscription,8–9. See alsoTallerTzotzil trees,communalownershipof,114 TribalNationspolicy(U.S.),27 tribalvs.foreignnations,39–40 truth,rulesofevidencefor,14 Tuki,Rafael(“Rinko”),73 Tunica-BiloxiTribe(Mississippiand Louisiana),182,189 Tyler,John,30 TzotzilMayapeople(Chiapas,Mexico): coffeeworkby,149–51,165;critical historicalnarrativeamong,170;migrationof,10;Protestant,151,155;as undocumentedworkersinCalifornia, 168–69;writingby,145,170,172n2.See alsoTallerTzotzil
inDex 261
udu(UnióndeUniones;Mexico),159– 60,164–65 uma(head),98–99 undocumentedmigration,168–69,174n19 UnióndeUniones(u du ;Mexico),159– 60,164–65 UniónRevolucionariaNacionalGuatemalteca(urng ),205,218n14 UnitedConfederationofBolivian WorkersandPeasants(csutcb ),89, 114 UnitedNations:Charter(1945),29,34, 43;CommissiononHumanRights, 44–45,47–48;EconomicandSocial Council,44;Hawaiʻi’sinclusionon listofnon-self-governingterritories, 33–34,51n3;HumanRightsCouncil, 45,53n19,69;onindigenousrights, 2,22–23.See alsoDeclarationonthe RightsofIndigenousPeoples UnitedStates:Constitutionof,32,39; Hawaiʻionindigenousrights,45; polarizedracialatmosphereof,141– 42n1;victoryinSpanish-American War,6–7.See alsoHawaiʻi UnitedStatesDepartmentofDefense, 40,42 UnitedStatesDepartmentofJustice,42 UnitedStatesDepartmentofState,40 UnitedStatesDepartmentoftheInterior,39–40 UnitedStatesNationalSecurityCouncil,47–48 UnitedStatesOfficeofNativeHawaiian Relations,39–40,42 UnitedStatesSenateCommitteeon IndianAffairs,42 UniversidaddelosAndes(Bogotá, Colombia),124 urng (UniónRevolucionariaNacional Guatemalteca),205,218n14 userightsvs.propertyrights,6 262 inDex
Valparaíso,Chile,56–58,66–67,70 Varese,Stéfano,12–13,15,17,219 Virginiaantimiscegenationlaws,181, 193n3 Waitangi,Treatyof,75n2 WarofthePacific(1879–84),6–7,55–56 Warren,Kay,198–99 Watanabe,J.,218n21 weatherprediction,110–12 whiteprivilege,2,11–12 whitesupremacy,35,49,179,186–87, 191–93,194n8 Williams,Brackette,206 WilliamsonBalfourandCompany (Compañía;Scotland),58–61,67 Wilson,AngelaCavender,2,15,17 Winant,H.,195n22 women,indigenous:Komes’sweavingand embroideringcooperative,12,158,161– 62,165–66;marginalizationof,19n7; Maya,211;writingby,150–51,173n8 Women’sOrganizationofKuyupaya,95 WorkingGrouponIndigenousPopulations(Wgip ;un ),44–46 WorkshopfortheHandlingofPotato andCornVarieties,95–96 writingvs.orality,95 yachayniyku(politicsofQuechuaknowledge),101–14,117 Yapita,JuandeDios,121n25 Zapatistas(Mexico):eZln ,84,167, 174n17;governmentrepressionof,167, 174nn14–15;“Losprimerosmesesde loszapatistas,”168–69,174n19;protectingleaders’identities,164;rebellionby(1994),10,83,144,150,154, 166–69,174n19;TallerTzotziland,10, 83,167–69.See alsoeZln Zavala,Virginia,119n1,121n19
Florencia e. mallon istheJulietaKirkwoodProfessorofHistoryandLatinAmerican Studies and chair of the History Department at the University of Wisconsin. SheistheauthorofCourage Tastes of Blood: The Mapuche Indigenous Community of Nicolás Ailío and the Chilean State, 1906–2000(Duke,2005);Peasant and Nation: The Making of Postcolonial Mexico and Peru(1995);andThe Defense of Community in Peru’s Central Highlands: Peasant Struggle and Capitalist Transition, 1860–1940(1983) andtheeditorandtranslatorofRosaIsoldeReuquePaillalef,When a Flower Is Reborn: The Life and Times of a Mapuche Feminist(Duke,2002).
LibraryofCongressCataloging-in-PublicationData Decolonizingnativehistories:collaboration,knowledge,andlanguageintheAmericas/ editedbyFlorenciaE.Mallon;selectedessaystranslatedbyGladysMcCormick. p.cm.—(Narratingnativehistories) Includesbibliographicalreferencesandindex.
isbn 978-0-8223-5137-5(cloth:alk.paper)—isbn 978-0-8223-5152-8(pbk.:alk.paper) 1.Languageandlanguages—Politicalaspects. 2.Languageandculture—America. 3.Indigenouspeoplesandmassmedia—America. I.Mallon,FlorenciaE.,1951– II.Series:Narratingnativehistories.
p119.3.D432012 306.44′6097—dc23 2011027459